1 //===- ScalarEvolution.cpp - Scalar Evolution Analysis --------------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file contains the implementation of the scalar evolution analysis 10 // engine, which is used primarily to analyze expressions involving induction 11 // variables in loops. 12 // 13 // There are several aspects to this library. First is the representation of 14 // scalar expressions, which are represented as subclasses of the SCEV class. 15 // These classes are used to represent certain types of subexpressions that we 16 // can handle. We only create one SCEV of a particular shape, so 17 // pointer-comparisons for equality are legal. 18 // 19 // One important aspect of the SCEV objects is that they are never cyclic, even 20 // if there is a cycle in the dataflow for an expression (ie, a PHI node). If 21 // the PHI node is one of the idioms that we can represent (e.g., a polynomial 22 // recurrence) then we represent it directly as a recurrence node, otherwise we 23 // represent it as a SCEVUnknown node. 24 // 25 // In addition to being able to represent expressions of various types, we also 26 // have folders that are used to build the *canonical* representation for a 27 // particular expression. These folders are capable of using a variety of 28 // rewrite rules to simplify the expressions. 29 // 30 // Once the folders are defined, we can implement the more interesting 31 // higher-level code, such as the code that recognizes PHI nodes of various 32 // types, computes the execution count of a loop, etc. 33 // 34 // TODO: We should use these routines and value representations to implement 35 // dependence analysis! 36 // 37 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 38 // 39 // There are several good references for the techniques used in this analysis. 40 // 41 // Chains of recurrences -- a method to expedite the evaluation 42 // of closed-form functions 43 // Olaf Bachmann, Paul S. Wang, Eugene V. Zima 44 // 45 // On computational properties of chains of recurrences 46 // Eugene V. Zima 47 // 48 // Symbolic Evaluation of Chains of Recurrences for Loop Optimization 49 // Robert A. van Engelen 50 // 51 // Efficient Symbolic Analysis for Optimizing Compilers 52 // Robert A. van Engelen 53 // 54 // Using the chains of recurrences algebra for data dependence testing and 55 // induction variable substitution 56 // MS Thesis, Johnie Birch 57 // 58 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 59 60 #include "llvm/Analysis/ScalarEvolution.h" 61 #include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h" 62 #include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h" 63 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h" 64 #include "llvm/ADT/DepthFirstIterator.h" 65 #include "llvm/ADT/EquivalenceClasses.h" 66 #include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h" 67 #include "llvm/ADT/None.h" 68 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" 69 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 70 #include "llvm/ADT/ScopeExit.h" 71 #include "llvm/ADT/Sequence.h" 72 #include "llvm/ADT/SetVector.h" 73 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 74 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallSet.h" 75 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h" 76 #include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h" 77 #include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h" 78 #include "llvm/Analysis/AssumptionCache.h" 79 #include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h" 80 #include "llvm/Analysis/InstructionSimplify.h" 81 #include "llvm/Analysis/LoopInfo.h" 82 #include "llvm/Analysis/ScalarEvolutionDivision.h" 83 #include "llvm/Analysis/ScalarEvolutionExpressions.h" 84 #include "llvm/Analysis/TargetLibraryInfo.h" 85 #include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h" 86 #include "llvm/Config/llvm-config.h" 87 #include "llvm/IR/Argument.h" 88 #include "llvm/IR/BasicBlock.h" 89 #include "llvm/IR/CFG.h" 90 #include "llvm/IR/Constant.h" 91 #include "llvm/IR/ConstantRange.h" 92 #include "llvm/IR/Constants.h" 93 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h" 94 #include "llvm/IR/DerivedTypes.h" 95 #include "llvm/IR/Dominators.h" 96 #include "llvm/IR/Function.h" 97 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalAlias.h" 98 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalValue.h" 99 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalVariable.h" 100 #include "llvm/IR/InstIterator.h" 101 #include "llvm/IR/InstrTypes.h" 102 #include "llvm/IR/Instruction.h" 103 #include "llvm/IR/Instructions.h" 104 #include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicInst.h" 105 #include "llvm/IR/Intrinsics.h" 106 #include "llvm/IR/LLVMContext.h" 107 #include "llvm/IR/Metadata.h" 108 #include "llvm/IR/Operator.h" 109 #include "llvm/IR/PatternMatch.h" 110 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h" 111 #include "llvm/IR/Use.h" 112 #include "llvm/IR/User.h" 113 #include "llvm/IR/Value.h" 114 #include "llvm/IR/Verifier.h" 115 #include "llvm/InitializePasses.h" 116 #include "llvm/Pass.h" 117 #include "llvm/Support/Casting.h" 118 #include "llvm/Support/CommandLine.h" 119 #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h" 120 #include "llvm/Support/Debug.h" 121 #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h" 122 #include "llvm/Support/KnownBits.h" 123 #include "llvm/Support/SaveAndRestore.h" 124 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h" 125 #include <algorithm> 126 #include <cassert> 127 #include <climits> 128 #include <cstddef> 129 #include <cstdint> 130 #include <cstdlib> 131 #include <map> 132 #include <memory> 133 #include <tuple> 134 #include <utility> 135 #include <vector> 136 137 using namespace llvm; 138 using namespace PatternMatch; 139 140 #define DEBUG_TYPE "scalar-evolution" 141 142 STATISTIC(NumTripCountsComputed, 143 "Number of loops with predictable loop counts"); 144 STATISTIC(NumTripCountsNotComputed, 145 "Number of loops without predictable loop counts"); 146 STATISTIC(NumBruteForceTripCountsComputed, 147 "Number of loops with trip counts computed by force"); 148 149 static cl::opt<unsigned> 150 MaxBruteForceIterations("scalar-evolution-max-iterations", cl::ReallyHidden, 151 cl::ZeroOrMore, 152 cl::desc("Maximum number of iterations SCEV will " 153 "symbolically execute a constant " 154 "derived loop"), 155 cl::init(100)); 156 157 // FIXME: Enable this with EXPENSIVE_CHECKS when the test suite is clean. 158 static cl::opt<bool> VerifySCEV( 159 "verify-scev", cl::Hidden, 160 cl::desc("Verify ScalarEvolution's backedge taken counts (slow)")); 161 static cl::opt<bool> VerifySCEVStrict( 162 "verify-scev-strict", cl::Hidden, 163 cl::desc("Enable stricter verification with -verify-scev is passed")); 164 static cl::opt<bool> 165 VerifySCEVMap("verify-scev-maps", cl::Hidden, 166 cl::desc("Verify no dangling value in ScalarEvolution's " 167 "ExprValueMap (slow)")); 168 169 static cl::opt<bool> VerifyIR( 170 "scev-verify-ir", cl::Hidden, 171 cl::desc("Verify IR correctness when making sensitive SCEV queries (slow)"), 172 cl::init(false)); 173 174 static cl::opt<unsigned> MulOpsInlineThreshold( 175 "scev-mulops-inline-threshold", cl::Hidden, 176 cl::desc("Threshold for inlining multiplication operands into a SCEV"), 177 cl::init(32)); 178 179 static cl::opt<unsigned> AddOpsInlineThreshold( 180 "scev-addops-inline-threshold", cl::Hidden, 181 cl::desc("Threshold for inlining addition operands into a SCEV"), 182 cl::init(500)); 183 184 static cl::opt<unsigned> MaxSCEVCompareDepth( 185 "scalar-evolution-max-scev-compare-depth", cl::Hidden, 186 cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive SCEV complexity comparisons"), 187 cl::init(32)); 188 189 static cl::opt<unsigned> MaxSCEVOperationsImplicationDepth( 190 "scalar-evolution-max-scev-operations-implication-depth", cl::Hidden, 191 cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive SCEV operations implication analysis"), 192 cl::init(2)); 193 194 static cl::opt<unsigned> MaxValueCompareDepth( 195 "scalar-evolution-max-value-compare-depth", cl::Hidden, 196 cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive value complexity comparisons"), 197 cl::init(2)); 198 199 static cl::opt<unsigned> 200 MaxArithDepth("scalar-evolution-max-arith-depth", cl::Hidden, 201 cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive arithmetics"), 202 cl::init(32)); 203 204 static cl::opt<unsigned> MaxConstantEvolvingDepth( 205 "scalar-evolution-max-constant-evolving-depth", cl::Hidden, 206 cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive constant evolving"), cl::init(32)); 207 208 static cl::opt<unsigned> 209 MaxCastDepth("scalar-evolution-max-cast-depth", cl::Hidden, 210 cl::desc("Maximum depth of recursive SExt/ZExt/Trunc"), 211 cl::init(8)); 212 213 static cl::opt<unsigned> 214 MaxAddRecSize("scalar-evolution-max-add-rec-size", cl::Hidden, 215 cl::desc("Max coefficients in AddRec during evolving"), 216 cl::init(8)); 217 218 static cl::opt<unsigned> 219 HugeExprThreshold("scalar-evolution-huge-expr-threshold", cl::Hidden, 220 cl::desc("Size of the expression which is considered huge"), 221 cl::init(4096)); 222 223 static cl::opt<bool> 224 ClassifyExpressions("scalar-evolution-classify-expressions", 225 cl::Hidden, cl::init(true), 226 cl::desc("When printing analysis, include information on every instruction")); 227 228 static cl::opt<bool> UseExpensiveRangeSharpening( 229 "scalar-evolution-use-expensive-range-sharpening", cl::Hidden, 230 cl::init(false), 231 cl::desc("Use more powerful methods of sharpening expression ranges. May " 232 "be costly in terms of compile time")); 233 234 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 235 // SCEV class definitions 236 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 237 238 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 239 // Implementation of the SCEV class. 240 // 241 242 #if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(LLVM_ENABLE_DUMP) 243 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void SCEV::dump() const { 244 print(dbgs()); 245 dbgs() << '\n'; 246 } 247 #endif 248 249 void SCEV::print(raw_ostream &OS) const { 250 switch (getSCEVType()) { 251 case scConstant: 252 cast<SCEVConstant>(this)->getValue()->printAsOperand(OS, false); 253 return; 254 case scPtrToInt: { 255 const SCEVPtrToIntExpr *PtrToInt = cast<SCEVPtrToIntExpr>(this); 256 const SCEV *Op = PtrToInt->getOperand(); 257 OS << "(ptrtoint " << *Op->getType() << " " << *Op << " to " 258 << *PtrToInt->getType() << ")"; 259 return; 260 } 261 case scTruncate: { 262 const SCEVTruncateExpr *Trunc = cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(this); 263 const SCEV *Op = Trunc->getOperand(); 264 OS << "(trunc " << *Op->getType() << " " << *Op << " to " 265 << *Trunc->getType() << ")"; 266 return; 267 } 268 case scZeroExtend: { 269 const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(this); 270 const SCEV *Op = ZExt->getOperand(); 271 OS << "(zext " << *Op->getType() << " " << *Op << " to " 272 << *ZExt->getType() << ")"; 273 return; 274 } 275 case scSignExtend: { 276 const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(this); 277 const SCEV *Op = SExt->getOperand(); 278 OS << "(sext " << *Op->getType() << " " << *Op << " to " 279 << *SExt->getType() << ")"; 280 return; 281 } 282 case scAddRecExpr: { 283 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(this); 284 OS << "{" << *AR->getOperand(0); 285 for (unsigned i = 1, e = AR->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 286 OS << ",+," << *AR->getOperand(i); 287 OS << "}<"; 288 if (AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) 289 OS << "nuw><"; 290 if (AR->hasNoSignedWrap()) 291 OS << "nsw><"; 292 if (AR->hasNoSelfWrap() && 293 !AR->getNoWrapFlags((NoWrapFlags)(FlagNUW | FlagNSW))) 294 OS << "nw><"; 295 AR->getLoop()->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false); 296 OS << ">"; 297 return; 298 } 299 case scAddExpr: 300 case scMulExpr: 301 case scUMaxExpr: 302 case scSMaxExpr: 303 case scUMinExpr: 304 case scSMinExpr: { 305 const SCEVNAryExpr *NAry = cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(this); 306 const char *OpStr = nullptr; 307 switch (NAry->getSCEVType()) { 308 case scAddExpr: OpStr = " + "; break; 309 case scMulExpr: OpStr = " * "; break; 310 case scUMaxExpr: OpStr = " umax "; break; 311 case scSMaxExpr: OpStr = " smax "; break; 312 case scUMinExpr: 313 OpStr = " umin "; 314 break; 315 case scSMinExpr: 316 OpStr = " smin "; 317 break; 318 default: 319 llvm_unreachable("There are no other nary expression types."); 320 } 321 OS << "("; 322 ListSeparator LS(OpStr); 323 for (const SCEV *Op : NAry->operands()) 324 OS << LS << *Op; 325 OS << ")"; 326 switch (NAry->getSCEVType()) { 327 case scAddExpr: 328 case scMulExpr: 329 if (NAry->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) 330 OS << "<nuw>"; 331 if (NAry->hasNoSignedWrap()) 332 OS << "<nsw>"; 333 break; 334 default: 335 // Nothing to print for other nary expressions. 336 break; 337 } 338 return; 339 } 340 case scUDivExpr: { 341 const SCEVUDivExpr *UDiv = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(this); 342 OS << "(" << *UDiv->getLHS() << " /u " << *UDiv->getRHS() << ")"; 343 return; 344 } 345 case scUnknown: { 346 const SCEVUnknown *U = cast<SCEVUnknown>(this); 347 Type *AllocTy; 348 if (U->isSizeOf(AllocTy)) { 349 OS << "sizeof(" << *AllocTy << ")"; 350 return; 351 } 352 if (U->isAlignOf(AllocTy)) { 353 OS << "alignof(" << *AllocTy << ")"; 354 return; 355 } 356 357 Type *CTy; 358 Constant *FieldNo; 359 if (U->isOffsetOf(CTy, FieldNo)) { 360 OS << "offsetof(" << *CTy << ", "; 361 FieldNo->printAsOperand(OS, false); 362 OS << ")"; 363 return; 364 } 365 366 // Otherwise just print it normally. 367 U->getValue()->printAsOperand(OS, false); 368 return; 369 } 370 case scCouldNotCompute: 371 OS << "***COULDNOTCOMPUTE***"; 372 return; 373 } 374 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!"); 375 } 376 377 Type *SCEV::getType() const { 378 switch (getSCEVType()) { 379 case scConstant: 380 return cast<SCEVConstant>(this)->getType(); 381 case scPtrToInt: 382 case scTruncate: 383 case scZeroExtend: 384 case scSignExtend: 385 return cast<SCEVCastExpr>(this)->getType(); 386 case scAddRecExpr: 387 return cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(this)->getType(); 388 case scMulExpr: 389 return cast<SCEVMulExpr>(this)->getType(); 390 case scUMaxExpr: 391 case scSMaxExpr: 392 case scUMinExpr: 393 case scSMinExpr: 394 return cast<SCEVMinMaxExpr>(this)->getType(); 395 case scAddExpr: 396 return cast<SCEVAddExpr>(this)->getType(); 397 case scUDivExpr: 398 return cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(this)->getType(); 399 case scUnknown: 400 return cast<SCEVUnknown>(this)->getType(); 401 case scCouldNotCompute: 402 llvm_unreachable("Attempt to use a SCEVCouldNotCompute object!"); 403 } 404 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!"); 405 } 406 407 bool SCEV::isZero() const { 408 if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(this)) 409 return SC->getValue()->isZero(); 410 return false; 411 } 412 413 bool SCEV::isOne() const { 414 if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(this)) 415 return SC->getValue()->isOne(); 416 return false; 417 } 418 419 bool SCEV::isAllOnesValue() const { 420 if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(this)) 421 return SC->getValue()->isMinusOne(); 422 return false; 423 } 424 425 bool SCEV::isNonConstantNegative() const { 426 const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(this); 427 if (!Mul) return false; 428 429 // If there is a constant factor, it will be first. 430 const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0)); 431 if (!SC) return false; 432 433 // Return true if the value is negative, this matches things like (-42 * V). 434 return SC->getAPInt().isNegative(); 435 } 436 437 SCEVCouldNotCompute::SCEVCouldNotCompute() : 438 SCEV(FoldingSetNodeIDRef(), scCouldNotCompute, 0) {} 439 440 bool SCEVCouldNotCompute::classof(const SCEV *S) { 441 return S->getSCEVType() == scCouldNotCompute; 442 } 443 444 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getConstant(ConstantInt *V) { 445 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 446 ID.AddInteger(scConstant); 447 ID.AddPointer(V); 448 void *IP = nullptr; 449 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S; 450 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVConstant(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), V); 451 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 452 return S; 453 } 454 455 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getConstant(const APInt &Val) { 456 return getConstant(ConstantInt::get(getContext(), Val)); 457 } 458 459 const SCEV * 460 ScalarEvolution::getConstant(Type *Ty, uint64_t V, bool isSigned) { 461 IntegerType *ITy = cast<IntegerType>(getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty)); 462 return getConstant(ConstantInt::get(ITy, V, isSigned)); 463 } 464 465 SCEVCastExpr::SCEVCastExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID, SCEVTypes SCEVTy, 466 const SCEV *op, Type *ty) 467 : SCEV(ID, SCEVTy, computeExpressionSize(op)), Ty(ty) { 468 Operands[0] = op; 469 } 470 471 SCEVPtrToIntExpr::SCEVPtrToIntExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID, const SCEV *Op, 472 Type *ITy) 473 : SCEVCastExpr(ID, scPtrToInt, Op, ITy) { 474 assert(getOperand()->getType()->isPointerTy() && Ty->isIntegerTy() && 475 "Must be a non-bit-width-changing pointer-to-integer cast!"); 476 } 477 478 SCEVIntegralCastExpr::SCEVIntegralCastExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID, 479 SCEVTypes SCEVTy, const SCEV *op, 480 Type *ty) 481 : SCEVCastExpr(ID, SCEVTy, op, ty) {} 482 483 SCEVTruncateExpr::SCEVTruncateExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID, const SCEV *op, 484 Type *ty) 485 : SCEVIntegralCastExpr(ID, scTruncate, op, ty) { 486 assert(getOperand()->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() && 487 "Cannot truncate non-integer value!"); 488 } 489 490 SCEVZeroExtendExpr::SCEVZeroExtendExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID, 491 const SCEV *op, Type *ty) 492 : SCEVIntegralCastExpr(ID, scZeroExtend, op, ty) { 493 assert(getOperand()->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() && 494 "Cannot zero extend non-integer value!"); 495 } 496 497 SCEVSignExtendExpr::SCEVSignExtendExpr(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID, 498 const SCEV *op, Type *ty) 499 : SCEVIntegralCastExpr(ID, scSignExtend, op, ty) { 500 assert(getOperand()->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() && 501 "Cannot sign extend non-integer value!"); 502 } 503 504 void SCEVUnknown::deleted() { 505 // Clear this SCEVUnknown from various maps. 506 SE->forgetMemoizedResults(this); 507 508 // Remove this SCEVUnknown from the uniquing map. 509 SE->UniqueSCEVs.RemoveNode(this); 510 511 // Release the value. 512 setValPtr(nullptr); 513 } 514 515 void SCEVUnknown::allUsesReplacedWith(Value *New) { 516 // Remove this SCEVUnknown from the uniquing map. 517 SE->UniqueSCEVs.RemoveNode(this); 518 519 // Update this SCEVUnknown to point to the new value. This is needed 520 // because there may still be outstanding SCEVs which still point to 521 // this SCEVUnknown. 522 setValPtr(New); 523 } 524 525 bool SCEVUnknown::isSizeOf(Type *&AllocTy) const { 526 if (ConstantExpr *VCE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(getValue())) 527 if (VCE->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt) 528 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(VCE->getOperand(0))) 529 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr && 530 CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue() && 531 CE->getNumOperands() == 2) 532 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CE->getOperand(1))) 533 if (CI->isOne()) { 534 AllocTy = cast<GEPOperator>(CE)->getSourceElementType(); 535 return true; 536 } 537 538 return false; 539 } 540 541 bool SCEVUnknown::isAlignOf(Type *&AllocTy) const { 542 if (ConstantExpr *VCE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(getValue())) 543 if (VCE->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt) 544 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(VCE->getOperand(0))) 545 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr && 546 CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) { 547 Type *Ty = cast<GEPOperator>(CE)->getSourceElementType(); 548 if (StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty)) 549 if (!STy->isPacked() && 550 CE->getNumOperands() == 3 && 551 CE->getOperand(1)->isNullValue()) { 552 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CE->getOperand(2))) 553 if (CI->isOne() && 554 STy->getNumElements() == 2 && 555 STy->getElementType(0)->isIntegerTy(1)) { 556 AllocTy = STy->getElementType(1); 557 return true; 558 } 559 } 560 } 561 562 return false; 563 } 564 565 bool SCEVUnknown::isOffsetOf(Type *&CTy, Constant *&FieldNo) const { 566 if (ConstantExpr *VCE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(getValue())) 567 if (VCE->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt) 568 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(VCE->getOperand(0))) 569 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr && 570 CE->getNumOperands() == 3 && 571 CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue() && 572 CE->getOperand(1)->isNullValue()) { 573 Type *Ty = cast<GEPOperator>(CE)->getSourceElementType(); 574 // Ignore vector types here so that ScalarEvolutionExpander doesn't 575 // emit getelementptrs that index into vectors. 576 if (Ty->isStructTy() || Ty->isArrayTy()) { 577 CTy = Ty; 578 FieldNo = CE->getOperand(2); 579 return true; 580 } 581 } 582 583 return false; 584 } 585 586 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 587 // SCEV Utilities 588 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 589 590 /// Compare the two values \p LV and \p RV in terms of their "complexity" where 591 /// "complexity" is a partial (and somewhat ad-hoc) relation used to order 592 /// operands in SCEV expressions. \p EqCache is a set of pairs of values that 593 /// have been previously deemed to be "equally complex" by this routine. It is 594 /// intended to avoid exponential time complexity in cases like: 595 /// 596 /// %a = f(%x, %y) 597 /// %b = f(%a, %a) 598 /// %c = f(%b, %b) 599 /// 600 /// %d = f(%x, %y) 601 /// %e = f(%d, %d) 602 /// %f = f(%e, %e) 603 /// 604 /// CompareValueComplexity(%f, %c) 605 /// 606 /// Since we do not continue running this routine on expression trees once we 607 /// have seen unequal values, there is no need to track them in the cache. 608 static int 609 CompareValueComplexity(EquivalenceClasses<const Value *> &EqCacheValue, 610 const LoopInfo *const LI, Value *LV, Value *RV, 611 unsigned Depth) { 612 if (Depth > MaxValueCompareDepth || EqCacheValue.isEquivalent(LV, RV)) 613 return 0; 614 615 // Order pointer values after integer values. This helps SCEVExpander form 616 // GEPs. 617 bool LIsPointer = LV->getType()->isPointerTy(), 618 RIsPointer = RV->getType()->isPointerTy(); 619 if (LIsPointer != RIsPointer) 620 return (int)LIsPointer - (int)RIsPointer; 621 622 // Compare getValueID values. 623 unsigned LID = LV->getValueID(), RID = RV->getValueID(); 624 if (LID != RID) 625 return (int)LID - (int)RID; 626 627 // Sort arguments by their position. 628 if (const auto *LA = dyn_cast<Argument>(LV)) { 629 const auto *RA = cast<Argument>(RV); 630 unsigned LArgNo = LA->getArgNo(), RArgNo = RA->getArgNo(); 631 return (int)LArgNo - (int)RArgNo; 632 } 633 634 if (const auto *LGV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(LV)) { 635 const auto *RGV = cast<GlobalValue>(RV); 636 637 const auto IsGVNameSemantic = [&](const GlobalValue *GV) { 638 auto LT = GV->getLinkage(); 639 return !(GlobalValue::isPrivateLinkage(LT) || 640 GlobalValue::isInternalLinkage(LT)); 641 }; 642 643 // Use the names to distinguish the two values, but only if the 644 // names are semantically important. 645 if (IsGVNameSemantic(LGV) && IsGVNameSemantic(RGV)) 646 return LGV->getName().compare(RGV->getName()); 647 } 648 649 // For instructions, compare their loop depth, and their operand count. This 650 // is pretty loose. 651 if (const auto *LInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LV)) { 652 const auto *RInst = cast<Instruction>(RV); 653 654 // Compare loop depths. 655 const BasicBlock *LParent = LInst->getParent(), 656 *RParent = RInst->getParent(); 657 if (LParent != RParent) { 658 unsigned LDepth = LI->getLoopDepth(LParent), 659 RDepth = LI->getLoopDepth(RParent); 660 if (LDepth != RDepth) 661 return (int)LDepth - (int)RDepth; 662 } 663 664 // Compare the number of operands. 665 unsigned LNumOps = LInst->getNumOperands(), 666 RNumOps = RInst->getNumOperands(); 667 if (LNumOps != RNumOps) 668 return (int)LNumOps - (int)RNumOps; 669 670 for (unsigned Idx : seq(0u, LNumOps)) { 671 int Result = 672 CompareValueComplexity(EqCacheValue, LI, LInst->getOperand(Idx), 673 RInst->getOperand(Idx), Depth + 1); 674 if (Result != 0) 675 return Result; 676 } 677 } 678 679 EqCacheValue.unionSets(LV, RV); 680 return 0; 681 } 682 683 // Return negative, zero, or positive, if LHS is less than, equal to, or greater 684 // than RHS, respectively. A three-way result allows recursive comparisons to be 685 // more efficient. 686 // If the max analysis depth was reached, return None, assuming we do not know 687 // if they are equivalent for sure. 688 static Optional<int> 689 CompareSCEVComplexity(EquivalenceClasses<const SCEV *> &EqCacheSCEV, 690 EquivalenceClasses<const Value *> &EqCacheValue, 691 const LoopInfo *const LI, const SCEV *LHS, 692 const SCEV *RHS, DominatorTree &DT, unsigned Depth = 0) { 693 // Fast-path: SCEVs are uniqued so we can do a quick equality check. 694 if (LHS == RHS) 695 return 0; 696 697 // Primarily, sort the SCEVs by their getSCEVType(). 698 SCEVTypes LType = LHS->getSCEVType(), RType = RHS->getSCEVType(); 699 if (LType != RType) 700 return (int)LType - (int)RType; 701 702 if (EqCacheSCEV.isEquivalent(LHS, RHS)) 703 return 0; 704 705 if (Depth > MaxSCEVCompareDepth) 706 return None; 707 708 // Aside from the getSCEVType() ordering, the particular ordering 709 // isn't very important except that it's beneficial to be consistent, 710 // so that (a + b) and (b + a) don't end up as different expressions. 711 switch (LType) { 712 case scUnknown: { 713 const SCEVUnknown *LU = cast<SCEVUnknown>(LHS); 714 const SCEVUnknown *RU = cast<SCEVUnknown>(RHS); 715 716 int X = CompareValueComplexity(EqCacheValue, LI, LU->getValue(), 717 RU->getValue(), Depth + 1); 718 if (X == 0) 719 EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS); 720 return X; 721 } 722 723 case scConstant: { 724 const SCEVConstant *LC = cast<SCEVConstant>(LHS); 725 const SCEVConstant *RC = cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS); 726 727 // Compare constant values. 728 const APInt &LA = LC->getAPInt(); 729 const APInt &RA = RC->getAPInt(); 730 unsigned LBitWidth = LA.getBitWidth(), RBitWidth = RA.getBitWidth(); 731 if (LBitWidth != RBitWidth) 732 return (int)LBitWidth - (int)RBitWidth; 733 return LA.ult(RA) ? -1 : 1; 734 } 735 736 case scAddRecExpr: { 737 const SCEVAddRecExpr *LA = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS); 738 const SCEVAddRecExpr *RA = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(RHS); 739 740 // There is always a dominance between two recs that are used by one SCEV, 741 // so we can safely sort recs by loop header dominance. We require such 742 // order in getAddExpr. 743 const Loop *LLoop = LA->getLoop(), *RLoop = RA->getLoop(); 744 if (LLoop != RLoop) { 745 const BasicBlock *LHead = LLoop->getHeader(), *RHead = RLoop->getHeader(); 746 assert(LHead != RHead && "Two loops share the same header?"); 747 if (DT.dominates(LHead, RHead)) 748 return 1; 749 else 750 assert(DT.dominates(RHead, LHead) && 751 "No dominance between recurrences used by one SCEV?"); 752 return -1; 753 } 754 755 // Addrec complexity grows with operand count. 756 unsigned LNumOps = LA->getNumOperands(), RNumOps = RA->getNumOperands(); 757 if (LNumOps != RNumOps) 758 return (int)LNumOps - (int)RNumOps; 759 760 // Lexicographically compare. 761 for (unsigned i = 0; i != LNumOps; ++i) { 762 auto X = CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI, 763 LA->getOperand(i), RA->getOperand(i), DT, 764 Depth + 1); 765 if (X != 0) 766 return X; 767 } 768 EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS); 769 return 0; 770 } 771 772 case scAddExpr: 773 case scMulExpr: 774 case scSMaxExpr: 775 case scUMaxExpr: 776 case scSMinExpr: 777 case scUMinExpr: { 778 const SCEVNAryExpr *LC = cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(LHS); 779 const SCEVNAryExpr *RC = cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(RHS); 780 781 // Lexicographically compare n-ary expressions. 782 unsigned LNumOps = LC->getNumOperands(), RNumOps = RC->getNumOperands(); 783 if (LNumOps != RNumOps) 784 return (int)LNumOps - (int)RNumOps; 785 786 for (unsigned i = 0; i != LNumOps; ++i) { 787 auto X = CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI, 788 LC->getOperand(i), RC->getOperand(i), DT, 789 Depth + 1); 790 if (X != 0) 791 return X; 792 } 793 EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS); 794 return 0; 795 } 796 797 case scUDivExpr: { 798 const SCEVUDivExpr *LC = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(LHS); 799 const SCEVUDivExpr *RC = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(RHS); 800 801 // Lexicographically compare udiv expressions. 802 auto X = CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI, LC->getLHS(), 803 RC->getLHS(), DT, Depth + 1); 804 if (X != 0) 805 return X; 806 X = CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI, LC->getRHS(), 807 RC->getRHS(), DT, Depth + 1); 808 if (X == 0) 809 EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS); 810 return X; 811 } 812 813 case scPtrToInt: 814 case scTruncate: 815 case scZeroExtend: 816 case scSignExtend: { 817 const SCEVCastExpr *LC = cast<SCEVCastExpr>(LHS); 818 const SCEVCastExpr *RC = cast<SCEVCastExpr>(RHS); 819 820 // Compare cast expressions by operand. 821 auto X = 822 CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI, LC->getOperand(), 823 RC->getOperand(), DT, Depth + 1); 824 if (X == 0) 825 EqCacheSCEV.unionSets(LHS, RHS); 826 return X; 827 } 828 829 case scCouldNotCompute: 830 llvm_unreachable("Attempt to use a SCEVCouldNotCompute object!"); 831 } 832 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!"); 833 } 834 835 /// Given a list of SCEV objects, order them by their complexity, and group 836 /// objects of the same complexity together by value. When this routine is 837 /// finished, we know that any duplicates in the vector are consecutive and that 838 /// complexity is monotonically increasing. 839 /// 840 /// Note that we go take special precautions to ensure that we get deterministic 841 /// results from this routine. In other words, we don't want the results of 842 /// this to depend on where the addresses of various SCEV objects happened to 843 /// land in memory. 844 static void GroupByComplexity(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops, 845 LoopInfo *LI, DominatorTree &DT) { 846 if (Ops.size() < 2) return; // Noop 847 848 EquivalenceClasses<const SCEV *> EqCacheSCEV; 849 EquivalenceClasses<const Value *> EqCacheValue; 850 851 // Whether LHS has provably less complexity than RHS. 852 auto IsLessComplex = [&](const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 853 auto Complexity = 854 CompareSCEVComplexity(EqCacheSCEV, EqCacheValue, LI, LHS, RHS, DT); 855 return Complexity && *Complexity < 0; 856 }; 857 if (Ops.size() == 2) { 858 // This is the common case, which also happens to be trivially simple. 859 // Special case it. 860 const SCEV *&LHS = Ops[0], *&RHS = Ops[1]; 861 if (IsLessComplex(RHS, LHS)) 862 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 863 return; 864 } 865 866 // Do the rough sort by complexity. 867 llvm::stable_sort(Ops, [&](const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 868 return IsLessComplex(LHS, RHS); 869 }); 870 871 // Now that we are sorted by complexity, group elements of the same 872 // complexity. Note that this is, at worst, N^2, but the vector is likely to 873 // be extremely short in practice. Note that we take this approach because we 874 // do not want to depend on the addresses of the objects we are grouping. 875 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e-2; ++i) { 876 const SCEV *S = Ops[i]; 877 unsigned Complexity = S->getSCEVType(); 878 879 // If there are any objects of the same complexity and same value as this 880 // one, group them. 881 for (unsigned j = i+1; j != e && Ops[j]->getSCEVType() == Complexity; ++j) { 882 if (Ops[j] == S) { // Found a duplicate. 883 // Move it to immediately after i'th element. 884 std::swap(Ops[i+1], Ops[j]); 885 ++i; // no need to rescan it. 886 if (i == e-2) return; // Done! 887 } 888 } 889 } 890 } 891 892 /// Returns true if \p Ops contains a huge SCEV (the subtree of S contains at 893 /// least HugeExprThreshold nodes). 894 static bool hasHugeExpression(ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops) { 895 return any_of(Ops, [](const SCEV *S) { 896 return S->getExpressionSize() >= HugeExprThreshold; 897 }); 898 } 899 900 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 901 // Simple SCEV method implementations 902 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 903 904 /// Compute BC(It, K). The result has width W. Assume, K > 0. 905 static const SCEV *BinomialCoefficient(const SCEV *It, unsigned K, 906 ScalarEvolution &SE, 907 Type *ResultTy) { 908 // Handle the simplest case efficiently. 909 if (K == 1) 910 return SE.getTruncateOrZeroExtend(It, ResultTy); 911 912 // We are using the following formula for BC(It, K): 913 // 914 // BC(It, K) = (It * (It - 1) * ... * (It - K + 1)) / K! 915 // 916 // Suppose, W is the bitwidth of the return value. We must be prepared for 917 // overflow. Hence, we must assure that the result of our computation is 918 // equal to the accurate one modulo 2^W. Unfortunately, division isn't 919 // safe in modular arithmetic. 920 // 921 // However, this code doesn't use exactly that formula; the formula it uses 922 // is something like the following, where T is the number of factors of 2 in 923 // K! (i.e. trailing zeros in the binary representation of K!), and ^ is 924 // exponentiation: 925 // 926 // BC(It, K) = (It * (It - 1) * ... * (It - K + 1)) / 2^T / (K! / 2^T) 927 // 928 // This formula is trivially equivalent to the previous formula. However, 929 // this formula can be implemented much more efficiently. The trick is that 930 // K! / 2^T is odd, and exact division by an odd number *is* safe in modular 931 // arithmetic. To do exact division in modular arithmetic, all we have 932 // to do is multiply by the inverse. Therefore, this step can be done at 933 // width W. 934 // 935 // The next issue is how to safely do the division by 2^T. The way this 936 // is done is by doing the multiplication step at a width of at least W + T 937 // bits. This way, the bottom W+T bits of the product are accurate. Then, 938 // when we perform the division by 2^T (which is equivalent to a right shift 939 // by T), the bottom W bits are accurate. Extra bits are okay; they'll get 940 // truncated out after the division by 2^T. 941 // 942 // In comparison to just directly using the first formula, this technique 943 // is much more efficient; using the first formula requires W * K bits, 944 // but this formula less than W + K bits. Also, the first formula requires 945 // a division step, whereas this formula only requires multiplies and shifts. 946 // 947 // It doesn't matter whether the subtraction step is done in the calculation 948 // width or the input iteration count's width; if the subtraction overflows, 949 // the result must be zero anyway. We prefer here to do it in the width of 950 // the induction variable because it helps a lot for certain cases; CodeGen 951 // isn't smart enough to ignore the overflow, which leads to much less 952 // efficient code if the width of the subtraction is wider than the native 953 // register width. 954 // 955 // (It's possible to not widen at all by pulling out factors of 2 before 956 // the multiplication; for example, K=2 can be calculated as 957 // It/2*(It+(It*INT_MIN/INT_MIN)+-1). However, it requires 958 // extra arithmetic, so it's not an obvious win, and it gets 959 // much more complicated for K > 3.) 960 961 // Protection from insane SCEVs; this bound is conservative, 962 // but it probably doesn't matter. 963 if (K > 1000) 964 return SE.getCouldNotCompute(); 965 966 unsigned W = SE.getTypeSizeInBits(ResultTy); 967 968 // Calculate K! / 2^T and T; we divide out the factors of two before 969 // multiplying for calculating K! / 2^T to avoid overflow. 970 // Other overflow doesn't matter because we only care about the bottom 971 // W bits of the result. 972 APInt OddFactorial(W, 1); 973 unsigned T = 1; 974 for (unsigned i = 3; i <= K; ++i) { 975 APInt Mult(W, i); 976 unsigned TwoFactors = Mult.countTrailingZeros(); 977 T += TwoFactors; 978 Mult.lshrInPlace(TwoFactors); 979 OddFactorial *= Mult; 980 } 981 982 // We need at least W + T bits for the multiplication step 983 unsigned CalculationBits = W + T; 984 985 // Calculate 2^T, at width T+W. 986 APInt DivFactor = APInt::getOneBitSet(CalculationBits, T); 987 988 // Calculate the multiplicative inverse of K! / 2^T; 989 // this multiplication factor will perform the exact division by 990 // K! / 2^T. 991 APInt Mod = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W+1); 992 APInt MultiplyFactor = OddFactorial.zext(W+1); 993 MultiplyFactor = MultiplyFactor.multiplicativeInverse(Mod); 994 MultiplyFactor = MultiplyFactor.trunc(W); 995 996 // Calculate the product, at width T+W 997 IntegerType *CalculationTy = IntegerType::get(SE.getContext(), 998 CalculationBits); 999 const SCEV *Dividend = SE.getTruncateOrZeroExtend(It, CalculationTy); 1000 for (unsigned i = 1; i != K; ++i) { 1001 const SCEV *S = SE.getMinusSCEV(It, SE.getConstant(It->getType(), i)); 1002 Dividend = SE.getMulExpr(Dividend, 1003 SE.getTruncateOrZeroExtend(S, CalculationTy)); 1004 } 1005 1006 // Divide by 2^T 1007 const SCEV *DivResult = SE.getUDivExpr(Dividend, SE.getConstant(DivFactor)); 1008 1009 // Truncate the result, and divide by K! / 2^T. 1010 1011 return SE.getMulExpr(SE.getConstant(MultiplyFactor), 1012 SE.getTruncateOrZeroExtend(DivResult, ResultTy)); 1013 } 1014 1015 /// Return the value of this chain of recurrences at the specified iteration 1016 /// number. We can evaluate this recurrence by multiplying each element in the 1017 /// chain by the binomial coefficient corresponding to it. In other words, we 1018 /// can evaluate {A,+,B,+,C,+,D} as: 1019 /// 1020 /// A*BC(It, 0) + B*BC(It, 1) + C*BC(It, 2) + D*BC(It, 3) 1021 /// 1022 /// where BC(It, k) stands for binomial coefficient. 1023 const SCEV *SCEVAddRecExpr::evaluateAtIteration(const SCEV *It, 1024 ScalarEvolution &SE) const { 1025 return evaluateAtIteration(makeArrayRef(op_begin(), op_end()), It, SE); 1026 } 1027 1028 const SCEV * 1029 SCEVAddRecExpr::evaluateAtIteration(ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Operands, 1030 const SCEV *It, ScalarEvolution &SE) { 1031 assert(Operands.size() > 0); 1032 const SCEV *Result = Operands[0]; 1033 for (unsigned i = 1, e = Operands.size(); i != e; ++i) { 1034 // The computation is correct in the face of overflow provided that the 1035 // multiplication is performed _after_ the evaluation of the binomial 1036 // coefficient. 1037 const SCEV *Coeff = BinomialCoefficient(It, i, SE, Result->getType()); 1038 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(Coeff)) 1039 return Coeff; 1040 1041 Result = SE.getAddExpr(Result, SE.getMulExpr(Operands[i], Coeff)); 1042 } 1043 return Result; 1044 } 1045 1046 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1047 // SCEV Expression folder implementations 1048 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1049 1050 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(const SCEV *Op, 1051 unsigned Depth) { 1052 assert(Depth <= 1 && 1053 "getLosslessPtrToIntExpr() should self-recurse at most once."); 1054 1055 // We could be called with an integer-typed operands during SCEV rewrites. 1056 // Since the operand is an integer already, just perform zext/trunc/self cast. 1057 if (!Op->getType()->isPointerTy()) 1058 return Op; 1059 1060 // What would be an ID for such a SCEV cast expression? 1061 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 1062 ID.AddInteger(scPtrToInt); 1063 ID.AddPointer(Op); 1064 1065 void *IP = nullptr; 1066 1067 // Is there already an expression for such a cast? 1068 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) 1069 return S; 1070 1071 // It isn't legal for optimizations to construct new ptrtoint expressions 1072 // for non-integral pointers. 1073 if (getDataLayout().isNonIntegralPointerType(Op->getType())) 1074 return getCouldNotCompute(); 1075 1076 Type *IntPtrTy = getDataLayout().getIntPtrType(Op->getType()); 1077 1078 // We can only trivially model ptrtoint if SCEV's effective (integer) type 1079 // is sufficiently wide to represent all possible pointer values. 1080 // We could theoretically teach SCEV to truncate wider pointers, but 1081 // that isn't implemented for now. 1082 if (getDataLayout().getTypeSizeInBits(getEffectiveSCEVType(Op->getType())) != 1083 getDataLayout().getTypeSizeInBits(IntPtrTy)) 1084 return getCouldNotCompute(); 1085 1086 // If not, is this expression something we can't reduce any further? 1087 if (auto *U = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(Op)) { 1088 // Perform some basic constant folding. If the operand of the ptr2int cast 1089 // is a null pointer, don't create a ptr2int SCEV expression (that will be 1090 // left as-is), but produce a zero constant. 1091 // NOTE: We could handle a more general case, but lack motivational cases. 1092 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(U->getValue())) 1093 return getZero(IntPtrTy); 1094 1095 // Create an explicit cast node. 1096 // We can reuse the existing insert position since if we get here, 1097 // we won't have made any changes which would invalidate it. 1098 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) 1099 SCEVPtrToIntExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), Op, IntPtrTy); 1100 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 1101 registerUser(S, Op); 1102 return S; 1103 } 1104 1105 assert(Depth == 0 && "getLosslessPtrToIntExpr() should not self-recurse for " 1106 "non-SCEVUnknown's."); 1107 1108 // Otherwise, we've got some expression that is more complex than just a 1109 // single SCEVUnknown. But we don't want to have a SCEVPtrToIntExpr of an 1110 // arbitrary expression, we want to have SCEVPtrToIntExpr of an SCEVUnknown 1111 // only, and the expressions must otherwise be integer-typed. 1112 // So sink the cast down to the SCEVUnknown's. 1113 1114 /// The SCEVPtrToIntSinkingRewriter takes a scalar evolution expression, 1115 /// which computes a pointer-typed value, and rewrites the whole expression 1116 /// tree so that *all* the computations are done on integers, and the only 1117 /// pointer-typed operands in the expression are SCEVUnknown. 1118 class SCEVPtrToIntSinkingRewriter 1119 : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVPtrToIntSinkingRewriter> { 1120 using Base = SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVPtrToIntSinkingRewriter>; 1121 1122 public: 1123 SCEVPtrToIntSinkingRewriter(ScalarEvolution &SE) : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE) {} 1124 1125 static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *Scev, ScalarEvolution &SE) { 1126 SCEVPtrToIntSinkingRewriter Rewriter(SE); 1127 return Rewriter.visit(Scev); 1128 } 1129 1130 const SCEV *visit(const SCEV *S) { 1131 Type *STy = S->getType(); 1132 // If the expression is not pointer-typed, just keep it as-is. 1133 if (!STy->isPointerTy()) 1134 return S; 1135 // Else, recursively sink the cast down into it. 1136 return Base::visit(S); 1137 } 1138 1139 const SCEV *visitAddExpr(const SCEVAddExpr *Expr) { 1140 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Operands; 1141 bool Changed = false; 1142 for (auto *Op : Expr->operands()) { 1143 Operands.push_back(visit(Op)); 1144 Changed |= Op != Operands.back(); 1145 } 1146 return !Changed ? Expr : SE.getAddExpr(Operands, Expr->getNoWrapFlags()); 1147 } 1148 1149 const SCEV *visitMulExpr(const SCEVMulExpr *Expr) { 1150 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Operands; 1151 bool Changed = false; 1152 for (auto *Op : Expr->operands()) { 1153 Operands.push_back(visit(Op)); 1154 Changed |= Op != Operands.back(); 1155 } 1156 return !Changed ? Expr : SE.getMulExpr(Operands, Expr->getNoWrapFlags()); 1157 } 1158 1159 const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) { 1160 assert(Expr->getType()->isPointerTy() && 1161 "Should only reach pointer-typed SCEVUnknown's."); 1162 return SE.getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(Expr, /*Depth=*/1); 1163 } 1164 }; 1165 1166 // And actually perform the cast sinking. 1167 const SCEV *IntOp = SCEVPtrToIntSinkingRewriter::rewrite(Op, *this); 1168 assert(IntOp->getType()->isIntegerTy() && 1169 "We must have succeeded in sinking the cast, " 1170 "and ending up with an integer-typed expression!"); 1171 return IntOp; 1172 } 1173 1174 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getPtrToIntExpr(const SCEV *Op, Type *Ty) { 1175 assert(Ty->isIntegerTy() && "Target type must be an integer type!"); 1176 1177 const SCEV *IntOp = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(Op); 1178 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(IntOp)) 1179 return IntOp; 1180 1181 return getTruncateOrZeroExtend(IntOp, Ty); 1182 } 1183 1184 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getTruncateExpr(const SCEV *Op, Type *Ty, 1185 unsigned Depth) { 1186 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) && 1187 "This is not a truncating conversion!"); 1188 assert(isSCEVable(Ty) && 1189 "This is not a conversion to a SCEVable type!"); 1190 assert(!Op->getType()->isPointerTy() && "Can't truncate pointer!"); 1191 Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty); 1192 1193 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 1194 ID.AddInteger(scTruncate); 1195 ID.AddPointer(Op); 1196 ID.AddPointer(Ty); 1197 void *IP = nullptr; 1198 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S; 1199 1200 // Fold if the operand is constant. 1201 if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Op)) 1202 return getConstant( 1203 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getTrunc(SC->getValue(), Ty))); 1204 1205 // trunc(trunc(x)) --> trunc(x) 1206 if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *ST = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Op)) 1207 return getTruncateExpr(ST->getOperand(), Ty, Depth + 1); 1208 1209 // trunc(sext(x)) --> sext(x) if widening or trunc(x) if narrowing 1210 if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SS = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(Op)) 1211 return getTruncateOrSignExtend(SS->getOperand(), Ty, Depth + 1); 1212 1213 // trunc(zext(x)) --> zext(x) if widening or trunc(x) if narrowing 1214 if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *SZ = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Op)) 1215 return getTruncateOrZeroExtend(SZ->getOperand(), Ty, Depth + 1); 1216 1217 if (Depth > MaxCastDepth) { 1218 SCEV *S = 1219 new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVTruncateExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), Op, Ty); 1220 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 1221 registerUser(S, Op); 1222 return S; 1223 } 1224 1225 // trunc(x1 + ... + xN) --> trunc(x1) + ... + trunc(xN) and 1226 // trunc(x1 * ... * xN) --> trunc(x1) * ... * trunc(xN), 1227 // if after transforming we have at most one truncate, not counting truncates 1228 // that replace other casts. 1229 if (isa<SCEVAddExpr>(Op) || isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Op)) { 1230 auto *CommOp = cast<SCEVCommutativeExpr>(Op); 1231 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands; 1232 unsigned numTruncs = 0; 1233 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CommOp->getNumOperands(); i != e && numTruncs < 2; 1234 ++i) { 1235 const SCEV *S = getTruncateExpr(CommOp->getOperand(i), Ty, Depth + 1); 1236 if (!isa<SCEVIntegralCastExpr>(CommOp->getOperand(i)) && 1237 isa<SCEVTruncateExpr>(S)) 1238 numTruncs++; 1239 Operands.push_back(S); 1240 } 1241 if (numTruncs < 2) { 1242 if (isa<SCEVAddExpr>(Op)) 1243 return getAddExpr(Operands); 1244 else if (isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Op)) 1245 return getMulExpr(Operands); 1246 else 1247 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected SCEV type for Op."); 1248 } 1249 // Although we checked in the beginning that ID is not in the cache, it is 1250 // possible that during recursion and different modification ID was inserted 1251 // into the cache. So if we find it, just return it. 1252 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) 1253 return S; 1254 } 1255 1256 // If the input value is a chrec scev, truncate the chrec's operands. 1257 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Op)) { 1258 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands; 1259 for (const SCEV *Op : AddRec->operands()) 1260 Operands.push_back(getTruncateExpr(Op, Ty, Depth + 1)); 1261 return getAddRecExpr(Operands, AddRec->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagAnyWrap); 1262 } 1263 1264 // Return zero if truncating to known zeros. 1265 uint32_t MinTrailingZeros = GetMinTrailingZeros(Op); 1266 if (MinTrailingZeros >= getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 1267 return getZero(Ty); 1268 1269 // The cast wasn't folded; create an explicit cast node. We can reuse 1270 // the existing insert position since if we get here, we won't have 1271 // made any changes which would invalidate it. 1272 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVTruncateExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), 1273 Op, Ty); 1274 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 1275 registerUser(S, Op); 1276 return S; 1277 } 1278 1279 // Get the limit of a recurrence such that incrementing by Step cannot cause 1280 // signed overflow as long as the value of the recurrence within the 1281 // loop does not exceed this limit before incrementing. 1282 static const SCEV *getSignedOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step, 1283 ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred, 1284 ScalarEvolution *SE) { 1285 unsigned BitWidth = SE->getTypeSizeInBits(Step->getType()); 1286 if (SE->isKnownPositive(Step)) { 1287 *Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; 1288 return SE->getConstant(APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth) - 1289 SE->getSignedRangeMax(Step)); 1290 } 1291 if (SE->isKnownNegative(Step)) { 1292 *Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; 1293 return SE->getConstant(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth) - 1294 SE->getSignedRangeMin(Step)); 1295 } 1296 return nullptr; 1297 } 1298 1299 // Get the limit of a recurrence such that incrementing by Step cannot cause 1300 // unsigned overflow as long as the value of the recurrence within the loop does 1301 // not exceed this limit before incrementing. 1302 static const SCEV *getUnsignedOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step, 1303 ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred, 1304 ScalarEvolution *SE) { 1305 unsigned BitWidth = SE->getTypeSizeInBits(Step->getType()); 1306 *Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT; 1307 1308 return SE->getConstant(APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth) - 1309 SE->getUnsignedRangeMax(Step)); 1310 } 1311 1312 namespace { 1313 1314 struct ExtendOpTraitsBase { 1315 typedef const SCEV *(ScalarEvolution::*GetExtendExprTy)(const SCEV *, Type *, 1316 unsigned); 1317 }; 1318 1319 // Used to make code generic over signed and unsigned overflow. 1320 template <typename ExtendOp> struct ExtendOpTraits { 1321 // Members present: 1322 // 1323 // static const SCEV::NoWrapFlags WrapType; 1324 // 1325 // static const ExtendOpTraitsBase::GetExtendExprTy GetExtendExpr; 1326 // 1327 // static const SCEV *getOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step, 1328 // ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred, 1329 // ScalarEvolution *SE); 1330 }; 1331 1332 template <> 1333 struct ExtendOpTraits<SCEVSignExtendExpr> : public ExtendOpTraitsBase { 1334 static const SCEV::NoWrapFlags WrapType = SCEV::FlagNSW; 1335 1336 static const GetExtendExprTy GetExtendExpr; 1337 1338 static const SCEV *getOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step, 1339 ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred, 1340 ScalarEvolution *SE) { 1341 return getSignedOverflowLimitForStep(Step, Pred, SE); 1342 } 1343 }; 1344 1345 const ExtendOpTraitsBase::GetExtendExprTy ExtendOpTraits< 1346 SCEVSignExtendExpr>::GetExtendExpr = &ScalarEvolution::getSignExtendExpr; 1347 1348 template <> 1349 struct ExtendOpTraits<SCEVZeroExtendExpr> : public ExtendOpTraitsBase { 1350 static const SCEV::NoWrapFlags WrapType = SCEV::FlagNUW; 1351 1352 static const GetExtendExprTy GetExtendExpr; 1353 1354 static const SCEV *getOverflowLimitForStep(const SCEV *Step, 1355 ICmpInst::Predicate *Pred, 1356 ScalarEvolution *SE) { 1357 return getUnsignedOverflowLimitForStep(Step, Pred, SE); 1358 } 1359 }; 1360 1361 const ExtendOpTraitsBase::GetExtendExprTy ExtendOpTraits< 1362 SCEVZeroExtendExpr>::GetExtendExpr = &ScalarEvolution::getZeroExtendExpr; 1363 1364 } // end anonymous namespace 1365 1366 // The recurrence AR has been shown to have no signed/unsigned wrap or something 1367 // close to it. Typically, if we can prove NSW/NUW for AR, then we can just as 1368 // easily prove NSW/NUW for its preincrement or postincrement sibling. This 1369 // allows normalizing a sign/zero extended AddRec as such: {sext/zext(Step + 1370 // Start),+,Step} => {(Step + sext/zext(Start),+,Step} As a result, the 1371 // expression "Step + sext/zext(PreIncAR)" is congruent with 1372 // "sext/zext(PostIncAR)" 1373 template <typename ExtendOpTy> 1374 static const SCEV *getPreStartForExtend(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR, Type *Ty, 1375 ScalarEvolution *SE, unsigned Depth) { 1376 auto WrapType = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::WrapType; 1377 auto GetExtendExpr = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::GetExtendExpr; 1378 1379 const Loop *L = AR->getLoop(); 1380 const SCEV *Start = AR->getStart(); 1381 const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*SE); 1382 1383 // Check for a simple looking step prior to loop entry. 1384 const SCEVAddExpr *SA = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Start); 1385 if (!SA) 1386 return nullptr; 1387 1388 // Create an AddExpr for "PreStart" after subtracting Step. Full SCEV 1389 // subtraction is expensive. For this purpose, perform a quick and dirty 1390 // difference, by checking for Step in the operand list. 1391 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> DiffOps; 1392 for (const SCEV *Op : SA->operands()) 1393 if (Op != Step) 1394 DiffOps.push_back(Op); 1395 1396 if (DiffOps.size() == SA->getNumOperands()) 1397 return nullptr; 1398 1399 // Try to prove `WrapType` (SCEV::FlagNSW or SCEV::FlagNUW) on `PreStart` + 1400 // `Step`: 1401 1402 // 1. NSW/NUW flags on the step increment. 1403 auto PreStartFlags = 1404 ScalarEvolution::maskFlags(SA->getNoWrapFlags(), SCEV::FlagNUW); 1405 const SCEV *PreStart = SE->getAddExpr(DiffOps, PreStartFlags); 1406 const SCEVAddRecExpr *PreAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>( 1407 SE->getAddRecExpr(PreStart, Step, L, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap)); 1408 1409 // "{S,+,X} is <nsw>/<nuw>" and "the backedge is taken at least once" implies 1410 // "S+X does not sign/unsign-overflow". 1411 // 1412 1413 const SCEV *BECount = SE->getBackedgeTakenCount(L); 1414 if (PreAR && PreAR->getNoWrapFlags(WrapType) && 1415 !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(BECount) && SE->isKnownPositive(BECount)) 1416 return PreStart; 1417 1418 // 2. Direct overflow check on the step operation's expression. 1419 unsigned BitWidth = SE->getTypeSizeInBits(AR->getType()); 1420 Type *WideTy = IntegerType::get(SE->getContext(), BitWidth * 2); 1421 const SCEV *OperandExtendedStart = 1422 SE->getAddExpr((SE->*GetExtendExpr)(PreStart, WideTy, Depth), 1423 (SE->*GetExtendExpr)(Step, WideTy, Depth)); 1424 if ((SE->*GetExtendExpr)(Start, WideTy, Depth) == OperandExtendedStart) { 1425 if (PreAR && AR->getNoWrapFlags(WrapType)) { 1426 // If we know `AR` == {`PreStart`+`Step`,+,`Step`} is `WrapType` (FlagNSW 1427 // or FlagNUW) and that `PreStart` + `Step` is `WrapType` too, then 1428 // `PreAR` == {`PreStart`,+,`Step`} is also `WrapType`. Cache this fact. 1429 SE->setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(PreAR), WrapType); 1430 } 1431 return PreStart; 1432 } 1433 1434 // 3. Loop precondition. 1435 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred; 1436 const SCEV *OverflowLimit = 1437 ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::getOverflowLimitForStep(Step, &Pred, SE); 1438 1439 if (OverflowLimit && 1440 SE->isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Pred, PreStart, OverflowLimit)) 1441 return PreStart; 1442 1443 return nullptr; 1444 } 1445 1446 // Get the normalized zero or sign extended expression for this AddRec's Start. 1447 template <typename ExtendOpTy> 1448 static const SCEV *getExtendAddRecStart(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR, Type *Ty, 1449 ScalarEvolution *SE, 1450 unsigned Depth) { 1451 auto GetExtendExpr = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::GetExtendExpr; 1452 1453 const SCEV *PreStart = getPreStartForExtend<ExtendOpTy>(AR, Ty, SE, Depth); 1454 if (!PreStart) 1455 return (SE->*GetExtendExpr)(AR->getStart(), Ty, Depth); 1456 1457 return SE->getAddExpr((SE->*GetExtendExpr)(AR->getStepRecurrence(*SE), Ty, 1458 Depth), 1459 (SE->*GetExtendExpr)(PreStart, Ty, Depth)); 1460 } 1461 1462 // Try to prove away overflow by looking at "nearby" add recurrences. A 1463 // motivating example for this rule: if we know `{0,+,4}` is `ult` `-1` and it 1464 // does not itself wrap then we can conclude that `{1,+,4}` is `nuw`. 1465 // 1466 // Formally: 1467 // 1468 // {S,+,X} == {S-T,+,X} + T 1469 // => Ext({S,+,X}) == Ext({S-T,+,X} + T) 1470 // 1471 // If ({S-T,+,X} + T) does not overflow ... (1) 1472 // 1473 // RHS == Ext({S-T,+,X} + T) == Ext({S-T,+,X}) + Ext(T) 1474 // 1475 // If {S-T,+,X} does not overflow ... (2) 1476 // 1477 // RHS == Ext({S-T,+,X}) + Ext(T) == {Ext(S-T),+,Ext(X)} + Ext(T) 1478 // == {Ext(S-T)+Ext(T),+,Ext(X)} 1479 // 1480 // If (S-T)+T does not overflow ... (3) 1481 // 1482 // RHS == {Ext(S-T)+Ext(T),+,Ext(X)} == {Ext(S-T+T),+,Ext(X)} 1483 // == {Ext(S),+,Ext(X)} == LHS 1484 // 1485 // Thus, if (1), (2) and (3) are true for some T, then 1486 // Ext({S,+,X}) == {Ext(S),+,Ext(X)} 1487 // 1488 // (3) is implied by (1) -- "(S-T)+T does not overflow" is simply "({S-T,+,X}+T) 1489 // does not overflow" restricted to the 0th iteration. Therefore we only need 1490 // to check for (1) and (2). 1491 // 1492 // In the current context, S is `Start`, X is `Step`, Ext is `ExtendOpTy` and T 1493 // is `Delta` (defined below). 1494 template <typename ExtendOpTy> 1495 bool ScalarEvolution::proveNoWrapByVaryingStart(const SCEV *Start, 1496 const SCEV *Step, 1497 const Loop *L) { 1498 auto WrapType = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::WrapType; 1499 1500 // We restrict `Start` to a constant to prevent SCEV from spending too much 1501 // time here. It is correct (but more expensive) to continue with a 1502 // non-constant `Start` and do a general SCEV subtraction to compute 1503 // `PreStart` below. 1504 const SCEVConstant *StartC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Start); 1505 if (!StartC) 1506 return false; 1507 1508 APInt StartAI = StartC->getAPInt(); 1509 1510 for (unsigned Delta : {-2, -1, 1, 2}) { 1511 const SCEV *PreStart = getConstant(StartAI - Delta); 1512 1513 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 1514 ID.AddInteger(scAddRecExpr); 1515 ID.AddPointer(PreStart); 1516 ID.AddPointer(Step); 1517 ID.AddPointer(L); 1518 void *IP = nullptr; 1519 const auto *PreAR = 1520 static_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)); 1521 1522 // Give up if we don't already have the add recurrence we need because 1523 // actually constructing an add recurrence is relatively expensive. 1524 if (PreAR && PreAR->getNoWrapFlags(WrapType)) { // proves (2) 1525 const SCEV *DeltaS = getConstant(StartC->getType(), Delta); 1526 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE; 1527 const SCEV *Limit = ExtendOpTraits<ExtendOpTy>::getOverflowLimitForStep( 1528 DeltaS, &Pred, this); 1529 if (Limit && isKnownPredicate(Pred, PreAR, Limit)) // proves (1) 1530 return true; 1531 } 1532 } 1533 1534 return false; 1535 } 1536 1537 // Finds an integer D for an expression (C + x + y + ...) such that the top 1538 // level addition in (D + (C - D + x + y + ...)) would not wrap (signed or 1539 // unsigned) and the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + x + y + ...) is 1540 // maximized, where C is the \p ConstantTerm, x, y, ... are arbitrary SCEVs, and 1541 // the (C + x + y + ...) expression is \p WholeAddExpr. 1542 static APInt extractConstantWithoutWrapping(ScalarEvolution &SE, 1543 const SCEVConstant *ConstantTerm, 1544 const SCEVAddExpr *WholeAddExpr) { 1545 const APInt &C = ConstantTerm->getAPInt(); 1546 const unsigned BitWidth = C.getBitWidth(); 1547 // Find number of trailing zeros of (x + y + ...) w/o the C first: 1548 uint32_t TZ = BitWidth; 1549 for (unsigned I = 1, E = WholeAddExpr->getNumOperands(); I < E && TZ; ++I) 1550 TZ = std::min(TZ, SE.GetMinTrailingZeros(WholeAddExpr->getOperand(I))); 1551 if (TZ) { 1552 // Set D to be as many least significant bits of C as possible while still 1553 // guaranteeing that adding D to (C - D + x + y + ...) won't cause a wrap: 1554 return TZ < BitWidth ? C.trunc(TZ).zext(BitWidth) : C; 1555 } 1556 return APInt(BitWidth, 0); 1557 } 1558 1559 // Finds an integer D for an affine AddRec expression {C,+,x} such that the top 1560 // level addition in (D + {C-D,+,x}) would not wrap (signed or unsigned) and the 1561 // number of trailing zeros of (C - D + x * n) is maximized, where C is the \p 1562 // ConstantStart, x is an arbitrary \p Step, and n is the loop trip count. 1563 static APInt extractConstantWithoutWrapping(ScalarEvolution &SE, 1564 const APInt &ConstantStart, 1565 const SCEV *Step) { 1566 const unsigned BitWidth = ConstantStart.getBitWidth(); 1567 const uint32_t TZ = SE.GetMinTrailingZeros(Step); 1568 if (TZ) 1569 return TZ < BitWidth ? ConstantStart.trunc(TZ).zext(BitWidth) 1570 : ConstantStart; 1571 return APInt(BitWidth, 0); 1572 } 1573 1574 const SCEV * 1575 ScalarEvolution::getZeroExtendExpr(const SCEV *Op, Type *Ty, unsigned Depth) { 1576 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) && 1577 "This is not an extending conversion!"); 1578 assert(isSCEVable(Ty) && 1579 "This is not a conversion to a SCEVable type!"); 1580 assert(!Op->getType()->isPointerTy() && "Can't extend pointer!"); 1581 Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty); 1582 1583 // Fold if the operand is constant. 1584 if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Op)) 1585 return getConstant( 1586 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getZExt(SC->getValue(), Ty))); 1587 1588 // zext(zext(x)) --> zext(x) 1589 if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *SZ = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Op)) 1590 return getZeroExtendExpr(SZ->getOperand(), Ty, Depth + 1); 1591 1592 // Before doing any expensive analysis, check to see if we've already 1593 // computed a SCEV for this Op and Ty. 1594 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 1595 ID.AddInteger(scZeroExtend); 1596 ID.AddPointer(Op); 1597 ID.AddPointer(Ty); 1598 void *IP = nullptr; 1599 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S; 1600 if (Depth > MaxCastDepth) { 1601 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVZeroExtendExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), 1602 Op, Ty); 1603 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 1604 registerUser(S, Op); 1605 return S; 1606 } 1607 1608 // zext(trunc(x)) --> zext(x) or x or trunc(x) 1609 if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *ST = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Op)) { 1610 // It's possible the bits taken off by the truncate were all zero bits. If 1611 // so, we should be able to simplify this further. 1612 const SCEV *X = ST->getOperand(); 1613 ConstantRange CR = getUnsignedRange(X); 1614 unsigned TruncBits = getTypeSizeInBits(ST->getType()); 1615 unsigned NewBits = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty); 1616 if (CR.truncate(TruncBits).zeroExtend(NewBits).contains( 1617 CR.zextOrTrunc(NewBits))) 1618 return getTruncateOrZeroExtend(X, Ty, Depth); 1619 } 1620 1621 // If the input value is a chrec scev, and we can prove that the value 1622 // did not overflow the old, smaller, value, we can zero extend all of the 1623 // operands (often constants). This allows analysis of something like 1624 // this: for (unsigned char X = 0; X < 100; ++X) { int Y = X; } 1625 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Op)) 1626 if (AR->isAffine()) { 1627 const SCEV *Start = AR->getStart(); 1628 const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*this); 1629 unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(AR->getType()); 1630 const Loop *L = AR->getLoop(); 1631 1632 if (!AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) { 1633 auto NewFlags = proveNoWrapViaConstantRanges(AR); 1634 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), NewFlags); 1635 } 1636 1637 // If we have special knowledge that this addrec won't overflow, 1638 // we don't need to do any further analysis. 1639 if (AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) 1640 return getAddRecExpr( 1641 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1), 1642 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 1643 1644 // Check whether the backedge-taken count is SCEVCouldNotCompute. 1645 // Note that this serves two purposes: It filters out loops that are 1646 // simply not analyzable, and it covers the case where this code is 1647 // being called from within backedge-taken count analysis, such that 1648 // attempting to ask for the backedge-taken count would likely result 1649 // in infinite recursion. In the later case, the analysis code will 1650 // cope with a conservative value, and it will take care to purge 1651 // that value once it has finished. 1652 const SCEV *MaxBECount = getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L); 1653 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount)) { 1654 // Manually compute the final value for AR, checking for overflow. 1655 1656 // Check whether the backedge-taken count can be losslessly casted to 1657 // the addrec's type. The count is always unsigned. 1658 const SCEV *CastedMaxBECount = 1659 getTruncateOrZeroExtend(MaxBECount, Start->getType(), Depth); 1660 const SCEV *RecastedMaxBECount = getTruncateOrZeroExtend( 1661 CastedMaxBECount, MaxBECount->getType(), Depth); 1662 if (MaxBECount == RecastedMaxBECount) { 1663 Type *WideTy = IntegerType::get(getContext(), BitWidth * 2); 1664 // Check whether Start+Step*MaxBECount has no unsigned overflow. 1665 const SCEV *ZMul = getMulExpr(CastedMaxBECount, Step, 1666 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 1667 const SCEV *ZAdd = getZeroExtendExpr(getAddExpr(Start, ZMul, 1668 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, 1669 Depth + 1), 1670 WideTy, Depth + 1); 1671 const SCEV *WideStart = getZeroExtendExpr(Start, WideTy, Depth + 1); 1672 const SCEV *WideMaxBECount = 1673 getZeroExtendExpr(CastedMaxBECount, WideTy, Depth + 1); 1674 const SCEV *OperandExtendedAdd = 1675 getAddExpr(WideStart, 1676 getMulExpr(WideMaxBECount, 1677 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, WideTy, Depth + 1), 1678 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1), 1679 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 1680 if (ZAdd == OperandExtendedAdd) { 1681 // Cache knowledge of AR NUW, which is propagated to this AddRec. 1682 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), SCEV::FlagNUW); 1683 // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside. 1684 return getAddRecExpr( 1685 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, 1686 Depth + 1), 1687 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, 1688 AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 1689 } 1690 // Similar to above, only this time treat the step value as signed. 1691 // This covers loops that count down. 1692 OperandExtendedAdd = 1693 getAddExpr(WideStart, 1694 getMulExpr(WideMaxBECount, 1695 getSignExtendExpr(Step, WideTy, Depth + 1), 1696 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1), 1697 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 1698 if (ZAdd == OperandExtendedAdd) { 1699 // Cache knowledge of AR NW, which is propagated to this AddRec. 1700 // Negative step causes unsigned wrap, but it still can't self-wrap. 1701 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), SCEV::FlagNW); 1702 // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside. 1703 return getAddRecExpr( 1704 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, 1705 Depth + 1), 1706 getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, 1707 AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 1708 } 1709 } 1710 } 1711 1712 // Normally, in the cases we can prove no-overflow via a 1713 // backedge guarding condition, we can also compute a backedge 1714 // taken count for the loop. The exceptions are assumptions and 1715 // guards present in the loop -- SCEV is not great at exploiting 1716 // these to compute max backedge taken counts, but can still use 1717 // these to prove lack of overflow. Use this fact to avoid 1718 // doing extra work that may not pay off. 1719 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) || HasGuards || 1720 !AC.assumptions().empty()) { 1721 1722 auto NewFlags = proveNoUnsignedWrapViaInduction(AR); 1723 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), NewFlags); 1724 if (AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) { 1725 // Same as nuw case above - duplicated here to avoid a compile time 1726 // issue. It's not clear that the order of checks does matter, but 1727 // it's one of two issue possible causes for a change which was 1728 // reverted. Be conservative for the moment. 1729 return getAddRecExpr( 1730 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, 1731 Depth + 1), 1732 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, 1733 AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 1734 } 1735 1736 // For a negative step, we can extend the operands iff doing so only 1737 // traverses values in the range zext([0,UINT_MAX]). 1738 if (isKnownNegative(Step)) { 1739 const SCEV *N = getConstant(APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth) - 1740 getSignedRangeMin(Step)); 1741 if (isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, AR, N) || 1742 isKnownOnEveryIteration(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, AR, N)) { 1743 // Cache knowledge of AR NW, which is propagated to this 1744 // AddRec. Negative step causes unsigned wrap, but it 1745 // still can't self-wrap. 1746 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), SCEV::FlagNW); 1747 // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside. 1748 return getAddRecExpr( 1749 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, 1750 Depth + 1), 1751 getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, 1752 AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 1753 } 1754 } 1755 } 1756 1757 // zext({C,+,Step}) --> (zext(D) + zext({C-D,+,Step}))<nuw><nsw> 1758 // if D + (C - D + Step * n) could be proven to not unsigned wrap 1759 // where D maximizes the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + Step * n) 1760 if (const auto *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Start)) { 1761 const APInt &C = SC->getAPInt(); 1762 const APInt &D = extractConstantWithoutWrapping(*this, C, Step); 1763 if (D != 0) { 1764 const SCEV *SZExtD = getZeroExtendExpr(getConstant(D), Ty, Depth); 1765 const SCEV *SResidual = 1766 getAddRecExpr(getConstant(C - D), Step, L, AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 1767 const SCEV *SZExtR = getZeroExtendExpr(SResidual, Ty, Depth + 1); 1768 return getAddExpr(SZExtD, SZExtR, 1769 (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(SCEV::FlagNSW | SCEV::FlagNUW), 1770 Depth + 1); 1771 } 1772 } 1773 1774 if (proveNoWrapByVaryingStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Start, Step, L)) { 1775 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), SCEV::FlagNUW); 1776 return getAddRecExpr( 1777 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1), 1778 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 1779 } 1780 } 1781 1782 // zext(A % B) --> zext(A) % zext(B) 1783 { 1784 const SCEV *LHS; 1785 const SCEV *RHS; 1786 if (matchURem(Op, LHS, RHS)) 1787 return getURemExpr(getZeroExtendExpr(LHS, Ty, Depth + 1), 1788 getZeroExtendExpr(RHS, Ty, Depth + 1)); 1789 } 1790 1791 // zext(A / B) --> zext(A) / zext(B). 1792 if (auto *Div = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(Op)) 1793 return getUDivExpr(getZeroExtendExpr(Div->getLHS(), Ty, Depth + 1), 1794 getZeroExtendExpr(Div->getRHS(), Ty, Depth + 1)); 1795 1796 if (auto *SA = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Op)) { 1797 // zext((A + B + ...)<nuw>) --> (zext(A) + zext(B) + ...)<nuw> 1798 if (SA->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) { 1799 // If the addition does not unsign overflow then we can, by definition, 1800 // commute the zero extension with the addition operation. 1801 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops; 1802 for (const auto *Op : SA->operands()) 1803 Ops.push_back(getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Ty, Depth + 1)); 1804 return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagNUW, Depth + 1); 1805 } 1806 1807 // zext(C + x + y + ...) --> (zext(D) + zext((C - D) + x + y + ...)) 1808 // if D + (C - D + x + y + ...) could be proven to not unsigned wrap 1809 // where D maximizes the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + x + y + ...) 1810 // 1811 // Often address arithmetics contain expressions like 1812 // (zext (add (shl X, C1), C2)), for instance, (zext (5 + (4 * X))). 1813 // This transformation is useful while proving that such expressions are 1814 // equal or differ by a small constant amount, see LoadStoreVectorizer pass. 1815 if (const auto *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(SA->getOperand(0))) { 1816 const APInt &D = extractConstantWithoutWrapping(*this, SC, SA); 1817 if (D != 0) { 1818 const SCEV *SZExtD = getZeroExtendExpr(getConstant(D), Ty, Depth); 1819 const SCEV *SResidual = 1820 getAddExpr(getConstant(-D), SA, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth); 1821 const SCEV *SZExtR = getZeroExtendExpr(SResidual, Ty, Depth + 1); 1822 return getAddExpr(SZExtD, SZExtR, 1823 (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(SCEV::FlagNSW | SCEV::FlagNUW), 1824 Depth + 1); 1825 } 1826 } 1827 } 1828 1829 if (auto *SM = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Op)) { 1830 // zext((A * B * ...)<nuw>) --> (zext(A) * zext(B) * ...)<nuw> 1831 if (SM->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) { 1832 // If the multiply does not unsign overflow then we can, by definition, 1833 // commute the zero extension with the multiply operation. 1834 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops; 1835 for (const auto *Op : SM->operands()) 1836 Ops.push_back(getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Ty, Depth + 1)); 1837 return getMulExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagNUW, Depth + 1); 1838 } 1839 1840 // zext(2^K * (trunc X to iN)) to iM -> 1841 // 2^K * (zext(trunc X to i{N-K}) to iM)<nuw> 1842 // 1843 // Proof: 1844 // 1845 // zext(2^K * (trunc X to iN)) to iM 1846 // = zext((trunc X to iN) << K) to iM 1847 // = zext((trunc X to i{N-K}) << K)<nuw> to iM 1848 // (because shl removes the top K bits) 1849 // = zext((2^K * (trunc X to i{N-K}))<nuw>) to iM 1850 // = (2^K * (zext(trunc X to i{N-K}) to iM))<nuw>. 1851 // 1852 if (SM->getNumOperands() == 2) 1853 if (auto *MulLHS = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(SM->getOperand(0))) 1854 if (MulLHS->getAPInt().isPowerOf2()) 1855 if (auto *TruncRHS = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(SM->getOperand(1))) { 1856 int NewTruncBits = getTypeSizeInBits(TruncRHS->getType()) - 1857 MulLHS->getAPInt().logBase2(); 1858 Type *NewTruncTy = IntegerType::get(getContext(), NewTruncBits); 1859 return getMulExpr( 1860 getZeroExtendExpr(MulLHS, Ty), 1861 getZeroExtendExpr( 1862 getTruncateExpr(TruncRHS->getOperand(), NewTruncTy), Ty), 1863 SCEV::FlagNUW, Depth + 1); 1864 } 1865 } 1866 1867 // The cast wasn't folded; create an explicit cast node. 1868 // Recompute the insert position, as it may have been invalidated. 1869 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S; 1870 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVZeroExtendExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), 1871 Op, Ty); 1872 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 1873 registerUser(S, Op); 1874 return S; 1875 } 1876 1877 const SCEV * 1878 ScalarEvolution::getSignExtendExpr(const SCEV *Op, Type *Ty, unsigned Depth) { 1879 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) && 1880 "This is not an extending conversion!"); 1881 assert(isSCEVable(Ty) && 1882 "This is not a conversion to a SCEVable type!"); 1883 assert(!Op->getType()->isPointerTy() && "Can't extend pointer!"); 1884 Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty); 1885 1886 // Fold if the operand is constant. 1887 if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Op)) 1888 return getConstant( 1889 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getSExt(SC->getValue(), Ty))); 1890 1891 // sext(sext(x)) --> sext(x) 1892 if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SS = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(Op)) 1893 return getSignExtendExpr(SS->getOperand(), Ty, Depth + 1); 1894 1895 // sext(zext(x)) --> zext(x) 1896 if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *SZ = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Op)) 1897 return getZeroExtendExpr(SZ->getOperand(), Ty, Depth + 1); 1898 1899 // Before doing any expensive analysis, check to see if we've already 1900 // computed a SCEV for this Op and Ty. 1901 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 1902 ID.AddInteger(scSignExtend); 1903 ID.AddPointer(Op); 1904 ID.AddPointer(Ty); 1905 void *IP = nullptr; 1906 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S; 1907 // Limit recursion depth. 1908 if (Depth > MaxCastDepth) { 1909 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVSignExtendExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), 1910 Op, Ty); 1911 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 1912 registerUser(S, Op); 1913 return S; 1914 } 1915 1916 // sext(trunc(x)) --> sext(x) or x or trunc(x) 1917 if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *ST = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Op)) { 1918 // It's possible the bits taken off by the truncate were all sign bits. If 1919 // so, we should be able to simplify this further. 1920 const SCEV *X = ST->getOperand(); 1921 ConstantRange CR = getSignedRange(X); 1922 unsigned TruncBits = getTypeSizeInBits(ST->getType()); 1923 unsigned NewBits = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty); 1924 if (CR.truncate(TruncBits).signExtend(NewBits).contains( 1925 CR.sextOrTrunc(NewBits))) 1926 return getTruncateOrSignExtend(X, Ty, Depth); 1927 } 1928 1929 if (auto *SA = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Op)) { 1930 // sext((A + B + ...)<nsw>) --> (sext(A) + sext(B) + ...)<nsw> 1931 if (SA->hasNoSignedWrap()) { 1932 // If the addition does not sign overflow then we can, by definition, 1933 // commute the sign extension with the addition operation. 1934 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops; 1935 for (const auto *Op : SA->operands()) 1936 Ops.push_back(getSignExtendExpr(Op, Ty, Depth + 1)); 1937 return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagNSW, Depth + 1); 1938 } 1939 1940 // sext(C + x + y + ...) --> (sext(D) + sext((C - D) + x + y + ...)) 1941 // if D + (C - D + x + y + ...) could be proven to not signed wrap 1942 // where D maximizes the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + x + y + ...) 1943 // 1944 // For instance, this will bring two seemingly different expressions: 1945 // 1 + sext(5 + 20 * %x + 24 * %y) and 1946 // sext(6 + 20 * %x + 24 * %y) 1947 // to the same form: 1948 // 2 + sext(4 + 20 * %x + 24 * %y) 1949 if (const auto *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(SA->getOperand(0))) { 1950 const APInt &D = extractConstantWithoutWrapping(*this, SC, SA); 1951 if (D != 0) { 1952 const SCEV *SSExtD = getSignExtendExpr(getConstant(D), Ty, Depth); 1953 const SCEV *SResidual = 1954 getAddExpr(getConstant(-D), SA, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth); 1955 const SCEV *SSExtR = getSignExtendExpr(SResidual, Ty, Depth + 1); 1956 return getAddExpr(SSExtD, SSExtR, 1957 (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(SCEV::FlagNSW | SCEV::FlagNUW), 1958 Depth + 1); 1959 } 1960 } 1961 } 1962 // If the input value is a chrec scev, and we can prove that the value 1963 // did not overflow the old, smaller, value, we can sign extend all of the 1964 // operands (often constants). This allows analysis of something like 1965 // this: for (signed char X = 0; X < 100; ++X) { int Y = X; } 1966 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Op)) 1967 if (AR->isAffine()) { 1968 const SCEV *Start = AR->getStart(); 1969 const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*this); 1970 unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(AR->getType()); 1971 const Loop *L = AR->getLoop(); 1972 1973 if (!AR->hasNoSignedWrap()) { 1974 auto NewFlags = proveNoWrapViaConstantRanges(AR); 1975 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), NewFlags); 1976 } 1977 1978 // If we have special knowledge that this addrec won't overflow, 1979 // we don't need to do any further analysis. 1980 if (AR->hasNoSignedWrap()) 1981 return getAddRecExpr( 1982 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1), 1983 getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, SCEV::FlagNSW); 1984 1985 // Check whether the backedge-taken count is SCEVCouldNotCompute. 1986 // Note that this serves two purposes: It filters out loops that are 1987 // simply not analyzable, and it covers the case where this code is 1988 // being called from within backedge-taken count analysis, such that 1989 // attempting to ask for the backedge-taken count would likely result 1990 // in infinite recursion. In the later case, the analysis code will 1991 // cope with a conservative value, and it will take care to purge 1992 // that value once it has finished. 1993 const SCEV *MaxBECount = getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L); 1994 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount)) { 1995 // Manually compute the final value for AR, checking for 1996 // overflow. 1997 1998 // Check whether the backedge-taken count can be losslessly casted to 1999 // the addrec's type. The count is always unsigned. 2000 const SCEV *CastedMaxBECount = 2001 getTruncateOrZeroExtend(MaxBECount, Start->getType(), Depth); 2002 const SCEV *RecastedMaxBECount = getTruncateOrZeroExtend( 2003 CastedMaxBECount, MaxBECount->getType(), Depth); 2004 if (MaxBECount == RecastedMaxBECount) { 2005 Type *WideTy = IntegerType::get(getContext(), BitWidth * 2); 2006 // Check whether Start+Step*MaxBECount has no signed overflow. 2007 const SCEV *SMul = getMulExpr(CastedMaxBECount, Step, 2008 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2009 const SCEV *SAdd = getSignExtendExpr(getAddExpr(Start, SMul, 2010 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, 2011 Depth + 1), 2012 WideTy, Depth + 1); 2013 const SCEV *WideStart = getSignExtendExpr(Start, WideTy, Depth + 1); 2014 const SCEV *WideMaxBECount = 2015 getZeroExtendExpr(CastedMaxBECount, WideTy, Depth + 1); 2016 const SCEV *OperandExtendedAdd = 2017 getAddExpr(WideStart, 2018 getMulExpr(WideMaxBECount, 2019 getSignExtendExpr(Step, WideTy, Depth + 1), 2020 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1), 2021 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2022 if (SAdd == OperandExtendedAdd) { 2023 // Cache knowledge of AR NSW, which is propagated to this AddRec. 2024 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), SCEV::FlagNSW); 2025 // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside. 2026 return getAddRecExpr( 2027 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, 2028 Depth + 1), 2029 getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, 2030 AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 2031 } 2032 // Similar to above, only this time treat the step value as unsigned. 2033 // This covers loops that count up with an unsigned step. 2034 OperandExtendedAdd = 2035 getAddExpr(WideStart, 2036 getMulExpr(WideMaxBECount, 2037 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, WideTy, Depth + 1), 2038 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1), 2039 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2040 if (SAdd == OperandExtendedAdd) { 2041 // If AR wraps around then 2042 // 2043 // abs(Step) * MaxBECount > unsigned-max(AR->getType()) 2044 // => SAdd != OperandExtendedAdd 2045 // 2046 // Thus (AR is not NW => SAdd != OperandExtendedAdd) <=> 2047 // (SAdd == OperandExtendedAdd => AR is NW) 2048 2049 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), SCEV::FlagNW); 2050 2051 // Return the expression with the addrec on the outside. 2052 return getAddRecExpr( 2053 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, 2054 Depth + 1), 2055 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, 2056 AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 2057 } 2058 } 2059 } 2060 2061 auto NewFlags = proveNoSignedWrapViaInduction(AR); 2062 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), NewFlags); 2063 if (AR->hasNoSignedWrap()) { 2064 // Same as nsw case above - duplicated here to avoid a compile time 2065 // issue. It's not clear that the order of checks does matter, but 2066 // it's one of two issue possible causes for a change which was 2067 // reverted. Be conservative for the moment. 2068 return getAddRecExpr( 2069 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1), 2070 getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 2071 } 2072 2073 // sext({C,+,Step}) --> (sext(D) + sext({C-D,+,Step}))<nuw><nsw> 2074 // if D + (C - D + Step * n) could be proven to not signed wrap 2075 // where D maximizes the number of trailing zeros of (C - D + Step * n) 2076 if (const auto *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Start)) { 2077 const APInt &C = SC->getAPInt(); 2078 const APInt &D = extractConstantWithoutWrapping(*this, C, Step); 2079 if (D != 0) { 2080 const SCEV *SSExtD = getSignExtendExpr(getConstant(D), Ty, Depth); 2081 const SCEV *SResidual = 2082 getAddRecExpr(getConstant(C - D), Step, L, AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 2083 const SCEV *SSExtR = getSignExtendExpr(SResidual, Ty, Depth + 1); 2084 return getAddExpr(SSExtD, SSExtR, 2085 (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(SCEV::FlagNSW | SCEV::FlagNUW), 2086 Depth + 1); 2087 } 2088 } 2089 2090 if (proveNoWrapByVaryingStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(Start, Step, L)) { 2091 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), SCEV::FlagNSW); 2092 return getAddRecExpr( 2093 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, Depth + 1), 2094 getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty, Depth + 1), L, AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 2095 } 2096 } 2097 2098 // If the input value is provably positive and we could not simplify 2099 // away the sext build a zext instead. 2100 if (isKnownNonNegative(Op)) 2101 return getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Ty, Depth + 1); 2102 2103 // The cast wasn't folded; create an explicit cast node. 2104 // Recompute the insert position, as it may have been invalidated. 2105 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S; 2106 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVSignExtendExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), 2107 Op, Ty); 2108 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 2109 registerUser(S, { Op }); 2110 return S; 2111 } 2112 2113 /// getAnyExtendExpr - Return a SCEV for the given operand extended with 2114 /// unspecified bits out to the given type. 2115 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getAnyExtendExpr(const SCEV *Op, 2116 Type *Ty) { 2117 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) && 2118 "This is not an extending conversion!"); 2119 assert(isSCEVable(Ty) && 2120 "This is not a conversion to a SCEVable type!"); 2121 Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty); 2122 2123 // Sign-extend negative constants. 2124 if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Op)) 2125 if (SC->getAPInt().isNegative()) 2126 return getSignExtendExpr(Op, Ty); 2127 2128 // Peel off a truncate cast. 2129 if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Op)) { 2130 const SCEV *NewOp = T->getOperand(); 2131 if (getTypeSizeInBits(NewOp->getType()) < getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 2132 return getAnyExtendExpr(NewOp, Ty); 2133 return getTruncateOrNoop(NewOp, Ty); 2134 } 2135 2136 // Next try a zext cast. If the cast is folded, use it. 2137 const SCEV *ZExt = getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Ty); 2138 if (!isa<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(ZExt)) 2139 return ZExt; 2140 2141 // Next try a sext cast. If the cast is folded, use it. 2142 const SCEV *SExt = getSignExtendExpr(Op, Ty); 2143 if (!isa<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(SExt)) 2144 return SExt; 2145 2146 // Force the cast to be folded into the operands of an addrec. 2147 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Op)) { 2148 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops; 2149 for (const SCEV *Op : AR->operands()) 2150 Ops.push_back(getAnyExtendExpr(Op, Ty)); 2151 return getAddRecExpr(Ops, AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagNW); 2152 } 2153 2154 // If the expression is obviously signed, use the sext cast value. 2155 if (isa<SCEVSMaxExpr>(Op)) 2156 return SExt; 2157 2158 // Absent any other information, use the zext cast value. 2159 return ZExt; 2160 } 2161 2162 /// Process the given Ops list, which is a list of operands to be added under 2163 /// the given scale, update the given map. This is a helper function for 2164 /// getAddRecExpr. As an example of what it does, given a sequence of operands 2165 /// that would form an add expression like this: 2166 /// 2167 /// m + n + 13 + (A * (o + p + (B * (q + m + 29)))) + r + (-1 * r) 2168 /// 2169 /// where A and B are constants, update the map with these values: 2170 /// 2171 /// (m, 1+A*B), (n, 1), (o, A), (p, A), (q, A*B), (r, 0) 2172 /// 2173 /// and add 13 + A*B*29 to AccumulatedConstant. 2174 /// This will allow getAddRecExpr to produce this: 2175 /// 2176 /// 13+A*B*29 + n + (m * (1+A*B)) + ((o + p) * A) + (q * A*B) 2177 /// 2178 /// This form often exposes folding opportunities that are hidden in 2179 /// the original operand list. 2180 /// 2181 /// Return true iff it appears that any interesting folding opportunities 2182 /// may be exposed. This helps getAddRecExpr short-circuit extra work in 2183 /// the common case where no interesting opportunities are present, and 2184 /// is also used as a check to avoid infinite recursion. 2185 static bool 2186 CollectAddOperandsWithScales(DenseMap<const SCEV *, APInt> &M, 2187 SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &NewOps, 2188 APInt &AccumulatedConstant, 2189 const SCEV *const *Ops, size_t NumOperands, 2190 const APInt &Scale, 2191 ScalarEvolution &SE) { 2192 bool Interesting = false; 2193 2194 // Iterate over the add operands. They are sorted, with constants first. 2195 unsigned i = 0; 2196 while (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[i])) { 2197 ++i; 2198 // Pull a buried constant out to the outside. 2199 if (Scale != 1 || AccumulatedConstant != 0 || C->getValue()->isZero()) 2200 Interesting = true; 2201 AccumulatedConstant += Scale * C->getAPInt(); 2202 } 2203 2204 // Next comes everything else. We're especially interested in multiplies 2205 // here, but they're in the middle, so just visit the rest with one loop. 2206 for (; i != NumOperands; ++i) { 2207 const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[i]); 2208 if (Mul && isa<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0))) { 2209 APInt NewScale = 2210 Scale * cast<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0))->getAPInt(); 2211 if (Mul->getNumOperands() == 2 && isa<SCEVAddExpr>(Mul->getOperand(1))) { 2212 // A multiplication of a constant with another add; recurse. 2213 const SCEVAddExpr *Add = cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Mul->getOperand(1)); 2214 Interesting |= 2215 CollectAddOperandsWithScales(M, NewOps, AccumulatedConstant, 2216 Add->op_begin(), Add->getNumOperands(), 2217 NewScale, SE); 2218 } else { 2219 // A multiplication of a constant with some other value. Update 2220 // the map. 2221 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps(drop_begin(Mul->operands())); 2222 const SCEV *Key = SE.getMulExpr(MulOps); 2223 auto Pair = M.insert({Key, NewScale}); 2224 if (Pair.second) { 2225 NewOps.push_back(Pair.first->first); 2226 } else { 2227 Pair.first->second += NewScale; 2228 // The map already had an entry for this value, which may indicate 2229 // a folding opportunity. 2230 Interesting = true; 2231 } 2232 } 2233 } else { 2234 // An ordinary operand. Update the map. 2235 std::pair<DenseMap<const SCEV *, APInt>::iterator, bool> Pair = 2236 M.insert({Ops[i], Scale}); 2237 if (Pair.second) { 2238 NewOps.push_back(Pair.first->first); 2239 } else { 2240 Pair.first->second += Scale; 2241 // The map already had an entry for this value, which may indicate 2242 // a folding opportunity. 2243 Interesting = true; 2244 } 2245 } 2246 } 2247 2248 return Interesting; 2249 } 2250 2251 bool ScalarEvolution::willNotOverflow(Instruction::BinaryOps BinOp, bool Signed, 2252 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 2253 const SCEV *(ScalarEvolution::*Operation)(const SCEV *, const SCEV *, 2254 SCEV::NoWrapFlags, unsigned); 2255 switch (BinOp) { 2256 default: 2257 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported binary op"); 2258 case Instruction::Add: 2259 Operation = &ScalarEvolution::getAddExpr; 2260 break; 2261 case Instruction::Sub: 2262 Operation = &ScalarEvolution::getMinusSCEV; 2263 break; 2264 case Instruction::Mul: 2265 Operation = &ScalarEvolution::getMulExpr; 2266 break; 2267 } 2268 2269 const SCEV *(ScalarEvolution::*Extension)(const SCEV *, Type *, unsigned) = 2270 Signed ? &ScalarEvolution::getSignExtendExpr 2271 : &ScalarEvolution::getZeroExtendExpr; 2272 2273 // Check ext(LHS op RHS) == ext(LHS) op ext(RHS) 2274 auto *NarrowTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHS->getType()); 2275 auto *WideTy = 2276 IntegerType::get(NarrowTy->getContext(), NarrowTy->getBitWidth() * 2); 2277 2278 const SCEV *A = (this->*Extension)( 2279 (this->*Operation)(LHS, RHS, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, 0), WideTy, 0); 2280 const SCEV *B = (this->*Operation)((this->*Extension)(LHS, WideTy, 0), 2281 (this->*Extension)(RHS, WideTy, 0), 2282 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, 0); 2283 return A == B; 2284 } 2285 2286 std::pair<SCEV::NoWrapFlags, bool /*Deduced*/> 2287 ScalarEvolution::getStrengthenedNoWrapFlagsFromBinOp( 2288 const OverflowingBinaryOperator *OBO) { 2289 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = SCEV::NoWrapFlags::FlagAnyWrap; 2290 2291 if (OBO->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) 2292 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 2293 if (OBO->hasNoSignedWrap()) 2294 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW); 2295 2296 bool Deduced = false; 2297 2298 if (OBO->hasNoUnsignedWrap() && OBO->hasNoSignedWrap()) 2299 return {Flags, Deduced}; 2300 2301 if (OBO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Add && 2302 OBO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Sub && 2303 OBO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Mul) 2304 return {Flags, Deduced}; 2305 2306 const SCEV *LHS = getSCEV(OBO->getOperand(0)); 2307 const SCEV *RHS = getSCEV(OBO->getOperand(1)); 2308 2309 if (!OBO->hasNoUnsignedWrap() && 2310 willNotOverflow((Instruction::BinaryOps)OBO->getOpcode(), 2311 /* Signed */ false, LHS, RHS)) { 2312 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 2313 Deduced = true; 2314 } 2315 2316 if (!OBO->hasNoSignedWrap() && 2317 willNotOverflow((Instruction::BinaryOps)OBO->getOpcode(), 2318 /* Signed */ true, LHS, RHS)) { 2319 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW); 2320 Deduced = true; 2321 } 2322 2323 return {Flags, Deduced}; 2324 } 2325 2326 // We're trying to construct a SCEV of type `Type' with `Ops' as operands and 2327 // `OldFlags' as can't-wrap behavior. Infer a more aggressive set of 2328 // can't-overflow flags for the operation if possible. 2329 static SCEV::NoWrapFlags 2330 StrengthenNoWrapFlags(ScalarEvolution *SE, SCEVTypes Type, 2331 const ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops, 2332 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) { 2333 using namespace std::placeholders; 2334 2335 using OBO = OverflowingBinaryOperator; 2336 2337 bool CanAnalyze = 2338 Type == scAddExpr || Type == scAddRecExpr || Type == scMulExpr; 2339 (void)CanAnalyze; 2340 assert(CanAnalyze && "don't call from other places!"); 2341 2342 int SignOrUnsignMask = SCEV::FlagNUW | SCEV::FlagNSW; 2343 SCEV::NoWrapFlags SignOrUnsignWrap = 2344 ScalarEvolution::maskFlags(Flags, SignOrUnsignMask); 2345 2346 // If FlagNSW is true and all the operands are non-negative, infer FlagNUW. 2347 auto IsKnownNonNegative = [&](const SCEV *S) { 2348 return SE->isKnownNonNegative(S); 2349 }; 2350 2351 if (SignOrUnsignWrap == SCEV::FlagNSW && all_of(Ops, IsKnownNonNegative)) 2352 Flags = 2353 ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)SignOrUnsignMask); 2354 2355 SignOrUnsignWrap = ScalarEvolution::maskFlags(Flags, SignOrUnsignMask); 2356 2357 if (SignOrUnsignWrap != SignOrUnsignMask && 2358 (Type == scAddExpr || Type == scMulExpr) && Ops.size() == 2 && 2359 isa<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) { 2360 2361 auto Opcode = [&] { 2362 switch (Type) { 2363 case scAddExpr: 2364 return Instruction::Add; 2365 case scMulExpr: 2366 return Instruction::Mul; 2367 default: 2368 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected SCEV op."); 2369 } 2370 }(); 2371 2372 const APInt &C = cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])->getAPInt(); 2373 2374 // (A <opcode> C) --> (A <opcode> C)<nsw> if the op doesn't sign overflow. 2375 if (!(SignOrUnsignWrap & SCEV::FlagNSW)) { 2376 auto NSWRegion = ConstantRange::makeGuaranteedNoWrapRegion( 2377 Opcode, C, OBO::NoSignedWrap); 2378 if (NSWRegion.contains(SE->getSignedRange(Ops[1]))) 2379 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW); 2380 } 2381 2382 // (A <opcode> C) --> (A <opcode> C)<nuw> if the op doesn't unsign overflow. 2383 if (!(SignOrUnsignWrap & SCEV::FlagNUW)) { 2384 auto NUWRegion = ConstantRange::makeGuaranteedNoWrapRegion( 2385 Opcode, C, OBO::NoUnsignedWrap); 2386 if (NUWRegion.contains(SE->getUnsignedRange(Ops[1]))) 2387 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 2388 } 2389 } 2390 2391 // <0,+,nonnegative><nw> is also nuw 2392 // TODO: Add corresponding nsw case 2393 if (Type == scAddRecExpr && ScalarEvolution::hasFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW) && 2394 !ScalarEvolution::hasFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW) && Ops.size() == 2 && 2395 Ops[0]->isZero() && IsKnownNonNegative(Ops[1])) 2396 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 2397 2398 // both (udiv X, Y) * Y and Y * (udiv X, Y) are always NUW 2399 if (Type == scMulExpr && !ScalarEvolution::hasFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW) && 2400 Ops.size() == 2) { 2401 if (auto *UDiv = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(Ops[0])) 2402 if (UDiv->getOperand(1) == Ops[1]) 2403 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 2404 if (auto *UDiv = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(Ops[1])) 2405 if (UDiv->getOperand(1) == Ops[0]) 2406 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 2407 } 2408 2409 return Flags; 2410 } 2411 2412 bool ScalarEvolution::isAvailableAtLoopEntry(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) { 2413 return isLoopInvariant(S, L) && properlyDominates(S, L->getHeader()); 2414 } 2415 2416 /// Get a canonical add expression, or something simpler if possible. 2417 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getAddExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops, 2418 SCEV::NoWrapFlags OrigFlags, 2419 unsigned Depth) { 2420 assert(!(OrigFlags & ~(SCEV::FlagNUW | SCEV::FlagNSW)) && 2421 "only nuw or nsw allowed"); 2422 assert(!Ops.empty() && "Cannot get empty add!"); 2423 if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0]; 2424 #ifndef NDEBUG 2425 Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[0]->getType()); 2426 for (unsigned i = 1, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i) 2427 assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[i]->getType()) == ETy && 2428 "SCEVAddExpr operand types don't match!"); 2429 unsigned NumPtrs = count_if( 2430 Ops, [](const SCEV *Op) { return Op->getType()->isPointerTy(); }); 2431 assert(NumPtrs <= 1 && "add has at most one pointer operand"); 2432 #endif 2433 2434 // Sort by complexity, this groups all similar expression types together. 2435 GroupByComplexity(Ops, &LI, DT); 2436 2437 // If there are any constants, fold them together. 2438 unsigned Idx = 0; 2439 if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) { 2440 ++Idx; 2441 assert(Idx < Ops.size()); 2442 while (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[Idx])) { 2443 // We found two constants, fold them together! 2444 Ops[0] = getConstant(LHSC->getAPInt() + RHSC->getAPInt()); 2445 if (Ops.size() == 2) return Ops[0]; 2446 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+1); // Erase the folded element 2447 LHSC = cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0]); 2448 } 2449 2450 // If we are left with a constant zero being added, strip it off. 2451 if (LHSC->getValue()->isZero()) { 2452 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()); 2453 --Idx; 2454 } 2455 2456 if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0]; 2457 } 2458 2459 // Delay expensive flag strengthening until necessary. 2460 auto ComputeFlags = [this, OrigFlags](const ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops) { 2461 return StrengthenNoWrapFlags(this, scAddExpr, Ops, OrigFlags); 2462 }; 2463 2464 // Limit recursion calls depth. 2465 if (Depth > MaxArithDepth || hasHugeExpression(Ops)) 2466 return getOrCreateAddExpr(Ops, ComputeFlags(Ops)); 2467 2468 if (SCEV *S = findExistingSCEVInCache(scAddExpr, Ops)) { 2469 // Don't strengthen flags if we have no new information. 2470 SCEVAddExpr *Add = static_cast<SCEVAddExpr *>(S); 2471 if (Add->getNoWrapFlags(OrigFlags) != OrigFlags) 2472 Add->setNoWrapFlags(ComputeFlags(Ops)); 2473 return S; 2474 } 2475 2476 // Okay, check to see if the same value occurs in the operand list more than 2477 // once. If so, merge them together into an multiply expression. Since we 2478 // sorted the list, these values are required to be adjacent. 2479 Type *Ty = Ops[0]->getType(); 2480 bool FoundMatch = false; 2481 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e-1; ++i) 2482 if (Ops[i] == Ops[i+1]) { // X + Y + Y --> X + Y*2 2483 // Scan ahead to count how many equal operands there are. 2484 unsigned Count = 2; 2485 while (i+Count != e && Ops[i+Count] == Ops[i]) 2486 ++Count; 2487 // Merge the values into a multiply. 2488 const SCEV *Scale = getConstant(Ty, Count); 2489 const SCEV *Mul = getMulExpr(Scale, Ops[i], SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2490 if (Ops.size() == Count) 2491 return Mul; 2492 Ops[i] = Mul; 2493 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+i+1, Ops.begin()+i+Count); 2494 --i; e -= Count - 1; 2495 FoundMatch = true; 2496 } 2497 if (FoundMatch) 2498 return getAddExpr(Ops, OrigFlags, Depth + 1); 2499 2500 // Check for truncates. If all the operands are truncated from the same 2501 // type, see if factoring out the truncate would permit the result to be 2502 // folded. eg., n*trunc(x) + m*trunc(y) --> trunc(trunc(m)*x + trunc(n)*y) 2503 // if the contents of the resulting outer trunc fold to something simple. 2504 auto FindTruncSrcType = [&]() -> Type * { 2505 // We're ultimately looking to fold an addrec of truncs and muls of only 2506 // constants and truncs, so if we find any other types of SCEV 2507 // as operands of the addrec then we bail and return nullptr here. 2508 // Otherwise, we return the type of the operand of a trunc that we find. 2509 if (auto *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Ops[Idx])) 2510 return T->getOperand()->getType(); 2511 if (const auto *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx])) { 2512 const auto *LastOp = Mul->getOperand(Mul->getNumOperands() - 1); 2513 if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(LastOp)) 2514 return T->getOperand()->getType(); 2515 } 2516 return nullptr; 2517 }; 2518 if (auto *SrcType = FindTruncSrcType()) { 2519 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> LargeOps; 2520 bool Ok = true; 2521 // Check all the operands to see if they can be represented in the 2522 // source type of the truncate. 2523 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i) { 2524 if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(Ops[i])) { 2525 if (T->getOperand()->getType() != SrcType) { 2526 Ok = false; 2527 break; 2528 } 2529 LargeOps.push_back(T->getOperand()); 2530 } else if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[i])) { 2531 LargeOps.push_back(getAnyExtendExpr(C, SrcType)); 2532 } else if (const SCEVMulExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[i])) { 2533 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> LargeMulOps; 2534 for (unsigned j = 0, f = M->getNumOperands(); j != f && Ok; ++j) { 2535 if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *T = 2536 dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(M->getOperand(j))) { 2537 if (T->getOperand()->getType() != SrcType) { 2538 Ok = false; 2539 break; 2540 } 2541 LargeMulOps.push_back(T->getOperand()); 2542 } else if (const auto *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(M->getOperand(j))) { 2543 LargeMulOps.push_back(getAnyExtendExpr(C, SrcType)); 2544 } else { 2545 Ok = false; 2546 break; 2547 } 2548 } 2549 if (Ok) 2550 LargeOps.push_back(getMulExpr(LargeMulOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1)); 2551 } else { 2552 Ok = false; 2553 break; 2554 } 2555 } 2556 if (Ok) { 2557 // Evaluate the expression in the larger type. 2558 const SCEV *Fold = getAddExpr(LargeOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2559 // If it folds to something simple, use it. Otherwise, don't. 2560 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(Fold) || isa<SCEVUnknown>(Fold)) 2561 return getTruncateExpr(Fold, Ty); 2562 } 2563 } 2564 2565 if (Ops.size() == 2) { 2566 // Check if we have an expression of the form ((X + C1) - C2), where C1 and 2567 // C2 can be folded in a way that allows retaining wrapping flags of (X + 2568 // C1). 2569 const SCEV *A = Ops[0]; 2570 const SCEV *B = Ops[1]; 2571 auto *AddExpr = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(B); 2572 auto *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(A); 2573 if (AddExpr && C && isa<SCEVConstant>(AddExpr->getOperand(0))) { 2574 auto C1 = cast<SCEVConstant>(AddExpr->getOperand(0))->getAPInt(); 2575 auto C2 = C->getAPInt(); 2576 SCEV::NoWrapFlags PreservedFlags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 2577 2578 APInt ConstAdd = C1 + C2; 2579 auto AddFlags = AddExpr->getNoWrapFlags(); 2580 // Adding a smaller constant is NUW if the original AddExpr was NUW. 2581 if (ScalarEvolution::hasFlags(AddFlags, SCEV::FlagNUW) && 2582 ConstAdd.ule(C1)) { 2583 PreservedFlags = 2584 ScalarEvolution::setFlags(PreservedFlags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 2585 } 2586 2587 // Adding a constant with the same sign and small magnitude is NSW, if the 2588 // original AddExpr was NSW. 2589 if (ScalarEvolution::hasFlags(AddFlags, SCEV::FlagNSW) && 2590 C1.isSignBitSet() == ConstAdd.isSignBitSet() && 2591 ConstAdd.abs().ule(C1.abs())) { 2592 PreservedFlags = 2593 ScalarEvolution::setFlags(PreservedFlags, SCEV::FlagNSW); 2594 } 2595 2596 if (PreservedFlags != SCEV::FlagAnyWrap) { 2597 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> NewOps(AddExpr->operands()); 2598 NewOps[0] = getConstant(ConstAdd); 2599 return getAddExpr(NewOps, PreservedFlags); 2600 } 2601 } 2602 } 2603 2604 // Canonicalize (-1 * urem X, Y) + X --> (Y * X/Y) 2605 if (Ops.size() == 2) { 2606 const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[0]); 2607 if (Mul && Mul->getNumOperands() == 2 && 2608 Mul->getOperand(0)->isAllOnesValue()) { 2609 const SCEV *X; 2610 const SCEV *Y; 2611 if (matchURem(Mul->getOperand(1), X, Y) && X == Ops[1]) { 2612 return getMulExpr(Y, getUDivExpr(X, Y)); 2613 } 2614 } 2615 } 2616 2617 // Skip past any other cast SCEVs. 2618 while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scAddExpr) 2619 ++Idx; 2620 2621 // If there are add operands they would be next. 2622 if (Idx < Ops.size()) { 2623 bool DeletedAdd = false; 2624 // If the original flags and all inlined SCEVAddExprs are NUW, use the 2625 // common NUW flag for expression after inlining. Other flags cannot be 2626 // preserved, because they may depend on the original order of operations. 2627 SCEV::NoWrapFlags CommonFlags = maskFlags(OrigFlags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 2628 while (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Ops[Idx])) { 2629 if (Ops.size() > AddOpsInlineThreshold || 2630 Add->getNumOperands() > AddOpsInlineThreshold) 2631 break; 2632 // If we have an add, expand the add operands onto the end of the operands 2633 // list. 2634 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx); 2635 Ops.append(Add->op_begin(), Add->op_end()); 2636 DeletedAdd = true; 2637 CommonFlags = maskFlags(CommonFlags, Add->getNoWrapFlags()); 2638 } 2639 2640 // If we deleted at least one add, we added operands to the end of the list, 2641 // and they are not necessarily sorted. Recurse to resort and resimplify 2642 // any operands we just acquired. 2643 if (DeletedAdd) 2644 return getAddExpr(Ops, CommonFlags, Depth + 1); 2645 } 2646 2647 // Skip over the add expression until we get to a multiply. 2648 while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scMulExpr) 2649 ++Idx; 2650 2651 // Check to see if there are any folding opportunities present with 2652 // operands multiplied by constant values. 2653 if (Idx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx])) { 2654 uint64_t BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty); 2655 DenseMap<const SCEV *, APInt> M; 2656 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> NewOps; 2657 APInt AccumulatedConstant(BitWidth, 0); 2658 if (CollectAddOperandsWithScales(M, NewOps, AccumulatedConstant, 2659 Ops.data(), Ops.size(), 2660 APInt(BitWidth, 1), *this)) { 2661 struct APIntCompare { 2662 bool operator()(const APInt &LHS, const APInt &RHS) const { 2663 return LHS.ult(RHS); 2664 } 2665 }; 2666 2667 // Some interesting folding opportunity is present, so its worthwhile to 2668 // re-generate the operands list. Group the operands by constant scale, 2669 // to avoid multiplying by the same constant scale multiple times. 2670 std::map<APInt, SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4>, APIntCompare> MulOpLists; 2671 for (const SCEV *NewOp : NewOps) 2672 MulOpLists[M.find(NewOp)->second].push_back(NewOp); 2673 // Re-generate the operands list. 2674 Ops.clear(); 2675 if (AccumulatedConstant != 0) 2676 Ops.push_back(getConstant(AccumulatedConstant)); 2677 for (auto &MulOp : MulOpLists) { 2678 if (MulOp.first == 1) { 2679 Ops.push_back(getAddExpr(MulOp.second, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1)); 2680 } else if (MulOp.first != 0) { 2681 Ops.push_back(getMulExpr( 2682 getConstant(MulOp.first), 2683 getAddExpr(MulOp.second, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1), 2684 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1)); 2685 } 2686 } 2687 if (Ops.empty()) 2688 return getZero(Ty); 2689 if (Ops.size() == 1) 2690 return Ops[0]; 2691 return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2692 } 2693 } 2694 2695 // If we are adding something to a multiply expression, make sure the 2696 // something is not already an operand of the multiply. If so, merge it into 2697 // the multiply. 2698 for (; Idx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx]); ++Idx) { 2699 const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx]); 2700 for (unsigned MulOp = 0, e = Mul->getNumOperands(); MulOp != e; ++MulOp) { 2701 const SCEV *MulOpSCEV = Mul->getOperand(MulOp); 2702 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(MulOpSCEV)) 2703 continue; 2704 for (unsigned AddOp = 0, e = Ops.size(); AddOp != e; ++AddOp) 2705 if (MulOpSCEV == Ops[AddOp]) { 2706 // Fold W + X + (X * Y * Z) --> W + (X * ((Y*Z)+1)) 2707 const SCEV *InnerMul = Mul->getOperand(MulOp == 0); 2708 if (Mul->getNumOperands() != 2) { 2709 // If the multiply has more than two operands, we must get the 2710 // Y*Z term. 2711 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps(Mul->op_begin(), 2712 Mul->op_begin()+MulOp); 2713 MulOps.append(Mul->op_begin()+MulOp+1, Mul->op_end()); 2714 InnerMul = getMulExpr(MulOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2715 } 2716 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> TwoOps = {getOne(Ty), InnerMul}; 2717 const SCEV *AddOne = getAddExpr(TwoOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2718 const SCEV *OuterMul = getMulExpr(AddOne, MulOpSCEV, 2719 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2720 if (Ops.size() == 2) return OuterMul; 2721 if (AddOp < Idx) { 2722 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+AddOp); 2723 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx-1); 2724 } else { 2725 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx); 2726 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+AddOp-1); 2727 } 2728 Ops.push_back(OuterMul); 2729 return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2730 } 2731 2732 // Check this multiply against other multiplies being added together. 2733 for (unsigned OtherMulIdx = Idx+1; 2734 OtherMulIdx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[OtherMulIdx]); 2735 ++OtherMulIdx) { 2736 const SCEVMulExpr *OtherMul = cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[OtherMulIdx]); 2737 // If MulOp occurs in OtherMul, we can fold the two multiplies 2738 // together. 2739 for (unsigned OMulOp = 0, e = OtherMul->getNumOperands(); 2740 OMulOp != e; ++OMulOp) 2741 if (OtherMul->getOperand(OMulOp) == MulOpSCEV) { 2742 // Fold X + (A*B*C) + (A*D*E) --> X + (A*(B*C+D*E)) 2743 const SCEV *InnerMul1 = Mul->getOperand(MulOp == 0); 2744 if (Mul->getNumOperands() != 2) { 2745 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps(Mul->op_begin(), 2746 Mul->op_begin()+MulOp); 2747 MulOps.append(Mul->op_begin()+MulOp+1, Mul->op_end()); 2748 InnerMul1 = getMulExpr(MulOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2749 } 2750 const SCEV *InnerMul2 = OtherMul->getOperand(OMulOp == 0); 2751 if (OtherMul->getNumOperands() != 2) { 2752 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps(OtherMul->op_begin(), 2753 OtherMul->op_begin()+OMulOp); 2754 MulOps.append(OtherMul->op_begin()+OMulOp+1, OtherMul->op_end()); 2755 InnerMul2 = getMulExpr(MulOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2756 } 2757 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> TwoOps = {InnerMul1, InnerMul2}; 2758 const SCEV *InnerMulSum = 2759 getAddExpr(TwoOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2760 const SCEV *OuterMul = getMulExpr(MulOpSCEV, InnerMulSum, 2761 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2762 if (Ops.size() == 2) return OuterMul; 2763 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx); 2764 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+OtherMulIdx-1); 2765 Ops.push_back(OuterMul); 2766 return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2767 } 2768 } 2769 } 2770 } 2771 2772 // If there are any add recurrences in the operands list, see if any other 2773 // added values are loop invariant. If so, we can fold them into the 2774 // recurrence. 2775 while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scAddRecExpr) 2776 ++Idx; 2777 2778 // Scan over all recurrences, trying to fold loop invariants into them. 2779 for (; Idx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[Idx]); ++Idx) { 2780 // Scan all of the other operands to this add and add them to the vector if 2781 // they are loop invariant w.r.t. the recurrence. 2782 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> LIOps; 2783 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[Idx]); 2784 const Loop *AddRecLoop = AddRec->getLoop(); 2785 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i) 2786 if (isAvailableAtLoopEntry(Ops[i], AddRecLoop)) { 2787 LIOps.push_back(Ops[i]); 2788 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+i); 2789 --i; --e; 2790 } 2791 2792 // If we found some loop invariants, fold them into the recurrence. 2793 if (!LIOps.empty()) { 2794 // Compute nowrap flags for the addition of the loop-invariant ops and 2795 // the addrec. Temporarily push it as an operand for that purpose. These 2796 // flags are valid in the scope of the addrec only. 2797 LIOps.push_back(AddRec); 2798 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = ComputeFlags(LIOps); 2799 LIOps.pop_back(); 2800 2801 // NLI + LI + {Start,+,Step} --> NLI + {LI+Start,+,Step} 2802 LIOps.push_back(AddRec->getStart()); 2803 2804 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> AddRecOps(AddRec->operands()); 2805 2806 // It is not in general safe to propagate flags valid on an add within 2807 // the addrec scope to one outside it. We must prove that the inner 2808 // scope is guaranteed to execute if the outer one does to be able to 2809 // safely propagate. We know the program is undefined if poison is 2810 // produced on the inner scoped addrec. We also know that *for this use* 2811 // the outer scoped add can't overflow (because of the flags we just 2812 // computed for the inner scoped add) without the program being undefined. 2813 // Proving that entry to the outer scope neccesitates entry to the inner 2814 // scope, thus proves the program undefined if the flags would be violated 2815 // in the outer scope. 2816 SCEV::NoWrapFlags AddFlags = Flags; 2817 if (AddFlags != SCEV::FlagAnyWrap) { 2818 auto *DefI = getDefiningScopeBound(LIOps); 2819 auto *ReachI = &*AddRecLoop->getHeader()->begin(); 2820 if (!isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionTo(DefI, ReachI)) 2821 AddFlags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 2822 } 2823 AddRecOps[0] = getAddExpr(LIOps, AddFlags, Depth + 1); 2824 2825 // Build the new addrec. Propagate the NUW and NSW flags if both the 2826 // outer add and the inner addrec are guaranteed to have no overflow. 2827 // Always propagate NW. 2828 Flags = AddRec->getNoWrapFlags(setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW)); 2829 const SCEV *NewRec = getAddRecExpr(AddRecOps, AddRecLoop, Flags); 2830 2831 // If all of the other operands were loop invariant, we are done. 2832 if (Ops.size() == 1) return NewRec; 2833 2834 // Otherwise, add the folded AddRec by the non-invariant parts. 2835 for (unsigned i = 0;; ++i) 2836 if (Ops[i] == AddRec) { 2837 Ops[i] = NewRec; 2838 break; 2839 } 2840 return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2841 } 2842 2843 // Okay, if there weren't any loop invariants to be folded, check to see if 2844 // there are multiple AddRec's with the same loop induction variable being 2845 // added together. If so, we can fold them. 2846 for (unsigned OtherIdx = Idx+1; 2847 OtherIdx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]); 2848 ++OtherIdx) { 2849 // We expect the AddRecExpr's to be sorted in reverse dominance order, 2850 // so that the 1st found AddRecExpr is dominated by all others. 2851 assert(DT.dominates( 2852 cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx])->getLoop()->getHeader(), 2853 AddRec->getLoop()->getHeader()) && 2854 "AddRecExprs are not sorted in reverse dominance order?"); 2855 if (AddRecLoop == cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx])->getLoop()) { 2856 // Other + {A,+,B}<L> + {C,+,D}<L> --> Other + {A+C,+,B+D}<L> 2857 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> AddRecOps(AddRec->operands()); 2858 for (; OtherIdx != Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]); 2859 ++OtherIdx) { 2860 const auto *OtherAddRec = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]); 2861 if (OtherAddRec->getLoop() == AddRecLoop) { 2862 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OtherAddRec->getNumOperands(); 2863 i != e; ++i) { 2864 if (i >= AddRecOps.size()) { 2865 AddRecOps.append(OtherAddRec->op_begin()+i, 2866 OtherAddRec->op_end()); 2867 break; 2868 } 2869 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> TwoOps = { 2870 AddRecOps[i], OtherAddRec->getOperand(i)}; 2871 AddRecOps[i] = getAddExpr(TwoOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2872 } 2873 Ops.erase(Ops.begin() + OtherIdx); --OtherIdx; 2874 } 2875 } 2876 // Step size has changed, so we cannot guarantee no self-wraparound. 2877 Ops[Idx] = getAddRecExpr(AddRecOps, AddRecLoop, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap); 2878 return getAddExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 2879 } 2880 } 2881 2882 // Otherwise couldn't fold anything into this recurrence. Move onto the 2883 // next one. 2884 } 2885 2886 // Okay, it looks like we really DO need an add expr. Check to see if we 2887 // already have one, otherwise create a new one. 2888 return getOrCreateAddExpr(Ops, ComputeFlags(Ops)); 2889 } 2890 2891 const SCEV * 2892 ScalarEvolution::getOrCreateAddExpr(ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops, 2893 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) { 2894 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2895 ID.AddInteger(scAddExpr); 2896 for (const SCEV *Op : Ops) 2897 ID.AddPointer(Op); 2898 void *IP = nullptr; 2899 SCEVAddExpr *S = 2900 static_cast<SCEVAddExpr *>(UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)); 2901 if (!S) { 2902 const SCEV **O = SCEVAllocator.Allocate<const SCEV *>(Ops.size()); 2903 std::uninitialized_copy(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(), O); 2904 S = new (SCEVAllocator) 2905 SCEVAddExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), O, Ops.size()); 2906 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 2907 registerUser(S, Ops); 2908 } 2909 S->setNoWrapFlags(Flags); 2910 return S; 2911 } 2912 2913 const SCEV * 2914 ScalarEvolution::getOrCreateAddRecExpr(ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops, 2915 const Loop *L, SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) { 2916 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2917 ID.AddInteger(scAddRecExpr); 2918 for (const SCEV *Op : Ops) 2919 ID.AddPointer(Op); 2920 ID.AddPointer(L); 2921 void *IP = nullptr; 2922 SCEVAddRecExpr *S = 2923 static_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)); 2924 if (!S) { 2925 const SCEV **O = SCEVAllocator.Allocate<const SCEV *>(Ops.size()); 2926 std::uninitialized_copy(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(), O); 2927 S = new (SCEVAllocator) 2928 SCEVAddRecExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), O, Ops.size(), L); 2929 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 2930 LoopUsers[L].push_back(S); 2931 registerUser(S, Ops); 2932 } 2933 setNoWrapFlags(S, Flags); 2934 return S; 2935 } 2936 2937 const SCEV * 2938 ScalarEvolution::getOrCreateMulExpr(ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops, 2939 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) { 2940 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 2941 ID.AddInteger(scMulExpr); 2942 for (const SCEV *Op : Ops) 2943 ID.AddPointer(Op); 2944 void *IP = nullptr; 2945 SCEVMulExpr *S = 2946 static_cast<SCEVMulExpr *>(UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)); 2947 if (!S) { 2948 const SCEV **O = SCEVAllocator.Allocate<const SCEV *>(Ops.size()); 2949 std::uninitialized_copy(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(), O); 2950 S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVMulExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), 2951 O, Ops.size()); 2952 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 2953 registerUser(S, Ops); 2954 } 2955 S->setNoWrapFlags(Flags); 2956 return S; 2957 } 2958 2959 static uint64_t umul_ov(uint64_t i, uint64_t j, bool &Overflow) { 2960 uint64_t k = i*j; 2961 if (j > 1 && k / j != i) Overflow = true; 2962 return k; 2963 } 2964 2965 /// Compute the result of "n choose k", the binomial coefficient. If an 2966 /// intermediate computation overflows, Overflow will be set and the return will 2967 /// be garbage. Overflow is not cleared on absence of overflow. 2968 static uint64_t Choose(uint64_t n, uint64_t k, bool &Overflow) { 2969 // We use the multiplicative formula: 2970 // n(n-1)(n-2)...(n-(k-1)) / k(k-1)(k-2)...1 . 2971 // At each iteration, we take the n-th term of the numeral and divide by the 2972 // (k-n)th term of the denominator. This division will always produce an 2973 // integral result, and helps reduce the chance of overflow in the 2974 // intermediate computations. However, we can still overflow even when the 2975 // final result would fit. 2976 2977 if (n == 0 || n == k) return 1; 2978 if (k > n) return 0; 2979 2980 if (k > n/2) 2981 k = n-k; 2982 2983 uint64_t r = 1; 2984 for (uint64_t i = 1; i <= k; ++i) { 2985 r = umul_ov(r, n-(i-1), Overflow); 2986 r /= i; 2987 } 2988 return r; 2989 } 2990 2991 /// Determine if any of the operands in this SCEV are a constant or if 2992 /// any of the add or multiply expressions in this SCEV contain a constant. 2993 static bool containsConstantInAddMulChain(const SCEV *StartExpr) { 2994 struct FindConstantInAddMulChain { 2995 bool FoundConstant = false; 2996 2997 bool follow(const SCEV *S) { 2998 FoundConstant |= isa<SCEVConstant>(S); 2999 return isa<SCEVAddExpr>(S) || isa<SCEVMulExpr>(S); 3000 } 3001 3002 bool isDone() const { 3003 return FoundConstant; 3004 } 3005 }; 3006 3007 FindConstantInAddMulChain F; 3008 SCEVTraversal<FindConstantInAddMulChain> ST(F); 3009 ST.visitAll(StartExpr); 3010 return F.FoundConstant; 3011 } 3012 3013 /// Get a canonical multiply expression, or something simpler if possible. 3014 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getMulExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops, 3015 SCEV::NoWrapFlags OrigFlags, 3016 unsigned Depth) { 3017 assert(OrigFlags == maskFlags(OrigFlags, SCEV::FlagNUW | SCEV::FlagNSW) && 3018 "only nuw or nsw allowed"); 3019 assert(!Ops.empty() && "Cannot get empty mul!"); 3020 if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0]; 3021 #ifndef NDEBUG 3022 Type *ETy = Ops[0]->getType(); 3023 assert(!ETy->isPointerTy()); 3024 for (unsigned i = 1, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i) 3025 assert(Ops[i]->getType() == ETy && 3026 "SCEVMulExpr operand types don't match!"); 3027 #endif 3028 3029 // Sort by complexity, this groups all similar expression types together. 3030 GroupByComplexity(Ops, &LI, DT); 3031 3032 // If there are any constants, fold them together. 3033 unsigned Idx = 0; 3034 if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) { 3035 ++Idx; 3036 assert(Idx < Ops.size()); 3037 while (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[Idx])) { 3038 // We found two constants, fold them together! 3039 Ops[0] = getConstant(LHSC->getAPInt() * RHSC->getAPInt()); 3040 if (Ops.size() == 2) return Ops[0]; 3041 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+1); // Erase the folded element 3042 LHSC = cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0]); 3043 } 3044 3045 // If we have a multiply of zero, it will always be zero. 3046 if (LHSC->getValue()->isZero()) 3047 return LHSC; 3048 3049 // If we are left with a constant one being multiplied, strip it off. 3050 if (LHSC->getValue()->isOne()) { 3051 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()); 3052 --Idx; 3053 } 3054 3055 if (Ops.size() == 1) 3056 return Ops[0]; 3057 } 3058 3059 // Delay expensive flag strengthening until necessary. 3060 auto ComputeFlags = [this, OrigFlags](const ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops) { 3061 return StrengthenNoWrapFlags(this, scMulExpr, Ops, OrigFlags); 3062 }; 3063 3064 // Limit recursion calls depth. 3065 if (Depth > MaxArithDepth || hasHugeExpression(Ops)) 3066 return getOrCreateMulExpr(Ops, ComputeFlags(Ops)); 3067 3068 if (SCEV *S = findExistingSCEVInCache(scMulExpr, Ops)) { 3069 // Don't strengthen flags if we have no new information. 3070 SCEVMulExpr *Mul = static_cast<SCEVMulExpr *>(S); 3071 if (Mul->getNoWrapFlags(OrigFlags) != OrigFlags) 3072 Mul->setNoWrapFlags(ComputeFlags(Ops)); 3073 return S; 3074 } 3075 3076 if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) { 3077 if (Ops.size() == 2) { 3078 // C1*(C2+V) -> C1*C2 + C1*V 3079 if (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Ops[1])) 3080 // If any of Add's ops are Adds or Muls with a constant, apply this 3081 // transformation as well. 3082 // 3083 // TODO: There are some cases where this transformation is not 3084 // profitable; for example, Add = (C0 + X) * Y + Z. Maybe the scope of 3085 // this transformation should be narrowed down. 3086 if (Add->getNumOperands() == 2 && containsConstantInAddMulChain(Add)) 3087 return getAddExpr(getMulExpr(LHSC, Add->getOperand(0), 3088 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1), 3089 getMulExpr(LHSC, Add->getOperand(1), 3090 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1), 3091 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 3092 3093 if (Ops[0]->isAllOnesValue()) { 3094 // If we have a mul by -1 of an add, try distributing the -1 among the 3095 // add operands. 3096 if (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Ops[1])) { 3097 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> NewOps; 3098 bool AnyFolded = false; 3099 for (const SCEV *AddOp : Add->operands()) { 3100 const SCEV *Mul = getMulExpr(Ops[0], AddOp, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, 3101 Depth + 1); 3102 if (!isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Mul)) AnyFolded = true; 3103 NewOps.push_back(Mul); 3104 } 3105 if (AnyFolded) 3106 return getAddExpr(NewOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 3107 } else if (const auto *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[1])) { 3108 // Negation preserves a recurrence's no self-wrap property. 3109 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands; 3110 for (const SCEV *AddRecOp : AddRec->operands()) 3111 Operands.push_back(getMulExpr(Ops[0], AddRecOp, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, 3112 Depth + 1)); 3113 3114 return getAddRecExpr(Operands, AddRec->getLoop(), 3115 AddRec->getNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNW)); 3116 } 3117 } 3118 } 3119 } 3120 3121 // Skip over the add expression until we get to a multiply. 3122 while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scMulExpr) 3123 ++Idx; 3124 3125 // If there are mul operands inline them all into this expression. 3126 if (Idx < Ops.size()) { 3127 bool DeletedMul = false; 3128 while (const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Ops[Idx])) { 3129 if (Ops.size() > MulOpsInlineThreshold) 3130 break; 3131 // If we have an mul, expand the mul operands onto the end of the 3132 // operands list. 3133 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx); 3134 Ops.append(Mul->op_begin(), Mul->op_end()); 3135 DeletedMul = true; 3136 } 3137 3138 // If we deleted at least one mul, we added operands to the end of the 3139 // list, and they are not necessarily sorted. Recurse to resort and 3140 // resimplify any operands we just acquired. 3141 if (DeletedMul) 3142 return getMulExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 3143 } 3144 3145 // If there are any add recurrences in the operands list, see if any other 3146 // added values are loop invariant. If so, we can fold them into the 3147 // recurrence. 3148 while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < scAddRecExpr) 3149 ++Idx; 3150 3151 // Scan over all recurrences, trying to fold loop invariants into them. 3152 for (; Idx < Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[Idx]); ++Idx) { 3153 // Scan all of the other operands to this mul and add them to the vector 3154 // if they are loop invariant w.r.t. the recurrence. 3155 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> LIOps; 3156 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[Idx]); 3157 const Loop *AddRecLoop = AddRec->getLoop(); 3158 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i) 3159 if (isAvailableAtLoopEntry(Ops[i], AddRecLoop)) { 3160 LIOps.push_back(Ops[i]); 3161 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+i); 3162 --i; --e; 3163 } 3164 3165 // If we found some loop invariants, fold them into the recurrence. 3166 if (!LIOps.empty()) { 3167 // NLI * LI * {Start,+,Step} --> NLI * {LI*Start,+,LI*Step} 3168 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> NewOps; 3169 NewOps.reserve(AddRec->getNumOperands()); 3170 const SCEV *Scale = getMulExpr(LIOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 3171 for (unsigned i = 0, e = AddRec->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 3172 NewOps.push_back(getMulExpr(Scale, AddRec->getOperand(i), 3173 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1)); 3174 3175 // Build the new addrec. Propagate the NUW and NSW flags if both the 3176 // outer mul and the inner addrec are guaranteed to have no overflow. 3177 // 3178 // No self-wrap cannot be guaranteed after changing the step size, but 3179 // will be inferred if either NUW or NSW is true. 3180 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = ComputeFlags({Scale, AddRec}); 3181 const SCEV *NewRec = getAddRecExpr( 3182 NewOps, AddRecLoop, AddRec->getNoWrapFlags(Flags)); 3183 3184 // If all of the other operands were loop invariant, we are done. 3185 if (Ops.size() == 1) return NewRec; 3186 3187 // Otherwise, multiply the folded AddRec by the non-invariant parts. 3188 for (unsigned i = 0;; ++i) 3189 if (Ops[i] == AddRec) { 3190 Ops[i] = NewRec; 3191 break; 3192 } 3193 return getMulExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 3194 } 3195 3196 // Okay, if there weren't any loop invariants to be folded, check to see 3197 // if there are multiple AddRec's with the same loop induction variable 3198 // being multiplied together. If so, we can fold them. 3199 3200 // {A1,+,A2,+,...,+,An}<L> * {B1,+,B2,+,...,+,Bn}<L> 3201 // = {x=1 in [ sum y=x..2x [ sum z=max(y-x, y-n)..min(x,n) [ 3202 // choose(x, 2x)*choose(2x-y, x-z)*A_{y-z}*B_z 3203 // ]]],+,...up to x=2n}. 3204 // Note that the arguments to choose() are always integers with values 3205 // known at compile time, never SCEV objects. 3206 // 3207 // The implementation avoids pointless extra computations when the two 3208 // addrec's are of different length (mathematically, it's equivalent to 3209 // an infinite stream of zeros on the right). 3210 bool OpsModified = false; 3211 for (unsigned OtherIdx = Idx+1; 3212 OtherIdx != Ops.size() && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]); 3213 ++OtherIdx) { 3214 const SCEVAddRecExpr *OtherAddRec = 3215 dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Ops[OtherIdx]); 3216 if (!OtherAddRec || OtherAddRec->getLoop() != AddRecLoop) 3217 continue; 3218 3219 // Limit max number of arguments to avoid creation of unreasonably big 3220 // SCEVAddRecs with very complex operands. 3221 if (AddRec->getNumOperands() + OtherAddRec->getNumOperands() - 1 > 3222 MaxAddRecSize || hasHugeExpression({AddRec, OtherAddRec})) 3223 continue; 3224 3225 bool Overflow = false; 3226 Type *Ty = AddRec->getType(); 3227 bool LargerThan64Bits = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) > 64; 3228 SmallVector<const SCEV*, 7> AddRecOps; 3229 for (int x = 0, xe = AddRec->getNumOperands() + 3230 OtherAddRec->getNumOperands() - 1; x != xe && !Overflow; ++x) { 3231 SmallVector <const SCEV *, 7> SumOps; 3232 for (int y = x, ye = 2*x+1; y != ye && !Overflow; ++y) { 3233 uint64_t Coeff1 = Choose(x, 2*x - y, Overflow); 3234 for (int z = std::max(y-x, y-(int)AddRec->getNumOperands()+1), 3235 ze = std::min(x+1, (int)OtherAddRec->getNumOperands()); 3236 z < ze && !Overflow; ++z) { 3237 uint64_t Coeff2 = Choose(2*x - y, x-z, Overflow); 3238 uint64_t Coeff; 3239 if (LargerThan64Bits) 3240 Coeff = umul_ov(Coeff1, Coeff2, Overflow); 3241 else 3242 Coeff = Coeff1*Coeff2; 3243 const SCEV *CoeffTerm = getConstant(Ty, Coeff); 3244 const SCEV *Term1 = AddRec->getOperand(y-z); 3245 const SCEV *Term2 = OtherAddRec->getOperand(z); 3246 SumOps.push_back(getMulExpr(CoeffTerm, Term1, Term2, 3247 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1)); 3248 } 3249 } 3250 if (SumOps.empty()) 3251 SumOps.push_back(getZero(Ty)); 3252 AddRecOps.push_back(getAddExpr(SumOps, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1)); 3253 } 3254 if (!Overflow) { 3255 const SCEV *NewAddRec = getAddRecExpr(AddRecOps, AddRecLoop, 3256 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap); 3257 if (Ops.size() == 2) return NewAddRec; 3258 Ops[Idx] = NewAddRec; 3259 Ops.erase(Ops.begin() + OtherIdx); --OtherIdx; 3260 OpsModified = true; 3261 AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(NewAddRec); 3262 if (!AddRec) 3263 break; 3264 } 3265 } 3266 if (OpsModified) 3267 return getMulExpr(Ops, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap, Depth + 1); 3268 3269 // Otherwise couldn't fold anything into this recurrence. Move onto the 3270 // next one. 3271 } 3272 3273 // Okay, it looks like we really DO need an mul expr. Check to see if we 3274 // already have one, otherwise create a new one. 3275 return getOrCreateMulExpr(Ops, ComputeFlags(Ops)); 3276 } 3277 3278 /// Represents an unsigned remainder expression based on unsigned division. 3279 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getURemExpr(const SCEV *LHS, 3280 const SCEV *RHS) { 3281 assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(LHS->getType()) == 3282 getEffectiveSCEVType(RHS->getType()) && 3283 "SCEVURemExpr operand types don't match!"); 3284 3285 // Short-circuit easy cases 3286 if (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) { 3287 // If constant is one, the result is trivial 3288 if (RHSC->getValue()->isOne()) 3289 return getZero(LHS->getType()); // X urem 1 --> 0 3290 3291 // If constant is a power of two, fold into a zext(trunc(LHS)). 3292 if (RHSC->getAPInt().isPowerOf2()) { 3293 Type *FullTy = LHS->getType(); 3294 Type *TruncTy = 3295 IntegerType::get(getContext(), RHSC->getAPInt().logBase2()); 3296 return getZeroExtendExpr(getTruncateExpr(LHS, TruncTy), FullTy); 3297 } 3298 } 3299 3300 // Fallback to %a == %x urem %y == %x -<nuw> ((%x udiv %y) *<nuw> %y) 3301 const SCEV *UDiv = getUDivExpr(LHS, RHS); 3302 const SCEV *Mult = getMulExpr(UDiv, RHS, SCEV::FlagNUW); 3303 return getMinusSCEV(LHS, Mult, SCEV::FlagNUW); 3304 } 3305 3306 /// Get a canonical unsigned division expression, or something simpler if 3307 /// possible. 3308 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUDivExpr(const SCEV *LHS, 3309 const SCEV *RHS) { 3310 assert(!LHS->getType()->isPointerTy() && 3311 "SCEVUDivExpr operand can't be pointer!"); 3312 assert(LHS->getType() == RHS->getType() && 3313 "SCEVUDivExpr operand types don't match!"); 3314 3315 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3316 ID.AddInteger(scUDivExpr); 3317 ID.AddPointer(LHS); 3318 ID.AddPointer(RHS); 3319 void *IP = nullptr; 3320 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) 3321 return S; 3322 3323 // 0 udiv Y == 0 3324 if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LHS)) 3325 if (LHSC->getValue()->isZero()) 3326 return LHS; 3327 3328 if (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) { 3329 if (RHSC->getValue()->isOne()) 3330 return LHS; // X udiv 1 --> x 3331 // If the denominator is zero, the result of the udiv is undefined. Don't 3332 // try to analyze it, because the resolution chosen here may differ from 3333 // the resolution chosen in other parts of the compiler. 3334 if (!RHSC->getValue()->isZero()) { 3335 // Determine if the division can be folded into the operands of 3336 // its operands. 3337 // TODO: Generalize this to non-constants by using known-bits information. 3338 Type *Ty = LHS->getType(); 3339 unsigned LZ = RHSC->getAPInt().countLeadingZeros(); 3340 unsigned MaxShiftAmt = getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) - LZ - 1; 3341 // For non-power-of-two values, effectively round the value up to the 3342 // nearest power of two. 3343 if (!RHSC->getAPInt().isPowerOf2()) 3344 ++MaxShiftAmt; 3345 IntegerType *ExtTy = 3346 IntegerType::get(getContext(), getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) + MaxShiftAmt); 3347 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS)) 3348 if (const SCEVConstant *Step = 3349 dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this))) { 3350 // {X,+,N}/C --> {X/C,+,N/C} if safe and N/C can be folded. 3351 const APInt &StepInt = Step->getAPInt(); 3352 const APInt &DivInt = RHSC->getAPInt(); 3353 if (!StepInt.urem(DivInt) && 3354 getZeroExtendExpr(AR, ExtTy) == 3355 getAddRecExpr(getZeroExtendExpr(AR->getStart(), ExtTy), 3356 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, ExtTy), 3357 AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagAnyWrap)) { 3358 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands; 3359 for (const SCEV *Op : AR->operands()) 3360 Operands.push_back(getUDivExpr(Op, RHS)); 3361 return getAddRecExpr(Operands, AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagNW); 3362 } 3363 /// Get a canonical UDivExpr for a recurrence. 3364 /// {X,+,N}/C => {Y,+,N}/C where Y=X-(X%N). Safe when C%N=0. 3365 // We can currently only fold X%N if X is constant. 3366 const SCEVConstant *StartC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AR->getStart()); 3367 if (StartC && !DivInt.urem(StepInt) && 3368 getZeroExtendExpr(AR, ExtTy) == 3369 getAddRecExpr(getZeroExtendExpr(AR->getStart(), ExtTy), 3370 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, ExtTy), 3371 AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagAnyWrap)) { 3372 const APInt &StartInt = StartC->getAPInt(); 3373 const APInt &StartRem = StartInt.urem(StepInt); 3374 if (StartRem != 0) { 3375 const SCEV *NewLHS = 3376 getAddRecExpr(getConstant(StartInt - StartRem), Step, 3377 AR->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagNW); 3378 if (LHS != NewLHS) { 3379 LHS = NewLHS; 3380 3381 // Reset the ID to include the new LHS, and check if it is 3382 // already cached. 3383 ID.clear(); 3384 ID.AddInteger(scUDivExpr); 3385 ID.AddPointer(LHS); 3386 ID.AddPointer(RHS); 3387 IP = nullptr; 3388 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) 3389 return S; 3390 } 3391 } 3392 } 3393 } 3394 // (A*B)/C --> A*(B/C) if safe and B/C can be folded. 3395 if (const SCEVMulExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(LHS)) { 3396 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands; 3397 for (const SCEV *Op : M->operands()) 3398 Operands.push_back(getZeroExtendExpr(Op, ExtTy)); 3399 if (getZeroExtendExpr(M, ExtTy) == getMulExpr(Operands)) 3400 // Find an operand that's safely divisible. 3401 for (unsigned i = 0, e = M->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) { 3402 const SCEV *Op = M->getOperand(i); 3403 const SCEV *Div = getUDivExpr(Op, RHSC); 3404 if (!isa<SCEVUDivExpr>(Div) && getMulExpr(Div, RHSC) == Op) { 3405 Operands = SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4>(M->operands()); 3406 Operands[i] = Div; 3407 return getMulExpr(Operands); 3408 } 3409 } 3410 } 3411 3412 // (A/B)/C --> A/(B*C) if safe and B*C can be folded. 3413 if (const SCEVUDivExpr *OtherDiv = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(LHS)) { 3414 if (auto *DivisorConstant = 3415 dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(OtherDiv->getRHS())) { 3416 bool Overflow = false; 3417 APInt NewRHS = 3418 DivisorConstant->getAPInt().umul_ov(RHSC->getAPInt(), Overflow); 3419 if (Overflow) { 3420 return getConstant(RHSC->getType(), 0, false); 3421 } 3422 return getUDivExpr(OtherDiv->getLHS(), getConstant(NewRHS)); 3423 } 3424 } 3425 3426 // (A+B)/C --> (A/C + B/C) if safe and A/C and B/C can be folded. 3427 if (const SCEVAddExpr *A = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(LHS)) { 3428 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands; 3429 for (const SCEV *Op : A->operands()) 3430 Operands.push_back(getZeroExtendExpr(Op, ExtTy)); 3431 if (getZeroExtendExpr(A, ExtTy) == getAddExpr(Operands)) { 3432 Operands.clear(); 3433 for (unsigned i = 0, e = A->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) { 3434 const SCEV *Op = getUDivExpr(A->getOperand(i), RHS); 3435 if (isa<SCEVUDivExpr>(Op) || 3436 getMulExpr(Op, RHS) != A->getOperand(i)) 3437 break; 3438 Operands.push_back(Op); 3439 } 3440 if (Operands.size() == A->getNumOperands()) 3441 return getAddExpr(Operands); 3442 } 3443 } 3444 3445 // Fold if both operands are constant. 3446 if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LHS)) { 3447 Constant *LHSCV = LHSC->getValue(); 3448 Constant *RHSCV = RHSC->getValue(); 3449 return getConstant(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getUDiv(LHSCV, 3450 RHSCV))); 3451 } 3452 } 3453 } 3454 3455 // The Insertion Point (IP) might be invalid by now (due to UniqueSCEVs 3456 // changes). Make sure we get a new one. 3457 IP = nullptr; 3458 if (const SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) return S; 3459 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVUDivExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), 3460 LHS, RHS); 3461 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 3462 registerUser(S, {LHS, RHS}); 3463 return S; 3464 } 3465 3466 static const APInt gcd(const SCEVConstant *C1, const SCEVConstant *C2) { 3467 APInt A = C1->getAPInt().abs(); 3468 APInt B = C2->getAPInt().abs(); 3469 uint32_t ABW = A.getBitWidth(); 3470 uint32_t BBW = B.getBitWidth(); 3471 3472 if (ABW > BBW) 3473 B = B.zext(ABW); 3474 else if (ABW < BBW) 3475 A = A.zext(BBW); 3476 3477 return APIntOps::GreatestCommonDivisor(std::move(A), std::move(B)); 3478 } 3479 3480 /// Get a canonical unsigned division expression, or something simpler if 3481 /// possible. There is no representation for an exact udiv in SCEV IR, but we 3482 /// can attempt to remove factors from the LHS and RHS. We can't do this when 3483 /// it's not exact because the udiv may be clearing bits. 3484 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUDivExactExpr(const SCEV *LHS, 3485 const SCEV *RHS) { 3486 // TODO: we could try to find factors in all sorts of things, but for now we 3487 // just deal with u/exact (multiply, constant). See SCEVDivision towards the 3488 // end of this file for inspiration. 3489 3490 const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(LHS); 3491 if (!Mul || !Mul->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) 3492 return getUDivExpr(LHS, RHS); 3493 3494 if (const SCEVConstant *RHSCst = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) { 3495 // If the mulexpr multiplies by a constant, then that constant must be the 3496 // first element of the mulexpr. 3497 if (const auto *LHSCst = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0))) { 3498 if (LHSCst == RHSCst) { 3499 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Operands(drop_begin(Mul->operands())); 3500 return getMulExpr(Operands); 3501 } 3502 3503 // We can't just assume that LHSCst divides RHSCst cleanly, it could be 3504 // that there's a factor provided by one of the other terms. We need to 3505 // check. 3506 APInt Factor = gcd(LHSCst, RHSCst); 3507 if (!Factor.isIntN(1)) { 3508 LHSCst = 3509 cast<SCEVConstant>(getConstant(LHSCst->getAPInt().udiv(Factor))); 3510 RHSCst = 3511 cast<SCEVConstant>(getConstant(RHSCst->getAPInt().udiv(Factor))); 3512 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Operands; 3513 Operands.push_back(LHSCst); 3514 Operands.append(Mul->op_begin() + 1, Mul->op_end()); 3515 LHS = getMulExpr(Operands); 3516 RHS = RHSCst; 3517 Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(LHS); 3518 if (!Mul) 3519 return getUDivExactExpr(LHS, RHS); 3520 } 3521 } 3522 } 3523 3524 for (int i = 0, e = Mul->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) { 3525 if (Mul->getOperand(i) == RHS) { 3526 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Operands; 3527 Operands.append(Mul->op_begin(), Mul->op_begin() + i); 3528 Operands.append(Mul->op_begin() + i + 1, Mul->op_end()); 3529 return getMulExpr(Operands); 3530 } 3531 } 3532 3533 return getUDivExpr(LHS, RHS); 3534 } 3535 3536 /// Get an add recurrence expression for the specified loop. Simplify the 3537 /// expression as much as possible. 3538 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getAddRecExpr(const SCEV *Start, const SCEV *Step, 3539 const Loop *L, 3540 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) { 3541 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands; 3542 Operands.push_back(Start); 3543 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *StepChrec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Step)) 3544 if (StepChrec->getLoop() == L) { 3545 Operands.append(StepChrec->op_begin(), StepChrec->op_end()); 3546 return getAddRecExpr(Operands, L, maskFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW)); 3547 } 3548 3549 Operands.push_back(Step); 3550 return getAddRecExpr(Operands, L, Flags); 3551 } 3552 3553 /// Get an add recurrence expression for the specified loop. Simplify the 3554 /// expression as much as possible. 3555 const SCEV * 3556 ScalarEvolution::getAddRecExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Operands, 3557 const Loop *L, SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) { 3558 if (Operands.size() == 1) return Operands[0]; 3559 #ifndef NDEBUG 3560 Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(Operands[0]->getType()); 3561 for (unsigned i = 1, e = Operands.size(); i != e; ++i) { 3562 assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(Operands[i]->getType()) == ETy && 3563 "SCEVAddRecExpr operand types don't match!"); 3564 assert(!Operands[i]->getType()->isPointerTy() && "Step must be integer"); 3565 } 3566 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Operands.size(); i != e; ++i) 3567 assert(isLoopInvariant(Operands[i], L) && 3568 "SCEVAddRecExpr operand is not loop-invariant!"); 3569 #endif 3570 3571 if (Operands.back()->isZero()) { 3572 Operands.pop_back(); 3573 return getAddRecExpr(Operands, L, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap); // {X,+,0} --> X 3574 } 3575 3576 // It's tempting to want to call getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount count here and 3577 // use that information to infer NUW and NSW flags. However, computing a 3578 // BE count requires calling getAddRecExpr, so we may not yet have a 3579 // meaningful BE count at this point (and if we don't, we'd be stuck 3580 // with a SCEVCouldNotCompute as the cached BE count). 3581 3582 Flags = StrengthenNoWrapFlags(this, scAddRecExpr, Operands, Flags); 3583 3584 // Canonicalize nested AddRecs in by nesting them in order of loop depth. 3585 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *NestedAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Operands[0])) { 3586 const Loop *NestedLoop = NestedAR->getLoop(); 3587 if (L->contains(NestedLoop) 3588 ? (L->getLoopDepth() < NestedLoop->getLoopDepth()) 3589 : (!NestedLoop->contains(L) && 3590 DT.dominates(L->getHeader(), NestedLoop->getHeader()))) { 3591 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> NestedOperands(NestedAR->operands()); 3592 Operands[0] = NestedAR->getStart(); 3593 // AddRecs require their operands be loop-invariant with respect to their 3594 // loops. Don't perform this transformation if it would break this 3595 // requirement. 3596 bool AllInvariant = all_of( 3597 Operands, [&](const SCEV *Op) { return isLoopInvariant(Op, L); }); 3598 3599 if (AllInvariant) { 3600 // Create a recurrence for the outer loop with the same step size. 3601 // 3602 // The outer recurrence keeps its NW flag but only keeps NUW/NSW if the 3603 // inner recurrence has the same property. 3604 SCEV::NoWrapFlags OuterFlags = 3605 maskFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW | NestedAR->getNoWrapFlags()); 3606 3607 NestedOperands[0] = getAddRecExpr(Operands, L, OuterFlags); 3608 AllInvariant = all_of(NestedOperands, [&](const SCEV *Op) { 3609 return isLoopInvariant(Op, NestedLoop); 3610 }); 3611 3612 if (AllInvariant) { 3613 // Ok, both add recurrences are valid after the transformation. 3614 // 3615 // The inner recurrence keeps its NW flag but only keeps NUW/NSW if 3616 // the outer recurrence has the same property. 3617 SCEV::NoWrapFlags InnerFlags = 3618 maskFlags(NestedAR->getNoWrapFlags(), SCEV::FlagNW | Flags); 3619 return getAddRecExpr(NestedOperands, NestedLoop, InnerFlags); 3620 } 3621 } 3622 // Reset Operands to its original state. 3623 Operands[0] = NestedAR; 3624 } 3625 } 3626 3627 // Okay, it looks like we really DO need an addrec expr. Check to see if we 3628 // already have one, otherwise create a new one. 3629 return getOrCreateAddRecExpr(Operands, L, Flags); 3630 } 3631 3632 const SCEV * 3633 ScalarEvolution::getGEPExpr(GEPOperator *GEP, 3634 const SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &IndexExprs) { 3635 const SCEV *BaseExpr = getSCEV(GEP->getPointerOperand()); 3636 // getSCEV(Base)->getType() has the same address space as Base->getType() 3637 // because SCEV::getType() preserves the address space. 3638 Type *IntIdxTy = getEffectiveSCEVType(BaseExpr->getType()); 3639 const bool AssumeInBoundsFlags = [&]() { 3640 if (!GEP->isInBounds()) 3641 return false; 3642 3643 // We'd like to propagate flags from the IR to the corresponding SCEV nodes, 3644 // but to do that, we have to ensure that said flag is valid in the entire 3645 // defined scope of the SCEV. 3646 auto *GEPI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP); 3647 // TODO: non-instructions have global scope. We might be able to prove 3648 // some global scope cases 3649 return GEPI && isSCEVExprNeverPoison(GEPI); 3650 }(); 3651 3652 SCEV::NoWrapFlags OffsetWrap = 3653 AssumeInBoundsFlags ? SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 3654 3655 Type *CurTy = GEP->getType(); 3656 bool FirstIter = true; 3657 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Offsets; 3658 for (const SCEV *IndexExpr : IndexExprs) { 3659 // Compute the (potentially symbolic) offset in bytes for this index. 3660 if (StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(CurTy)) { 3661 // For a struct, add the member offset. 3662 ConstantInt *Index = cast<SCEVConstant>(IndexExpr)->getValue(); 3663 unsigned FieldNo = Index->getZExtValue(); 3664 const SCEV *FieldOffset = getOffsetOfExpr(IntIdxTy, STy, FieldNo); 3665 Offsets.push_back(FieldOffset); 3666 3667 // Update CurTy to the type of the field at Index. 3668 CurTy = STy->getTypeAtIndex(Index); 3669 } else { 3670 // Update CurTy to its element type. 3671 if (FirstIter) { 3672 assert(isa<PointerType>(CurTy) && 3673 "The first index of a GEP indexes a pointer"); 3674 CurTy = GEP->getSourceElementType(); 3675 FirstIter = false; 3676 } else { 3677 CurTy = GetElementPtrInst::getTypeAtIndex(CurTy, (uint64_t)0); 3678 } 3679 // For an array, add the element offset, explicitly scaled. 3680 const SCEV *ElementSize = getSizeOfExpr(IntIdxTy, CurTy); 3681 // Getelementptr indices are signed. 3682 IndexExpr = getTruncateOrSignExtend(IndexExpr, IntIdxTy); 3683 3684 // Multiply the index by the element size to compute the element offset. 3685 const SCEV *LocalOffset = getMulExpr(IndexExpr, ElementSize, OffsetWrap); 3686 Offsets.push_back(LocalOffset); 3687 } 3688 } 3689 3690 // Handle degenerate case of GEP without offsets. 3691 if (Offsets.empty()) 3692 return BaseExpr; 3693 3694 // Add the offsets together, assuming nsw if inbounds. 3695 const SCEV *Offset = getAddExpr(Offsets, OffsetWrap); 3696 // Add the base address and the offset. We cannot use the nsw flag, as the 3697 // base address is unsigned. However, if we know that the offset is 3698 // non-negative, we can use nuw. 3699 SCEV::NoWrapFlags BaseWrap = AssumeInBoundsFlags && isKnownNonNegative(Offset) 3700 ? SCEV::FlagNUW : SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 3701 auto *GEPExpr = getAddExpr(BaseExpr, Offset, BaseWrap); 3702 assert(BaseExpr->getType() == GEPExpr->getType() && 3703 "GEP should not change type mid-flight."); 3704 return GEPExpr; 3705 } 3706 3707 SCEV *ScalarEvolution::findExistingSCEVInCache(SCEVTypes SCEVType, 3708 ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops) { 3709 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3710 ID.AddInteger(SCEVType); 3711 for (const SCEV *Op : Ops) 3712 ID.AddPointer(Op); 3713 void *IP = nullptr; 3714 return UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP); 3715 } 3716 3717 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getAbsExpr(const SCEV *Op, bool IsNSW) { 3718 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = IsNSW ? SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 3719 return getSMaxExpr(Op, getNegativeSCEV(Op, Flags)); 3720 } 3721 3722 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getMinMaxExpr(SCEVTypes Kind, 3723 SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) { 3724 assert(!Ops.empty() && "Cannot get empty (u|s)(min|max)!"); 3725 if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0]; 3726 #ifndef NDEBUG 3727 Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[0]->getType()); 3728 for (unsigned i = 1, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i) { 3729 assert(getEffectiveSCEVType(Ops[i]->getType()) == ETy && 3730 "Operand types don't match!"); 3731 assert(Ops[0]->getType()->isPointerTy() == 3732 Ops[i]->getType()->isPointerTy() && 3733 "min/max should be consistently pointerish"); 3734 } 3735 #endif 3736 3737 bool IsSigned = Kind == scSMaxExpr || Kind == scSMinExpr; 3738 bool IsMax = Kind == scSMaxExpr || Kind == scUMaxExpr; 3739 3740 // Sort by complexity, this groups all similar expression types together. 3741 GroupByComplexity(Ops, &LI, DT); 3742 3743 // Check if we have created the same expression before. 3744 if (const SCEV *S = findExistingSCEVInCache(Kind, Ops)) { 3745 return S; 3746 } 3747 3748 // If there are any constants, fold them together. 3749 unsigned Idx = 0; 3750 if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0])) { 3751 ++Idx; 3752 assert(Idx < Ops.size()); 3753 auto FoldOp = [&](const APInt &LHS, const APInt &RHS) { 3754 if (Kind == scSMaxExpr) 3755 return APIntOps::smax(LHS, RHS); 3756 else if (Kind == scSMinExpr) 3757 return APIntOps::smin(LHS, RHS); 3758 else if (Kind == scUMaxExpr) 3759 return APIntOps::umax(LHS, RHS); 3760 else if (Kind == scUMinExpr) 3761 return APIntOps::umin(LHS, RHS); 3762 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV min/max opcode"); 3763 }; 3764 3765 while (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[Idx])) { 3766 // We found two constants, fold them together! 3767 ConstantInt *Fold = ConstantInt::get( 3768 getContext(), FoldOp(LHSC->getAPInt(), RHSC->getAPInt())); 3769 Ops[0] = getConstant(Fold); 3770 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+1); // Erase the folded element 3771 if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0]; 3772 LHSC = cast<SCEVConstant>(Ops[0]); 3773 } 3774 3775 bool IsMinV = LHSC->getValue()->isMinValue(IsSigned); 3776 bool IsMaxV = LHSC->getValue()->isMaxValue(IsSigned); 3777 3778 if (IsMax ? IsMinV : IsMaxV) { 3779 // If we are left with a constant minimum(/maximum)-int, strip it off. 3780 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()); 3781 --Idx; 3782 } else if (IsMax ? IsMaxV : IsMinV) { 3783 // If we have a max(/min) with a constant maximum(/minimum)-int, 3784 // it will always be the extremum. 3785 return LHSC; 3786 } 3787 3788 if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0]; 3789 } 3790 3791 // Find the first operation of the same kind 3792 while (Idx < Ops.size() && Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() < Kind) 3793 ++Idx; 3794 3795 // Check to see if one of the operands is of the same kind. If so, expand its 3796 // operands onto our operand list, and recurse to simplify. 3797 if (Idx < Ops.size()) { 3798 bool DeletedAny = false; 3799 while (Ops[Idx]->getSCEVType() == Kind) { 3800 const SCEVMinMaxExpr *SMME = cast<SCEVMinMaxExpr>(Ops[Idx]); 3801 Ops.erase(Ops.begin()+Idx); 3802 Ops.append(SMME->op_begin(), SMME->op_end()); 3803 DeletedAny = true; 3804 } 3805 3806 if (DeletedAny) 3807 return getMinMaxExpr(Kind, Ops); 3808 } 3809 3810 // Okay, check to see if the same value occurs in the operand list twice. If 3811 // so, delete one. Since we sorted the list, these values are required to 3812 // be adjacent. 3813 llvm::CmpInst::Predicate GEPred = 3814 IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE; 3815 llvm::CmpInst::Predicate LEPred = 3816 IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE; 3817 llvm::CmpInst::Predicate FirstPred = IsMax ? GEPred : LEPred; 3818 llvm::CmpInst::Predicate SecondPred = IsMax ? LEPred : GEPred; 3819 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size() - 1; i != e; ++i) { 3820 if (Ops[i] == Ops[i + 1] || 3821 isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(FirstPred, Ops[i], Ops[i + 1])) { 3822 // X op Y op Y --> X op Y 3823 // X op Y --> X, if we know X, Y are ordered appropriately 3824 Ops.erase(Ops.begin() + i + 1, Ops.begin() + i + 2); 3825 --i; 3826 --e; 3827 } else if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(SecondPred, Ops[i], 3828 Ops[i + 1])) { 3829 // X op Y --> Y, if we know X, Y are ordered appropriately 3830 Ops.erase(Ops.begin() + i, Ops.begin() + i + 1); 3831 --i; 3832 --e; 3833 } 3834 } 3835 3836 if (Ops.size() == 1) return Ops[0]; 3837 3838 assert(!Ops.empty() && "Reduced smax down to nothing!"); 3839 3840 // Okay, it looks like we really DO need an expr. Check to see if we 3841 // already have one, otherwise create a new one. 3842 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3843 ID.AddInteger(Kind); 3844 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ops.size(); i != e; ++i) 3845 ID.AddPointer(Ops[i]); 3846 void *IP = nullptr; 3847 const SCEV *ExistingSCEV = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP); 3848 if (ExistingSCEV) 3849 return ExistingSCEV; 3850 const SCEV **O = SCEVAllocator.Allocate<const SCEV *>(Ops.size()); 3851 std::uninitialized_copy(Ops.begin(), Ops.end(), O); 3852 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) 3853 SCEVMinMaxExpr(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), Kind, O, Ops.size()); 3854 3855 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 3856 registerUser(S, Ops); 3857 return S; 3858 } 3859 3860 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSMaxExpr(const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 3861 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = {LHS, RHS}; 3862 return getSMaxExpr(Ops); 3863 } 3864 3865 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSMaxExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) { 3866 return getMinMaxExpr(scSMaxExpr, Ops); 3867 } 3868 3869 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMaxExpr(const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 3870 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = {LHS, RHS}; 3871 return getUMaxExpr(Ops); 3872 } 3873 3874 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMaxExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) { 3875 return getMinMaxExpr(scUMaxExpr, Ops); 3876 } 3877 3878 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSMinExpr(const SCEV *LHS, 3879 const SCEV *RHS) { 3880 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = { LHS, RHS }; 3881 return getSMinExpr(Ops); 3882 } 3883 3884 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSMinExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) { 3885 return getMinMaxExpr(scSMinExpr, Ops); 3886 } 3887 3888 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMinExpr(const SCEV *LHS, 3889 const SCEV *RHS) { 3890 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = { LHS, RHS }; 3891 return getUMinExpr(Ops); 3892 } 3893 3894 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMinExpr(SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) { 3895 return getMinMaxExpr(scUMinExpr, Ops); 3896 } 3897 3898 const SCEV * 3899 ScalarEvolution::getSizeOfScalableVectorExpr(Type *IntTy, 3900 ScalableVectorType *ScalableTy) { 3901 Constant *NullPtr = Constant::getNullValue(ScalableTy->getPointerTo()); 3902 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(IntTy, 1); 3903 Constant *GEP = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(ScalableTy, NullPtr, One); 3904 // Note that the expression we created is the final expression, we don't 3905 // want to simplify it any further Also, if we call a normal getSCEV(), 3906 // we'll end up in an endless recursion. So just create an SCEVUnknown. 3907 return getUnknown(ConstantExpr::getPtrToInt(GEP, IntTy)); 3908 } 3909 3910 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSizeOfExpr(Type *IntTy, Type *AllocTy) { 3911 if (auto *ScalableAllocTy = dyn_cast<ScalableVectorType>(AllocTy)) 3912 return getSizeOfScalableVectorExpr(IntTy, ScalableAllocTy); 3913 // We can bypass creating a target-independent constant expression and then 3914 // folding it back into a ConstantInt. This is just a compile-time 3915 // optimization. 3916 return getConstant(IntTy, getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AllocTy)); 3917 } 3918 3919 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getStoreSizeOfExpr(Type *IntTy, Type *StoreTy) { 3920 if (auto *ScalableStoreTy = dyn_cast<ScalableVectorType>(StoreTy)) 3921 return getSizeOfScalableVectorExpr(IntTy, ScalableStoreTy); 3922 // We can bypass creating a target-independent constant expression and then 3923 // folding it back into a ConstantInt. This is just a compile-time 3924 // optimization. 3925 return getConstant(IntTy, getDataLayout().getTypeStoreSize(StoreTy)); 3926 } 3927 3928 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getOffsetOfExpr(Type *IntTy, 3929 StructType *STy, 3930 unsigned FieldNo) { 3931 // We can bypass creating a target-independent constant expression and then 3932 // folding it back into a ConstantInt. This is just a compile-time 3933 // optimization. 3934 return getConstant( 3935 IntTy, getDataLayout().getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(FieldNo)); 3936 } 3937 3938 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUnknown(Value *V) { 3939 // Don't attempt to do anything other than create a SCEVUnknown object 3940 // here. createSCEV only calls getUnknown after checking for all other 3941 // interesting possibilities, and any other code that calls getUnknown 3942 // is doing so in order to hide a value from SCEV canonicalization. 3943 3944 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 3945 ID.AddInteger(scUnknown); 3946 ID.AddPointer(V); 3947 void *IP = nullptr; 3948 if (SCEV *S = UniqueSCEVs.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) { 3949 assert(cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)->getValue() == V && 3950 "Stale SCEVUnknown in uniquing map!"); 3951 return S; 3952 } 3953 SCEV *S = new (SCEVAllocator) SCEVUnknown(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), V, this, 3954 FirstUnknown); 3955 FirstUnknown = cast<SCEVUnknown>(S); 3956 UniqueSCEVs.InsertNode(S, IP); 3957 return S; 3958 } 3959 3960 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 3961 // Basic SCEV Analysis and PHI Idiom Recognition Code 3962 // 3963 3964 /// Test if values of the given type are analyzable within the SCEV 3965 /// framework. This primarily includes integer types, and it can optionally 3966 /// include pointer types if the ScalarEvolution class has access to 3967 /// target-specific information. 3968 bool ScalarEvolution::isSCEVable(Type *Ty) const { 3969 // Integers and pointers are always SCEVable. 3970 return Ty->isIntOrPtrTy(); 3971 } 3972 3973 /// Return the size in bits of the specified type, for which isSCEVable must 3974 /// return true. 3975 uint64_t ScalarEvolution::getTypeSizeInBits(Type *Ty) const { 3976 assert(isSCEVable(Ty) && "Type is not SCEVable!"); 3977 if (Ty->isPointerTy()) 3978 return getDataLayout().getIndexTypeSizeInBits(Ty); 3979 return getDataLayout().getTypeSizeInBits(Ty); 3980 } 3981 3982 /// Return a type with the same bitwidth as the given type and which represents 3983 /// how SCEV will treat the given type, for which isSCEVable must return 3984 /// true. For pointer types, this is the pointer index sized integer type. 3985 Type *ScalarEvolution::getEffectiveSCEVType(Type *Ty) const { 3986 assert(isSCEVable(Ty) && "Type is not SCEVable!"); 3987 3988 if (Ty->isIntegerTy()) 3989 return Ty; 3990 3991 // The only other support type is pointer. 3992 assert(Ty->isPointerTy() && "Unexpected non-pointer non-integer type!"); 3993 return getDataLayout().getIndexType(Ty); 3994 } 3995 3996 Type *ScalarEvolution::getWiderType(Type *T1, Type *T2) const { 3997 return getTypeSizeInBits(T1) >= getTypeSizeInBits(T2) ? T1 : T2; 3998 } 3999 4000 bool ScalarEvolution::instructionCouldExistWitthOperands(const SCEV *A, 4001 const SCEV *B) { 4002 /// For a valid use point to exist, the defining scope of one operand 4003 /// must dominate the other. 4004 bool PreciseA, PreciseB; 4005 auto *ScopeA = getDefiningScopeBound({A}, PreciseA); 4006 auto *ScopeB = getDefiningScopeBound({B}, PreciseB); 4007 if (!PreciseA || !PreciseB) 4008 // Can't tell. 4009 return false; 4010 return (ScopeA == ScopeB) || DT.dominates(ScopeA, ScopeB) || 4011 DT.dominates(ScopeB, ScopeA); 4012 } 4013 4014 4015 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getCouldNotCompute() { 4016 return CouldNotCompute.get(); 4017 } 4018 4019 bool ScalarEvolution::checkValidity(const SCEV *S) const { 4020 bool ContainsNulls = SCEVExprContains(S, [](const SCEV *S) { 4021 auto *SU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S); 4022 return SU && SU->getValue() == nullptr; 4023 }); 4024 4025 return !ContainsNulls; 4026 } 4027 4028 bool ScalarEvolution::containsAddRecurrence(const SCEV *S) { 4029 HasRecMapType::iterator I = HasRecMap.find(S); 4030 if (I != HasRecMap.end()) 4031 return I->second; 4032 4033 bool FoundAddRec = 4034 SCEVExprContains(S, [](const SCEV *S) { return isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S); }); 4035 HasRecMap.insert({S, FoundAddRec}); 4036 return FoundAddRec; 4037 } 4038 4039 /// Try to split a SCEVAddExpr into a pair of {SCEV, ConstantInt}. 4040 /// If \p S is a SCEVAddExpr and is composed of a sub SCEV S' and an 4041 /// offset I, then return {S', I}, else return {\p S, nullptr}. 4042 static std::pair<const SCEV *, ConstantInt *> splitAddExpr(const SCEV *S) { 4043 const auto *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(S); 4044 if (!Add) 4045 return {S, nullptr}; 4046 4047 if (Add->getNumOperands() != 2) 4048 return {S, nullptr}; 4049 4050 auto *ConstOp = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Add->getOperand(0)); 4051 if (!ConstOp) 4052 return {S, nullptr}; 4053 4054 return {Add->getOperand(1), ConstOp->getValue()}; 4055 } 4056 4057 /// Return the ValueOffsetPair set for \p S. \p S can be represented 4058 /// by the value and offset from any ValueOffsetPair in the set. 4059 ScalarEvolution::ValueOffsetPairSetVector * 4060 ScalarEvolution::getSCEVValues(const SCEV *S) { 4061 ExprValueMapType::iterator SI = ExprValueMap.find_as(S); 4062 if (SI == ExprValueMap.end()) 4063 return nullptr; 4064 #ifndef NDEBUG 4065 if (VerifySCEVMap) { 4066 // Check there is no dangling Value in the set returned. 4067 for (const auto &VE : SI->second) 4068 assert(ValueExprMap.count(VE.first)); 4069 } 4070 #endif 4071 return &SI->second; 4072 } 4073 4074 /// Erase Value from ValueExprMap and ExprValueMap. ValueExprMap.erase(V) 4075 /// cannot be used separately. eraseValueFromMap should be used to remove 4076 /// V from ValueExprMap and ExprValueMap at the same time. 4077 void ScalarEvolution::eraseValueFromMap(Value *V) { 4078 ValueExprMapType::iterator I = ValueExprMap.find_as(V); 4079 if (I != ValueExprMap.end()) { 4080 const SCEV *S = I->second; 4081 // Remove {V, 0} from the set of ExprValueMap[S] 4082 if (auto *SV = getSCEVValues(S)) 4083 SV->remove({V, nullptr}); 4084 4085 // Remove {V, Offset} from the set of ExprValueMap[Stripped] 4086 const SCEV *Stripped; 4087 ConstantInt *Offset; 4088 std::tie(Stripped, Offset) = splitAddExpr(S); 4089 if (Offset != nullptr) { 4090 if (auto *SV = getSCEVValues(Stripped)) 4091 SV->remove({V, Offset}); 4092 } 4093 ValueExprMap.erase(V); 4094 } 4095 } 4096 4097 /// Return an existing SCEV if it exists, otherwise analyze the expression and 4098 /// create a new one. 4099 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSCEV(Value *V) { 4100 assert(isSCEVable(V->getType()) && "Value is not SCEVable!"); 4101 4102 const SCEV *S = getExistingSCEV(V); 4103 if (S == nullptr) { 4104 S = createSCEV(V); 4105 // During PHI resolution, it is possible to create two SCEVs for the same 4106 // V, so it is needed to double check whether V->S is inserted into 4107 // ValueExprMap before insert S->{V, 0} into ExprValueMap. 4108 std::pair<ValueExprMapType::iterator, bool> Pair = 4109 ValueExprMap.insert({SCEVCallbackVH(V, this), S}); 4110 if (Pair.second) { 4111 ExprValueMap[S].insert({V, nullptr}); 4112 4113 // If S == Stripped + Offset, add Stripped -> {V, Offset} into 4114 // ExprValueMap. 4115 const SCEV *Stripped = S; 4116 ConstantInt *Offset = nullptr; 4117 std::tie(Stripped, Offset) = splitAddExpr(S); 4118 // If stripped is SCEVUnknown, don't bother to save 4119 // Stripped -> {V, offset}. It doesn't simplify and sometimes even 4120 // increase the complexity of the expansion code. 4121 // If V is GetElementPtrInst, don't save Stripped -> {V, offset} 4122 // because it may generate add/sub instead of GEP in SCEV expansion. 4123 if (Offset != nullptr && !isa<SCEVUnknown>(Stripped) && 4124 !isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) 4125 ExprValueMap[Stripped].insert({V, Offset}); 4126 } 4127 } 4128 return S; 4129 } 4130 4131 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getExistingSCEV(Value *V) { 4132 assert(isSCEVable(V->getType()) && "Value is not SCEVable!"); 4133 4134 ValueExprMapType::iterator I = ValueExprMap.find_as(V); 4135 if (I != ValueExprMap.end()) { 4136 const SCEV *S = I->second; 4137 if (checkValidity(S)) 4138 return S; 4139 eraseValueFromMap(V); 4140 forgetMemoizedResults(S); 4141 } 4142 return nullptr; 4143 } 4144 4145 /// Return a SCEV corresponding to -V = -1*V 4146 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getNegativeSCEV(const SCEV *V, 4147 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) { 4148 if (const SCEVConstant *VC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(V)) 4149 return getConstant( 4150 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(VC->getValue()))); 4151 4152 Type *Ty = V->getType(); 4153 Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty); 4154 return getMulExpr(V, getMinusOne(Ty), Flags); 4155 } 4156 4157 /// If Expr computes ~A, return A else return nullptr 4158 static const SCEV *MatchNotExpr(const SCEV *Expr) { 4159 const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Expr); 4160 if (!Add || Add->getNumOperands() != 2 || 4161 !Add->getOperand(0)->isAllOnesValue()) 4162 return nullptr; 4163 4164 const SCEVMulExpr *AddRHS = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Add->getOperand(1)); 4165 if (!AddRHS || AddRHS->getNumOperands() != 2 || 4166 !AddRHS->getOperand(0)->isAllOnesValue()) 4167 return nullptr; 4168 4169 return AddRHS->getOperand(1); 4170 } 4171 4172 /// Return a SCEV corresponding to ~V = -1-V 4173 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getNotSCEV(const SCEV *V) { 4174 assert(!V->getType()->isPointerTy() && "Can't negate pointer"); 4175 4176 if (const SCEVConstant *VC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(V)) 4177 return getConstant( 4178 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNot(VC->getValue()))); 4179 4180 // Fold ~(u|s)(min|max)(~x, ~y) to (u|s)(max|min)(x, y) 4181 if (const SCEVMinMaxExpr *MME = dyn_cast<SCEVMinMaxExpr>(V)) { 4182 auto MatchMinMaxNegation = [&](const SCEVMinMaxExpr *MME) { 4183 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> MatchedOperands; 4184 for (const SCEV *Operand : MME->operands()) { 4185 const SCEV *Matched = MatchNotExpr(Operand); 4186 if (!Matched) 4187 return (const SCEV *)nullptr; 4188 MatchedOperands.push_back(Matched); 4189 } 4190 return getMinMaxExpr(SCEVMinMaxExpr::negate(MME->getSCEVType()), 4191 MatchedOperands); 4192 }; 4193 if (const SCEV *Replaced = MatchMinMaxNegation(MME)) 4194 return Replaced; 4195 } 4196 4197 Type *Ty = V->getType(); 4198 Ty = getEffectiveSCEVType(Ty); 4199 return getMinusSCEV(getMinusOne(Ty), V); 4200 } 4201 4202 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::removePointerBase(const SCEV *P) { 4203 assert(P->getType()->isPointerTy()); 4204 4205 if (auto *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(P)) { 4206 // The base of an AddRec is the first operand. 4207 SmallVector<const SCEV *> Ops{AddRec->operands()}; 4208 Ops[0] = removePointerBase(Ops[0]); 4209 // Don't try to transfer nowrap flags for now. We could in some cases 4210 // (for example, if pointer operand of the AddRec is a SCEVUnknown). 4211 return getAddRecExpr(Ops, AddRec->getLoop(), SCEV::FlagAnyWrap); 4212 } 4213 if (auto *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(P)) { 4214 // The base of an Add is the pointer operand. 4215 SmallVector<const SCEV *> Ops{Add->operands()}; 4216 const SCEV **PtrOp = nullptr; 4217 for (const SCEV *&AddOp : Ops) { 4218 if (AddOp->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 4219 assert(!PtrOp && "Cannot have multiple pointer ops"); 4220 PtrOp = &AddOp; 4221 } 4222 } 4223 *PtrOp = removePointerBase(*PtrOp); 4224 // Don't try to transfer nowrap flags for now. We could in some cases 4225 // (for example, if the pointer operand of the Add is a SCEVUnknown). 4226 return getAddExpr(Ops); 4227 } 4228 // Any other expression must be a pointer base. 4229 return getZero(P->getType()); 4230 } 4231 4232 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getMinusSCEV(const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 4233 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags, 4234 unsigned Depth) { 4235 // Fast path: X - X --> 0. 4236 if (LHS == RHS) 4237 return getZero(LHS->getType()); 4238 4239 // If we subtract two pointers with different pointer bases, bail. 4240 // Eventually, we're going to add an assertion to getMulExpr that we 4241 // can't multiply by a pointer. 4242 if (RHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 4243 if (!LHS->getType()->isPointerTy() || 4244 getPointerBase(LHS) != getPointerBase(RHS)) 4245 return getCouldNotCompute(); 4246 LHS = removePointerBase(LHS); 4247 RHS = removePointerBase(RHS); 4248 } 4249 4250 // We represent LHS - RHS as LHS + (-1)*RHS. This transformation 4251 // makes it so that we cannot make much use of NUW. 4252 auto AddFlags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 4253 const bool RHSIsNotMinSigned = 4254 !getSignedRangeMin(RHS).isMinSignedValue(); 4255 if (hasFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW)) { 4256 // Let M be the minimum representable signed value. Then (-1)*RHS 4257 // signed-wraps if and only if RHS is M. That can happen even for 4258 // a NSW subtraction because e.g. (-1)*M signed-wraps even though 4259 // -1 - M does not. So to transfer NSW from LHS - RHS to LHS + 4260 // (-1)*RHS, we need to prove that RHS != M. 4261 // 4262 // If LHS is non-negative and we know that LHS - RHS does not 4263 // signed-wrap, then RHS cannot be M. So we can rule out signed-wrap 4264 // either by proving that RHS > M or that LHS >= 0. 4265 if (RHSIsNotMinSigned || isKnownNonNegative(LHS)) { 4266 AddFlags = SCEV::FlagNSW; 4267 } 4268 } 4269 4270 // FIXME: Find a correct way to transfer NSW to (-1)*M when LHS - 4271 // RHS is NSW and LHS >= 0. 4272 // 4273 // The difficulty here is that the NSW flag may have been proven 4274 // relative to a loop that is to be found in a recurrence in LHS and 4275 // not in RHS. Applying NSW to (-1)*M may then let the NSW have a 4276 // larger scope than intended. 4277 auto NegFlags = RHSIsNotMinSigned ? SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 4278 4279 return getAddExpr(LHS, getNegativeSCEV(RHS, NegFlags), AddFlags, Depth); 4280 } 4281 4282 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getTruncateOrZeroExtend(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty, 4283 unsigned Depth) { 4284 Type *SrcTy = V->getType(); 4285 assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() && 4286 "Cannot truncate or zero extend with non-integer arguments!"); 4287 if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 4288 return V; // No conversion 4289 if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) > getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 4290 return getTruncateExpr(V, Ty, Depth); 4291 return getZeroExtendExpr(V, Ty, Depth); 4292 } 4293 4294 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getTruncateOrSignExtend(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty, 4295 unsigned Depth) { 4296 Type *SrcTy = V->getType(); 4297 assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() && 4298 "Cannot truncate or zero extend with non-integer arguments!"); 4299 if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 4300 return V; // No conversion 4301 if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) > getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 4302 return getTruncateExpr(V, Ty, Depth); 4303 return getSignExtendExpr(V, Ty, Depth); 4304 } 4305 4306 const SCEV * 4307 ScalarEvolution::getNoopOrZeroExtend(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty) { 4308 Type *SrcTy = V->getType(); 4309 assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() && 4310 "Cannot noop or zero extend with non-integer arguments!"); 4311 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) <= getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) && 4312 "getNoopOrZeroExtend cannot truncate!"); 4313 if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 4314 return V; // No conversion 4315 return getZeroExtendExpr(V, Ty); 4316 } 4317 4318 const SCEV * 4319 ScalarEvolution::getNoopOrSignExtend(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty) { 4320 Type *SrcTy = V->getType(); 4321 assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() && 4322 "Cannot noop or sign extend with non-integer arguments!"); 4323 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) <= getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) && 4324 "getNoopOrSignExtend cannot truncate!"); 4325 if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 4326 return V; // No conversion 4327 return getSignExtendExpr(V, Ty); 4328 } 4329 4330 const SCEV * 4331 ScalarEvolution::getNoopOrAnyExtend(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty) { 4332 Type *SrcTy = V->getType(); 4333 assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() && 4334 "Cannot noop or any extend with non-integer arguments!"); 4335 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) <= getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) && 4336 "getNoopOrAnyExtend cannot truncate!"); 4337 if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 4338 return V; // No conversion 4339 return getAnyExtendExpr(V, Ty); 4340 } 4341 4342 const SCEV * 4343 ScalarEvolution::getTruncateOrNoop(const SCEV *V, Type *Ty) { 4344 Type *SrcTy = V->getType(); 4345 assert(SrcTy->isIntOrPtrTy() && Ty->isIntOrPtrTy() && 4346 "Cannot truncate or noop with non-integer arguments!"); 4347 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) >= getTypeSizeInBits(Ty) && 4348 "getTruncateOrNoop cannot extend!"); 4349 if (getTypeSizeInBits(SrcTy) == getTypeSizeInBits(Ty)) 4350 return V; // No conversion 4351 return getTruncateExpr(V, Ty); 4352 } 4353 4354 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMaxFromMismatchedTypes(const SCEV *LHS, 4355 const SCEV *RHS) { 4356 const SCEV *PromotedLHS = LHS; 4357 const SCEV *PromotedRHS = RHS; 4358 4359 if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) > getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType())) 4360 PromotedRHS = getZeroExtendExpr(RHS, LHS->getType()); 4361 else 4362 PromotedLHS = getNoopOrZeroExtend(LHS, RHS->getType()); 4363 4364 return getUMaxExpr(PromotedLHS, PromotedRHS); 4365 } 4366 4367 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(const SCEV *LHS, 4368 const SCEV *RHS) { 4369 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops = { LHS, RHS }; 4370 return getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(Ops); 4371 } 4372 4373 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUMinFromMismatchedTypes( 4374 SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) { 4375 assert(!Ops.empty() && "At least one operand must be!"); 4376 // Trivial case. 4377 if (Ops.size() == 1) 4378 return Ops[0]; 4379 4380 // Find the max type first. 4381 Type *MaxType = nullptr; 4382 for (auto *S : Ops) 4383 if (MaxType) 4384 MaxType = getWiderType(MaxType, S->getType()); 4385 else 4386 MaxType = S->getType(); 4387 assert(MaxType && "Failed to find maximum type!"); 4388 4389 // Extend all ops to max type. 4390 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> PromotedOps; 4391 for (auto *S : Ops) 4392 PromotedOps.push_back(getNoopOrZeroExtend(S, MaxType)); 4393 4394 // Generate umin. 4395 return getUMinExpr(PromotedOps); 4396 } 4397 4398 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getPointerBase(const SCEV *V) { 4399 // A pointer operand may evaluate to a nonpointer expression, such as null. 4400 if (!V->getType()->isPointerTy()) 4401 return V; 4402 4403 while (true) { 4404 if (auto *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(V)) { 4405 V = AddRec->getStart(); 4406 } else if (auto *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(V)) { 4407 const SCEV *PtrOp = nullptr; 4408 for (const SCEV *AddOp : Add->operands()) { 4409 if (AddOp->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 4410 assert(!PtrOp && "Cannot have multiple pointer ops"); 4411 PtrOp = AddOp; 4412 } 4413 } 4414 assert(PtrOp && "Must have pointer op"); 4415 V = PtrOp; 4416 } else // Not something we can look further into. 4417 return V; 4418 } 4419 } 4420 4421 /// Push users of the given Instruction onto the given Worklist. 4422 static void PushDefUseChildren(Instruction *I, 4423 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Worklist, 4424 SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &Visited) { 4425 // Push the def-use children onto the Worklist stack. 4426 for (User *U : I->users()) { 4427 auto *UserInsn = cast<Instruction>(U); 4428 if (Visited.insert(UserInsn).second) 4429 Worklist.push_back(UserInsn); 4430 } 4431 } 4432 4433 void ScalarEvolution::forgetSymbolicName(Instruction *PN, const SCEV *SymName) { 4434 SmallVector<Instruction *, 16> Worklist; 4435 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 8> Visited; 4436 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> ToForget; 4437 Visited.insert(PN); 4438 Worklist.push_back(PN); 4439 while (!Worklist.empty()) { 4440 Instruction *I = Worklist.pop_back_val(); 4441 4442 auto It = ValueExprMap.find_as(static_cast<Value *>(I)); 4443 if (It != ValueExprMap.end()) { 4444 const SCEV *Old = It->second; 4445 4446 // Short-circuit the def-use traversal if the symbolic name 4447 // ceases to appear in expressions. 4448 if (Old != SymName && !hasOperand(Old, SymName)) 4449 continue; 4450 4451 // SCEVUnknown for a PHI either means that it has an unrecognized 4452 // structure, it's a PHI that's in the progress of being computed 4453 // by createNodeForPHI, or it's a single-value PHI. In the first case, 4454 // additional loop trip count information isn't going to change anything. 4455 // In the second case, createNodeForPHI will perform the necessary 4456 // updates on its own when it gets to that point. In the third, we do 4457 // want to forget the SCEVUnknown. 4458 if (!isa<PHINode>(I) || 4459 !isa<SCEVUnknown>(Old) || 4460 (I != PN && Old == SymName)) { 4461 eraseValueFromMap(It->first); 4462 ToForget.push_back(Old); 4463 } 4464 } 4465 4466 PushDefUseChildren(I, Worklist, Visited); 4467 } 4468 forgetMemoizedResults(ToForget); 4469 } 4470 4471 namespace { 4472 4473 /// Takes SCEV S and Loop L. For each AddRec sub-expression, use its start 4474 /// expression in case its Loop is L. If it is not L then 4475 /// if IgnoreOtherLoops is true then use AddRec itself 4476 /// otherwise rewrite cannot be done. 4477 /// If SCEV contains non-invariant unknown SCEV rewrite cannot be done. 4478 class SCEVInitRewriter : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVInitRewriter> { 4479 public: 4480 static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE, 4481 bool IgnoreOtherLoops = true) { 4482 SCEVInitRewriter Rewriter(L, SE); 4483 const SCEV *Result = Rewriter.visit(S); 4484 if (Rewriter.hasSeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown()) 4485 return SE.getCouldNotCompute(); 4486 return Rewriter.hasSeenOtherLoops() && !IgnoreOtherLoops 4487 ? SE.getCouldNotCompute() 4488 : Result; 4489 } 4490 4491 const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) { 4492 if (!SE.isLoopInvariant(Expr, L)) 4493 SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown = true; 4494 return Expr; 4495 } 4496 4497 const SCEV *visitAddRecExpr(const SCEVAddRecExpr *Expr) { 4498 // Only re-write AddRecExprs for this loop. 4499 if (Expr->getLoop() == L) 4500 return Expr->getStart(); 4501 SeenOtherLoops = true; 4502 return Expr; 4503 } 4504 4505 bool hasSeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown() { return SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown; } 4506 4507 bool hasSeenOtherLoops() { return SeenOtherLoops; } 4508 4509 private: 4510 explicit SCEVInitRewriter(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE) 4511 : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), L(L) {} 4512 4513 const Loop *L; 4514 bool SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown = false; 4515 bool SeenOtherLoops = false; 4516 }; 4517 4518 /// Takes SCEV S and Loop L. For each AddRec sub-expression, use its post 4519 /// increment expression in case its Loop is L. If it is not L then 4520 /// use AddRec itself. 4521 /// If SCEV contains non-invariant unknown SCEV rewrite cannot be done. 4522 class SCEVPostIncRewriter : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVPostIncRewriter> { 4523 public: 4524 static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE) { 4525 SCEVPostIncRewriter Rewriter(L, SE); 4526 const SCEV *Result = Rewriter.visit(S); 4527 return Rewriter.hasSeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown() 4528 ? SE.getCouldNotCompute() 4529 : Result; 4530 } 4531 4532 const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) { 4533 if (!SE.isLoopInvariant(Expr, L)) 4534 SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown = true; 4535 return Expr; 4536 } 4537 4538 const SCEV *visitAddRecExpr(const SCEVAddRecExpr *Expr) { 4539 // Only re-write AddRecExprs for this loop. 4540 if (Expr->getLoop() == L) 4541 return Expr->getPostIncExpr(SE); 4542 SeenOtherLoops = true; 4543 return Expr; 4544 } 4545 4546 bool hasSeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown() { return SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown; } 4547 4548 bool hasSeenOtherLoops() { return SeenOtherLoops; } 4549 4550 private: 4551 explicit SCEVPostIncRewriter(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE) 4552 : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), L(L) {} 4553 4554 const Loop *L; 4555 bool SeenLoopVariantSCEVUnknown = false; 4556 bool SeenOtherLoops = false; 4557 }; 4558 4559 /// This class evaluates the compare condition by matching it against the 4560 /// condition of loop latch. If there is a match we assume a true value 4561 /// for the condition while building SCEV nodes. 4562 class SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder 4563 : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder> { 4564 public: 4565 static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, 4566 ScalarEvolution &SE) { 4567 bool IsPosBECond = false; 4568 Value *BECond = nullptr; 4569 if (BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch()) { 4570 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Latch->getTerminator()); 4571 if (BI && BI->isConditional()) { 4572 assert(BI->getSuccessor(0) != BI->getSuccessor(1) && 4573 "Both outgoing branches should not target same header!"); 4574 BECond = BI->getCondition(); 4575 IsPosBECond = BI->getSuccessor(0) == L->getHeader(); 4576 } else { 4577 return S; 4578 } 4579 } 4580 SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder Rewriter(L, BECond, IsPosBECond, SE); 4581 return Rewriter.visit(S); 4582 } 4583 4584 const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) { 4585 const SCEV *Result = Expr; 4586 bool InvariantF = SE.isLoopInvariant(Expr, L); 4587 4588 if (!InvariantF) { 4589 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(Expr->getValue()); 4590 switch (I->getOpcode()) { 4591 case Instruction::Select: { 4592 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I); 4593 Optional<const SCEV *> Res = 4594 compareWithBackedgeCondition(SI->getCondition()); 4595 if (Res.hasValue()) { 4596 bool IsOne = cast<SCEVConstant>(Res.getValue())->getValue()->isOne(); 4597 Result = SE.getSCEV(IsOne ? SI->getTrueValue() : SI->getFalseValue()); 4598 } 4599 break; 4600 } 4601 default: { 4602 Optional<const SCEV *> Res = compareWithBackedgeCondition(I); 4603 if (Res.hasValue()) 4604 Result = Res.getValue(); 4605 break; 4606 } 4607 } 4608 } 4609 return Result; 4610 } 4611 4612 private: 4613 explicit SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder(const Loop *L, Value *BECond, 4614 bool IsPosBECond, ScalarEvolution &SE) 4615 : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), L(L), BackedgeCond(BECond), 4616 IsPositiveBECond(IsPosBECond) {} 4617 4618 Optional<const SCEV *> compareWithBackedgeCondition(Value *IC); 4619 4620 const Loop *L; 4621 /// Loop back condition. 4622 Value *BackedgeCond = nullptr; 4623 /// Set to true if loop back is on positive branch condition. 4624 bool IsPositiveBECond; 4625 }; 4626 4627 Optional<const SCEV *> 4628 SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder::compareWithBackedgeCondition(Value *IC) { 4629 4630 // If value matches the backedge condition for loop latch, 4631 // then return a constant evolution node based on loopback 4632 // branch taken. 4633 if (BackedgeCond == IC) 4634 return IsPositiveBECond ? SE.getOne(Type::getInt1Ty(SE.getContext())) 4635 : SE.getZero(Type::getInt1Ty(SE.getContext())); 4636 return None; 4637 } 4638 4639 class SCEVShiftRewriter : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVShiftRewriter> { 4640 public: 4641 static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, 4642 ScalarEvolution &SE) { 4643 SCEVShiftRewriter Rewriter(L, SE); 4644 const SCEV *Result = Rewriter.visit(S); 4645 return Rewriter.isValid() ? Result : SE.getCouldNotCompute(); 4646 } 4647 4648 const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) { 4649 // Only allow AddRecExprs for this loop. 4650 if (!SE.isLoopInvariant(Expr, L)) 4651 Valid = false; 4652 return Expr; 4653 } 4654 4655 const SCEV *visitAddRecExpr(const SCEVAddRecExpr *Expr) { 4656 if (Expr->getLoop() == L && Expr->isAffine()) 4657 return SE.getMinusSCEV(Expr, Expr->getStepRecurrence(SE)); 4658 Valid = false; 4659 return Expr; 4660 } 4661 4662 bool isValid() { return Valid; } 4663 4664 private: 4665 explicit SCEVShiftRewriter(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE) 4666 : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), L(L) {} 4667 4668 const Loop *L; 4669 bool Valid = true; 4670 }; 4671 4672 } // end anonymous namespace 4673 4674 SCEV::NoWrapFlags 4675 ScalarEvolution::proveNoWrapViaConstantRanges(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR) { 4676 if (!AR->isAffine()) 4677 return SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 4678 4679 using OBO = OverflowingBinaryOperator; 4680 4681 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Result = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 4682 4683 if (!AR->hasNoSignedWrap()) { 4684 ConstantRange AddRecRange = getSignedRange(AR); 4685 ConstantRange IncRange = getSignedRange(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this)); 4686 4687 auto NSWRegion = ConstantRange::makeGuaranteedNoWrapRegion( 4688 Instruction::Add, IncRange, OBO::NoSignedWrap); 4689 if (NSWRegion.contains(AddRecRange)) 4690 Result = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Result, SCEV::FlagNSW); 4691 } 4692 4693 if (!AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) { 4694 ConstantRange AddRecRange = getUnsignedRange(AR); 4695 ConstantRange IncRange = getUnsignedRange(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this)); 4696 4697 auto NUWRegion = ConstantRange::makeGuaranteedNoWrapRegion( 4698 Instruction::Add, IncRange, OBO::NoUnsignedWrap); 4699 if (NUWRegion.contains(AddRecRange)) 4700 Result = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Result, SCEV::FlagNUW); 4701 } 4702 4703 return Result; 4704 } 4705 4706 SCEV::NoWrapFlags 4707 ScalarEvolution::proveNoSignedWrapViaInduction(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR) { 4708 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Result = AR->getNoWrapFlags(); 4709 4710 if (AR->hasNoSignedWrap()) 4711 return Result; 4712 4713 if (!AR->isAffine()) 4714 return Result; 4715 4716 const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*this); 4717 const Loop *L = AR->getLoop(); 4718 4719 // Check whether the backedge-taken count is SCEVCouldNotCompute. 4720 // Note that this serves two purposes: It filters out loops that are 4721 // simply not analyzable, and it covers the case where this code is 4722 // being called from within backedge-taken count analysis, such that 4723 // attempting to ask for the backedge-taken count would likely result 4724 // in infinite recursion. In the later case, the analysis code will 4725 // cope with a conservative value, and it will take care to purge 4726 // that value once it has finished. 4727 const SCEV *MaxBECount = getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L); 4728 4729 // Normally, in the cases we can prove no-overflow via a 4730 // backedge guarding condition, we can also compute a backedge 4731 // taken count for the loop. The exceptions are assumptions and 4732 // guards present in the loop -- SCEV is not great at exploiting 4733 // these to compute max backedge taken counts, but can still use 4734 // these to prove lack of overflow. Use this fact to avoid 4735 // doing extra work that may not pay off. 4736 4737 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) && !HasGuards && 4738 AC.assumptions().empty()) 4739 return Result; 4740 4741 // If the backedge is guarded by a comparison with the pre-inc value the 4742 // addrec is safe. Also, if the entry is guarded by a comparison with the 4743 // start value and the backedge is guarded by a comparison with the post-inc 4744 // value, the addrec is safe. 4745 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred; 4746 const SCEV *OverflowLimit = 4747 getSignedOverflowLimitForStep(Step, &Pred, this); 4748 if (OverflowLimit && 4749 (isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, Pred, AR, OverflowLimit) || 4750 isKnownOnEveryIteration(Pred, AR, OverflowLimit))) { 4751 Result = setFlags(Result, SCEV::FlagNSW); 4752 } 4753 return Result; 4754 } 4755 SCEV::NoWrapFlags 4756 ScalarEvolution::proveNoUnsignedWrapViaInduction(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR) { 4757 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Result = AR->getNoWrapFlags(); 4758 4759 if (AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) 4760 return Result; 4761 4762 if (!AR->isAffine()) 4763 return Result; 4764 4765 const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*this); 4766 unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(AR->getType()); 4767 const Loop *L = AR->getLoop(); 4768 4769 // Check whether the backedge-taken count is SCEVCouldNotCompute. 4770 // Note that this serves two purposes: It filters out loops that are 4771 // simply not analyzable, and it covers the case where this code is 4772 // being called from within backedge-taken count analysis, such that 4773 // attempting to ask for the backedge-taken count would likely result 4774 // in infinite recursion. In the later case, the analysis code will 4775 // cope with a conservative value, and it will take care to purge 4776 // that value once it has finished. 4777 const SCEV *MaxBECount = getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L); 4778 4779 // Normally, in the cases we can prove no-overflow via a 4780 // backedge guarding condition, we can also compute a backedge 4781 // taken count for the loop. The exceptions are assumptions and 4782 // guards present in the loop -- SCEV is not great at exploiting 4783 // these to compute max backedge taken counts, but can still use 4784 // these to prove lack of overflow. Use this fact to avoid 4785 // doing extra work that may not pay off. 4786 4787 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) && !HasGuards && 4788 AC.assumptions().empty()) 4789 return Result; 4790 4791 // If the backedge is guarded by a comparison with the pre-inc value the 4792 // addrec is safe. Also, if the entry is guarded by a comparison with the 4793 // start value and the backedge is guarded by a comparison with the post-inc 4794 // value, the addrec is safe. 4795 if (isKnownPositive(Step)) { 4796 const SCEV *N = getConstant(APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth) - 4797 getUnsignedRangeMax(Step)); 4798 if (isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, AR, N) || 4799 isKnownOnEveryIteration(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, AR, N)) { 4800 Result = setFlags(Result, SCEV::FlagNUW); 4801 } 4802 } 4803 4804 return Result; 4805 } 4806 4807 namespace { 4808 4809 /// Represents an abstract binary operation. This may exist as a 4810 /// normal instruction or constant expression, or may have been 4811 /// derived from an expression tree. 4812 struct BinaryOp { 4813 unsigned Opcode; 4814 Value *LHS; 4815 Value *RHS; 4816 bool IsNSW = false; 4817 bool IsNUW = false; 4818 4819 /// Op is set if this BinaryOp corresponds to a concrete LLVM instruction or 4820 /// constant expression. 4821 Operator *Op = nullptr; 4822 4823 explicit BinaryOp(Operator *Op) 4824 : Opcode(Op->getOpcode()), LHS(Op->getOperand(0)), RHS(Op->getOperand(1)), 4825 Op(Op) { 4826 if (auto *OBO = dyn_cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(Op)) { 4827 IsNSW = OBO->hasNoSignedWrap(); 4828 IsNUW = OBO->hasNoUnsignedWrap(); 4829 } 4830 } 4831 4832 explicit BinaryOp(unsigned Opcode, Value *LHS, Value *RHS, bool IsNSW = false, 4833 bool IsNUW = false) 4834 : Opcode(Opcode), LHS(LHS), RHS(RHS), IsNSW(IsNSW), IsNUW(IsNUW) {} 4835 }; 4836 4837 } // end anonymous namespace 4838 4839 /// Try to map \p V into a BinaryOp, and return \c None on failure. 4840 static Optional<BinaryOp> MatchBinaryOp(Value *V, DominatorTree &DT) { 4841 auto *Op = dyn_cast<Operator>(V); 4842 if (!Op) 4843 return None; 4844 4845 // Implementation detail: all the cleverness here should happen without 4846 // creating new SCEV expressions -- our caller knowns tricks to avoid creating 4847 // SCEV expressions when possible, and we should not break that. 4848 4849 switch (Op->getOpcode()) { 4850 case Instruction::Add: 4851 case Instruction::Sub: 4852 case Instruction::Mul: 4853 case Instruction::UDiv: 4854 case Instruction::URem: 4855 case Instruction::And: 4856 case Instruction::Or: 4857 case Instruction::AShr: 4858 case Instruction::Shl: 4859 return BinaryOp(Op); 4860 4861 case Instruction::Xor: 4862 if (auto *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op->getOperand(1))) 4863 // If the RHS of the xor is a signmask, then this is just an add. 4864 // Instcombine turns add of signmask into xor as a strength reduction step. 4865 if (RHSC->getValue().isSignMask()) 4866 return BinaryOp(Instruction::Add, Op->getOperand(0), Op->getOperand(1)); 4867 return BinaryOp(Op); 4868 4869 case Instruction::LShr: 4870 // Turn logical shift right of a constant into a unsigned divide. 4871 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op->getOperand(1))) { 4872 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth(); 4873 4874 // If the shift count is not less than the bitwidth, the result of 4875 // the shift is undefined. Don't try to analyze it, because the 4876 // resolution chosen here may differ from the resolution chosen in 4877 // other parts of the compiler. 4878 if (SA->getValue().ult(BitWidth)) { 4879 Constant *X = 4880 ConstantInt::get(SA->getContext(), 4881 APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth, SA->getZExtValue())); 4882 return BinaryOp(Instruction::UDiv, Op->getOperand(0), X); 4883 } 4884 } 4885 return BinaryOp(Op); 4886 4887 case Instruction::ExtractValue: { 4888 auto *EVI = cast<ExtractValueInst>(Op); 4889 if (EVI->getNumIndices() != 1 || EVI->getIndices()[0] != 0) 4890 break; 4891 4892 auto *WO = dyn_cast<WithOverflowInst>(EVI->getAggregateOperand()); 4893 if (!WO) 4894 break; 4895 4896 Instruction::BinaryOps BinOp = WO->getBinaryOp(); 4897 bool Signed = WO->isSigned(); 4898 // TODO: Should add nuw/nsw flags for mul as well. 4899 if (BinOp == Instruction::Mul || !isOverflowIntrinsicNoWrap(WO, DT)) 4900 return BinaryOp(BinOp, WO->getLHS(), WO->getRHS()); 4901 4902 // Now that we know that all uses of the arithmetic-result component of 4903 // CI are guarded by the overflow check, we can go ahead and pretend 4904 // that the arithmetic is non-overflowing. 4905 return BinaryOp(BinOp, WO->getLHS(), WO->getRHS(), 4906 /* IsNSW = */ Signed, /* IsNUW = */ !Signed); 4907 } 4908 4909 default: 4910 break; 4911 } 4912 4913 // Recognise intrinsic loop.decrement.reg, and as this has exactly the same 4914 // semantics as a Sub, return a binary sub expression. 4915 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(V)) 4916 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::loop_decrement_reg) 4917 return BinaryOp(Instruction::Sub, II->getOperand(0), II->getOperand(1)); 4918 4919 return None; 4920 } 4921 4922 /// Helper function to createAddRecFromPHIWithCasts. We have a phi 4923 /// node whose symbolic (unknown) SCEV is \p SymbolicPHI, which is updated via 4924 /// the loop backedge by a SCEVAddExpr, possibly also with a few casts on the 4925 /// way. This function checks if \p Op, an operand of this SCEVAddExpr, 4926 /// follows one of the following patterns: 4927 /// Op == (SExt ix (Trunc iy (%SymbolicPHI) to ix) to iy) 4928 /// Op == (ZExt ix (Trunc iy (%SymbolicPHI) to ix) to iy) 4929 /// If the SCEV expression of \p Op conforms with one of the expected patterns 4930 /// we return the type of the truncation operation, and indicate whether the 4931 /// truncated type should be treated as signed/unsigned by setting 4932 /// \p Signed to true/false, respectively. 4933 static Type *isSimpleCastedPHI(const SCEV *Op, const SCEVUnknown *SymbolicPHI, 4934 bool &Signed, ScalarEvolution &SE) { 4935 // The case where Op == SymbolicPHI (that is, with no type conversions on 4936 // the way) is handled by the regular add recurrence creating logic and 4937 // would have already been triggered in createAddRecForPHI. Reaching it here 4938 // means that createAddRecFromPHI had failed for this PHI before (e.g., 4939 // because one of the other operands of the SCEVAddExpr updating this PHI is 4940 // not invariant). 4941 // 4942 // Here we look for the case where Op = (ext(trunc(SymbolicPHI))), and in 4943 // this case predicates that allow us to prove that Op == SymbolicPHI will 4944 // be added. 4945 if (Op == SymbolicPHI) 4946 return nullptr; 4947 4948 unsigned SourceBits = SE.getTypeSizeInBits(SymbolicPHI->getType()); 4949 unsigned NewBits = SE.getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()); 4950 if (SourceBits != NewBits) 4951 return nullptr; 4952 4953 const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(Op); 4954 const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Op); 4955 if (!SExt && !ZExt) 4956 return nullptr; 4957 const SCEVTruncateExpr *Trunc = 4958 SExt ? dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(SExt->getOperand()) 4959 : dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(ZExt->getOperand()); 4960 if (!Trunc) 4961 return nullptr; 4962 const SCEV *X = Trunc->getOperand(); 4963 if (X != SymbolicPHI) 4964 return nullptr; 4965 Signed = SExt != nullptr; 4966 return Trunc->getType(); 4967 } 4968 4969 static const Loop *isIntegerLoopHeaderPHI(const PHINode *PN, LoopInfo &LI) { 4970 if (!PN->getType()->isIntegerTy()) 4971 return nullptr; 4972 const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(PN->getParent()); 4973 if (!L || L->getHeader() != PN->getParent()) 4974 return nullptr; 4975 return L; 4976 } 4977 4978 // Analyze \p SymbolicPHI, a SCEV expression of a phi node, and check if the 4979 // computation that updates the phi follows the following pattern: 4980 // (SExt/ZExt ix (Trunc iy (%SymbolicPHI) to ix) to iy) + InvariantAccum 4981 // which correspond to a phi->trunc->sext/zext->add->phi update chain. 4982 // If so, try to see if it can be rewritten as an AddRecExpr under some 4983 // Predicates. If successful, return them as a pair. Also cache the results 4984 // of the analysis. 4985 // 4986 // Example usage scenario: 4987 // Say the Rewriter is called for the following SCEV: 4988 // 8 * ((sext i32 (trunc i64 %X to i32) to i64) + %Step) 4989 // where: 4990 // %X = phi i64 (%Start, %BEValue) 4991 // It will visitMul->visitAdd->visitSExt->visitTrunc->visitUnknown(%X), 4992 // and call this function with %SymbolicPHI = %X. 4993 // 4994 // The analysis will find that the value coming around the backedge has 4995 // the following SCEV: 4996 // BEValue = ((sext i32 (trunc i64 %X to i32) to i64) + %Step) 4997 // Upon concluding that this matches the desired pattern, the function 4998 // will return the pair {NewAddRec, SmallPredsVec} where: 4999 // NewAddRec = {%Start,+,%Step} 5000 // SmallPredsVec = {P1, P2, P3} as follows: 5001 // P1(WrapPred): AR: {trunc(%Start),+,(trunc %Step)}<nsw> Flags: <nssw> 5002 // P2(EqualPred): %Start == (sext i32 (trunc i64 %Start to i32) to i64) 5003 // P3(EqualPred): %Step == (sext i32 (trunc i64 %Step to i32) to i64) 5004 // The returned pair means that SymbolicPHI can be rewritten into NewAddRec 5005 // under the predicates {P1,P2,P3}. 5006 // This predicated rewrite will be cached in PredicatedSCEVRewrites: 5007 // PredicatedSCEVRewrites[{%X,L}] = {NewAddRec, {P1,P2,P3)} 5008 // 5009 // TODO's: 5010 // 5011 // 1) Extend the Induction descriptor to also support inductions that involve 5012 // casts: When needed (namely, when we are called in the context of the 5013 // vectorizer induction analysis), a Set of cast instructions will be 5014 // populated by this method, and provided back to isInductionPHI. This is 5015 // needed to allow the vectorizer to properly record them to be ignored by 5016 // the cost model and to avoid vectorizing them (otherwise these casts, 5017 // which are redundant under the runtime overflow checks, will be 5018 // vectorized, which can be costly). 5019 // 5020 // 2) Support additional induction/PHISCEV patterns: We also want to support 5021 // inductions where the sext-trunc / zext-trunc operations (partly) occur 5022 // after the induction update operation (the induction increment): 5023 // 5024 // (Trunc iy (SExt/ZExt ix (%SymbolicPHI + InvariantAccum) to iy) to ix) 5025 // which correspond to a phi->add->trunc->sext/zext->phi update chain. 5026 // 5027 // (Trunc iy ((SExt/ZExt ix (%SymbolicPhi) to iy) + InvariantAccum) to ix) 5028 // which correspond to a phi->trunc->add->sext/zext->phi update chain. 5029 // 5030 // 3) Outline common code with createAddRecFromPHI to avoid duplication. 5031 Optional<std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>>> 5032 ScalarEvolution::createAddRecFromPHIWithCastsImpl(const SCEVUnknown *SymbolicPHI) { 5033 SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3> Predicates; 5034 5035 // *** Part1: Analyze if we have a phi-with-cast pattern for which we can 5036 // return an AddRec expression under some predicate. 5037 5038 auto *PN = cast<PHINode>(SymbolicPHI->getValue()); 5039 const Loop *L = isIntegerLoopHeaderPHI(PN, LI); 5040 assert(L && "Expecting an integer loop header phi"); 5041 5042 // The loop may have multiple entrances or multiple exits; we can analyze 5043 // this phi as an addrec if it has a unique entry value and a unique 5044 // backedge value. 5045 Value *BEValueV = nullptr, *StartValueV = nullptr; 5046 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) { 5047 Value *V = PN->getIncomingValue(i); 5048 if (L->contains(PN->getIncomingBlock(i))) { 5049 if (!BEValueV) { 5050 BEValueV = V; 5051 } else if (BEValueV != V) { 5052 BEValueV = nullptr; 5053 break; 5054 } 5055 } else if (!StartValueV) { 5056 StartValueV = V; 5057 } else if (StartValueV != V) { 5058 StartValueV = nullptr; 5059 break; 5060 } 5061 } 5062 if (!BEValueV || !StartValueV) 5063 return None; 5064 5065 const SCEV *BEValue = getSCEV(BEValueV); 5066 5067 // If the value coming around the backedge is an add with the symbolic 5068 // value we just inserted, possibly with casts that we can ignore under 5069 // an appropriate runtime guard, then we found a simple induction variable! 5070 const auto *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(BEValue); 5071 if (!Add) 5072 return None; 5073 5074 // If there is a single occurrence of the symbolic value, possibly 5075 // casted, replace it with a recurrence. 5076 unsigned FoundIndex = Add->getNumOperands(); 5077 Type *TruncTy = nullptr; 5078 bool Signed; 5079 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 5080 if ((TruncTy = 5081 isSimpleCastedPHI(Add->getOperand(i), SymbolicPHI, Signed, *this))) 5082 if (FoundIndex == e) { 5083 FoundIndex = i; 5084 break; 5085 } 5086 5087 if (FoundIndex == Add->getNumOperands()) 5088 return None; 5089 5090 // Create an add with everything but the specified operand. 5091 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> Ops; 5092 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 5093 if (i != FoundIndex) 5094 Ops.push_back(Add->getOperand(i)); 5095 const SCEV *Accum = getAddExpr(Ops); 5096 5097 // The runtime checks will not be valid if the step amount is 5098 // varying inside the loop. 5099 if (!isLoopInvariant(Accum, L)) 5100 return None; 5101 5102 // *** Part2: Create the predicates 5103 5104 // Analysis was successful: we have a phi-with-cast pattern for which we 5105 // can return an AddRec expression under the following predicates: 5106 // 5107 // P1: A Wrap predicate that guarantees that Trunc(Start) + i*Trunc(Accum) 5108 // fits within the truncated type (does not overflow) for i = 0 to n-1. 5109 // P2: An Equal predicate that guarantees that 5110 // Start = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start) to ix) to iy) 5111 // P3: An Equal predicate that guarantees that 5112 // Accum = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Accum) to ix) to iy) 5113 // 5114 // As we next prove, the above predicates guarantee that: 5115 // Start + i*Accum = (Ext ix (Trunc iy ( Start + i*Accum ) to ix) to iy) 5116 // 5117 // 5118 // More formally, we want to prove that: 5119 // Expr(i+1) = Start + (i+1) * Accum 5120 // = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr(i)) to ix) to iy) + Accum 5121 // 5122 // Given that: 5123 // 1) Expr(0) = Start 5124 // 2) Expr(1) = Start + Accum 5125 // = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start) to ix) to iy) + Accum :: from P2 5126 // 3) Induction hypothesis (step i): 5127 // Expr(i) = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr(i-1)) to ix) to iy) + Accum 5128 // 5129 // Proof: 5130 // Expr(i+1) = 5131 // = Start + (i+1)*Accum 5132 // = (Start + i*Accum) + Accum 5133 // = Expr(i) + Accum 5134 // = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr(i-1)) to ix) to iy) + Accum + Accum 5135 // :: from step i 5136 // 5137 // = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start + (i-1)*Accum) to ix) to iy) + Accum + Accum 5138 // 5139 // = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start + (i-1)*Accum) to ix) to iy) 5140 // + (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Accum) to ix) to iy) 5141 // + Accum :: from P3 5142 // 5143 // = (Ext ix (Trunc iy ((Start + (i-1)*Accum) + Accum) to ix) to iy) 5144 // + Accum :: from P1: Ext(x)+Ext(y)=>Ext(x+y) 5145 // 5146 // = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Start + i*Accum) to ix) to iy) + Accum 5147 // = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr(i)) to ix) to iy) + Accum 5148 // 5149 // By induction, the same applies to all iterations 1<=i<n: 5150 // 5151 5152 // Create a truncated addrec for which we will add a no overflow check (P1). 5153 const SCEV *StartVal = getSCEV(StartValueV); 5154 const SCEV *PHISCEV = 5155 getAddRecExpr(getTruncateExpr(StartVal, TruncTy), 5156 getTruncateExpr(Accum, TruncTy), L, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap); 5157 5158 // PHISCEV can be either a SCEVConstant or a SCEVAddRecExpr. 5159 // ex: If truncated Accum is 0 and StartVal is a constant, then PHISCEV 5160 // will be constant. 5161 // 5162 // If PHISCEV is a constant, then P1 degenerates into P2 or P3, so we don't 5163 // add P1. 5164 if (const auto *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(PHISCEV)) { 5165 SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags AddedFlags = 5166 Signed ? SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNSSW 5167 : SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNUSW; 5168 const SCEVPredicate *AddRecPred = getWrapPredicate(AR, AddedFlags); 5169 Predicates.push_back(AddRecPred); 5170 } 5171 5172 // Create the Equal Predicates P2,P3: 5173 5174 // It is possible that the predicates P2 and/or P3 are computable at 5175 // compile time due to StartVal and/or Accum being constants. 5176 // If either one is, then we can check that now and escape if either P2 5177 // or P3 is false. 5178 5179 // Construct the extended SCEV: (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr) to ix) to iy) 5180 // for each of StartVal and Accum 5181 auto getExtendedExpr = [&](const SCEV *Expr, 5182 bool CreateSignExtend) -> const SCEV * { 5183 assert(isLoopInvariant(Expr, L) && "Expr is expected to be invariant"); 5184 const SCEV *TruncatedExpr = getTruncateExpr(Expr, TruncTy); 5185 const SCEV *ExtendedExpr = 5186 CreateSignExtend ? getSignExtendExpr(TruncatedExpr, Expr->getType()) 5187 : getZeroExtendExpr(TruncatedExpr, Expr->getType()); 5188 return ExtendedExpr; 5189 }; 5190 5191 // Given: 5192 // ExtendedExpr = (Ext ix (Trunc iy (Expr) to ix) to iy 5193 // = getExtendedExpr(Expr) 5194 // Determine whether the predicate P: Expr == ExtendedExpr 5195 // is known to be false at compile time 5196 auto PredIsKnownFalse = [&](const SCEV *Expr, 5197 const SCEV *ExtendedExpr) -> bool { 5198 return Expr != ExtendedExpr && 5199 isKnownPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Expr, ExtendedExpr); 5200 }; 5201 5202 const SCEV *StartExtended = getExtendedExpr(StartVal, Signed); 5203 if (PredIsKnownFalse(StartVal, StartExtended)) { 5204 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "P2 is compile-time false\n";); 5205 return None; 5206 } 5207 5208 // The Step is always Signed (because the overflow checks are either 5209 // NSSW or NUSW) 5210 const SCEV *AccumExtended = getExtendedExpr(Accum, /*CreateSignExtend=*/true); 5211 if (PredIsKnownFalse(Accum, AccumExtended)) { 5212 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "P3 is compile-time false\n";); 5213 return None; 5214 } 5215 5216 auto AppendPredicate = [&](const SCEV *Expr, 5217 const SCEV *ExtendedExpr) -> void { 5218 if (Expr != ExtendedExpr && 5219 !isKnownPredicate(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Expr, ExtendedExpr)) { 5220 const SCEVPredicate *Pred = getEqualPredicate(Expr, ExtendedExpr); 5221 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Added Predicate: " << *Pred); 5222 Predicates.push_back(Pred); 5223 } 5224 }; 5225 5226 AppendPredicate(StartVal, StartExtended); 5227 AppendPredicate(Accum, AccumExtended); 5228 5229 // *** Part3: Predicates are ready. Now go ahead and create the new addrec in 5230 // which the casts had been folded away. The caller can rewrite SymbolicPHI 5231 // into NewAR if it will also add the runtime overflow checks specified in 5232 // Predicates. 5233 auto *NewAR = getAddRecExpr(StartVal, Accum, L, SCEV::FlagAnyWrap); 5234 5235 std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>> PredRewrite = 5236 std::make_pair(NewAR, Predicates); 5237 // Remember the result of the analysis for this SCEV at this locayyytion. 5238 PredicatedSCEVRewrites[{SymbolicPHI, L}] = PredRewrite; 5239 return PredRewrite; 5240 } 5241 5242 Optional<std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>>> 5243 ScalarEvolution::createAddRecFromPHIWithCasts(const SCEVUnknown *SymbolicPHI) { 5244 auto *PN = cast<PHINode>(SymbolicPHI->getValue()); 5245 const Loop *L = isIntegerLoopHeaderPHI(PN, LI); 5246 if (!L) 5247 return None; 5248 5249 // Check to see if we already analyzed this PHI. 5250 auto I = PredicatedSCEVRewrites.find({SymbolicPHI, L}); 5251 if (I != PredicatedSCEVRewrites.end()) { 5252 std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>> Rewrite = 5253 I->second; 5254 // Analysis was done before and failed to create an AddRec: 5255 if (Rewrite.first == SymbolicPHI) 5256 return None; 5257 // Analysis was done before and succeeded to create an AddRec under 5258 // a predicate: 5259 assert(isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Rewrite.first) && "Expected an AddRec"); 5260 assert(!(Rewrite.second).empty() && "Expected to find Predicates"); 5261 return Rewrite; 5262 } 5263 5264 Optional<std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>>> 5265 Rewrite = createAddRecFromPHIWithCastsImpl(SymbolicPHI); 5266 5267 // Record in the cache that the analysis failed 5268 if (!Rewrite) { 5269 SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3> Predicates; 5270 PredicatedSCEVRewrites[{SymbolicPHI, L}] = {SymbolicPHI, Predicates}; 5271 return None; 5272 } 5273 5274 return Rewrite; 5275 } 5276 5277 // FIXME: This utility is currently required because the Rewriter currently 5278 // does not rewrite this expression: 5279 // {0, +, (sext ix (trunc iy to ix) to iy)} 5280 // into {0, +, %step}, 5281 // even when the following Equal predicate exists: 5282 // "%step == (sext ix (trunc iy to ix) to iy)". 5283 bool PredicatedScalarEvolution::areAddRecsEqualWithPreds( 5284 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR1, const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR2) const { 5285 if (AR1 == AR2) 5286 return true; 5287 5288 auto areExprsEqual = [&](const SCEV *Expr1, const SCEV *Expr2) -> bool { 5289 if (Expr1 != Expr2 && !Preds.implies(SE.getEqualPredicate(Expr1, Expr2)) && 5290 !Preds.implies(SE.getEqualPredicate(Expr2, Expr1))) 5291 return false; 5292 return true; 5293 }; 5294 5295 if (!areExprsEqual(AR1->getStart(), AR2->getStart()) || 5296 !areExprsEqual(AR1->getStepRecurrence(SE), AR2->getStepRecurrence(SE))) 5297 return false; 5298 return true; 5299 } 5300 5301 /// A helper function for createAddRecFromPHI to handle simple cases. 5302 /// 5303 /// This function tries to find an AddRec expression for the simplest (yet most 5304 /// common) cases: PN = PHI(Start, OP(Self, LoopInvariant)). 5305 /// If it fails, createAddRecFromPHI will use a more general, but slow, 5306 /// technique for finding the AddRec expression. 5307 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createSimpleAffineAddRec(PHINode *PN, 5308 Value *BEValueV, 5309 Value *StartValueV) { 5310 const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(PN->getParent()); 5311 assert(L && L->getHeader() == PN->getParent()); 5312 assert(BEValueV && StartValueV); 5313 5314 auto BO = MatchBinaryOp(BEValueV, DT); 5315 if (!BO) 5316 return nullptr; 5317 5318 if (BO->Opcode != Instruction::Add) 5319 return nullptr; 5320 5321 const SCEV *Accum = nullptr; 5322 if (BO->LHS == PN && L->isLoopInvariant(BO->RHS)) 5323 Accum = getSCEV(BO->RHS); 5324 else if (BO->RHS == PN && L->isLoopInvariant(BO->LHS)) 5325 Accum = getSCEV(BO->LHS); 5326 5327 if (!Accum) 5328 return nullptr; 5329 5330 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 5331 if (BO->IsNUW) 5332 Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 5333 if (BO->IsNSW) 5334 Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW); 5335 5336 const SCEV *StartVal = getSCEV(StartValueV); 5337 const SCEV *PHISCEV = getAddRecExpr(StartVal, Accum, L, Flags); 5338 5339 ValueExprMap[SCEVCallbackVH(PN, this)] = PHISCEV; 5340 5341 // We can add Flags to the post-inc expression only if we 5342 // know that it is *undefined behavior* for BEValueV to 5343 // overflow. 5344 if (auto *BEInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BEValueV)) { 5345 assert(isLoopInvariant(Accum, L) && 5346 "Accum is defined outside L, but is not invariant?"); 5347 if (isAddRecNeverPoison(BEInst, L)) 5348 (void)getAddRecExpr(getAddExpr(StartVal, Accum), Accum, L, Flags); 5349 } 5350 5351 return PHISCEV; 5352 } 5353 5354 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createAddRecFromPHI(PHINode *PN) { 5355 const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(PN->getParent()); 5356 if (!L || L->getHeader() != PN->getParent()) 5357 return nullptr; 5358 5359 // The loop may have multiple entrances or multiple exits; we can analyze 5360 // this phi as an addrec if it has a unique entry value and a unique 5361 // backedge value. 5362 Value *BEValueV = nullptr, *StartValueV = nullptr; 5363 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) { 5364 Value *V = PN->getIncomingValue(i); 5365 if (L->contains(PN->getIncomingBlock(i))) { 5366 if (!BEValueV) { 5367 BEValueV = V; 5368 } else if (BEValueV != V) { 5369 BEValueV = nullptr; 5370 break; 5371 } 5372 } else if (!StartValueV) { 5373 StartValueV = V; 5374 } else if (StartValueV != V) { 5375 StartValueV = nullptr; 5376 break; 5377 } 5378 } 5379 if (!BEValueV || !StartValueV) 5380 return nullptr; 5381 5382 assert(ValueExprMap.find_as(PN) == ValueExprMap.end() && 5383 "PHI node already processed?"); 5384 5385 // First, try to find AddRec expression without creating a fictituos symbolic 5386 // value for PN. 5387 if (auto *S = createSimpleAffineAddRec(PN, BEValueV, StartValueV)) 5388 return S; 5389 5390 // Handle PHI node value symbolically. 5391 const SCEV *SymbolicName = getUnknown(PN); 5392 ValueExprMap.insert({SCEVCallbackVH(PN, this), SymbolicName}); 5393 5394 // Using this symbolic name for the PHI, analyze the value coming around 5395 // the back-edge. 5396 const SCEV *BEValue = getSCEV(BEValueV); 5397 5398 // NOTE: If BEValue is loop invariant, we know that the PHI node just 5399 // has a special value for the first iteration of the loop. 5400 5401 // If the value coming around the backedge is an add with the symbolic 5402 // value we just inserted, then we found a simple induction variable! 5403 if (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(BEValue)) { 5404 // If there is a single occurrence of the symbolic value, replace it 5405 // with a recurrence. 5406 unsigned FoundIndex = Add->getNumOperands(); 5407 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 5408 if (Add->getOperand(i) == SymbolicName) 5409 if (FoundIndex == e) { 5410 FoundIndex = i; 5411 break; 5412 } 5413 5414 if (FoundIndex != Add->getNumOperands()) { 5415 // Create an add with everything but the specified operand. 5416 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> Ops; 5417 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 5418 if (i != FoundIndex) 5419 Ops.push_back(SCEVBackedgeConditionFolder::rewrite(Add->getOperand(i), 5420 L, *this)); 5421 const SCEV *Accum = getAddExpr(Ops); 5422 5423 // This is not a valid addrec if the step amount is varying each 5424 // loop iteration, but is not itself an addrec in this loop. 5425 if (isLoopInvariant(Accum, L) || 5426 (isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Accum) && 5427 cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Accum)->getLoop() == L)) { 5428 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 5429 5430 if (auto BO = MatchBinaryOp(BEValueV, DT)) { 5431 if (BO->Opcode == Instruction::Add && BO->LHS == PN) { 5432 if (BO->IsNUW) 5433 Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 5434 if (BO->IsNSW) 5435 Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW); 5436 } 5437 } else if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(BEValueV)) { 5438 // If the increment is an inbounds GEP, then we know the address 5439 // space cannot be wrapped around. We cannot make any guarantee 5440 // about signed or unsigned overflow because pointers are 5441 // unsigned but we may have a negative index from the base 5442 // pointer. We can guarantee that no unsigned wrap occurs if the 5443 // indices form a positive value. 5444 if (GEP->isInBounds() && GEP->getOperand(0) == PN) { 5445 Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW); 5446 5447 const SCEV *Ptr = getSCEV(GEP->getPointerOperand()); 5448 if (isKnownPositive(getMinusSCEV(getSCEV(GEP), Ptr))) 5449 Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 5450 } 5451 5452 // We cannot transfer nuw and nsw flags from subtraction 5453 // operations -- sub nuw X, Y is not the same as add nuw X, -Y 5454 // for instance. 5455 } 5456 5457 const SCEV *StartVal = getSCEV(StartValueV); 5458 const SCEV *PHISCEV = getAddRecExpr(StartVal, Accum, L, Flags); 5459 5460 // Okay, for the entire analysis of this edge we assumed the PHI 5461 // to be symbolic. We now need to go back and purge all of the 5462 // entries for the scalars that use the symbolic expression. 5463 forgetSymbolicName(PN, SymbolicName); 5464 ValueExprMap[SCEVCallbackVH(PN, this)] = PHISCEV; 5465 5466 // We can add Flags to the post-inc expression only if we 5467 // know that it is *undefined behavior* for BEValueV to 5468 // overflow. 5469 if (auto *BEInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BEValueV)) 5470 if (isLoopInvariant(Accum, L) && isAddRecNeverPoison(BEInst, L)) 5471 (void)getAddRecExpr(getAddExpr(StartVal, Accum), Accum, L, Flags); 5472 5473 return PHISCEV; 5474 } 5475 } 5476 } else { 5477 // Otherwise, this could be a loop like this: 5478 // i = 0; for (j = 1; ..; ++j) { .... i = j; } 5479 // In this case, j = {1,+,1} and BEValue is j. 5480 // Because the other in-value of i (0) fits the evolution of BEValue 5481 // i really is an addrec evolution. 5482 // 5483 // We can generalize this saying that i is the shifted value of BEValue 5484 // by one iteration: 5485 // PHI(f(0), f({1,+,1})) --> f({0,+,1}) 5486 const SCEV *Shifted = SCEVShiftRewriter::rewrite(BEValue, L, *this); 5487 const SCEV *Start = SCEVInitRewriter::rewrite(Shifted, L, *this, false); 5488 if (Shifted != getCouldNotCompute() && 5489 Start != getCouldNotCompute()) { 5490 const SCEV *StartVal = getSCEV(StartValueV); 5491 if (Start == StartVal) { 5492 // Okay, for the entire analysis of this edge we assumed the PHI 5493 // to be symbolic. We now need to go back and purge all of the 5494 // entries for the scalars that use the symbolic expression. 5495 forgetSymbolicName(PN, SymbolicName); 5496 ValueExprMap[SCEVCallbackVH(PN, this)] = Shifted; 5497 return Shifted; 5498 } 5499 } 5500 } 5501 5502 // Remove the temporary PHI node SCEV that has been inserted while intending 5503 // to create an AddRecExpr for this PHI node. We can not keep this temporary 5504 // as it will prevent later (possibly simpler) SCEV expressions to be added 5505 // to the ValueExprMap. 5506 eraseValueFromMap(PN); 5507 5508 return nullptr; 5509 } 5510 5511 // Checks if the SCEV S is available at BB. S is considered available at BB 5512 // if S can be materialized at BB without introducing a fault. 5513 static bool IsAvailableOnEntry(const Loop *L, DominatorTree &DT, const SCEV *S, 5514 BasicBlock *BB) { 5515 struct CheckAvailable { 5516 bool TraversalDone = false; 5517 bool Available = true; 5518 5519 const Loop *L = nullptr; // The loop BB is in (can be nullptr) 5520 BasicBlock *BB = nullptr; 5521 DominatorTree &DT; 5522 5523 CheckAvailable(const Loop *L, BasicBlock *BB, DominatorTree &DT) 5524 : L(L), BB(BB), DT(DT) {} 5525 5526 bool setUnavailable() { 5527 TraversalDone = true; 5528 Available = false; 5529 return false; 5530 } 5531 5532 bool follow(const SCEV *S) { 5533 switch (S->getSCEVType()) { 5534 case scConstant: 5535 case scPtrToInt: 5536 case scTruncate: 5537 case scZeroExtend: 5538 case scSignExtend: 5539 case scAddExpr: 5540 case scMulExpr: 5541 case scUMaxExpr: 5542 case scSMaxExpr: 5543 case scUMinExpr: 5544 case scSMinExpr: 5545 // These expressions are available if their operand(s) is/are. 5546 return true; 5547 5548 case scAddRecExpr: { 5549 // We allow add recurrences that are on the loop BB is in, or some 5550 // outer loop. This guarantees availability because the value of the 5551 // add recurrence at BB is simply the "current" value of the induction 5552 // variable. We can relax this in the future; for instance an add 5553 // recurrence on a sibling dominating loop is also available at BB. 5554 const auto *ARLoop = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)->getLoop(); 5555 if (L && (ARLoop == L || ARLoop->contains(L))) 5556 return true; 5557 5558 return setUnavailable(); 5559 } 5560 5561 case scUnknown: { 5562 // For SCEVUnknown, we check for simple dominance. 5563 const auto *SU = cast<SCEVUnknown>(S); 5564 Value *V = SU->getValue(); 5565 5566 if (isa<Argument>(V)) 5567 return false; 5568 5569 if (isa<Instruction>(V) && DT.dominates(cast<Instruction>(V), BB)) 5570 return false; 5571 5572 return setUnavailable(); 5573 } 5574 5575 case scUDivExpr: 5576 case scCouldNotCompute: 5577 // We do not try to smart about these at all. 5578 return setUnavailable(); 5579 } 5580 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!"); 5581 } 5582 5583 bool isDone() { return TraversalDone; } 5584 }; 5585 5586 CheckAvailable CA(L, BB, DT); 5587 SCEVTraversal<CheckAvailable> ST(CA); 5588 5589 ST.visitAll(S); 5590 return CA.Available; 5591 } 5592 5593 // Try to match a control flow sequence that branches out at BI and merges back 5594 // at Merge into a "C ? LHS : RHS" select pattern. Return true on a successful 5595 // match. 5596 static bool BrPHIToSelect(DominatorTree &DT, BranchInst *BI, PHINode *Merge, 5597 Value *&C, Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS) { 5598 C = BI->getCondition(); 5599 5600 BasicBlockEdge LeftEdge(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(0)); 5601 BasicBlockEdge RightEdge(BI->getParent(), BI->getSuccessor(1)); 5602 5603 if (!LeftEdge.isSingleEdge()) 5604 return false; 5605 5606 assert(RightEdge.isSingleEdge() && "Follows from LeftEdge.isSingleEdge()"); 5607 5608 Use &LeftUse = Merge->getOperandUse(0); 5609 Use &RightUse = Merge->getOperandUse(1); 5610 5611 if (DT.dominates(LeftEdge, LeftUse) && DT.dominates(RightEdge, RightUse)) { 5612 LHS = LeftUse; 5613 RHS = RightUse; 5614 return true; 5615 } 5616 5617 if (DT.dominates(LeftEdge, RightUse) && DT.dominates(RightEdge, LeftUse)) { 5618 LHS = RightUse; 5619 RHS = LeftUse; 5620 return true; 5621 } 5622 5623 return false; 5624 } 5625 5626 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createNodeFromSelectLikePHI(PHINode *PN) { 5627 auto IsReachable = 5628 [&](BasicBlock *BB) { return DT.isReachableFromEntry(BB); }; 5629 if (PN->getNumIncomingValues() == 2 && all_of(PN->blocks(), IsReachable)) { 5630 const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(PN->getParent()); 5631 5632 // We don't want to break LCSSA, even in a SCEV expression tree. 5633 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) 5634 if (LI.getLoopFor(PN->getIncomingBlock(i)) != L) 5635 return nullptr; 5636 5637 // Try to match 5638 // 5639 // br %cond, label %left, label %right 5640 // left: 5641 // br label %merge 5642 // right: 5643 // br label %merge 5644 // merge: 5645 // V = phi [ %x, %left ], [ %y, %right ] 5646 // 5647 // as "select %cond, %x, %y" 5648 5649 BasicBlock *IDom = DT[PN->getParent()]->getIDom()->getBlock(); 5650 assert(IDom && "At least the entry block should dominate PN"); 5651 5652 auto *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(IDom->getTerminator()); 5653 Value *Cond = nullptr, *LHS = nullptr, *RHS = nullptr; 5654 5655 if (BI && BI->isConditional() && 5656 BrPHIToSelect(DT, BI, PN, Cond, LHS, RHS) && 5657 IsAvailableOnEntry(L, DT, getSCEV(LHS), PN->getParent()) && 5658 IsAvailableOnEntry(L, DT, getSCEV(RHS), PN->getParent())) 5659 return createNodeForSelectOrPHI(PN, Cond, LHS, RHS); 5660 } 5661 5662 return nullptr; 5663 } 5664 5665 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createNodeForPHI(PHINode *PN) { 5666 if (const SCEV *S = createAddRecFromPHI(PN)) 5667 return S; 5668 5669 if (const SCEV *S = createNodeFromSelectLikePHI(PN)) 5670 return S; 5671 5672 // If the PHI has a single incoming value, follow that value, unless the 5673 // PHI's incoming blocks are in a different loop, in which case doing so 5674 // risks breaking LCSSA form. Instcombine would normally zap these, but 5675 // it doesn't have DominatorTree information, so it may miss cases. 5676 if (Value *V = SimplifyInstruction(PN, {getDataLayout(), &TLI, &DT, &AC})) 5677 if (LI.replacementPreservesLCSSAForm(PN, V)) 5678 return getSCEV(V); 5679 5680 // If it's not a loop phi, we can't handle it yet. 5681 return getUnknown(PN); 5682 } 5683 5684 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createNodeForSelectOrPHI(Instruction *I, 5685 Value *Cond, 5686 Value *TrueVal, 5687 Value *FalseVal) { 5688 // Handle "constant" branch or select. This can occur for instance when a 5689 // loop pass transforms an inner loop and moves on to process the outer loop. 5690 if (auto *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Cond)) 5691 return getSCEV(CI->isOne() ? TrueVal : FalseVal); 5692 5693 // Try to match some simple smax or umax patterns. 5694 auto *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Cond); 5695 if (!ICI) 5696 return getUnknown(I); 5697 5698 Value *LHS = ICI->getOperand(0); 5699 Value *RHS = ICI->getOperand(1); 5700 5701 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) { 5702 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: 5703 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: 5704 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: 5705 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: 5706 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 5707 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 5708 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: 5709 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: 5710 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: 5711 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: 5712 // a > b ? a+x : b+x -> max(a, b)+x 5713 // a > b ? b+x : a+x -> min(a, b)+x 5714 if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) <= getTypeSizeInBits(I->getType())) { 5715 bool Signed = ICI->isSigned(); 5716 const SCEV *LA = getSCEV(TrueVal); 5717 const SCEV *RA = getSCEV(FalseVal); 5718 const SCEV *LS = getSCEV(LHS); 5719 const SCEV *RS = getSCEV(RHS); 5720 if (LA->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 5721 // FIXME: Handle cases where LS/RS are pointers not equal to LA/RA. 5722 // Need to make sure we can't produce weird expressions involving 5723 // negated pointers. 5724 if (LA == LS && RA == RS) 5725 return Signed ? getSMaxExpr(LS, RS) : getUMaxExpr(LS, RS); 5726 if (LA == RS && RA == LS) 5727 return Signed ? getSMinExpr(LS, RS) : getUMinExpr(LS, RS); 5728 } 5729 auto CoerceOperand = [&](const SCEV *Op) -> const SCEV * { 5730 if (Op->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 5731 Op = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(Op); 5732 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(Op)) 5733 return Op; 5734 } 5735 if (Signed) 5736 Op = getNoopOrSignExtend(Op, I->getType()); 5737 else 5738 Op = getNoopOrZeroExtend(Op, I->getType()); 5739 return Op; 5740 }; 5741 LS = CoerceOperand(LS); 5742 RS = CoerceOperand(RS); 5743 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(LS) || isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(RS)) 5744 break; 5745 const SCEV *LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, LS); 5746 const SCEV *RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, RS); 5747 if (LDiff == RDiff) 5748 return getAddExpr(Signed ? getSMaxExpr(LS, RS) : getUMaxExpr(LS, RS), 5749 LDiff); 5750 LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, RS); 5751 RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, LS); 5752 if (LDiff == RDiff) 5753 return getAddExpr(Signed ? getSMinExpr(LS, RS) : getUMinExpr(LS, RS), 5754 LDiff); 5755 } 5756 break; 5757 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: 5758 // n != 0 ? n+x : 1+x -> umax(n, 1)+x 5759 if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) <= getTypeSizeInBits(I->getType()) && 5760 isa<ConstantInt>(RHS) && cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)->isZero()) { 5761 const SCEV *One = getOne(I->getType()); 5762 const SCEV *LS = getNoopOrZeroExtend(getSCEV(LHS), I->getType()); 5763 const SCEV *LA = getSCEV(TrueVal); 5764 const SCEV *RA = getSCEV(FalseVal); 5765 const SCEV *LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, LS); 5766 const SCEV *RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, One); 5767 if (LDiff == RDiff) 5768 return getAddExpr(getUMaxExpr(One, LS), LDiff); 5769 } 5770 break; 5771 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: 5772 // n == 0 ? 1+x : n+x -> umax(n, 1)+x 5773 if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) <= getTypeSizeInBits(I->getType()) && 5774 isa<ConstantInt>(RHS) && cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)->isZero()) { 5775 const SCEV *One = getOne(I->getType()); 5776 const SCEV *LS = getNoopOrZeroExtend(getSCEV(LHS), I->getType()); 5777 const SCEV *LA = getSCEV(TrueVal); 5778 const SCEV *RA = getSCEV(FalseVal); 5779 const SCEV *LDiff = getMinusSCEV(LA, One); 5780 const SCEV *RDiff = getMinusSCEV(RA, LS); 5781 if (LDiff == RDiff) 5782 return getAddExpr(getUMaxExpr(One, LS), LDiff); 5783 } 5784 break; 5785 default: 5786 break; 5787 } 5788 5789 return getUnknown(I); 5790 } 5791 5792 /// Expand GEP instructions into add and multiply operations. This allows them 5793 /// to be analyzed by regular SCEV code. 5794 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createNodeForGEP(GEPOperator *GEP) { 5795 // Don't attempt to analyze GEPs over unsized objects. 5796 if (!GEP->getSourceElementType()->isSized()) 5797 return getUnknown(GEP); 5798 5799 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> IndexExprs; 5800 for (Value *Index : GEP->indices()) 5801 IndexExprs.push_back(getSCEV(Index)); 5802 return getGEPExpr(GEP, IndexExprs); 5803 } 5804 5805 uint32_t ScalarEvolution::GetMinTrailingZerosImpl(const SCEV *S) { 5806 if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(S)) 5807 return C->getAPInt().countTrailingZeros(); 5808 5809 if (const SCEVPtrToIntExpr *I = dyn_cast<SCEVPtrToIntExpr>(S)) 5810 return GetMinTrailingZeros(I->getOperand()); 5811 5812 if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *T = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(S)) 5813 return std::min(GetMinTrailingZeros(T->getOperand()), 5814 (uint32_t)getTypeSizeInBits(T->getType())); 5815 5816 if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *E = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(S)) { 5817 uint32_t OpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(E->getOperand()); 5818 return OpRes == getTypeSizeInBits(E->getOperand()->getType()) 5819 ? getTypeSizeInBits(E->getType()) 5820 : OpRes; 5821 } 5822 5823 if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *E = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(S)) { 5824 uint32_t OpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(E->getOperand()); 5825 return OpRes == getTypeSizeInBits(E->getOperand()->getType()) 5826 ? getTypeSizeInBits(E->getType()) 5827 : OpRes; 5828 } 5829 5830 if (const SCEVAddExpr *A = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(S)) { 5831 // The result is the min of all operands results. 5832 uint32_t MinOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(A->getOperand(0)); 5833 for (unsigned i = 1, e = A->getNumOperands(); MinOpRes && i != e; ++i) 5834 MinOpRes = std::min(MinOpRes, GetMinTrailingZeros(A->getOperand(i))); 5835 return MinOpRes; 5836 } 5837 5838 if (const SCEVMulExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(S)) { 5839 // The result is the sum of all operands results. 5840 uint32_t SumOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(0)); 5841 uint32_t BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(M->getType()); 5842 for (unsigned i = 1, e = M->getNumOperands(); 5843 SumOpRes != BitWidth && i != e; ++i) 5844 SumOpRes = 5845 std::min(SumOpRes + GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(i)), BitWidth); 5846 return SumOpRes; 5847 } 5848 5849 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *A = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)) { 5850 // The result is the min of all operands results. 5851 uint32_t MinOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(A->getOperand(0)); 5852 for (unsigned i = 1, e = A->getNumOperands(); MinOpRes && i != e; ++i) 5853 MinOpRes = std::min(MinOpRes, GetMinTrailingZeros(A->getOperand(i))); 5854 return MinOpRes; 5855 } 5856 5857 if (const SCEVSMaxExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVSMaxExpr>(S)) { 5858 // The result is the min of all operands results. 5859 uint32_t MinOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(0)); 5860 for (unsigned i = 1, e = M->getNumOperands(); MinOpRes && i != e; ++i) 5861 MinOpRes = std::min(MinOpRes, GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(i))); 5862 return MinOpRes; 5863 } 5864 5865 if (const SCEVUMaxExpr *M = dyn_cast<SCEVUMaxExpr>(S)) { 5866 // The result is the min of all operands results. 5867 uint32_t MinOpRes = GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(0)); 5868 for (unsigned i = 1, e = M->getNumOperands(); MinOpRes && i != e; ++i) 5869 MinOpRes = std::min(MinOpRes, GetMinTrailingZeros(M->getOperand(i))); 5870 return MinOpRes; 5871 } 5872 5873 if (const SCEVUnknown *U = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)) { 5874 // For a SCEVUnknown, ask ValueTracking. 5875 KnownBits Known = computeKnownBits(U->getValue(), getDataLayout(), 0, &AC, nullptr, &DT); 5876 return Known.countMinTrailingZeros(); 5877 } 5878 5879 // SCEVUDivExpr 5880 return 0; 5881 } 5882 5883 uint32_t ScalarEvolution::GetMinTrailingZeros(const SCEV *S) { 5884 auto I = MinTrailingZerosCache.find(S); 5885 if (I != MinTrailingZerosCache.end()) 5886 return I->second; 5887 5888 uint32_t Result = GetMinTrailingZerosImpl(S); 5889 auto InsertPair = MinTrailingZerosCache.insert({S, Result}); 5890 assert(InsertPair.second && "Should insert a new key"); 5891 return InsertPair.first->second; 5892 } 5893 5894 /// Helper method to assign a range to V from metadata present in the IR. 5895 static Optional<ConstantRange> GetRangeFromMetadata(Value *V) { 5896 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) 5897 if (MDNode *MD = I->getMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_range)) 5898 return getConstantRangeFromMetadata(*MD); 5899 5900 return None; 5901 } 5902 5903 void ScalarEvolution::setNoWrapFlags(SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec, 5904 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags) { 5905 if (AddRec->getNoWrapFlags(Flags) != Flags) { 5906 AddRec->setNoWrapFlags(Flags); 5907 UnsignedRanges.erase(AddRec); 5908 SignedRanges.erase(AddRec); 5909 } 5910 } 5911 5912 ConstantRange ScalarEvolution:: 5913 getRangeForUnknownRecurrence(const SCEVUnknown *U) { 5914 const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout(); 5915 5916 unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(U->getType()); 5917 const ConstantRange FullSet(BitWidth, /*isFullSet=*/true); 5918 5919 // Match a simple recurrence of the form: <start, ShiftOp, Step>, and then 5920 // use information about the trip count to improve our available range. Note 5921 // that the trip count independent cases are already handled by known bits. 5922 // WARNING: The definition of recurrence used here is subtly different than 5923 // the one used by AddRec (and thus most of this file). Step is allowed to 5924 // be arbitrarily loop varying here, where AddRec allows only loop invariant 5925 // and other addrecs in the same loop (for non-affine addrecs). The code 5926 // below intentionally handles the case where step is not loop invariant. 5927 auto *P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(U->getValue()); 5928 if (!P) 5929 return FullSet; 5930 5931 // Make sure that no Phi input comes from an unreachable block. Otherwise, 5932 // even the values that are not available in these blocks may come from them, 5933 // and this leads to false-positive recurrence test. 5934 for (auto *Pred : predecessors(P->getParent())) 5935 if (!DT.isReachableFromEntry(Pred)) 5936 return FullSet; 5937 5938 BinaryOperator *BO; 5939 Value *Start, *Step; 5940 if (!matchSimpleRecurrence(P, BO, Start, Step)) 5941 return FullSet; 5942 5943 // If we found a recurrence in reachable code, we must be in a loop. Note 5944 // that BO might be in some subloop of L, and that's completely okay. 5945 auto *L = LI.getLoopFor(P->getParent()); 5946 assert(L && L->getHeader() == P->getParent()); 5947 if (!L->contains(BO->getParent())) 5948 // NOTE: This bailout should be an assert instead. However, asserting 5949 // the condition here exposes a case where LoopFusion is querying SCEV 5950 // with malformed loop information during the midst of the transform. 5951 // There doesn't appear to be an obvious fix, so for the moment bailout 5952 // until the caller issue can be fixed. PR49566 tracks the bug. 5953 return FullSet; 5954 5955 // TODO: Extend to other opcodes such as mul, and div 5956 switch (BO->getOpcode()) { 5957 default: 5958 return FullSet; 5959 case Instruction::AShr: 5960 case Instruction::LShr: 5961 case Instruction::Shl: 5962 break; 5963 }; 5964 5965 if (BO->getOperand(0) != P) 5966 // TODO: Handle the power function forms some day. 5967 return FullSet; 5968 5969 unsigned TC = getSmallConstantMaxTripCount(L); 5970 if (!TC || TC >= BitWidth) 5971 return FullSet; 5972 5973 auto KnownStart = computeKnownBits(Start, DL, 0, &AC, nullptr, &DT); 5974 auto KnownStep = computeKnownBits(Step, DL, 0, &AC, nullptr, &DT); 5975 assert(KnownStart.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && 5976 KnownStep.getBitWidth() == BitWidth); 5977 5978 // Compute total shift amount, being careful of overflow and bitwidths. 5979 auto MaxShiftAmt = KnownStep.getMaxValue(); 5980 APInt TCAP(BitWidth, TC-1); 5981 bool Overflow = false; 5982 auto TotalShift = MaxShiftAmt.umul_ov(TCAP, Overflow); 5983 if (Overflow) 5984 return FullSet; 5985 5986 switch (BO->getOpcode()) { 5987 default: 5988 llvm_unreachable("filtered out above"); 5989 case Instruction::AShr: { 5990 // For each ashr, three cases: 5991 // shift = 0 => unchanged value 5992 // saturation => 0 or -1 5993 // other => a value closer to zero (of the same sign) 5994 // Thus, the end value is closer to zero than the start. 5995 auto KnownEnd = KnownBits::ashr(KnownStart, 5996 KnownBits::makeConstant(TotalShift)); 5997 if (KnownStart.isNonNegative()) 5998 // Analogous to lshr (simply not yet canonicalized) 5999 return ConstantRange::getNonEmpty(KnownEnd.getMinValue(), 6000 KnownStart.getMaxValue() + 1); 6001 if (KnownStart.isNegative()) 6002 // End >=u Start && End <=s Start 6003 return ConstantRange::getNonEmpty(KnownStart.getMinValue(), 6004 KnownEnd.getMaxValue() + 1); 6005 break; 6006 } 6007 case Instruction::LShr: { 6008 // For each lshr, three cases: 6009 // shift = 0 => unchanged value 6010 // saturation => 0 6011 // other => a smaller positive number 6012 // Thus, the low end of the unsigned range is the last value produced. 6013 auto KnownEnd = KnownBits::lshr(KnownStart, 6014 KnownBits::makeConstant(TotalShift)); 6015 return ConstantRange::getNonEmpty(KnownEnd.getMinValue(), 6016 KnownStart.getMaxValue() + 1); 6017 } 6018 case Instruction::Shl: { 6019 // Iff no bits are shifted out, value increases on every shift. 6020 auto KnownEnd = KnownBits::shl(KnownStart, 6021 KnownBits::makeConstant(TotalShift)); 6022 if (TotalShift.ult(KnownStart.countMinLeadingZeros())) 6023 return ConstantRange(KnownStart.getMinValue(), 6024 KnownEnd.getMaxValue() + 1); 6025 break; 6026 } 6027 }; 6028 return FullSet; 6029 } 6030 6031 /// Determine the range for a particular SCEV. If SignHint is 6032 /// HINT_RANGE_UNSIGNED (resp. HINT_RANGE_SIGNED) then getRange prefers ranges 6033 /// with a "cleaner" unsigned (resp. signed) representation. 6034 const ConstantRange & 6035 ScalarEvolution::getRangeRef(const SCEV *S, 6036 ScalarEvolution::RangeSignHint SignHint) { 6037 DenseMap<const SCEV *, ConstantRange> &Cache = 6038 SignHint == ScalarEvolution::HINT_RANGE_UNSIGNED ? UnsignedRanges 6039 : SignedRanges; 6040 ConstantRange::PreferredRangeType RangeType = 6041 SignHint == ScalarEvolution::HINT_RANGE_UNSIGNED 6042 ? ConstantRange::Unsigned : ConstantRange::Signed; 6043 6044 // See if we've computed this range already. 6045 DenseMap<const SCEV *, ConstantRange>::iterator I = Cache.find(S); 6046 if (I != Cache.end()) 6047 return I->second; 6048 6049 if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(S)) 6050 return setRange(C, SignHint, ConstantRange(C->getAPInt())); 6051 6052 unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(S->getType()); 6053 ConstantRange ConservativeResult(BitWidth, /*isFullSet=*/true); 6054 using OBO = OverflowingBinaryOperator; 6055 6056 // If the value has known zeros, the maximum value will have those known zeros 6057 // as well. 6058 uint32_t TZ = GetMinTrailingZeros(S); 6059 if (TZ != 0) { 6060 if (SignHint == ScalarEvolution::HINT_RANGE_UNSIGNED) 6061 ConservativeResult = 6062 ConstantRange(APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth), 6063 APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth).lshr(TZ).shl(TZ) + 1); 6064 else 6065 ConservativeResult = ConstantRange( 6066 APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth), 6067 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth).ashr(TZ).shl(TZ) + 1); 6068 } 6069 6070 if (const SCEVAddExpr *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(S)) { 6071 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(Add->getOperand(0), SignHint); 6072 unsigned WrapType = OBO::AnyWrap; 6073 if (Add->hasNoSignedWrap()) 6074 WrapType |= OBO::NoSignedWrap; 6075 if (Add->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) 6076 WrapType |= OBO::NoUnsignedWrap; 6077 for (unsigned i = 1, e = Add->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 6078 X = X.addWithNoWrap(getRangeRef(Add->getOperand(i), SignHint), 6079 WrapType, RangeType); 6080 return setRange(Add, SignHint, 6081 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X, RangeType)); 6082 } 6083 6084 if (const SCEVMulExpr *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(S)) { 6085 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(Mul->getOperand(0), SignHint); 6086 for (unsigned i = 1, e = Mul->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 6087 X = X.multiply(getRangeRef(Mul->getOperand(i), SignHint)); 6088 return setRange(Mul, SignHint, 6089 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X, RangeType)); 6090 } 6091 6092 if (const SCEVSMaxExpr *SMax = dyn_cast<SCEVSMaxExpr>(S)) { 6093 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(SMax->getOperand(0), SignHint); 6094 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SMax->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 6095 X = X.smax(getRangeRef(SMax->getOperand(i), SignHint)); 6096 return setRange(SMax, SignHint, 6097 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X, RangeType)); 6098 } 6099 6100 if (const SCEVUMaxExpr *UMax = dyn_cast<SCEVUMaxExpr>(S)) { 6101 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(UMax->getOperand(0), SignHint); 6102 for (unsigned i = 1, e = UMax->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 6103 X = X.umax(getRangeRef(UMax->getOperand(i), SignHint)); 6104 return setRange(UMax, SignHint, 6105 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X, RangeType)); 6106 } 6107 6108 if (const SCEVSMinExpr *SMin = dyn_cast<SCEVSMinExpr>(S)) { 6109 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(SMin->getOperand(0), SignHint); 6110 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SMin->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 6111 X = X.smin(getRangeRef(SMin->getOperand(i), SignHint)); 6112 return setRange(SMin, SignHint, 6113 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X, RangeType)); 6114 } 6115 6116 if (const SCEVUMinExpr *UMin = dyn_cast<SCEVUMinExpr>(S)) { 6117 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(UMin->getOperand(0), SignHint); 6118 for (unsigned i = 1, e = UMin->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) 6119 X = X.umin(getRangeRef(UMin->getOperand(i), SignHint)); 6120 return setRange(UMin, SignHint, 6121 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X, RangeType)); 6122 } 6123 6124 if (const SCEVUDivExpr *UDiv = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(S)) { 6125 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(UDiv->getLHS(), SignHint); 6126 ConstantRange Y = getRangeRef(UDiv->getRHS(), SignHint); 6127 return setRange(UDiv, SignHint, 6128 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X.udiv(Y), RangeType)); 6129 } 6130 6131 if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(S)) { 6132 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(ZExt->getOperand(), SignHint); 6133 return setRange(ZExt, SignHint, 6134 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X.zeroExtend(BitWidth), 6135 RangeType)); 6136 } 6137 6138 if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(S)) { 6139 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(SExt->getOperand(), SignHint); 6140 return setRange(SExt, SignHint, 6141 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X.signExtend(BitWidth), 6142 RangeType)); 6143 } 6144 6145 if (const SCEVPtrToIntExpr *PtrToInt = dyn_cast<SCEVPtrToIntExpr>(S)) { 6146 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(PtrToInt->getOperand(), SignHint); 6147 return setRange(PtrToInt, SignHint, X); 6148 } 6149 6150 if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *Trunc = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(S)) { 6151 ConstantRange X = getRangeRef(Trunc->getOperand(), SignHint); 6152 return setRange(Trunc, SignHint, 6153 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(X.truncate(BitWidth), 6154 RangeType)); 6155 } 6156 6157 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)) { 6158 // If there's no unsigned wrap, the value will never be less than its 6159 // initial value. 6160 if (AddRec->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) { 6161 APInt UnsignedMinValue = getUnsignedRangeMin(AddRec->getStart()); 6162 if (!UnsignedMinValue.isZero()) 6163 ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith( 6164 ConstantRange(UnsignedMinValue, APInt(BitWidth, 0)), RangeType); 6165 } 6166 6167 // If there's no signed wrap, and all the operands except initial value have 6168 // the same sign or zero, the value won't ever be: 6169 // 1: smaller than initial value if operands are non negative, 6170 // 2: bigger than initial value if operands are non positive. 6171 // For both cases, value can not cross signed min/max boundary. 6172 if (AddRec->hasNoSignedWrap()) { 6173 bool AllNonNeg = true; 6174 bool AllNonPos = true; 6175 for (unsigned i = 1, e = AddRec->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) { 6176 if (!isKnownNonNegative(AddRec->getOperand(i))) 6177 AllNonNeg = false; 6178 if (!isKnownNonPositive(AddRec->getOperand(i))) 6179 AllNonPos = false; 6180 } 6181 if (AllNonNeg) 6182 ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith( 6183 ConstantRange::getNonEmpty(getSignedRangeMin(AddRec->getStart()), 6184 APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth)), 6185 RangeType); 6186 else if (AllNonPos) 6187 ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith( 6188 ConstantRange::getNonEmpty( 6189 APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth), 6190 getSignedRangeMax(AddRec->getStart()) + 1), 6191 RangeType); 6192 } 6193 6194 // TODO: non-affine addrec 6195 if (AddRec->isAffine()) { 6196 const SCEV *MaxBECount = getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount(AddRec->getLoop()); 6197 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) && 6198 getTypeSizeInBits(MaxBECount->getType()) <= BitWidth) { 6199 auto RangeFromAffine = getRangeForAffineAR( 6200 AddRec->getStart(), AddRec->getStepRecurrence(*this), MaxBECount, 6201 BitWidth); 6202 ConservativeResult = 6203 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(RangeFromAffine, RangeType); 6204 6205 auto RangeFromFactoring = getRangeViaFactoring( 6206 AddRec->getStart(), AddRec->getStepRecurrence(*this), MaxBECount, 6207 BitWidth); 6208 ConservativeResult = 6209 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(RangeFromFactoring, RangeType); 6210 } 6211 6212 // Now try symbolic BE count and more powerful methods. 6213 if (UseExpensiveRangeSharpening) { 6214 const SCEV *SymbolicMaxBECount = 6215 getSymbolicMaxBackedgeTakenCount(AddRec->getLoop()); 6216 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(SymbolicMaxBECount) && 6217 getTypeSizeInBits(MaxBECount->getType()) <= BitWidth && 6218 AddRec->hasNoSelfWrap()) { 6219 auto RangeFromAffineNew = getRangeForAffineNoSelfWrappingAR( 6220 AddRec, SymbolicMaxBECount, BitWidth, SignHint); 6221 ConservativeResult = 6222 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(RangeFromAffineNew, RangeType); 6223 } 6224 } 6225 } 6226 6227 return setRange(AddRec, SignHint, std::move(ConservativeResult)); 6228 } 6229 6230 if (const SCEVUnknown *U = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)) { 6231 6232 // Check if the IR explicitly contains !range metadata. 6233 Optional<ConstantRange> MDRange = GetRangeFromMetadata(U->getValue()); 6234 if (MDRange.hasValue()) 6235 ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith(MDRange.getValue(), 6236 RangeType); 6237 6238 // Use facts about recurrences in the underlying IR. Note that add 6239 // recurrences are AddRecExprs and thus don't hit this path. This 6240 // primarily handles shift recurrences. 6241 auto CR = getRangeForUnknownRecurrence(U); 6242 ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith(CR); 6243 6244 // See if ValueTracking can give us a useful range. 6245 const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout(); 6246 KnownBits Known = computeKnownBits(U->getValue(), DL, 0, &AC, nullptr, &DT); 6247 if (Known.getBitWidth() != BitWidth) 6248 Known = Known.zextOrTrunc(BitWidth); 6249 6250 // ValueTracking may be able to compute a tighter result for the number of 6251 // sign bits than for the value of those sign bits. 6252 unsigned NS = ComputeNumSignBits(U->getValue(), DL, 0, &AC, nullptr, &DT); 6253 if (U->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 6254 // If the pointer size is larger than the index size type, this can cause 6255 // NS to be larger than BitWidth. So compensate for this. 6256 unsigned ptrSize = DL.getPointerTypeSizeInBits(U->getType()); 6257 int ptrIdxDiff = ptrSize - BitWidth; 6258 if (ptrIdxDiff > 0 && ptrSize > BitWidth && NS > (unsigned)ptrIdxDiff) 6259 NS -= ptrIdxDiff; 6260 } 6261 6262 if (NS > 1) { 6263 // If we know any of the sign bits, we know all of the sign bits. 6264 if (!Known.Zero.getHiBits(NS).isZero()) 6265 Known.Zero.setHighBits(NS); 6266 if (!Known.One.getHiBits(NS).isZero()) 6267 Known.One.setHighBits(NS); 6268 } 6269 6270 if (Known.getMinValue() != Known.getMaxValue() + 1) 6271 ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith( 6272 ConstantRange(Known.getMinValue(), Known.getMaxValue() + 1), 6273 RangeType); 6274 if (NS > 1) 6275 ConservativeResult = ConservativeResult.intersectWith( 6276 ConstantRange(APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth).ashr(NS - 1), 6277 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth).ashr(NS - 1) + 1), 6278 RangeType); 6279 6280 // A range of Phi is a subset of union of all ranges of its input. 6281 if (const PHINode *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(U->getValue())) { 6282 // Make sure that we do not run over cycled Phis. 6283 if (PendingPhiRanges.insert(Phi).second) { 6284 ConstantRange RangeFromOps(BitWidth, /*isFullSet=*/false); 6285 for (auto &Op : Phi->operands()) { 6286 auto OpRange = getRangeRef(getSCEV(Op), SignHint); 6287 RangeFromOps = RangeFromOps.unionWith(OpRange); 6288 // No point to continue if we already have a full set. 6289 if (RangeFromOps.isFullSet()) 6290 break; 6291 } 6292 ConservativeResult = 6293 ConservativeResult.intersectWith(RangeFromOps, RangeType); 6294 bool Erased = PendingPhiRanges.erase(Phi); 6295 assert(Erased && "Failed to erase Phi properly?"); 6296 (void) Erased; 6297 } 6298 } 6299 6300 return setRange(U, SignHint, std::move(ConservativeResult)); 6301 } 6302 6303 return setRange(S, SignHint, std::move(ConservativeResult)); 6304 } 6305 6306 // Given a StartRange, Step and MaxBECount for an expression compute a range of 6307 // values that the expression can take. Initially, the expression has a value 6308 // from StartRange and then is changed by Step up to MaxBECount times. Signed 6309 // argument defines if we treat Step as signed or unsigned. 6310 static ConstantRange getRangeForAffineARHelper(APInt Step, 6311 const ConstantRange &StartRange, 6312 const APInt &MaxBECount, 6313 unsigned BitWidth, bool Signed) { 6314 // If either Step or MaxBECount is 0, then the expression won't change, and we 6315 // just need to return the initial range. 6316 if (Step == 0 || MaxBECount == 0) 6317 return StartRange; 6318 6319 // If we don't know anything about the initial value (i.e. StartRange is 6320 // FullRange), then we don't know anything about the final range either. 6321 // Return FullRange. 6322 if (StartRange.isFullSet()) 6323 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6324 6325 // If Step is signed and negative, then we use its absolute value, but we also 6326 // note that we're moving in the opposite direction. 6327 bool Descending = Signed && Step.isNegative(); 6328 6329 if (Signed) 6330 // This is correct even for INT_SMIN. Let's look at i8 to illustrate this: 6331 // abs(INT_SMIN) = abs(-128) = abs(0x80) = -0x80 = 0x80 = 128. 6332 // This equations hold true due to the well-defined wrap-around behavior of 6333 // APInt. 6334 Step = Step.abs(); 6335 6336 // Check if Offset is more than full span of BitWidth. If it is, the 6337 // expression is guaranteed to overflow. 6338 if (APInt::getMaxValue(StartRange.getBitWidth()).udiv(Step).ult(MaxBECount)) 6339 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6340 6341 // Offset is by how much the expression can change. Checks above guarantee no 6342 // overflow here. 6343 APInt Offset = Step * MaxBECount; 6344 6345 // Minimum value of the final range will match the minimal value of StartRange 6346 // if the expression is increasing and will be decreased by Offset otherwise. 6347 // Maximum value of the final range will match the maximal value of StartRange 6348 // if the expression is decreasing and will be increased by Offset otherwise. 6349 APInt StartLower = StartRange.getLower(); 6350 APInt StartUpper = StartRange.getUpper() - 1; 6351 APInt MovedBoundary = Descending ? (StartLower - std::move(Offset)) 6352 : (StartUpper + std::move(Offset)); 6353 6354 // It's possible that the new minimum/maximum value will fall into the initial 6355 // range (due to wrap around). This means that the expression can take any 6356 // value in this bitwidth, and we have to return full range. 6357 if (StartRange.contains(MovedBoundary)) 6358 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6359 6360 APInt NewLower = 6361 Descending ? std::move(MovedBoundary) : std::move(StartLower); 6362 APInt NewUpper = 6363 Descending ? std::move(StartUpper) : std::move(MovedBoundary); 6364 NewUpper += 1; 6365 6366 // No overflow detected, return [StartLower, StartUpper + Offset + 1) range. 6367 return ConstantRange::getNonEmpty(std::move(NewLower), std::move(NewUpper)); 6368 } 6369 6370 ConstantRange ScalarEvolution::getRangeForAffineAR(const SCEV *Start, 6371 const SCEV *Step, 6372 const SCEV *MaxBECount, 6373 unsigned BitWidth) { 6374 assert(!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) && 6375 getTypeSizeInBits(MaxBECount->getType()) <= BitWidth && 6376 "Precondition!"); 6377 6378 MaxBECount = getNoopOrZeroExtend(MaxBECount, Start->getType()); 6379 APInt MaxBECountValue = getUnsignedRangeMax(MaxBECount); 6380 6381 // First, consider step signed. 6382 ConstantRange StartSRange = getSignedRange(Start); 6383 ConstantRange StepSRange = getSignedRange(Step); 6384 6385 // If Step can be both positive and negative, we need to find ranges for the 6386 // maximum absolute step values in both directions and union them. 6387 ConstantRange SR = 6388 getRangeForAffineARHelper(StepSRange.getSignedMin(), StartSRange, 6389 MaxBECountValue, BitWidth, /* Signed = */ true); 6390 SR = SR.unionWith(getRangeForAffineARHelper(StepSRange.getSignedMax(), 6391 StartSRange, MaxBECountValue, 6392 BitWidth, /* Signed = */ true)); 6393 6394 // Next, consider step unsigned. 6395 ConstantRange UR = getRangeForAffineARHelper( 6396 getUnsignedRangeMax(Step), getUnsignedRange(Start), 6397 MaxBECountValue, BitWidth, /* Signed = */ false); 6398 6399 // Finally, intersect signed and unsigned ranges. 6400 return SR.intersectWith(UR, ConstantRange::Smallest); 6401 } 6402 6403 ConstantRange ScalarEvolution::getRangeForAffineNoSelfWrappingAR( 6404 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec, const SCEV *MaxBECount, unsigned BitWidth, 6405 ScalarEvolution::RangeSignHint SignHint) { 6406 assert(AddRec->isAffine() && "Non-affine AddRecs are not suppored!\n"); 6407 assert(AddRec->hasNoSelfWrap() && 6408 "This only works for non-self-wrapping AddRecs!"); 6409 const bool IsSigned = SignHint == HINT_RANGE_SIGNED; 6410 const SCEV *Step = AddRec->getStepRecurrence(*this); 6411 // Only deal with constant step to save compile time. 6412 if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(Step)) 6413 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6414 // Let's make sure that we can prove that we do not self-wrap during 6415 // MaxBECount iterations. We need this because MaxBECount is a maximum 6416 // iteration count estimate, and we might infer nw from some exit for which we 6417 // do not know max exit count (or any other side reasoning). 6418 // TODO: Turn into assert at some point. 6419 if (getTypeSizeInBits(MaxBECount->getType()) > 6420 getTypeSizeInBits(AddRec->getType())) 6421 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6422 MaxBECount = getNoopOrZeroExtend(MaxBECount, AddRec->getType()); 6423 const SCEV *RangeWidth = getMinusOne(AddRec->getType()); 6424 const SCEV *StepAbs = getUMinExpr(Step, getNegativeSCEV(Step)); 6425 const SCEV *MaxItersWithoutWrap = getUDivExpr(RangeWidth, StepAbs); 6426 if (!isKnownPredicateViaConstantRanges(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, MaxBECount, 6427 MaxItersWithoutWrap)) 6428 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6429 6430 ICmpInst::Predicate LEPred = 6431 IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE; 6432 ICmpInst::Predicate GEPred = 6433 IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE; 6434 const SCEV *End = AddRec->evaluateAtIteration(MaxBECount, *this); 6435 6436 // We know that there is no self-wrap. Let's take Start and End values and 6437 // look at all intermediate values V1, V2, ..., Vn that IndVar takes during 6438 // the iteration. They either lie inside the range [Min(Start, End), 6439 // Max(Start, End)] or outside it: 6440 // 6441 // Case 1: RangeMin ... Start V1 ... VN End ... RangeMax; 6442 // Case 2: RangeMin Vk ... V1 Start ... End Vn ... Vk + 1 RangeMax; 6443 // 6444 // No self wrap flag guarantees that the intermediate values cannot be BOTH 6445 // outside and inside the range [Min(Start, End), Max(Start, End)]. Using that 6446 // knowledge, let's try to prove that we are dealing with Case 1. It is so if 6447 // Start <= End and step is positive, or Start >= End and step is negative. 6448 const SCEV *Start = AddRec->getStart(); 6449 ConstantRange StartRange = getRangeRef(Start, SignHint); 6450 ConstantRange EndRange = getRangeRef(End, SignHint); 6451 ConstantRange RangeBetween = StartRange.unionWith(EndRange); 6452 // If they already cover full iteration space, we will know nothing useful 6453 // even if we prove what we want to prove. 6454 if (RangeBetween.isFullSet()) 6455 return RangeBetween; 6456 // Only deal with ranges that do not wrap (i.e. RangeMin < RangeMax). 6457 bool IsWrappedSet = IsSigned ? RangeBetween.isSignWrappedSet() 6458 : RangeBetween.isWrappedSet(); 6459 if (IsWrappedSet) 6460 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6461 6462 if (isKnownPositive(Step) && 6463 isKnownPredicateViaConstantRanges(LEPred, Start, End)) 6464 return RangeBetween; 6465 else if (isKnownNegative(Step) && 6466 isKnownPredicateViaConstantRanges(GEPred, Start, End)) 6467 return RangeBetween; 6468 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6469 } 6470 6471 ConstantRange ScalarEvolution::getRangeViaFactoring(const SCEV *Start, 6472 const SCEV *Step, 6473 const SCEV *MaxBECount, 6474 unsigned BitWidth) { 6475 // RangeOf({C?A:B,+,C?P:Q}) == RangeOf(C?{A,+,P}:{B,+,Q}) 6476 // == RangeOf({A,+,P}) union RangeOf({B,+,Q}) 6477 6478 struct SelectPattern { 6479 Value *Condition = nullptr; 6480 APInt TrueValue; 6481 APInt FalseValue; 6482 6483 explicit SelectPattern(ScalarEvolution &SE, unsigned BitWidth, 6484 const SCEV *S) { 6485 Optional<unsigned> CastOp; 6486 APInt Offset(BitWidth, 0); 6487 6488 assert(SE.getTypeSizeInBits(S->getType()) == BitWidth && 6489 "Should be!"); 6490 6491 // Peel off a constant offset: 6492 if (auto *SA = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(S)) { 6493 // In the future we could consider being smarter here and handle 6494 // {Start+Step,+,Step} too. 6495 if (SA->getNumOperands() != 2 || !isa<SCEVConstant>(SA->getOperand(0))) 6496 return; 6497 6498 Offset = cast<SCEVConstant>(SA->getOperand(0))->getAPInt(); 6499 S = SA->getOperand(1); 6500 } 6501 6502 // Peel off a cast operation 6503 if (auto *SCast = dyn_cast<SCEVIntegralCastExpr>(S)) { 6504 CastOp = SCast->getSCEVType(); 6505 S = SCast->getOperand(); 6506 } 6507 6508 using namespace llvm::PatternMatch; 6509 6510 auto *SU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S); 6511 const APInt *TrueVal, *FalseVal; 6512 if (!SU || 6513 !match(SU->getValue(), m_Select(m_Value(Condition), m_APInt(TrueVal), 6514 m_APInt(FalseVal)))) { 6515 Condition = nullptr; 6516 return; 6517 } 6518 6519 TrueValue = *TrueVal; 6520 FalseValue = *FalseVal; 6521 6522 // Re-apply the cast we peeled off earlier 6523 if (CastOp.hasValue()) 6524 switch (*CastOp) { 6525 default: 6526 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV cast type!"); 6527 6528 case scTruncate: 6529 TrueValue = TrueValue.trunc(BitWidth); 6530 FalseValue = FalseValue.trunc(BitWidth); 6531 break; 6532 case scZeroExtend: 6533 TrueValue = TrueValue.zext(BitWidth); 6534 FalseValue = FalseValue.zext(BitWidth); 6535 break; 6536 case scSignExtend: 6537 TrueValue = TrueValue.sext(BitWidth); 6538 FalseValue = FalseValue.sext(BitWidth); 6539 break; 6540 } 6541 6542 // Re-apply the constant offset we peeled off earlier 6543 TrueValue += Offset; 6544 FalseValue += Offset; 6545 } 6546 6547 bool isRecognized() { return Condition != nullptr; } 6548 }; 6549 6550 SelectPattern StartPattern(*this, BitWidth, Start); 6551 if (!StartPattern.isRecognized()) 6552 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6553 6554 SelectPattern StepPattern(*this, BitWidth, Step); 6555 if (!StepPattern.isRecognized()) 6556 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6557 6558 if (StartPattern.Condition != StepPattern.Condition) { 6559 // We don't handle this case today; but we could, by considering four 6560 // possibilities below instead of two. I'm not sure if there are cases where 6561 // that will help over what getRange already does, though. 6562 return ConstantRange::getFull(BitWidth); 6563 } 6564 6565 // NB! Calling ScalarEvolution::getConstant is fine, but we should not try to 6566 // construct arbitrary general SCEV expressions here. This function is called 6567 // from deep in the call stack, and calling getSCEV (on a sext instruction, 6568 // say) can end up caching a suboptimal value. 6569 6570 // FIXME: without the explicit `this` receiver below, MSVC errors out with 6571 // C2352 and C2512 (otherwise it isn't needed). 6572 6573 const SCEV *TrueStart = this->getConstant(StartPattern.TrueValue); 6574 const SCEV *TrueStep = this->getConstant(StepPattern.TrueValue); 6575 const SCEV *FalseStart = this->getConstant(StartPattern.FalseValue); 6576 const SCEV *FalseStep = this->getConstant(StepPattern.FalseValue); 6577 6578 ConstantRange TrueRange = 6579 this->getRangeForAffineAR(TrueStart, TrueStep, MaxBECount, BitWidth); 6580 ConstantRange FalseRange = 6581 this->getRangeForAffineAR(FalseStart, FalseStep, MaxBECount, BitWidth); 6582 6583 return TrueRange.unionWith(FalseRange); 6584 } 6585 6586 SCEV::NoWrapFlags ScalarEvolution::getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(const Value *V) { 6587 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(V)) return SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 6588 const BinaryOperator *BinOp = cast<BinaryOperator>(V); 6589 6590 // Return early if there are no flags to propagate to the SCEV. 6591 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 6592 if (BinOp->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) 6593 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 6594 if (BinOp->hasNoSignedWrap()) 6595 Flags = ScalarEvolution::setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNSW); 6596 if (Flags == SCEV::FlagAnyWrap) 6597 return SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 6598 6599 return isSCEVExprNeverPoison(BinOp) ? Flags : SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 6600 } 6601 6602 const Instruction * 6603 ScalarEvolution::getNonTrivialDefiningScopeBound(const SCEV *S) { 6604 if (auto *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)) 6605 return &*AddRec->getLoop()->getHeader()->begin(); 6606 if (auto *U = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)) 6607 if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U->getValue())) 6608 return I; 6609 return nullptr; 6610 } 6611 6612 /// Fills \p Ops with unique operands of \p S, if it has operands. If not, 6613 /// \p Ops remains unmodified. 6614 static void collectUniqueOps(const SCEV *S, 6615 SmallVectorImpl<const SCEV *> &Ops) { 6616 SmallPtrSet<const SCEV *, 4> Unique; 6617 auto InsertUnique = [&](const SCEV *S) { 6618 if (Unique.insert(S).second) 6619 Ops.push_back(S); 6620 }; 6621 if (auto *S2 = dyn_cast<SCEVCastExpr>(S)) 6622 for (auto *Op : S2->operands()) 6623 InsertUnique(Op); 6624 else if (auto *S2 = dyn_cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(S)) 6625 for (auto *Op : S2->operands()) 6626 InsertUnique(Op); 6627 else if (auto *S2 = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(S)) 6628 for (auto *Op : S2->operands()) 6629 InsertUnique(Op); 6630 } 6631 6632 const Instruction * 6633 ScalarEvolution::getDefiningScopeBound(ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops, 6634 bool &Precise) { 6635 Precise = true; 6636 // Do a bounded search of the def relation of the requested SCEVs. 6637 SmallSet<const SCEV *, 16> Visited; 6638 SmallVector<const SCEV *> Worklist; 6639 auto pushOp = [&](const SCEV *S) { 6640 if (!Visited.insert(S).second) 6641 return; 6642 // Threshold of 30 here is arbitrary. 6643 if (Visited.size() > 30) { 6644 Precise = false; 6645 return; 6646 } 6647 Worklist.push_back(S); 6648 }; 6649 6650 for (auto *S : Ops) 6651 pushOp(S); 6652 6653 const Instruction *Bound = nullptr; 6654 while (!Worklist.empty()) { 6655 auto *S = Worklist.pop_back_val(); 6656 if (auto *DefI = getNonTrivialDefiningScopeBound(S)) { 6657 if (!Bound || DT.dominates(Bound, DefI)) 6658 Bound = DefI; 6659 } else { 6660 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops; 6661 collectUniqueOps(S, Ops); 6662 for (auto *Op : Ops) 6663 pushOp(Op); 6664 } 6665 } 6666 return Bound ? Bound : &*F.getEntryBlock().begin(); 6667 } 6668 6669 const Instruction * 6670 ScalarEvolution::getDefiningScopeBound(ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops) { 6671 bool Discard; 6672 return getDefiningScopeBound(Ops, Discard); 6673 } 6674 6675 bool ScalarEvolution::isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionTo(const Instruction *A, 6676 const Instruction *B) { 6677 if (A->getParent() == B->getParent() && 6678 isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionToSuccessor(A->getIterator(), 6679 B->getIterator())) 6680 return true; 6681 6682 auto *BLoop = LI.getLoopFor(B->getParent()); 6683 if (BLoop && BLoop->getHeader() == B->getParent() && 6684 BLoop->getLoopPreheader() == A->getParent() && 6685 isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionToSuccessor(A->getIterator(), 6686 A->getParent()->end()) && 6687 isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionToSuccessor(B->getParent()->begin(), 6688 B->getIterator())) 6689 return true; 6690 return false; 6691 } 6692 6693 6694 bool ScalarEvolution::isSCEVExprNeverPoison(const Instruction *I) { 6695 // Only proceed if we can prove that I does not yield poison. 6696 if (!programUndefinedIfPoison(I)) 6697 return false; 6698 6699 // At this point we know that if I is executed, then it does not wrap 6700 // according to at least one of NSW or NUW. If I is not executed, then we do 6701 // not know if the calculation that I represents would wrap. Multiple 6702 // instructions can map to the same SCEV. If we apply NSW or NUW from I to 6703 // the SCEV, we must guarantee no wrapping for that SCEV also when it is 6704 // derived from other instructions that map to the same SCEV. We cannot make 6705 // that guarantee for cases where I is not executed. So we need to find a 6706 // upper bound on the defining scope for the SCEV, and prove that I is 6707 // executed every time we enter that scope. When the bounding scope is a 6708 // loop (the common case), this is equivalent to proving I executes on every 6709 // iteration of that loop. 6710 SmallVector<const SCEV *> SCEVOps; 6711 for (const Use &Op : I->operands()) { 6712 // I could be an extractvalue from a call to an overflow intrinsic. 6713 // TODO: We can do better here in some cases. 6714 if (isSCEVable(Op->getType())) 6715 SCEVOps.push_back(getSCEV(Op)); 6716 } 6717 auto *DefI = getDefiningScopeBound(SCEVOps); 6718 return isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionTo(DefI, I); 6719 } 6720 6721 bool ScalarEvolution::isAddRecNeverPoison(const Instruction *I, const Loop *L) { 6722 // If we know that \c I can never be poison period, then that's enough. 6723 if (isSCEVExprNeverPoison(I)) 6724 return true; 6725 6726 // For an add recurrence specifically, we assume that infinite loops without 6727 // side effects are undefined behavior, and then reason as follows: 6728 // 6729 // If the add recurrence is poison in any iteration, it is poison on all 6730 // future iterations (since incrementing poison yields poison). If the result 6731 // of the add recurrence is fed into the loop latch condition and the loop 6732 // does not contain any throws or exiting blocks other than the latch, we now 6733 // have the ability to "choose" whether the backedge is taken or not (by 6734 // choosing a sufficiently evil value for the poison feeding into the branch) 6735 // for every iteration including and after the one in which \p I first became 6736 // poison. There are two possibilities (let's call the iteration in which \p 6737 // I first became poison as K): 6738 // 6739 // 1. In the set of iterations including and after K, the loop body executes 6740 // no side effects. In this case executing the backege an infinte number 6741 // of times will yield undefined behavior. 6742 // 6743 // 2. In the set of iterations including and after K, the loop body executes 6744 // at least one side effect. In this case, that specific instance of side 6745 // effect is control dependent on poison, which also yields undefined 6746 // behavior. 6747 6748 auto *ExitingBB = L->getExitingBlock(); 6749 auto *LatchBB = L->getLoopLatch(); 6750 if (!ExitingBB || !LatchBB || ExitingBB != LatchBB) 6751 return false; 6752 6753 SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *, 16> Pushed; 6754 SmallVector<const Instruction *, 8> PoisonStack; 6755 6756 // We start by assuming \c I, the post-inc add recurrence, is poison. Only 6757 // things that are known to be poison under that assumption go on the 6758 // PoisonStack. 6759 Pushed.insert(I); 6760 PoisonStack.push_back(I); 6761 6762 bool LatchControlDependentOnPoison = false; 6763 while (!PoisonStack.empty() && !LatchControlDependentOnPoison) { 6764 const Instruction *Poison = PoisonStack.pop_back_val(); 6765 6766 for (auto *PoisonUser : Poison->users()) { 6767 if (propagatesPoison(cast<Operator>(PoisonUser))) { 6768 if (Pushed.insert(cast<Instruction>(PoisonUser)).second) 6769 PoisonStack.push_back(cast<Instruction>(PoisonUser)); 6770 } else if (auto *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(PoisonUser)) { 6771 assert(BI->isConditional() && "Only possibility!"); 6772 if (BI->getParent() == LatchBB) { 6773 LatchControlDependentOnPoison = true; 6774 break; 6775 } 6776 } 6777 } 6778 } 6779 6780 return LatchControlDependentOnPoison && loopHasNoAbnormalExits(L); 6781 } 6782 6783 ScalarEvolution::LoopProperties 6784 ScalarEvolution::getLoopProperties(const Loop *L) { 6785 using LoopProperties = ScalarEvolution::LoopProperties; 6786 6787 auto Itr = LoopPropertiesCache.find(L); 6788 if (Itr == LoopPropertiesCache.end()) { 6789 auto HasSideEffects = [](Instruction *I) { 6790 if (auto *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(I)) 6791 return !SI->isSimple(); 6792 6793 return I->mayThrow() || I->mayWriteToMemory(); 6794 }; 6795 6796 LoopProperties LP = {/* HasNoAbnormalExits */ true, 6797 /*HasNoSideEffects*/ true}; 6798 6799 for (auto *BB : L->getBlocks()) 6800 for (auto &I : *BB) { 6801 if (!isGuaranteedToTransferExecutionToSuccessor(&I)) 6802 LP.HasNoAbnormalExits = false; 6803 if (HasSideEffects(&I)) 6804 LP.HasNoSideEffects = false; 6805 if (!LP.HasNoAbnormalExits && !LP.HasNoSideEffects) 6806 break; // We're already as pessimistic as we can get. 6807 } 6808 6809 auto InsertPair = LoopPropertiesCache.insert({L, LP}); 6810 assert(InsertPair.second && "We just checked!"); 6811 Itr = InsertPair.first; 6812 } 6813 6814 return Itr->second; 6815 } 6816 6817 bool ScalarEvolution::loopIsFiniteByAssumption(const Loop *L) { 6818 // A mustprogress loop without side effects must be finite. 6819 // TODO: The check used here is very conservative. It's only *specific* 6820 // side effects which are well defined in infinite loops. 6821 return isMustProgress(L) && loopHasNoSideEffects(L); 6822 } 6823 6824 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::createSCEV(Value *V) { 6825 if (!isSCEVable(V->getType())) 6826 return getUnknown(V); 6827 6828 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) { 6829 // Don't attempt to analyze instructions in blocks that aren't 6830 // reachable. Such instructions don't matter, and they aren't required 6831 // to obey basic rules for definitions dominating uses which this 6832 // analysis depends on. 6833 if (!DT.isReachableFromEntry(I->getParent())) 6834 return getUnknown(UndefValue::get(V->getType())); 6835 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) 6836 return getConstant(CI); 6837 else if (GlobalAlias *GA = dyn_cast<GlobalAlias>(V)) 6838 return GA->isInterposable() ? getUnknown(V) : getSCEV(GA->getAliasee()); 6839 else if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(V)) 6840 return getUnknown(V); 6841 6842 Operator *U = cast<Operator>(V); 6843 if (auto BO = MatchBinaryOp(U, DT)) { 6844 switch (BO->Opcode) { 6845 case Instruction::Add: { 6846 // The simple thing to do would be to just call getSCEV on both operands 6847 // and call getAddExpr with the result. However if we're looking at a 6848 // bunch of things all added together, this can be quite inefficient, 6849 // because it leads to N-1 getAddExpr calls for N ultimate operands. 6850 // Instead, gather up all the operands and make a single getAddExpr call. 6851 // LLVM IR canonical form means we need only traverse the left operands. 6852 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> AddOps; 6853 do { 6854 if (BO->Op) { 6855 if (auto *OpSCEV = getExistingSCEV(BO->Op)) { 6856 AddOps.push_back(OpSCEV); 6857 break; 6858 } 6859 6860 // If a NUW or NSW flag can be applied to the SCEV for this 6861 // addition, then compute the SCEV for this addition by itself 6862 // with a separate call to getAddExpr. We need to do that 6863 // instead of pushing the operands of the addition onto AddOps, 6864 // since the flags are only known to apply to this particular 6865 // addition - they may not apply to other additions that can be 6866 // formed with operands from AddOps. 6867 const SCEV *RHS = getSCEV(BO->RHS); 6868 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(BO->Op); 6869 if (Flags != SCEV::FlagAnyWrap) { 6870 const SCEV *LHS = getSCEV(BO->LHS); 6871 if (BO->Opcode == Instruction::Sub) 6872 AddOps.push_back(getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS, Flags)); 6873 else 6874 AddOps.push_back(getAddExpr(LHS, RHS, Flags)); 6875 break; 6876 } 6877 } 6878 6879 if (BO->Opcode == Instruction::Sub) 6880 AddOps.push_back(getNegativeSCEV(getSCEV(BO->RHS))); 6881 else 6882 AddOps.push_back(getSCEV(BO->RHS)); 6883 6884 auto NewBO = MatchBinaryOp(BO->LHS, DT); 6885 if (!NewBO || (NewBO->Opcode != Instruction::Add && 6886 NewBO->Opcode != Instruction::Sub)) { 6887 AddOps.push_back(getSCEV(BO->LHS)); 6888 break; 6889 } 6890 BO = NewBO; 6891 } while (true); 6892 6893 return getAddExpr(AddOps); 6894 } 6895 6896 case Instruction::Mul: { 6897 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> MulOps; 6898 do { 6899 if (BO->Op) { 6900 if (auto *OpSCEV = getExistingSCEV(BO->Op)) { 6901 MulOps.push_back(OpSCEV); 6902 break; 6903 } 6904 6905 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(BO->Op); 6906 if (Flags != SCEV::FlagAnyWrap) { 6907 MulOps.push_back( 6908 getMulExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(BO->RHS), Flags)); 6909 break; 6910 } 6911 } 6912 6913 MulOps.push_back(getSCEV(BO->RHS)); 6914 auto NewBO = MatchBinaryOp(BO->LHS, DT); 6915 if (!NewBO || NewBO->Opcode != Instruction::Mul) { 6916 MulOps.push_back(getSCEV(BO->LHS)); 6917 break; 6918 } 6919 BO = NewBO; 6920 } while (true); 6921 6922 return getMulExpr(MulOps); 6923 } 6924 case Instruction::UDiv: 6925 return getUDivExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(BO->RHS)); 6926 case Instruction::URem: 6927 return getURemExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(BO->RHS)); 6928 case Instruction::Sub: { 6929 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 6930 if (BO->Op) 6931 Flags = getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(BO->Op); 6932 return getMinusSCEV(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(BO->RHS), Flags); 6933 } 6934 case Instruction::And: 6935 // For an expression like x&255 that merely masks off the high bits, 6936 // use zext(trunc(x)) as the SCEV expression. 6937 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS)) { 6938 if (CI->isZero()) 6939 return getSCEV(BO->RHS); 6940 if (CI->isMinusOne()) 6941 return getSCEV(BO->LHS); 6942 const APInt &A = CI->getValue(); 6943 6944 // Instcombine's ShrinkDemandedConstant may strip bits out of 6945 // constants, obscuring what would otherwise be a low-bits mask. 6946 // Use computeKnownBits to compute what ShrinkDemandedConstant 6947 // knew about to reconstruct a low-bits mask value. 6948 unsigned LZ = A.countLeadingZeros(); 6949 unsigned TZ = A.countTrailingZeros(); 6950 unsigned BitWidth = A.getBitWidth(); 6951 KnownBits Known(BitWidth); 6952 computeKnownBits(BO->LHS, Known, getDataLayout(), 6953 0, &AC, nullptr, &DT); 6954 6955 APInt EffectiveMask = 6956 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - LZ - TZ).shl(TZ); 6957 if ((LZ != 0 || TZ != 0) && !((~A & ~Known.Zero) & EffectiveMask)) { 6958 const SCEV *MulCount = getConstant(APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth, TZ)); 6959 const SCEV *LHS = getSCEV(BO->LHS); 6960 const SCEV *ShiftedLHS = nullptr; 6961 if (auto *LHSMul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(LHS)) { 6962 if (auto *OpC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LHSMul->getOperand(0))) { 6963 // For an expression like (x * 8) & 8, simplify the multiply. 6964 unsigned MulZeros = OpC->getAPInt().countTrailingZeros(); 6965 unsigned GCD = std::min(MulZeros, TZ); 6966 APInt DivAmt = APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth, TZ - GCD); 6967 SmallVector<const SCEV*, 4> MulOps; 6968 MulOps.push_back(getConstant(OpC->getAPInt().lshr(GCD))); 6969 MulOps.append(LHSMul->op_begin() + 1, LHSMul->op_end()); 6970 auto *NewMul = getMulExpr(MulOps, LHSMul->getNoWrapFlags()); 6971 ShiftedLHS = getUDivExpr(NewMul, getConstant(DivAmt)); 6972 } 6973 } 6974 if (!ShiftedLHS) 6975 ShiftedLHS = getUDivExpr(LHS, MulCount); 6976 return getMulExpr( 6977 getZeroExtendExpr( 6978 getTruncateExpr(ShiftedLHS, 6979 IntegerType::get(getContext(), BitWidth - LZ - TZ)), 6980 BO->LHS->getType()), 6981 MulCount); 6982 } 6983 } 6984 break; 6985 6986 case Instruction::Or: 6987 // If the RHS of the Or is a constant, we may have something like: 6988 // X*4+1 which got turned into X*4|1. Handle this as an Add so loop 6989 // optimizations will transparently handle this case. 6990 // 6991 // In order for this transformation to be safe, the LHS must be of the 6992 // form X*(2^n) and the Or constant must be less than 2^n. 6993 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS)) { 6994 const SCEV *LHS = getSCEV(BO->LHS); 6995 const APInt &CIVal = CI->getValue(); 6996 if (GetMinTrailingZeros(LHS) >= 6997 (CIVal.getBitWidth() - CIVal.countLeadingZeros())) { 6998 // Build a plain add SCEV. 6999 return getAddExpr(LHS, getSCEV(CI), 7000 (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(SCEV::FlagNUW | SCEV::FlagNSW)); 7001 } 7002 } 7003 break; 7004 7005 case Instruction::Xor: 7006 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS)) { 7007 // If the RHS of xor is -1, then this is a not operation. 7008 if (CI->isMinusOne()) 7009 return getNotSCEV(getSCEV(BO->LHS)); 7010 7011 // Model xor(and(x, C), C) as and(~x, C), if C is a low-bits mask. 7012 // This is a variant of the check for xor with -1, and it handles 7013 // the case where instcombine has trimmed non-demanded bits out 7014 // of an xor with -1. 7015 if (auto *LBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(BO->LHS)) 7016 if (ConstantInt *LCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LBO->getOperand(1))) 7017 if (LBO->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && 7018 LCI->getValue() == CI->getValue()) 7019 if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *Z = 7020 dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(getSCEV(BO->LHS))) { 7021 Type *UTy = BO->LHS->getType(); 7022 const SCEV *Z0 = Z->getOperand(); 7023 Type *Z0Ty = Z0->getType(); 7024 unsigned Z0TySize = getTypeSizeInBits(Z0Ty); 7025 7026 // If C is a low-bits mask, the zero extend is serving to 7027 // mask off the high bits. Complement the operand and 7028 // re-apply the zext. 7029 if (CI->getValue().isMask(Z0TySize)) 7030 return getZeroExtendExpr(getNotSCEV(Z0), UTy); 7031 7032 // If C is a single bit, it may be in the sign-bit position 7033 // before the zero-extend. In this case, represent the xor 7034 // using an add, which is equivalent, and re-apply the zext. 7035 APInt Trunc = CI->getValue().trunc(Z0TySize); 7036 if (Trunc.zext(getTypeSizeInBits(UTy)) == CI->getValue() && 7037 Trunc.isSignMask()) 7038 return getZeroExtendExpr(getAddExpr(Z0, getConstant(Trunc)), 7039 UTy); 7040 } 7041 } 7042 break; 7043 7044 case Instruction::Shl: 7045 // Turn shift left of a constant amount into a multiply. 7046 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS)) { 7047 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(SA->getType())->getBitWidth(); 7048 7049 // If the shift count is not less than the bitwidth, the result of 7050 // the shift is undefined. Don't try to analyze it, because the 7051 // resolution chosen here may differ from the resolution chosen in 7052 // other parts of the compiler. 7053 if (SA->getValue().uge(BitWidth)) 7054 break; 7055 7056 // We can safely preserve the nuw flag in all cases. It's also safe to 7057 // turn a nuw nsw shl into a nuw nsw mul. However, nsw in isolation 7058 // requires special handling. It can be preserved as long as we're not 7059 // left shifting by bitwidth - 1. 7060 auto Flags = SCEV::FlagAnyWrap; 7061 if (BO->Op) { 7062 auto MulFlags = getNoWrapFlagsFromUB(BO->Op); 7063 if ((MulFlags & SCEV::FlagNSW) && 7064 ((MulFlags & SCEV::FlagNUW) || SA->getValue().ult(BitWidth - 1))) 7065 Flags = (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(Flags | SCEV::FlagNSW); 7066 if (MulFlags & SCEV::FlagNUW) 7067 Flags = (SCEV::NoWrapFlags)(Flags | SCEV::FlagNUW); 7068 } 7069 7070 Constant *X = ConstantInt::get( 7071 getContext(), APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth, SA->getZExtValue())); 7072 return getMulExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), getSCEV(X), Flags); 7073 } 7074 break; 7075 7076 case Instruction::AShr: { 7077 // AShr X, C, where C is a constant. 7078 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->RHS); 7079 if (!CI) 7080 break; 7081 7082 Type *OuterTy = BO->LHS->getType(); 7083 uint64_t BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(OuterTy); 7084 // If the shift count is not less than the bitwidth, the result of 7085 // the shift is undefined. Don't try to analyze it, because the 7086 // resolution chosen here may differ from the resolution chosen in 7087 // other parts of the compiler. 7088 if (CI->getValue().uge(BitWidth)) 7089 break; 7090 7091 if (CI->isZero()) 7092 return getSCEV(BO->LHS); // shift by zero --> noop 7093 7094 uint64_t AShrAmt = CI->getZExtValue(); 7095 Type *TruncTy = IntegerType::get(getContext(), BitWidth - AShrAmt); 7096 7097 Operator *L = dyn_cast<Operator>(BO->LHS); 7098 if (L && L->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) { 7099 // X = Shl A, n 7100 // Y = AShr X, m 7101 // Both n and m are constant. 7102 7103 const SCEV *ShlOp0SCEV = getSCEV(L->getOperand(0)); 7104 if (L->getOperand(1) == BO->RHS) 7105 // For a two-shift sext-inreg, i.e. n = m, 7106 // use sext(trunc(x)) as the SCEV expression. 7107 return getSignExtendExpr( 7108 getTruncateExpr(ShlOp0SCEV, TruncTy), OuterTy); 7109 7110 ConstantInt *ShlAmtCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(L->getOperand(1)); 7111 if (ShlAmtCI && ShlAmtCI->getValue().ult(BitWidth)) { 7112 uint64_t ShlAmt = ShlAmtCI->getZExtValue(); 7113 if (ShlAmt > AShrAmt) { 7114 // When n > m, use sext(mul(trunc(x), 2^(n-m)))) as the SCEV 7115 // expression. We already checked that ShlAmt < BitWidth, so 7116 // the multiplier, 1 << (ShlAmt - AShrAmt), fits into TruncTy as 7117 // ShlAmt - AShrAmt < Amt. 7118 APInt Mul = APInt::getOneBitSet(BitWidth - AShrAmt, 7119 ShlAmt - AShrAmt); 7120 return getSignExtendExpr( 7121 getMulExpr(getTruncateExpr(ShlOp0SCEV, TruncTy), 7122 getConstant(Mul)), OuterTy); 7123 } 7124 } 7125 } 7126 break; 7127 } 7128 } 7129 } 7130 7131 switch (U->getOpcode()) { 7132 case Instruction::Trunc: 7133 return getTruncateExpr(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)), U->getType()); 7134 7135 case Instruction::ZExt: 7136 return getZeroExtendExpr(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)), U->getType()); 7137 7138 case Instruction::SExt: 7139 if (auto BO = MatchBinaryOp(U->getOperand(0), DT)) { 7140 // The NSW flag of a subtract does not always survive the conversion to 7141 // A + (-1)*B. By pushing sign extension onto its operands we are much 7142 // more likely to preserve NSW and allow later AddRec optimisations. 7143 // 7144 // NOTE: This is effectively duplicating this logic from getSignExtend: 7145 // sext((A + B + ...)<nsw>) --> (sext(A) + sext(B) + ...)<nsw> 7146 // but by that point the NSW information has potentially been lost. 7147 if (BO->Opcode == Instruction::Sub && BO->IsNSW) { 7148 Type *Ty = U->getType(); 7149 auto *V1 = getSignExtendExpr(getSCEV(BO->LHS), Ty); 7150 auto *V2 = getSignExtendExpr(getSCEV(BO->RHS), Ty); 7151 return getMinusSCEV(V1, V2, SCEV::FlagNSW); 7152 } 7153 } 7154 return getSignExtendExpr(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)), U->getType()); 7155 7156 case Instruction::BitCast: 7157 // BitCasts are no-op casts so we just eliminate the cast. 7158 if (isSCEVable(U->getType()) && isSCEVable(U->getOperand(0)->getType())) 7159 return getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)); 7160 break; 7161 7162 case Instruction::PtrToInt: { 7163 // Pointer to integer cast is straight-forward, so do model it. 7164 const SCEV *Op = getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)); 7165 Type *DstIntTy = U->getType(); 7166 // But only if effective SCEV (integer) type is wide enough to represent 7167 // all possible pointer values. 7168 const SCEV *IntOp = getPtrToIntExpr(Op, DstIntTy); 7169 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(IntOp)) 7170 return getUnknown(V); 7171 return IntOp; 7172 } 7173 case Instruction::IntToPtr: 7174 // Just don't deal with inttoptr casts. 7175 return getUnknown(V); 7176 7177 case Instruction::SDiv: 7178 // If both operands are non-negative, this is just an udiv. 7179 if (isKnownNonNegative(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0))) && 7180 isKnownNonNegative(getSCEV(U->getOperand(1)))) 7181 return getUDivExpr(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)), getSCEV(U->getOperand(1))); 7182 break; 7183 7184 case Instruction::SRem: 7185 // If both operands are non-negative, this is just an urem. 7186 if (isKnownNonNegative(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0))) && 7187 isKnownNonNegative(getSCEV(U->getOperand(1)))) 7188 return getURemExpr(getSCEV(U->getOperand(0)), getSCEV(U->getOperand(1))); 7189 break; 7190 7191 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: 7192 return createNodeForGEP(cast<GEPOperator>(U)); 7193 7194 case Instruction::PHI: 7195 return createNodeForPHI(cast<PHINode>(U)); 7196 7197 case Instruction::Select: 7198 // U can also be a select constant expr, which let fall through. Since 7199 // createNodeForSelect only works for a condition that is an `ICmpInst`, and 7200 // constant expressions cannot have instructions as operands, we'd have 7201 // returned getUnknown for a select constant expressions anyway. 7202 if (isa<Instruction>(U)) 7203 return createNodeForSelectOrPHI(cast<Instruction>(U), U->getOperand(0), 7204 U->getOperand(1), U->getOperand(2)); 7205 break; 7206 7207 case Instruction::Call: 7208 case Instruction::Invoke: 7209 if (Value *RV = cast<CallBase>(U)->getReturnedArgOperand()) 7210 return getSCEV(RV); 7211 7212 if (auto *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(U)) { 7213 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) { 7214 case Intrinsic::abs: 7215 return getAbsExpr( 7216 getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(0)), 7217 /*IsNSW=*/cast<ConstantInt>(II->getArgOperand(1))->isOne()); 7218 case Intrinsic::umax: 7219 return getUMaxExpr(getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(0)), 7220 getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(1))); 7221 case Intrinsic::umin: 7222 return getUMinExpr(getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(0)), 7223 getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(1))); 7224 case Intrinsic::smax: 7225 return getSMaxExpr(getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(0)), 7226 getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(1))); 7227 case Intrinsic::smin: 7228 return getSMinExpr(getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(0)), 7229 getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(1))); 7230 case Intrinsic::usub_sat: { 7231 const SCEV *X = getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(0)); 7232 const SCEV *Y = getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(1)); 7233 const SCEV *ClampedY = getUMinExpr(X, Y); 7234 return getMinusSCEV(X, ClampedY, SCEV::FlagNUW); 7235 } 7236 case Intrinsic::uadd_sat: { 7237 const SCEV *X = getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(0)); 7238 const SCEV *Y = getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(1)); 7239 const SCEV *ClampedX = getUMinExpr(X, getNotSCEV(Y)); 7240 return getAddExpr(ClampedX, Y, SCEV::FlagNUW); 7241 } 7242 case Intrinsic::start_loop_iterations: 7243 // A start_loop_iterations is just equivalent to the first operand for 7244 // SCEV purposes. 7245 return getSCEV(II->getArgOperand(0)); 7246 default: 7247 break; 7248 } 7249 } 7250 break; 7251 } 7252 7253 return getUnknown(V); 7254 } 7255 7256 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 7257 // Iteration Count Computation Code 7258 // 7259 7260 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getTripCountFromExitCount(const SCEV *ExitCount, 7261 bool Extend) { 7262 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ExitCount)) 7263 return getCouldNotCompute(); 7264 7265 auto *ExitCountType = ExitCount->getType(); 7266 assert(ExitCountType->isIntegerTy()); 7267 7268 if (!Extend) 7269 return getAddExpr(ExitCount, getOne(ExitCountType)); 7270 7271 auto *WiderType = Type::getIntNTy(ExitCountType->getContext(), 7272 1 + ExitCountType->getScalarSizeInBits()); 7273 return getAddExpr(getNoopOrZeroExtend(ExitCount, WiderType), 7274 getOne(WiderType)); 7275 } 7276 7277 static unsigned getConstantTripCount(const SCEVConstant *ExitCount) { 7278 if (!ExitCount) 7279 return 0; 7280 7281 ConstantInt *ExitConst = ExitCount->getValue(); 7282 7283 // Guard against huge trip counts. 7284 if (ExitConst->getValue().getActiveBits() > 32) 7285 return 0; 7286 7287 // In case of integer overflow, this returns 0, which is correct. 7288 return ((unsigned)ExitConst->getZExtValue()) + 1; 7289 } 7290 7291 unsigned ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantTripCount(const Loop *L) { 7292 auto *ExitCount = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(getBackedgeTakenCount(L, Exact)); 7293 return getConstantTripCount(ExitCount); 7294 } 7295 7296 unsigned 7297 ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantTripCount(const Loop *L, 7298 const BasicBlock *ExitingBlock) { 7299 assert(ExitingBlock && "Must pass a non-null exiting block!"); 7300 assert(L->isLoopExiting(ExitingBlock) && 7301 "Exiting block must actually branch out of the loop!"); 7302 const SCEVConstant *ExitCount = 7303 dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(getExitCount(L, ExitingBlock)); 7304 return getConstantTripCount(ExitCount); 7305 } 7306 7307 unsigned ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantMaxTripCount(const Loop *L) { 7308 const auto *MaxExitCount = 7309 dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L)); 7310 return getConstantTripCount(MaxExitCount); 7311 } 7312 7313 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getConstantMaxTripCountFromArray(const Loop *L) { 7314 // We can't infer from Array in Irregular Loop. 7315 // FIXME: It's hard to infer loop bound from array operated in Nested Loop. 7316 if (!L->isLoopSimplifyForm() || !L->isInnermost()) 7317 return getCouldNotCompute(); 7318 7319 // FIXME: To make the scene more typical, we only analysis loops that have 7320 // one exiting block and that block must be the latch. To make it easier to 7321 // capture loops that have memory access and memory access will be executed 7322 // in each iteration. 7323 const BasicBlock *LoopLatch = L->getLoopLatch(); 7324 assert(LoopLatch && "See defination of simplify form loop."); 7325 if (L->getExitingBlock() != LoopLatch) 7326 return getCouldNotCompute(); 7327 7328 const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout(); 7329 SmallVector<const SCEV *> InferCountColl; 7330 for (auto *BB : L->getBlocks()) { 7331 // Go here, we can know that Loop is a single exiting and simplified form 7332 // loop. Make sure that infer from Memory Operation in those BBs must be 7333 // executed in loop. First step, we can make sure that max execution time 7334 // of MemAccessBB in loop represents latch max excution time. 7335 // If MemAccessBB does not dom Latch, skip. 7336 // Entry 7337 // │ 7338 // ┌─────▼─────┐ 7339 // │Loop Header◄─────┐ 7340 // └──┬──────┬─┘ │ 7341 // │ │ │ 7342 // ┌────────▼──┐ ┌─▼─────┐ │ 7343 // │MemAccessBB│ │OtherBB│ │ 7344 // └────────┬──┘ └─┬─────┘ │ 7345 // │ │ │ 7346 // ┌─▼──────▼─┐ │ 7347 // │Loop Latch├─────┘ 7348 // └────┬─────┘ 7349 // ▼ 7350 // Exit 7351 if (!DT.dominates(BB, LoopLatch)) 7352 continue; 7353 7354 for (Instruction &Inst : *BB) { 7355 // Find Memory Operation Instruction. 7356 auto *GEP = getLoadStorePointerOperand(&Inst); 7357 if (!GEP) 7358 continue; 7359 7360 auto *ElemSize = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(getElementSize(&Inst)); 7361 // Do not infer from scalar type, eg."ElemSize = sizeof()". 7362 if (!ElemSize) 7363 continue; 7364 7365 // Use a existing polynomial recurrence on the trip count. 7366 auto *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(getSCEV(GEP)); 7367 if (!AddRec) 7368 continue; 7369 auto *ArrBase = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(getPointerBase(AddRec)); 7370 auto *Step = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AddRec->getStepRecurrence(*this)); 7371 if (!ArrBase || !Step) 7372 continue; 7373 assert(isLoopInvariant(ArrBase, L) && "See addrec definition"); 7374 7375 // Only handle { %array + step }, 7376 // FIXME: {(SCEVAddRecExpr) + step } could not be analysed here. 7377 if (AddRec->getStart() != ArrBase) 7378 continue; 7379 7380 // Memory operation pattern which have gaps. 7381 // Or repeat memory opreation. 7382 // And index of GEP wraps arround. 7383 if (Step->getAPInt().getActiveBits() > 32 || 7384 Step->getAPInt().getZExtValue() != 7385 ElemSize->getAPInt().getZExtValue() || 7386 Step->isZero() || Step->getAPInt().isNegative()) 7387 continue; 7388 7389 // Only infer from stack array which has certain size. 7390 // Make sure alloca instruction is not excuted in loop. 7391 AllocaInst *AllocateInst = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(ArrBase->getValue()); 7392 if (!AllocateInst || L->contains(AllocateInst->getParent())) 7393 continue; 7394 7395 // Make sure only handle normal array. 7396 auto *Ty = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(AllocateInst->getAllocatedType()); 7397 auto *ArrSize = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AllocateInst->getArraySize()); 7398 if (!Ty || !ArrSize || !ArrSize->isOne()) 7399 continue; 7400 // Also make sure step was increased the same with sizeof allocated 7401 // element type. 7402 const PointerType *GEPT = dyn_cast<PointerType>(GEP->getType()); 7403 if (Ty->getElementType() != GEPT->getElementType()) 7404 continue; 7405 7406 // FIXME: Since gep indices are silently zext to the indexing type, 7407 // we will have a narrow gep index which wraps around rather than 7408 // increasing strictly, we shoule ensure that step is increasing 7409 // strictly by the loop iteration. 7410 // Now we can infer a max execution time by MemLength/StepLength. 7411 const SCEV *MemSize = 7412 getConstant(Step->getType(), DL.getTypeAllocSize(Ty)); 7413 auto *MaxExeCount = 7414 dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(getUDivCeilSCEV(MemSize, Step)); 7415 if (!MaxExeCount || MaxExeCount->getAPInt().getActiveBits() > 32) 7416 continue; 7417 7418 // If the loop reaches the maximum number of executions, we can not 7419 // access bytes starting outside the statically allocated size without 7420 // being immediate UB. But it is allowed to enter loop header one more 7421 // time. 7422 auto *InferCount = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>( 7423 getAddExpr(MaxExeCount, getOne(MaxExeCount->getType()))); 7424 // Discard the maximum number of execution times under 32bits. 7425 if (!InferCount || InferCount->getAPInt().getActiveBits() > 32) 7426 continue; 7427 7428 InferCountColl.push_back(InferCount); 7429 } 7430 } 7431 7432 if (InferCountColl.size() == 0) 7433 return getCouldNotCompute(); 7434 7435 return getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(InferCountColl); 7436 } 7437 7438 unsigned ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantTripMultiple(const Loop *L) { 7439 SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 8> ExitingBlocks; 7440 L->getExitingBlocks(ExitingBlocks); 7441 7442 Optional<unsigned> Res = None; 7443 for (auto *ExitingBB : ExitingBlocks) { 7444 unsigned Multiple = getSmallConstantTripMultiple(L, ExitingBB); 7445 if (!Res) 7446 Res = Multiple; 7447 Res = (unsigned)GreatestCommonDivisor64(*Res, Multiple); 7448 } 7449 return Res.getValueOr(1); 7450 } 7451 7452 unsigned ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantTripMultiple(const Loop *L, 7453 const SCEV *ExitCount) { 7454 if (ExitCount == getCouldNotCompute()) 7455 return 1; 7456 7457 // Get the trip count 7458 const SCEV *TCExpr = getTripCountFromExitCount(ExitCount); 7459 7460 const SCEVConstant *TC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(TCExpr); 7461 if (!TC) 7462 // Attempt to factor more general cases. Returns the greatest power of 7463 // two divisor. If overflow happens, the trip count expression is still 7464 // divisible by the greatest power of 2 divisor returned. 7465 return 1U << std::min((uint32_t)31, 7466 GetMinTrailingZeros(applyLoopGuards(TCExpr, L))); 7467 7468 ConstantInt *Result = TC->getValue(); 7469 7470 // Guard against huge trip counts (this requires checking 7471 // for zero to handle the case where the trip count == -1 and the 7472 // addition wraps). 7473 if (!Result || Result->getValue().getActiveBits() > 32 || 7474 Result->getValue().getActiveBits() == 0) 7475 return 1; 7476 7477 return (unsigned)Result->getZExtValue(); 7478 } 7479 7480 /// Returns the largest constant divisor of the trip count of this loop as a 7481 /// normal unsigned value, if possible. This means that the actual trip count is 7482 /// always a multiple of the returned value (don't forget the trip count could 7483 /// very well be zero as well!). 7484 /// 7485 /// Returns 1 if the trip count is unknown or not guaranteed to be the 7486 /// multiple of a constant (which is also the case if the trip count is simply 7487 /// constant, use getSmallConstantTripCount for that case), Will also return 1 7488 /// if the trip count is very large (>= 2^32). 7489 /// 7490 /// As explained in the comments for getSmallConstantTripCount, this assumes 7491 /// that control exits the loop via ExitingBlock. 7492 unsigned 7493 ScalarEvolution::getSmallConstantTripMultiple(const Loop *L, 7494 const BasicBlock *ExitingBlock) { 7495 assert(ExitingBlock && "Must pass a non-null exiting block!"); 7496 assert(L->isLoopExiting(ExitingBlock) && 7497 "Exiting block must actually branch out of the loop!"); 7498 const SCEV *ExitCount = getExitCount(L, ExitingBlock); 7499 return getSmallConstantTripMultiple(L, ExitCount); 7500 } 7501 7502 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getExitCount(const Loop *L, 7503 const BasicBlock *ExitingBlock, 7504 ExitCountKind Kind) { 7505 switch (Kind) { 7506 case Exact: 7507 case SymbolicMaximum: 7508 return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getExact(ExitingBlock, this); 7509 case ConstantMaximum: 7510 return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getConstantMax(ExitingBlock, this); 7511 }; 7512 llvm_unreachable("Invalid ExitCountKind!"); 7513 } 7514 7515 const SCEV * 7516 ScalarEvolution::getPredicatedBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L, 7517 SCEVUnionPredicate &Preds) { 7518 return getPredicatedBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getExact(L, this, &Preds); 7519 } 7520 7521 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L, 7522 ExitCountKind Kind) { 7523 switch (Kind) { 7524 case Exact: 7525 return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getExact(L, this); 7526 case ConstantMaximum: 7527 return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getConstantMax(this); 7528 case SymbolicMaximum: 7529 return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).getSymbolicMax(L, this); 7530 }; 7531 llvm_unreachable("Invalid ExitCountKind!"); 7532 } 7533 7534 bool ScalarEvolution::isBackedgeTakenCountMaxOrZero(const Loop *L) { 7535 return getBackedgeTakenInfo(L).isConstantMaxOrZero(this); 7536 } 7537 7538 /// Push PHI nodes in the header of the given loop onto the given Worklist. 7539 static void PushLoopPHIs(const Loop *L, 7540 SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Worklist, 7541 SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &Visited) { 7542 BasicBlock *Header = L->getHeader(); 7543 7544 // Push all Loop-header PHIs onto the Worklist stack. 7545 for (PHINode &PN : Header->phis()) 7546 if (Visited.insert(&PN).second) 7547 Worklist.push_back(&PN); 7548 } 7549 7550 const ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo & 7551 ScalarEvolution::getPredicatedBackedgeTakenInfo(const Loop *L) { 7552 auto &BTI = getBackedgeTakenInfo(L); 7553 if (BTI.hasFullInfo()) 7554 return BTI; 7555 7556 auto Pair = PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts.insert({L, BackedgeTakenInfo()}); 7557 7558 if (!Pair.second) 7559 return Pair.first->second; 7560 7561 BackedgeTakenInfo Result = 7562 computeBackedgeTakenCount(L, /*AllowPredicates=*/true); 7563 7564 return PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts.find(L)->second = std::move(Result); 7565 } 7566 7567 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo & 7568 ScalarEvolution::getBackedgeTakenInfo(const Loop *L) { 7569 // Initially insert an invalid entry for this loop. If the insertion 7570 // succeeds, proceed to actually compute a backedge-taken count and 7571 // update the value. The temporary CouldNotCompute value tells SCEV 7572 // code elsewhere that it shouldn't attempt to request a new 7573 // backedge-taken count, which could result in infinite recursion. 7574 std::pair<DenseMap<const Loop *, BackedgeTakenInfo>::iterator, bool> Pair = 7575 BackedgeTakenCounts.insert({L, BackedgeTakenInfo()}); 7576 if (!Pair.second) 7577 return Pair.first->second; 7578 7579 // computeBackedgeTakenCount may allocate memory for its result. Inserting it 7580 // into the BackedgeTakenCounts map transfers ownership. Otherwise, the result 7581 // must be cleared in this scope. 7582 BackedgeTakenInfo Result = computeBackedgeTakenCount(L); 7583 7584 // In product build, there are no usage of statistic. 7585 (void)NumTripCountsComputed; 7586 (void)NumTripCountsNotComputed; 7587 #if LLVM_ENABLE_STATS || !defined(NDEBUG) 7588 const SCEV *BEExact = Result.getExact(L, this); 7589 if (BEExact != getCouldNotCompute()) { 7590 assert(isLoopInvariant(BEExact, L) && 7591 isLoopInvariant(Result.getConstantMax(this), L) && 7592 "Computed backedge-taken count isn't loop invariant for loop!"); 7593 ++NumTripCountsComputed; 7594 } else if (Result.getConstantMax(this) == getCouldNotCompute() && 7595 isa<PHINode>(L->getHeader()->begin())) { 7596 // Only count loops that have phi nodes as not being computable. 7597 ++NumTripCountsNotComputed; 7598 } 7599 #endif // LLVM_ENABLE_STATS || !defined(NDEBUG) 7600 7601 // Now that we know more about the trip count for this loop, forget any 7602 // existing SCEV values for PHI nodes in this loop since they are only 7603 // conservative estimates made without the benefit of trip count 7604 // information. This is similar to the code in forgetLoop, except that 7605 // it handles SCEVUnknown PHI nodes specially. 7606 if (Result.hasAnyInfo()) { 7607 SmallVector<Instruction *, 16> Worklist; 7608 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 8> Discovered; 7609 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> ToForget; 7610 PushLoopPHIs(L, Worklist, Discovered); 7611 while (!Worklist.empty()) { 7612 Instruction *I = Worklist.pop_back_val(); 7613 7614 ValueExprMapType::iterator It = 7615 ValueExprMap.find_as(static_cast<Value *>(I)); 7616 if (It != ValueExprMap.end()) { 7617 const SCEV *Old = It->second; 7618 7619 // SCEVUnknown for a PHI either means that it has an unrecognized 7620 // structure, or it's a PHI that's in the progress of being computed 7621 // by createNodeForPHI. In the former case, additional loop trip 7622 // count information isn't going to change anything. In the later 7623 // case, createNodeForPHI will perform the necessary updates on its 7624 // own when it gets to that point. 7625 if (!isa<PHINode>(I) || !isa<SCEVUnknown>(Old)) { 7626 eraseValueFromMap(It->first); 7627 ToForget.push_back(Old); 7628 } 7629 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) 7630 ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN); 7631 } 7632 7633 // Since we don't need to invalidate anything for correctness and we're 7634 // only invalidating to make SCEV's results more precise, we get to stop 7635 // early to avoid invalidating too much. This is especially important in 7636 // cases like: 7637 // 7638 // %v = f(pn0, pn1) // pn0 and pn1 used through some other phi node 7639 // loop0: 7640 // %pn0 = phi 7641 // ... 7642 // loop1: 7643 // %pn1 = phi 7644 // ... 7645 // 7646 // where both loop0 and loop1's backedge taken count uses the SCEV 7647 // expression for %v. If we don't have the early stop below then in cases 7648 // like the above, getBackedgeTakenInfo(loop1) will clear out the trip 7649 // count for loop0 and getBackedgeTakenInfo(loop0) will clear out the trip 7650 // count for loop1, effectively nullifying SCEV's trip count cache. 7651 for (auto *U : I->users()) 7652 if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U)) { 7653 auto *LoopForUser = LI.getLoopFor(I->getParent()); 7654 if (LoopForUser && L->contains(LoopForUser) && 7655 Discovered.insert(I).second) 7656 Worklist.push_back(I); 7657 } 7658 } 7659 forgetMemoizedResults(ToForget); 7660 } 7661 7662 // Re-lookup the insert position, since the call to 7663 // computeBackedgeTakenCount above could result in a 7664 // recusive call to getBackedgeTakenInfo (on a different 7665 // loop), which would invalidate the iterator computed 7666 // earlier. 7667 return BackedgeTakenCounts.find(L)->second = std::move(Result); 7668 } 7669 7670 void ScalarEvolution::forgetAllLoops() { 7671 // This method is intended to forget all info about loops. It should 7672 // invalidate caches as if the following happened: 7673 // - The trip counts of all loops have changed arbitrarily 7674 // - Every llvm::Value has been updated in place to produce a different 7675 // result. 7676 BackedgeTakenCounts.clear(); 7677 PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts.clear(); 7678 LoopPropertiesCache.clear(); 7679 ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.clear(); 7680 ValueExprMap.clear(); 7681 ValuesAtScopes.clear(); 7682 LoopDispositions.clear(); 7683 BlockDispositions.clear(); 7684 UnsignedRanges.clear(); 7685 SignedRanges.clear(); 7686 ExprValueMap.clear(); 7687 HasRecMap.clear(); 7688 MinTrailingZerosCache.clear(); 7689 PredicatedSCEVRewrites.clear(); 7690 } 7691 7692 void ScalarEvolution::forgetLoop(const Loop *L) { 7693 SmallVector<const Loop *, 16> LoopWorklist(1, L); 7694 SmallVector<Instruction *, 32> Worklist; 7695 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16> Visited; 7696 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 16> ToForget; 7697 7698 // Iterate over all the loops and sub-loops to drop SCEV information. 7699 while (!LoopWorklist.empty()) { 7700 auto *CurrL = LoopWorklist.pop_back_val(); 7701 7702 // Drop any stored trip count value. 7703 BackedgeTakenCounts.erase(CurrL); 7704 PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts.erase(CurrL); 7705 7706 // Drop information about predicated SCEV rewrites for this loop. 7707 for (auto I = PredicatedSCEVRewrites.begin(); 7708 I != PredicatedSCEVRewrites.end();) { 7709 std::pair<const SCEV *, const Loop *> Entry = I->first; 7710 if (Entry.second == CurrL) 7711 PredicatedSCEVRewrites.erase(I++); 7712 else 7713 ++I; 7714 } 7715 7716 auto LoopUsersItr = LoopUsers.find(CurrL); 7717 if (LoopUsersItr != LoopUsers.end()) { 7718 ToForget.insert(ToForget.end(), LoopUsersItr->second.begin(), 7719 LoopUsersItr->second.end()); 7720 LoopUsers.erase(LoopUsersItr); 7721 } 7722 7723 // Drop information about expressions based on loop-header PHIs. 7724 PushLoopPHIs(CurrL, Worklist, Visited); 7725 7726 while (!Worklist.empty()) { 7727 Instruction *I = Worklist.pop_back_val(); 7728 7729 ValueExprMapType::iterator It = 7730 ValueExprMap.find_as(static_cast<Value *>(I)); 7731 if (It != ValueExprMap.end()) { 7732 eraseValueFromMap(It->first); 7733 ToForget.push_back(It->second); 7734 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) 7735 ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN); 7736 } 7737 7738 PushDefUseChildren(I, Worklist, Visited); 7739 } 7740 7741 LoopPropertiesCache.erase(CurrL); 7742 // Forget all contained loops too, to avoid dangling entries in the 7743 // ValuesAtScopes map. 7744 LoopWorklist.append(CurrL->begin(), CurrL->end()); 7745 } 7746 forgetMemoizedResults(ToForget); 7747 } 7748 7749 void ScalarEvolution::forgetTopmostLoop(const Loop *L) { 7750 while (Loop *Parent = L->getParentLoop()) 7751 L = Parent; 7752 forgetLoop(L); 7753 } 7754 7755 void ScalarEvolution::forgetValue(Value *V) { 7756 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V); 7757 if (!I) return; 7758 7759 // Drop information about expressions based on loop-header PHIs. 7760 SmallVector<Instruction *, 16> Worklist; 7761 SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 8> Visited; 7762 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> ToForget; 7763 Worklist.push_back(I); 7764 Visited.insert(I); 7765 7766 while (!Worklist.empty()) { 7767 I = Worklist.pop_back_val(); 7768 ValueExprMapType::iterator It = 7769 ValueExprMap.find_as(static_cast<Value *>(I)); 7770 if (It != ValueExprMap.end()) { 7771 eraseValueFromMap(It->first); 7772 ToForget.push_back(It->second); 7773 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) 7774 ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN); 7775 } 7776 7777 PushDefUseChildren(I, Worklist, Visited); 7778 } 7779 forgetMemoizedResults(ToForget); 7780 } 7781 7782 void ScalarEvolution::forgetLoopDispositions(const Loop *L) { 7783 LoopDispositions.clear(); 7784 } 7785 7786 /// Get the exact loop backedge taken count considering all loop exits. A 7787 /// computable result can only be returned for loops with all exiting blocks 7788 /// dominating the latch. howFarToZero assumes that the limit of each loop test 7789 /// is never skipped. This is a valid assumption as long as the loop exits via 7790 /// that test. For precise results, it is the caller's responsibility to specify 7791 /// the relevant loop exiting block using getExact(ExitingBlock, SE). 7792 const SCEV * 7793 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::getExact(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution *SE, 7794 SCEVUnionPredicate *Preds) const { 7795 // If any exits were not computable, the loop is not computable. 7796 if (!isComplete() || ExitNotTaken.empty()) 7797 return SE->getCouldNotCompute(); 7798 7799 const BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch(); 7800 // All exiting blocks we have collected must dominate the only backedge. 7801 if (!Latch) 7802 return SE->getCouldNotCompute(); 7803 7804 // All exiting blocks we have gathered dominate loop's latch, so exact trip 7805 // count is simply a minimum out of all these calculated exit counts. 7806 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 2> Ops; 7807 for (auto &ENT : ExitNotTaken) { 7808 const SCEV *BECount = ENT.ExactNotTaken; 7809 assert(BECount != SE->getCouldNotCompute() && "Bad exit SCEV!"); 7810 assert(SE->DT.dominates(ENT.ExitingBlock, Latch) && 7811 "We should only have known counts for exiting blocks that dominate " 7812 "latch!"); 7813 7814 Ops.push_back(BECount); 7815 7816 if (Preds && !ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate()) 7817 Preds->add(ENT.Predicate.get()); 7818 7819 assert((Preds || ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate()) && 7820 "Predicate should be always true!"); 7821 } 7822 7823 return SE->getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(Ops); 7824 } 7825 7826 /// Get the exact not taken count for this loop exit. 7827 const SCEV * 7828 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::getExact(const BasicBlock *ExitingBlock, 7829 ScalarEvolution *SE) const { 7830 for (auto &ENT : ExitNotTaken) 7831 if (ENT.ExitingBlock == ExitingBlock && ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate()) 7832 return ENT.ExactNotTaken; 7833 7834 return SE->getCouldNotCompute(); 7835 } 7836 7837 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::getConstantMax( 7838 const BasicBlock *ExitingBlock, ScalarEvolution *SE) const { 7839 for (auto &ENT : ExitNotTaken) 7840 if (ENT.ExitingBlock == ExitingBlock && ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate()) 7841 return ENT.MaxNotTaken; 7842 7843 return SE->getCouldNotCompute(); 7844 } 7845 7846 /// getConstantMax - Get the constant max backedge taken count for the loop. 7847 const SCEV * 7848 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::getConstantMax(ScalarEvolution *SE) const { 7849 auto PredicateNotAlwaysTrue = [](const ExitNotTakenInfo &ENT) { 7850 return !ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate(); 7851 }; 7852 7853 if (!getConstantMax() || any_of(ExitNotTaken, PredicateNotAlwaysTrue)) 7854 return SE->getCouldNotCompute(); 7855 7856 assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(getConstantMax()) || 7857 isa<SCEVConstant>(getConstantMax())) && 7858 "No point in having a non-constant max backedge taken count!"); 7859 return getConstantMax(); 7860 } 7861 7862 const SCEV * 7863 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::getSymbolicMax(const Loop *L, 7864 ScalarEvolution *SE) { 7865 if (!SymbolicMax) 7866 SymbolicMax = SE->computeSymbolicMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L); 7867 return SymbolicMax; 7868 } 7869 7870 bool ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::isConstantMaxOrZero( 7871 ScalarEvolution *SE) const { 7872 auto PredicateNotAlwaysTrue = [](const ExitNotTakenInfo &ENT) { 7873 return !ENT.hasAlwaysTruePredicate(); 7874 }; 7875 return MaxOrZero && !any_of(ExitNotTaken, PredicateNotAlwaysTrue); 7876 } 7877 7878 bool ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::hasOperand(const SCEV *S) const { 7879 return Operands.contains(S); 7880 } 7881 7882 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit::ExitLimit(const SCEV *E) 7883 : ExitLimit(E, E, false, None) { 7884 } 7885 7886 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit::ExitLimit( 7887 const SCEV *E, const SCEV *M, bool MaxOrZero, 7888 ArrayRef<const SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> *> PredSetList) 7889 : ExactNotTaken(E), MaxNotTaken(M), MaxOrZero(MaxOrZero) { 7890 // If we prove the max count is zero, so is the symbolic bound. This happens 7891 // in practice due to differences in a) how context sensitive we've chosen 7892 // to be and b) how we reason about bounds impied by UB. 7893 if (MaxNotTaken->isZero()) 7894 ExactNotTaken = MaxNotTaken; 7895 7896 assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ExactNotTaken) || 7897 !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxNotTaken)) && 7898 "Exact is not allowed to be less precise than Max"); 7899 assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxNotTaken) || 7900 isa<SCEVConstant>(MaxNotTaken)) && 7901 "No point in having a non-constant max backedge taken count!"); 7902 for (auto *PredSet : PredSetList) 7903 for (auto *P : *PredSet) 7904 addPredicate(P); 7905 assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(E) || !E->getType()->isPointerTy()) && 7906 "Backedge count should be int"); 7907 assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(M) || !M->getType()->isPointerTy()) && 7908 "Max backedge count should be int"); 7909 } 7910 7911 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit::ExitLimit( 7912 const SCEV *E, const SCEV *M, bool MaxOrZero, 7913 const SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> &PredSet) 7914 : ExitLimit(E, M, MaxOrZero, {&PredSet}) { 7915 } 7916 7917 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit::ExitLimit(const SCEV *E, const SCEV *M, 7918 bool MaxOrZero) 7919 : ExitLimit(E, M, MaxOrZero, None) { 7920 } 7921 7922 class SCEVRecordOperands { 7923 SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEV *> &Operands; 7924 7925 public: 7926 SCEVRecordOperands(SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEV *> &Operands) 7927 : Operands(Operands) {} 7928 bool follow(const SCEV *S) { 7929 Operands.insert(S); 7930 return true; 7931 } 7932 bool isDone() { return false; } 7933 }; 7934 7935 /// Allocate memory for BackedgeTakenInfo and copy the not-taken count of each 7936 /// computable exit into a persistent ExitNotTakenInfo array. 7937 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::BackedgeTakenInfo( 7938 ArrayRef<ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::EdgeExitInfo> ExitCounts, 7939 bool IsComplete, const SCEV *ConstantMax, bool MaxOrZero) 7940 : ConstantMax(ConstantMax), IsComplete(IsComplete), MaxOrZero(MaxOrZero) { 7941 using EdgeExitInfo = ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::EdgeExitInfo; 7942 7943 ExitNotTaken.reserve(ExitCounts.size()); 7944 std::transform( 7945 ExitCounts.begin(), ExitCounts.end(), std::back_inserter(ExitNotTaken), 7946 [&](const EdgeExitInfo &EEI) { 7947 BasicBlock *ExitBB = EEI.first; 7948 const ExitLimit &EL = EEI.second; 7949 if (EL.Predicates.empty()) 7950 return ExitNotTakenInfo(ExitBB, EL.ExactNotTaken, EL.MaxNotTaken, 7951 nullptr); 7952 7953 std::unique_ptr<SCEVUnionPredicate> Predicate(new SCEVUnionPredicate); 7954 for (auto *Pred : EL.Predicates) 7955 Predicate->add(Pred); 7956 7957 return ExitNotTakenInfo(ExitBB, EL.ExactNotTaken, EL.MaxNotTaken, 7958 std::move(Predicate)); 7959 }); 7960 assert((isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ConstantMax) || 7961 isa<SCEVConstant>(ConstantMax)) && 7962 "No point in having a non-constant max backedge taken count!"); 7963 7964 SCEVRecordOperands RecordOperands(Operands); 7965 SCEVTraversal<SCEVRecordOperands> ST(RecordOperands); 7966 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ConstantMax)) 7967 ST.visitAll(ConstantMax); 7968 for (auto &ENT : ExitNotTaken) 7969 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ENT.ExactNotTaken)) 7970 ST.visitAll(ENT.ExactNotTaken); 7971 } 7972 7973 /// Compute the number of times the backedge of the specified loop will execute. 7974 ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo 7975 ScalarEvolution::computeBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L, 7976 bool AllowPredicates) { 7977 SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 8> ExitingBlocks; 7978 L->getExitingBlocks(ExitingBlocks); 7979 7980 using EdgeExitInfo = ScalarEvolution::BackedgeTakenInfo::EdgeExitInfo; 7981 7982 SmallVector<EdgeExitInfo, 4> ExitCounts; 7983 bool CouldComputeBECount = true; 7984 BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch(); // may be NULL. 7985 const SCEV *MustExitMaxBECount = nullptr; 7986 const SCEV *MayExitMaxBECount = nullptr; 7987 bool MustExitMaxOrZero = false; 7988 7989 // Compute the ExitLimit for each loop exit. Use this to populate ExitCounts 7990 // and compute maxBECount. 7991 // Do a union of all the predicates here. 7992 for (unsigned i = 0, e = ExitingBlocks.size(); i != e; ++i) { 7993 BasicBlock *ExitBB = ExitingBlocks[i]; 7994 7995 // We canonicalize untaken exits to br (constant), ignore them so that 7996 // proving an exit untaken doesn't negatively impact our ability to reason 7997 // about the loop as whole. 7998 if (auto *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(ExitBB->getTerminator())) 7999 if (auto *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) { 8000 bool ExitIfTrue = !L->contains(BI->getSuccessor(0)); 8001 if (ExitIfTrue == CI->isZero()) 8002 continue; 8003 } 8004 8005 ExitLimit EL = computeExitLimit(L, ExitBB, AllowPredicates); 8006 8007 assert((AllowPredicates || EL.Predicates.empty()) && 8008 "Predicated exit limit when predicates are not allowed!"); 8009 8010 // 1. For each exit that can be computed, add an entry to ExitCounts. 8011 // CouldComputeBECount is true only if all exits can be computed. 8012 if (EL.ExactNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute()) 8013 // We couldn't compute an exact value for this exit, so 8014 // we won't be able to compute an exact value for the loop. 8015 CouldComputeBECount = false; 8016 else 8017 ExitCounts.emplace_back(ExitBB, EL); 8018 8019 // 2. Derive the loop's MaxBECount from each exit's max number of 8020 // non-exiting iterations. Partition the loop exits into two kinds: 8021 // LoopMustExits and LoopMayExits. 8022 // 8023 // If the exit dominates the loop latch, it is a LoopMustExit otherwise it 8024 // is a LoopMayExit. If any computable LoopMustExit is found, then 8025 // MaxBECount is the minimum EL.MaxNotTaken of computable 8026 // LoopMustExits. Otherwise, MaxBECount is conservatively the maximum 8027 // EL.MaxNotTaken, where CouldNotCompute is considered greater than any 8028 // computable EL.MaxNotTaken. 8029 if (EL.MaxNotTaken != getCouldNotCompute() && Latch && 8030 DT.dominates(ExitBB, Latch)) { 8031 if (!MustExitMaxBECount) { 8032 MustExitMaxBECount = EL.MaxNotTaken; 8033 MustExitMaxOrZero = EL.MaxOrZero; 8034 } else { 8035 MustExitMaxBECount = 8036 getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(MustExitMaxBECount, EL.MaxNotTaken); 8037 } 8038 } else if (MayExitMaxBECount != getCouldNotCompute()) { 8039 if (!MayExitMaxBECount || EL.MaxNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute()) 8040 MayExitMaxBECount = EL.MaxNotTaken; 8041 else { 8042 MayExitMaxBECount = 8043 getUMaxFromMismatchedTypes(MayExitMaxBECount, EL.MaxNotTaken); 8044 } 8045 } 8046 } 8047 const SCEV *MaxBECount = MustExitMaxBECount ? MustExitMaxBECount : 8048 (MayExitMaxBECount ? MayExitMaxBECount : getCouldNotCompute()); 8049 // The loop backedge will be taken the maximum or zero times if there's 8050 // a single exit that must be taken the maximum or zero times. 8051 bool MaxOrZero = (MustExitMaxOrZero && ExitingBlocks.size() == 1); 8052 return BackedgeTakenInfo(std::move(ExitCounts), CouldComputeBECount, 8053 MaxBECount, MaxOrZero); 8054 } 8055 8056 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit 8057 ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimit(const Loop *L, BasicBlock *ExitingBlock, 8058 bool AllowPredicates) { 8059 assert(L->contains(ExitingBlock) && "Exit count for non-loop block?"); 8060 // If our exiting block does not dominate the latch, then its connection with 8061 // loop's exit limit may be far from trivial. 8062 const BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch(); 8063 if (!Latch || !DT.dominates(ExitingBlock, Latch)) 8064 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8065 8066 bool IsOnlyExit = (L->getExitingBlock() != nullptr); 8067 Instruction *Term = ExitingBlock->getTerminator(); 8068 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Term)) { 8069 assert(BI->isConditional() && "If unconditional, it can't be in loop!"); 8070 bool ExitIfTrue = !L->contains(BI->getSuccessor(0)); 8071 assert(ExitIfTrue == L->contains(BI->getSuccessor(1)) && 8072 "It should have one successor in loop and one exit block!"); 8073 // Proceed to the next level to examine the exit condition expression. 8074 return computeExitLimitFromCond( 8075 L, BI->getCondition(), ExitIfTrue, 8076 /*ControlsExit=*/IsOnlyExit, AllowPredicates); 8077 } 8078 8079 if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(Term)) { 8080 // For switch, make sure that there is a single exit from the loop. 8081 BasicBlock *Exit = nullptr; 8082 for (auto *SBB : successors(ExitingBlock)) 8083 if (!L->contains(SBB)) { 8084 if (Exit) // Multiple exit successors. 8085 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8086 Exit = SBB; 8087 } 8088 assert(Exit && "Exiting block must have at least one exit"); 8089 return computeExitLimitFromSingleExitSwitch(L, SI, Exit, 8090 /*ControlsExit=*/IsOnlyExit); 8091 } 8092 8093 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8094 } 8095 8096 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromCond( 8097 const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond, bool ExitIfTrue, 8098 bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) { 8099 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimitCacheTy Cache(L, ExitIfTrue, AllowPredicates); 8100 return computeExitLimitFromCondCached(Cache, L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue, 8101 ControlsExit, AllowPredicates); 8102 } 8103 8104 Optional<ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit> 8105 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimitCache::find(const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond, 8106 bool ExitIfTrue, bool ControlsExit, 8107 bool AllowPredicates) { 8108 (void)this->L; 8109 (void)this->ExitIfTrue; 8110 (void)this->AllowPredicates; 8111 8112 assert(this->L == L && this->ExitIfTrue == ExitIfTrue && 8113 this->AllowPredicates == AllowPredicates && 8114 "Variance in assumed invariant key components!"); 8115 auto Itr = TripCountMap.find({ExitCond, ControlsExit}); 8116 if (Itr == TripCountMap.end()) 8117 return None; 8118 return Itr->second; 8119 } 8120 8121 void ScalarEvolution::ExitLimitCache::insert(const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond, 8122 bool ExitIfTrue, 8123 bool ControlsExit, 8124 bool AllowPredicates, 8125 const ExitLimit &EL) { 8126 assert(this->L == L && this->ExitIfTrue == ExitIfTrue && 8127 this->AllowPredicates == AllowPredicates && 8128 "Variance in assumed invariant key components!"); 8129 8130 auto InsertResult = TripCountMap.insert({{ExitCond, ControlsExit}, EL}); 8131 assert(InsertResult.second && "Expected successful insertion!"); 8132 (void)InsertResult; 8133 (void)ExitIfTrue; 8134 } 8135 8136 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromCondCached( 8137 ExitLimitCacheTy &Cache, const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond, bool ExitIfTrue, 8138 bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) { 8139 8140 if (auto MaybeEL = 8141 Cache.find(L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue, ControlsExit, AllowPredicates)) 8142 return *MaybeEL; 8143 8144 ExitLimit EL = computeExitLimitFromCondImpl(Cache, L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue, 8145 ControlsExit, AllowPredicates); 8146 Cache.insert(L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue, ControlsExit, AllowPredicates, EL); 8147 return EL; 8148 } 8149 8150 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromCondImpl( 8151 ExitLimitCacheTy &Cache, const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond, bool ExitIfTrue, 8152 bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) { 8153 // Handle BinOp conditions (And, Or). 8154 if (auto LimitFromBinOp = computeExitLimitFromCondFromBinOp( 8155 Cache, L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue, ControlsExit, AllowPredicates)) 8156 return *LimitFromBinOp; 8157 8158 // With an icmp, it may be feasible to compute an exact backedge-taken count. 8159 // Proceed to the next level to examine the icmp. 8160 if (ICmpInst *ExitCondICmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(ExitCond)) { 8161 ExitLimit EL = 8162 computeExitLimitFromICmp(L, ExitCondICmp, ExitIfTrue, ControlsExit); 8163 if (EL.hasFullInfo() || !AllowPredicates) 8164 return EL; 8165 8166 // Try again, but use SCEV predicates this time. 8167 return computeExitLimitFromICmp(L, ExitCondICmp, ExitIfTrue, ControlsExit, 8168 /*AllowPredicates=*/true); 8169 } 8170 8171 // Check for a constant condition. These are normally stripped out by 8172 // SimplifyCFG, but ScalarEvolution may be used by a pass which wishes to 8173 // preserve the CFG and is temporarily leaving constant conditions 8174 // in place. 8175 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ExitCond)) { 8176 if (ExitIfTrue == !CI->getZExtValue()) 8177 // The backedge is always taken. 8178 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8179 else 8180 // The backedge is never taken. 8181 return getZero(CI->getType()); 8182 } 8183 8184 // If it's not an integer or pointer comparison then compute it the hard way. 8185 return computeExitCountExhaustively(L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue); 8186 } 8187 8188 Optional<ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit> 8189 ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromCondFromBinOp( 8190 ExitLimitCacheTy &Cache, const Loop *L, Value *ExitCond, bool ExitIfTrue, 8191 bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) { 8192 // Check if the controlling expression for this loop is an And or Or. 8193 Value *Op0, *Op1; 8194 bool IsAnd = false; 8195 if (match(ExitCond, m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(Op0), m_Value(Op1)))) 8196 IsAnd = true; 8197 else if (match(ExitCond, m_LogicalOr(m_Value(Op0), m_Value(Op1)))) 8198 IsAnd = false; 8199 else 8200 return None; 8201 8202 // EitherMayExit is true in these two cases: 8203 // br (and Op0 Op1), loop, exit 8204 // br (or Op0 Op1), exit, loop 8205 bool EitherMayExit = IsAnd ^ ExitIfTrue; 8206 ExitLimit EL0 = computeExitLimitFromCondCached(Cache, L, Op0, ExitIfTrue, 8207 ControlsExit && !EitherMayExit, 8208 AllowPredicates); 8209 ExitLimit EL1 = computeExitLimitFromCondCached(Cache, L, Op1, ExitIfTrue, 8210 ControlsExit && !EitherMayExit, 8211 AllowPredicates); 8212 8213 // Be robust against unsimplified IR for the form "op i1 X, NeutralElement" 8214 const Constant *NeutralElement = ConstantInt::get(ExitCond->getType(), IsAnd); 8215 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) 8216 return Op1 == NeutralElement ? EL0 : EL1; 8217 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op0)) 8218 return Op0 == NeutralElement ? EL1 : EL0; 8219 8220 const SCEV *BECount = getCouldNotCompute(); 8221 const SCEV *MaxBECount = getCouldNotCompute(); 8222 if (EitherMayExit) { 8223 // Both conditions must be same for the loop to continue executing. 8224 // Choose the less conservative count. 8225 // If ExitCond is a short-circuit form (select), using 8226 // umin(EL0.ExactNotTaken, EL1.ExactNotTaken) is unsafe in general. 8227 // To see the detailed examples, please see 8228 // test/Analysis/ScalarEvolution/exit-count-select.ll 8229 bool PoisonSafe = isa<BinaryOperator>(ExitCond); 8230 if (!PoisonSafe) 8231 // Even if ExitCond is select, we can safely derive BECount using both 8232 // EL0 and EL1 in these cases: 8233 // (1) EL0.ExactNotTaken is non-zero 8234 // (2) EL1.ExactNotTaken is non-poison 8235 // (3) EL0.ExactNotTaken is zero (BECount should be simply zero and 8236 // it cannot be umin(0, ..)) 8237 // The PoisonSafe assignment below is simplified and the assertion after 8238 // BECount calculation fully guarantees the condition (3). 8239 PoisonSafe = isa<SCEVConstant>(EL0.ExactNotTaken) || 8240 isa<SCEVConstant>(EL1.ExactNotTaken); 8241 if (EL0.ExactNotTaken != getCouldNotCompute() && 8242 EL1.ExactNotTaken != getCouldNotCompute() && PoisonSafe) { 8243 BECount = 8244 getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(EL0.ExactNotTaken, EL1.ExactNotTaken); 8245 8246 // If EL0.ExactNotTaken was zero and ExitCond was a short-circuit form, 8247 // it should have been simplified to zero (see the condition (3) above) 8248 assert(!isa<BinaryOperator>(ExitCond) || !EL0.ExactNotTaken->isZero() || 8249 BECount->isZero()); 8250 } 8251 if (EL0.MaxNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute()) 8252 MaxBECount = EL1.MaxNotTaken; 8253 else if (EL1.MaxNotTaken == getCouldNotCompute()) 8254 MaxBECount = EL0.MaxNotTaken; 8255 else 8256 MaxBECount = getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(EL0.MaxNotTaken, EL1.MaxNotTaken); 8257 } else { 8258 // Both conditions must be same at the same time for the loop to exit. 8259 // For now, be conservative. 8260 if (EL0.ExactNotTaken == EL1.ExactNotTaken) 8261 BECount = EL0.ExactNotTaken; 8262 } 8263 8264 // There are cases (e.g. PR26207) where computeExitLimitFromCond is able 8265 // to be more aggressive when computing BECount than when computing 8266 // MaxBECount. In these cases it is possible for EL0.ExactNotTaken and 8267 // EL1.ExactNotTaken to match, but for EL0.MaxNotTaken and EL1.MaxNotTaken 8268 // to not. 8269 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) && 8270 !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(BECount)) 8271 MaxBECount = getConstant(getUnsignedRangeMax(BECount)); 8272 8273 return ExitLimit(BECount, MaxBECount, false, 8274 { &EL0.Predicates, &EL1.Predicates }); 8275 } 8276 8277 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit 8278 ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromICmp(const Loop *L, 8279 ICmpInst *ExitCond, 8280 bool ExitIfTrue, 8281 bool ControlsExit, 8282 bool AllowPredicates) { 8283 // If the condition was exit on true, convert the condition to exit on false 8284 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred; 8285 if (!ExitIfTrue) 8286 Pred = ExitCond->getPredicate(); 8287 else 8288 Pred = ExitCond->getInversePredicate(); 8289 const ICmpInst::Predicate OriginalPred = Pred; 8290 8291 const SCEV *LHS = getSCEV(ExitCond->getOperand(0)); 8292 const SCEV *RHS = getSCEV(ExitCond->getOperand(1)); 8293 8294 // Try to evaluate any dependencies out of the loop. 8295 LHS = getSCEVAtScope(LHS, L); 8296 RHS = getSCEVAtScope(RHS, L); 8297 8298 // At this point, we would like to compute how many iterations of the 8299 // loop the predicate will return true for these inputs. 8300 if (isLoopInvariant(LHS, L) && !isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) { 8301 // If there is a loop-invariant, force it into the RHS. 8302 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 8303 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred); 8304 } 8305 8306 // Simplify the operands before analyzing them. 8307 (void)SimplifyICmpOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS); 8308 8309 // If we have a comparison of a chrec against a constant, try to use value 8310 // ranges to answer this query. 8311 if (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) 8312 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS)) 8313 if (AddRec->getLoop() == L) { 8314 // Form the constant range. 8315 ConstantRange CompRange = 8316 ConstantRange::makeExactICmpRegion(Pred, RHSC->getAPInt()); 8317 8318 const SCEV *Ret = AddRec->getNumIterationsInRange(CompRange, *this); 8319 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(Ret)) return Ret; 8320 } 8321 8322 // If this loop must exit based on this condition (or execute undefined 8323 // behaviour), and we can prove the test sequence produced must repeat 8324 // the same values on self-wrap of the IV, then we can infer that IV 8325 // doesn't self wrap because if it did, we'd have an infinite (undefined) 8326 // loop. 8327 if (ControlsExit && isLoopInvariant(RHS, L) && loopHasNoAbnormalExits(L) && 8328 loopIsFiniteByAssumption(L)) { 8329 8330 // TODO: We can peel off any functions which are invertible *in L*. Loop 8331 // invariant terms are effectively constants for our purposes here. 8332 auto *InnerLHS = LHS; 8333 if (auto *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(LHS)) 8334 InnerLHS = ZExt->getOperand(); 8335 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(InnerLHS)) { 8336 auto *StrideC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this)); 8337 if (!AR->hasNoSelfWrap() && AR->getLoop() == L && AR->isAffine() && 8338 StrideC && StrideC->getAPInt().isPowerOf2()) { 8339 auto Flags = AR->getNoWrapFlags(); 8340 Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNW); 8341 SmallVector<const SCEV*> Operands{AR->operands()}; 8342 Flags = StrengthenNoWrapFlags(this, scAddRecExpr, Operands, Flags); 8343 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), Flags); 8344 } 8345 } 8346 } 8347 8348 switch (Pred) { 8349 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: { // while (X != Y) 8350 // Convert to: while (X-Y != 0) 8351 if (LHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 8352 LHS = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(LHS); 8353 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(LHS)) 8354 return LHS; 8355 } 8356 if (RHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 8357 RHS = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(RHS); 8358 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(RHS)) 8359 return RHS; 8360 } 8361 ExitLimit EL = howFarToZero(getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS), L, ControlsExit, 8362 AllowPredicates); 8363 if (EL.hasAnyInfo()) return EL; 8364 break; 8365 } 8366 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // while (X == Y) 8367 // Convert to: while (X-Y == 0) 8368 if (LHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 8369 LHS = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(LHS); 8370 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(LHS)) 8371 return LHS; 8372 } 8373 if (RHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 8374 RHS = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(RHS); 8375 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(RHS)) 8376 return RHS; 8377 } 8378 ExitLimit EL = howFarToNonZero(getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS), L); 8379 if (EL.hasAnyInfo()) return EL; 8380 break; 8381 } 8382 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: 8383 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: { // while (X < Y) 8384 bool IsSigned = Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; 8385 ExitLimit EL = howManyLessThans(LHS, RHS, L, IsSigned, ControlsExit, 8386 AllowPredicates); 8387 if (EL.hasAnyInfo()) return EL; 8388 break; 8389 } 8390 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: 8391 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: { // while (X > Y) 8392 bool IsSigned = Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; 8393 ExitLimit EL = 8394 howManyGreaterThans(LHS, RHS, L, IsSigned, ControlsExit, 8395 AllowPredicates); 8396 if (EL.hasAnyInfo()) return EL; 8397 break; 8398 } 8399 default: 8400 break; 8401 } 8402 8403 auto *ExhaustiveCount = 8404 computeExitCountExhaustively(L, ExitCond, ExitIfTrue); 8405 8406 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ExhaustiveCount)) 8407 return ExhaustiveCount; 8408 8409 return computeShiftCompareExitLimit(ExitCond->getOperand(0), 8410 ExitCond->getOperand(1), L, OriginalPred); 8411 } 8412 8413 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit 8414 ScalarEvolution::computeExitLimitFromSingleExitSwitch(const Loop *L, 8415 SwitchInst *Switch, 8416 BasicBlock *ExitingBlock, 8417 bool ControlsExit) { 8418 assert(!L->contains(ExitingBlock) && "Not an exiting block!"); 8419 8420 // Give up if the exit is the default dest of a switch. 8421 if (Switch->getDefaultDest() == ExitingBlock) 8422 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8423 8424 assert(L->contains(Switch->getDefaultDest()) && 8425 "Default case must not exit the loop!"); 8426 const SCEV *LHS = getSCEVAtScope(Switch->getCondition(), L); 8427 const SCEV *RHS = getConstant(Switch->findCaseDest(ExitingBlock)); 8428 8429 // while (X != Y) --> while (X-Y != 0) 8430 ExitLimit EL = howFarToZero(getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS), L, ControlsExit); 8431 if (EL.hasAnyInfo()) 8432 return EL; 8433 8434 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8435 } 8436 8437 static ConstantInt * 8438 EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec, ConstantInt *C, 8439 ScalarEvolution &SE) { 8440 const SCEV *InVal = SE.getConstant(C); 8441 const SCEV *Val = AddRec->evaluateAtIteration(InVal, SE); 8442 assert(isa<SCEVConstant>(Val) && 8443 "Evaluation of SCEV at constant didn't fold correctly?"); 8444 return cast<SCEVConstant>(Val)->getValue(); 8445 } 8446 8447 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit ScalarEvolution::computeShiftCompareExitLimit( 8448 Value *LHS, Value *RHSV, const Loop *L, ICmpInst::Predicate Pred) { 8449 ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV); 8450 if (!RHS) 8451 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8452 8453 const BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch(); 8454 if (!Latch) 8455 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8456 8457 const BasicBlock *Predecessor = L->getLoopPredecessor(); 8458 if (!Predecessor) 8459 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8460 8461 // Return true if V is of the form "LHS `shift_op` <positive constant>". 8462 // Return LHS in OutLHS and shift_opt in OutOpCode. 8463 auto MatchPositiveShift = 8464 [](Value *V, Value *&OutLHS, Instruction::BinaryOps &OutOpCode) { 8465 8466 using namespace PatternMatch; 8467 8468 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt; 8469 if (match(V, m_LShr(m_Value(OutLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt)))) 8470 OutOpCode = Instruction::LShr; 8471 else if (match(V, m_AShr(m_Value(OutLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt)))) 8472 OutOpCode = Instruction::AShr; 8473 else if (match(V, m_Shl(m_Value(OutLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt)))) 8474 OutOpCode = Instruction::Shl; 8475 else 8476 return false; 8477 8478 return ShiftAmt->getValue().isStrictlyPositive(); 8479 }; 8480 8481 // Recognize a "shift recurrence" either of the form %iv or of %iv.shifted in 8482 // 8483 // loop: 8484 // %iv = phi i32 [ %iv.shifted, %loop ], [ %val, %preheader ] 8485 // %iv.shifted = lshr i32 %iv, <positive constant> 8486 // 8487 // Return true on a successful match. Return the corresponding PHI node (%iv 8488 // above) in PNOut and the opcode of the shift operation in OpCodeOut. 8489 auto MatchShiftRecurrence = 8490 [&](Value *V, PHINode *&PNOut, Instruction::BinaryOps &OpCodeOut) { 8491 Optional<Instruction::BinaryOps> PostShiftOpCode; 8492 8493 { 8494 Instruction::BinaryOps OpC; 8495 Value *V; 8496 8497 // If we encounter a shift instruction, "peel off" the shift operation, 8498 // and remember that we did so. Later when we inspect %iv's backedge 8499 // value, we will make sure that the backedge value uses the same 8500 // operation. 8501 // 8502 // Note: the peeled shift operation does not have to be the same 8503 // instruction as the one feeding into the PHI's backedge value. We only 8504 // really care about it being the same *kind* of shift instruction -- 8505 // that's all that is required for our later inferences to hold. 8506 if (MatchPositiveShift(LHS, V, OpC)) { 8507 PostShiftOpCode = OpC; 8508 LHS = V; 8509 } 8510 } 8511 8512 PNOut = dyn_cast<PHINode>(LHS); 8513 if (!PNOut || PNOut->getParent() != L->getHeader()) 8514 return false; 8515 8516 Value *BEValue = PNOut->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch); 8517 Value *OpLHS; 8518 8519 return 8520 // The backedge value for the PHI node must be a shift by a positive 8521 // amount 8522 MatchPositiveShift(BEValue, OpLHS, OpCodeOut) && 8523 8524 // of the PHI node itself 8525 OpLHS == PNOut && 8526 8527 // and the kind of shift should be match the kind of shift we peeled 8528 // off, if any. 8529 (!PostShiftOpCode.hasValue() || *PostShiftOpCode == OpCodeOut); 8530 }; 8531 8532 PHINode *PN; 8533 Instruction::BinaryOps OpCode; 8534 if (!MatchShiftRecurrence(LHS, PN, OpCode)) 8535 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8536 8537 const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout(); 8538 8539 // The key rationale for this optimization is that for some kinds of shift 8540 // recurrences, the value of the recurrence "stabilizes" to either 0 or -1 8541 // within a finite number of iterations. If the condition guarding the 8542 // backedge (in the sense that the backedge is taken if the condition is true) 8543 // is false for the value the shift recurrence stabilizes to, then we know 8544 // that the backedge is taken only a finite number of times. 8545 8546 ConstantInt *StableValue = nullptr; 8547 switch (OpCode) { 8548 default: 8549 llvm_unreachable("Impossible case!"); 8550 8551 case Instruction::AShr: { 8552 // {K,ashr,<positive-constant>} stabilizes to signum(K) in at most 8553 // bitwidth(K) iterations. 8554 Value *FirstValue = PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(Predecessor); 8555 KnownBits Known = computeKnownBits(FirstValue, DL, 0, &AC, 8556 Predecessor->getTerminator(), &DT); 8557 auto *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType()); 8558 if (Known.isNonNegative()) 8559 StableValue = ConstantInt::get(Ty, 0); 8560 else if (Known.isNegative()) 8561 StableValue = ConstantInt::get(Ty, -1, true); 8562 else 8563 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8564 8565 break; 8566 } 8567 case Instruction::LShr: 8568 case Instruction::Shl: 8569 // Both {K,lshr,<positive-constant>} and {K,shl,<positive-constant>} 8570 // stabilize to 0 in at most bitwidth(K) iterations. 8571 StableValue = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType()), 0); 8572 break; 8573 } 8574 8575 auto *Result = 8576 ConstantFoldCompareInstOperands(Pred, StableValue, RHS, DL, &TLI); 8577 assert(Result->getType()->isIntegerTy(1) && 8578 "Otherwise cannot be an operand to a branch instruction"); 8579 8580 if (Result->isZeroValue()) { 8581 unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType()); 8582 const SCEV *UpperBound = 8583 getConstant(getEffectiveSCEVType(RHS->getType()), BitWidth); 8584 return ExitLimit(getCouldNotCompute(), UpperBound, false); 8585 } 8586 8587 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8588 } 8589 8590 /// Return true if we can constant fold an instruction of the specified type, 8591 /// assuming that all operands were constants. 8592 static bool CanConstantFold(const Instruction *I) { 8593 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(I) || isa<CmpInst>(I) || 8594 isa<SelectInst>(I) || isa<CastInst>(I) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(I) || 8595 isa<LoadInst>(I) || isa<ExtractValueInst>(I)) 8596 return true; 8597 8598 if (const CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(I)) 8599 if (const Function *F = CI->getCalledFunction()) 8600 return canConstantFoldCallTo(CI, F); 8601 return false; 8602 } 8603 8604 /// Determine whether this instruction can constant evolve within this loop 8605 /// assuming its operands can all constant evolve. 8606 static bool canConstantEvolve(Instruction *I, const Loop *L) { 8607 // An instruction outside of the loop can't be derived from a loop PHI. 8608 if (!L->contains(I)) return false; 8609 8610 if (isa<PHINode>(I)) { 8611 // We don't currently keep track of the control flow needed to evaluate 8612 // PHIs, so we cannot handle PHIs inside of loops. 8613 return L->getHeader() == I->getParent(); 8614 } 8615 8616 // If we won't be able to constant fold this expression even if the operands 8617 // are constants, bail early. 8618 return CanConstantFold(I); 8619 } 8620 8621 /// getConstantEvolvingPHIOperands - Implement getConstantEvolvingPHI by 8622 /// recursing through each instruction operand until reaching a loop header phi. 8623 static PHINode * 8624 getConstantEvolvingPHIOperands(Instruction *UseInst, const Loop *L, 8625 DenseMap<Instruction *, PHINode *> &PHIMap, 8626 unsigned Depth) { 8627 if (Depth > MaxConstantEvolvingDepth) 8628 return nullptr; 8629 8630 // Otherwise, we can evaluate this instruction if all of its operands are 8631 // constant or derived from a PHI node themselves. 8632 PHINode *PHI = nullptr; 8633 for (Value *Op : UseInst->operands()) { 8634 if (isa<Constant>(Op)) continue; 8635 8636 Instruction *OpInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op); 8637 if (!OpInst || !canConstantEvolve(OpInst, L)) return nullptr; 8638 8639 PHINode *P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(OpInst); 8640 if (!P) 8641 // If this operand is already visited, reuse the prior result. 8642 // We may have P != PHI if this is the deepest point at which the 8643 // inconsistent paths meet. 8644 P = PHIMap.lookup(OpInst); 8645 if (!P) { 8646 // Recurse and memoize the results, whether a phi is found or not. 8647 // This recursive call invalidates pointers into PHIMap. 8648 P = getConstantEvolvingPHIOperands(OpInst, L, PHIMap, Depth + 1); 8649 PHIMap[OpInst] = P; 8650 } 8651 if (!P) 8652 return nullptr; // Not evolving from PHI 8653 if (PHI && PHI != P) 8654 return nullptr; // Evolving from multiple different PHIs. 8655 PHI = P; 8656 } 8657 // This is a expression evolving from a constant PHI! 8658 return PHI; 8659 } 8660 8661 /// getConstantEvolvingPHI - Given an LLVM value and a loop, return a PHI node 8662 /// in the loop that V is derived from. We allow arbitrary operations along the 8663 /// way, but the operands of an operation must either be constants or a value 8664 /// derived from a constant PHI. If this expression does not fit with these 8665 /// constraints, return null. 8666 static PHINode *getConstantEvolvingPHI(Value *V, const Loop *L) { 8667 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V); 8668 if (!I || !canConstantEvolve(I, L)) return nullptr; 8669 8670 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) 8671 return PN; 8672 8673 // Record non-constant instructions contained by the loop. 8674 DenseMap<Instruction *, PHINode *> PHIMap; 8675 return getConstantEvolvingPHIOperands(I, L, PHIMap, 0); 8676 } 8677 8678 /// EvaluateExpression - Given an expression that passes the 8679 /// getConstantEvolvingPHI predicate, evaluate its value assuming the PHI node 8680 /// in the loop has the value PHIVal. If we can't fold this expression for some 8681 /// reason, return null. 8682 static Constant *EvaluateExpression(Value *V, const Loop *L, 8683 DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> &Vals, 8684 const DataLayout &DL, 8685 const TargetLibraryInfo *TLI) { 8686 // Convenient constant check, but redundant for recursive calls. 8687 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V)) return C; 8688 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V); 8689 if (!I) return nullptr; 8690 8691 if (Constant *C = Vals.lookup(I)) return C; 8692 8693 // An instruction inside the loop depends on a value outside the loop that we 8694 // weren't given a mapping for, or a value such as a call inside the loop. 8695 if (!canConstantEvolve(I, L)) return nullptr; 8696 8697 // An unmapped PHI can be due to a branch or another loop inside this loop, 8698 // or due to this not being the initial iteration through a loop where we 8699 // couldn't compute the evolution of this particular PHI last time. 8700 if (isa<PHINode>(I)) return nullptr; 8701 8702 std::vector<Constant*> Operands(I->getNumOperands()); 8703 8704 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) { 8705 Instruction *Operand = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I->getOperand(i)); 8706 if (!Operand) { 8707 Operands[i] = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(i)); 8708 if (!Operands[i]) return nullptr; 8709 continue; 8710 } 8711 Constant *C = EvaluateExpression(Operand, L, Vals, DL, TLI); 8712 Vals[Operand] = C; 8713 if (!C) return nullptr; 8714 Operands[i] = C; 8715 } 8716 8717 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I)) 8718 return ConstantFoldCompareInstOperands(CI->getPredicate(), Operands[0], 8719 Operands[1], DL, TLI); 8720 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) { 8721 if (!LI->isVolatile()) 8722 return ConstantFoldLoadFromConstPtr(Operands[0], LI->getType(), DL); 8723 } 8724 return ConstantFoldInstOperands(I, Operands, DL, TLI); 8725 } 8726 8727 8728 // If every incoming value to PN except the one for BB is a specific Constant, 8729 // return that, else return nullptr. 8730 static Constant *getOtherIncomingValue(PHINode *PN, BasicBlock *BB) { 8731 Constant *IncomingVal = nullptr; 8732 8733 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) { 8734 if (PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == BB) 8735 continue; 8736 8737 auto *CurrentVal = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i)); 8738 if (!CurrentVal) 8739 return nullptr; 8740 8741 if (IncomingVal != CurrentVal) { 8742 if (IncomingVal) 8743 return nullptr; 8744 IncomingVal = CurrentVal; 8745 } 8746 } 8747 8748 return IncomingVal; 8749 } 8750 8751 /// getConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue - If we know that the specified Phi is 8752 /// in the header of its containing loop, we know the loop executes a 8753 /// constant number of times, and the PHI node is just a recurrence 8754 /// involving constants, fold it. 8755 Constant * 8756 ScalarEvolution::getConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue(PHINode *PN, 8757 const APInt &BEs, 8758 const Loop *L) { 8759 auto I = ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.find(PN); 8760 if (I != ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.end()) 8761 return I->second; 8762 8763 if (BEs.ugt(MaxBruteForceIterations)) 8764 return ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue[PN] = nullptr; // Not going to evaluate it. 8765 8766 Constant *&RetVal = ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue[PN]; 8767 8768 DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> CurrentIterVals; 8769 BasicBlock *Header = L->getHeader(); 8770 assert(PN->getParent() == Header && "Can't evaluate PHI not in loop header!"); 8771 8772 BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch(); 8773 if (!Latch) 8774 return nullptr; 8775 8776 for (PHINode &PHI : Header->phis()) { 8777 if (auto *StartCST = getOtherIncomingValue(&PHI, Latch)) 8778 CurrentIterVals[&PHI] = StartCST; 8779 } 8780 if (!CurrentIterVals.count(PN)) 8781 return RetVal = nullptr; 8782 8783 Value *BEValue = PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch); 8784 8785 // Execute the loop symbolically to determine the exit value. 8786 assert(BEs.getActiveBits() < CHAR_BIT * sizeof(unsigned) && 8787 "BEs is <= MaxBruteForceIterations which is an 'unsigned'!"); 8788 8789 unsigned NumIterations = BEs.getZExtValue(); // must be in range 8790 unsigned IterationNum = 0; 8791 const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout(); 8792 for (; ; ++IterationNum) { 8793 if (IterationNum == NumIterations) 8794 return RetVal = CurrentIterVals[PN]; // Got exit value! 8795 8796 // Compute the value of the PHIs for the next iteration. 8797 // EvaluateExpression adds non-phi values to the CurrentIterVals map. 8798 DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> NextIterVals; 8799 Constant *NextPHI = 8800 EvaluateExpression(BEValue, L, CurrentIterVals, DL, &TLI); 8801 if (!NextPHI) 8802 return nullptr; // Couldn't evaluate! 8803 NextIterVals[PN] = NextPHI; 8804 8805 bool StoppedEvolving = NextPHI == CurrentIterVals[PN]; 8806 8807 // Also evaluate the other PHI nodes. However, we don't get to stop if we 8808 // cease to be able to evaluate one of them or if they stop evolving, 8809 // because that doesn't necessarily prevent us from computing PN. 8810 SmallVector<std::pair<PHINode *, Constant *>, 8> PHIsToCompute; 8811 for (const auto &I : CurrentIterVals) { 8812 PHINode *PHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I.first); 8813 if (!PHI || PHI == PN || PHI->getParent() != Header) continue; 8814 PHIsToCompute.emplace_back(PHI, I.second); 8815 } 8816 // We use two distinct loops because EvaluateExpression may invalidate any 8817 // iterators into CurrentIterVals. 8818 for (const auto &I : PHIsToCompute) { 8819 PHINode *PHI = I.first; 8820 Constant *&NextPHI = NextIterVals[PHI]; 8821 if (!NextPHI) { // Not already computed. 8822 Value *BEValue = PHI->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch); 8823 NextPHI = EvaluateExpression(BEValue, L, CurrentIterVals, DL, &TLI); 8824 } 8825 if (NextPHI != I.second) 8826 StoppedEvolving = false; 8827 } 8828 8829 // If all entries in CurrentIterVals == NextIterVals then we can stop 8830 // iterating, the loop can't continue to change. 8831 if (StoppedEvolving) 8832 return RetVal = CurrentIterVals[PN]; 8833 8834 CurrentIterVals.swap(NextIterVals); 8835 } 8836 } 8837 8838 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::computeExitCountExhaustively(const Loop *L, 8839 Value *Cond, 8840 bool ExitWhen) { 8841 PHINode *PN = getConstantEvolvingPHI(Cond, L); 8842 if (!PN) return getCouldNotCompute(); 8843 8844 // If the loop is canonicalized, the PHI will have exactly two entries. 8845 // That's the only form we support here. 8846 if (PN->getNumIncomingValues() != 2) return getCouldNotCompute(); 8847 8848 DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> CurrentIterVals; 8849 BasicBlock *Header = L->getHeader(); 8850 assert(PN->getParent() == Header && "Can't evaluate PHI not in loop header!"); 8851 8852 BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch(); 8853 assert(Latch && "Should follow from NumIncomingValues == 2!"); 8854 8855 for (PHINode &PHI : Header->phis()) { 8856 if (auto *StartCST = getOtherIncomingValue(&PHI, Latch)) 8857 CurrentIterVals[&PHI] = StartCST; 8858 } 8859 if (!CurrentIterVals.count(PN)) 8860 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8861 8862 // Okay, we find a PHI node that defines the trip count of this loop. Execute 8863 // the loop symbolically to determine when the condition gets a value of 8864 // "ExitWhen". 8865 unsigned MaxIterations = MaxBruteForceIterations; // Limit analysis. 8866 const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout(); 8867 for (unsigned IterationNum = 0; IterationNum != MaxIterations;++IterationNum){ 8868 auto *CondVal = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantInt>( 8869 EvaluateExpression(Cond, L, CurrentIterVals, DL, &TLI)); 8870 8871 // Couldn't symbolically evaluate. 8872 if (!CondVal) return getCouldNotCompute(); 8873 8874 if (CondVal->getValue() == uint64_t(ExitWhen)) { 8875 ++NumBruteForceTripCountsComputed; 8876 return getConstant(Type::getInt32Ty(getContext()), IterationNum); 8877 } 8878 8879 // Update all the PHI nodes for the next iteration. 8880 DenseMap<Instruction *, Constant *> NextIterVals; 8881 8882 // Create a list of which PHIs we need to compute. We want to do this before 8883 // calling EvaluateExpression on them because that may invalidate iterators 8884 // into CurrentIterVals. 8885 SmallVector<PHINode *, 8> PHIsToCompute; 8886 for (const auto &I : CurrentIterVals) { 8887 PHINode *PHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I.first); 8888 if (!PHI || PHI->getParent() != Header) continue; 8889 PHIsToCompute.push_back(PHI); 8890 } 8891 for (PHINode *PHI : PHIsToCompute) { 8892 Constant *&NextPHI = NextIterVals[PHI]; 8893 if (NextPHI) continue; // Already computed! 8894 8895 Value *BEValue = PHI->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch); 8896 NextPHI = EvaluateExpression(BEValue, L, CurrentIterVals, DL, &TLI); 8897 } 8898 CurrentIterVals.swap(NextIterVals); 8899 } 8900 8901 // Too many iterations were needed to evaluate. 8902 return getCouldNotCompute(); 8903 } 8904 8905 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSCEVAtScope(const SCEV *V, const Loop *L) { 8906 SmallVector<std::pair<const Loop *, const SCEV *>, 2> &Values = 8907 ValuesAtScopes[V]; 8908 // Check to see if we've folded this expression at this loop before. 8909 for (auto &LS : Values) 8910 if (LS.first == L) 8911 return LS.second ? LS.second : V; 8912 8913 Values.emplace_back(L, nullptr); 8914 8915 // Otherwise compute it. 8916 const SCEV *C = computeSCEVAtScope(V, L); 8917 for (auto &LS : reverse(ValuesAtScopes[V])) 8918 if (LS.first == L) { 8919 LS.second = C; 8920 break; 8921 } 8922 return C; 8923 } 8924 8925 /// This builds up a Constant using the ConstantExpr interface. That way, we 8926 /// will return Constants for objects which aren't represented by a 8927 /// SCEVConstant, because SCEVConstant is restricted to ConstantInt. 8928 /// Returns NULL if the SCEV isn't representable as a Constant. 8929 static Constant *BuildConstantFromSCEV(const SCEV *V) { 8930 switch (V->getSCEVType()) { 8931 case scCouldNotCompute: 8932 case scAddRecExpr: 8933 return nullptr; 8934 case scConstant: 8935 return cast<SCEVConstant>(V)->getValue(); 8936 case scUnknown: 8937 return dyn_cast<Constant>(cast<SCEVUnknown>(V)->getValue()); 8938 case scSignExtend: { 8939 const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SS = cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(V); 8940 if (Constant *CastOp = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SS->getOperand())) 8941 return ConstantExpr::getSExt(CastOp, SS->getType()); 8942 return nullptr; 8943 } 8944 case scZeroExtend: { 8945 const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *SZ = cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(V); 8946 if (Constant *CastOp = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SZ->getOperand())) 8947 return ConstantExpr::getZExt(CastOp, SZ->getType()); 8948 return nullptr; 8949 } 8950 case scPtrToInt: { 8951 const SCEVPtrToIntExpr *P2I = cast<SCEVPtrToIntExpr>(V); 8952 if (Constant *CastOp = BuildConstantFromSCEV(P2I->getOperand())) 8953 return ConstantExpr::getPtrToInt(CastOp, P2I->getType()); 8954 8955 return nullptr; 8956 } 8957 case scTruncate: { 8958 const SCEVTruncateExpr *ST = cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(V); 8959 if (Constant *CastOp = BuildConstantFromSCEV(ST->getOperand())) 8960 return ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CastOp, ST->getType()); 8961 return nullptr; 8962 } 8963 case scAddExpr: { 8964 const SCEVAddExpr *SA = cast<SCEVAddExpr>(V); 8965 if (Constant *C = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SA->getOperand(0))) { 8966 if (PointerType *PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(C->getType())) { 8967 unsigned AS = PTy->getAddressSpace(); 8968 Type *DestPtrTy = Type::getInt8PtrTy(C->getContext(), AS); 8969 C = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(C, DestPtrTy); 8970 } 8971 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SA->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) { 8972 Constant *C2 = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SA->getOperand(i)); 8973 if (!C2) 8974 return nullptr; 8975 8976 // First pointer! 8977 if (!C->getType()->isPointerTy() && C2->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 8978 unsigned AS = C2->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace(); 8979 std::swap(C, C2); 8980 Type *DestPtrTy = Type::getInt8PtrTy(C->getContext(), AS); 8981 // The offsets have been converted to bytes. We can add bytes to an 8982 // i8* by GEP with the byte count in the first index. 8983 C = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(C, DestPtrTy); 8984 } 8985 8986 // Don't bother trying to sum two pointers. We probably can't 8987 // statically compute a load that results from it anyway. 8988 if (C2->getType()->isPointerTy()) 8989 return nullptr; 8990 8991 if (C->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 8992 C = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(Type::getInt8Ty(C->getContext()), 8993 C, C2); 8994 } else { 8995 C = ConstantExpr::getAdd(C, C2); 8996 } 8997 } 8998 return C; 8999 } 9000 return nullptr; 9001 } 9002 case scMulExpr: { 9003 const SCEVMulExpr *SM = cast<SCEVMulExpr>(V); 9004 if (Constant *C = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SM->getOperand(0))) { 9005 // Don't bother with pointers at all. 9006 if (C->getType()->isPointerTy()) 9007 return nullptr; 9008 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SM->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) { 9009 Constant *C2 = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SM->getOperand(i)); 9010 if (!C2 || C2->getType()->isPointerTy()) 9011 return nullptr; 9012 C = ConstantExpr::getMul(C, C2); 9013 } 9014 return C; 9015 } 9016 return nullptr; 9017 } 9018 case scUDivExpr: { 9019 const SCEVUDivExpr *SU = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(V); 9020 if (Constant *LHS = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SU->getLHS())) 9021 if (Constant *RHS = BuildConstantFromSCEV(SU->getRHS())) 9022 if (LHS->getType() == RHS->getType()) 9023 return ConstantExpr::getUDiv(LHS, RHS); 9024 return nullptr; 9025 } 9026 case scSMaxExpr: 9027 case scUMaxExpr: 9028 case scSMinExpr: 9029 case scUMinExpr: 9030 return nullptr; // TODO: smax, umax, smin, umax. 9031 } 9032 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!"); 9033 } 9034 9035 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::computeSCEVAtScope(const SCEV *V, const Loop *L) { 9036 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(V)) return V; 9037 9038 // If this instruction is evolved from a constant-evolving PHI, compute the 9039 // exit value from the loop without using SCEVs. 9040 if (const SCEVUnknown *SU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(V)) { 9041 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SU->getValue())) { 9042 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) { 9043 const Loop *CurrLoop = this->LI[I->getParent()]; 9044 // Looking for loop exit value. 9045 if (CurrLoop && CurrLoop->getParentLoop() == L && 9046 PN->getParent() == CurrLoop->getHeader()) { 9047 // Okay, there is no closed form solution for the PHI node. Check 9048 // to see if the loop that contains it has a known backedge-taken 9049 // count. If so, we may be able to force computation of the exit 9050 // value. 9051 const SCEV *BackedgeTakenCount = getBackedgeTakenCount(CurrLoop); 9052 // This trivial case can show up in some degenerate cases where 9053 // the incoming IR has not yet been fully simplified. 9054 if (BackedgeTakenCount->isZero()) { 9055 Value *InitValue = nullptr; 9056 bool MultipleInitValues = false; 9057 for (unsigned i = 0; i < PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i++) { 9058 if (!CurrLoop->contains(PN->getIncomingBlock(i))) { 9059 if (!InitValue) 9060 InitValue = PN->getIncomingValue(i); 9061 else if (InitValue != PN->getIncomingValue(i)) { 9062 MultipleInitValues = true; 9063 break; 9064 } 9065 } 9066 } 9067 if (!MultipleInitValues && InitValue) 9068 return getSCEV(InitValue); 9069 } 9070 // Do we have a loop invariant value flowing around the backedge 9071 // for a loop which must execute the backedge? 9072 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(BackedgeTakenCount) && 9073 isKnownPositive(BackedgeTakenCount) && 9074 PN->getNumIncomingValues() == 2) { 9075 9076 unsigned InLoopPred = 9077 CurrLoop->contains(PN->getIncomingBlock(0)) ? 0 : 1; 9078 Value *BackedgeVal = PN->getIncomingValue(InLoopPred); 9079 if (CurrLoop->isLoopInvariant(BackedgeVal)) 9080 return getSCEV(BackedgeVal); 9081 } 9082 if (auto *BTCC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(BackedgeTakenCount)) { 9083 // Okay, we know how many times the containing loop executes. If 9084 // this is a constant evolving PHI node, get the final value at 9085 // the specified iteration number. 9086 Constant *RV = getConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue( 9087 PN, BTCC->getAPInt(), CurrLoop); 9088 if (RV) return getSCEV(RV); 9089 } 9090 } 9091 9092 // If there is a single-input Phi, evaluate it at our scope. If we can 9093 // prove that this replacement does not break LCSSA form, use new value. 9094 if (PN->getNumOperands() == 1) { 9095 const SCEV *Input = getSCEV(PN->getOperand(0)); 9096 const SCEV *InputAtScope = getSCEVAtScope(Input, L); 9097 // TODO: We can generalize it using LI.replacementPreservesLCSSAForm, 9098 // for the simplest case just support constants. 9099 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(InputAtScope)) return InputAtScope; 9100 } 9101 } 9102 9103 // Okay, this is an expression that we cannot symbolically evaluate 9104 // into a SCEV. Check to see if it's possible to symbolically evaluate 9105 // the arguments into constants, and if so, try to constant propagate the 9106 // result. This is particularly useful for computing loop exit values. 9107 if (CanConstantFold(I)) { 9108 SmallVector<Constant *, 4> Operands; 9109 bool MadeImprovement = false; 9110 for (Value *Op : I->operands()) { 9111 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) { 9112 Operands.push_back(C); 9113 continue; 9114 } 9115 9116 // If any of the operands is non-constant and if they are 9117 // non-integer and non-pointer, don't even try to analyze them 9118 // with scev techniques. 9119 if (!isSCEVable(Op->getType())) 9120 return V; 9121 9122 const SCEV *OrigV = getSCEV(Op); 9123 const SCEV *OpV = getSCEVAtScope(OrigV, L); 9124 MadeImprovement |= OrigV != OpV; 9125 9126 Constant *C = BuildConstantFromSCEV(OpV); 9127 if (!C) return V; 9128 if (C->getType() != Op->getType()) 9129 C = ConstantExpr::getCast(CastInst::getCastOpcode(C, false, 9130 Op->getType(), 9131 false), 9132 C, Op->getType()); 9133 Operands.push_back(C); 9134 } 9135 9136 // Check to see if getSCEVAtScope actually made an improvement. 9137 if (MadeImprovement) { 9138 Constant *C = nullptr; 9139 const DataLayout &DL = getDataLayout(); 9140 if (const CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I)) 9141 C = ConstantFoldCompareInstOperands(CI->getPredicate(), Operands[0], 9142 Operands[1], DL, &TLI); 9143 else if (const LoadInst *Load = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) { 9144 if (!Load->isVolatile()) 9145 C = ConstantFoldLoadFromConstPtr(Operands[0], Load->getType(), 9146 DL); 9147 } else 9148 C = ConstantFoldInstOperands(I, Operands, DL, &TLI); 9149 if (!C) return V; 9150 return getSCEV(C); 9151 } 9152 } 9153 } 9154 9155 // This is some other type of SCEVUnknown, just return it. 9156 return V; 9157 } 9158 9159 if (const SCEVCommutativeExpr *Comm = dyn_cast<SCEVCommutativeExpr>(V)) { 9160 // Avoid performing the look-up in the common case where the specified 9161 // expression has no loop-variant portions. 9162 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Comm->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) { 9163 const SCEV *OpAtScope = getSCEVAtScope(Comm->getOperand(i), L); 9164 if (OpAtScope != Comm->getOperand(i)) { 9165 // Okay, at least one of these operands is loop variant but might be 9166 // foldable. Build a new instance of the folded commutative expression. 9167 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> NewOps(Comm->op_begin(), 9168 Comm->op_begin()+i); 9169 NewOps.push_back(OpAtScope); 9170 9171 for (++i; i != e; ++i) { 9172 OpAtScope = getSCEVAtScope(Comm->getOperand(i), L); 9173 NewOps.push_back(OpAtScope); 9174 } 9175 if (isa<SCEVAddExpr>(Comm)) 9176 return getAddExpr(NewOps, Comm->getNoWrapFlags()); 9177 if (isa<SCEVMulExpr>(Comm)) 9178 return getMulExpr(NewOps, Comm->getNoWrapFlags()); 9179 if (isa<SCEVMinMaxExpr>(Comm)) 9180 return getMinMaxExpr(Comm->getSCEVType(), NewOps); 9181 llvm_unreachable("Unknown commutative SCEV type!"); 9182 } 9183 } 9184 // If we got here, all operands are loop invariant. 9185 return Comm; 9186 } 9187 9188 if (const SCEVUDivExpr *Div = dyn_cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(V)) { 9189 const SCEV *LHS = getSCEVAtScope(Div->getLHS(), L); 9190 const SCEV *RHS = getSCEVAtScope(Div->getRHS(), L); 9191 if (LHS == Div->getLHS() && RHS == Div->getRHS()) 9192 return Div; // must be loop invariant 9193 return getUDivExpr(LHS, RHS); 9194 } 9195 9196 // If this is a loop recurrence for a loop that does not contain L, then we 9197 // are dealing with the final value computed by the loop. 9198 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(V)) { 9199 // First, attempt to evaluate each operand. 9200 // Avoid performing the look-up in the common case where the specified 9201 // expression has no loop-variant portions. 9202 for (unsigned i = 0, e = AddRec->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i) { 9203 const SCEV *OpAtScope = getSCEVAtScope(AddRec->getOperand(i), L); 9204 if (OpAtScope == AddRec->getOperand(i)) 9205 continue; 9206 9207 // Okay, at least one of these operands is loop variant but might be 9208 // foldable. Build a new instance of the folded commutative expression. 9209 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> NewOps(AddRec->op_begin(), 9210 AddRec->op_begin()+i); 9211 NewOps.push_back(OpAtScope); 9212 for (++i; i != e; ++i) 9213 NewOps.push_back(getSCEVAtScope(AddRec->getOperand(i), L)); 9214 9215 const SCEV *FoldedRec = 9216 getAddRecExpr(NewOps, AddRec->getLoop(), 9217 AddRec->getNoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNW)); 9218 AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(FoldedRec); 9219 // The addrec may be folded to a nonrecurrence, for example, if the 9220 // induction variable is multiplied by zero after constant folding. Go 9221 // ahead and return the folded value. 9222 if (!AddRec) 9223 return FoldedRec; 9224 break; 9225 } 9226 9227 // If the scope is outside the addrec's loop, evaluate it by using the 9228 // loop exit value of the addrec. 9229 if (!AddRec->getLoop()->contains(L)) { 9230 // To evaluate this recurrence, we need to know how many times the AddRec 9231 // loop iterates. Compute this now. 9232 const SCEV *BackedgeTakenCount = getBackedgeTakenCount(AddRec->getLoop()); 9233 if (BackedgeTakenCount == getCouldNotCompute()) return AddRec; 9234 9235 // Then, evaluate the AddRec. 9236 return AddRec->evaluateAtIteration(BackedgeTakenCount, *this); 9237 } 9238 9239 return AddRec; 9240 } 9241 9242 if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *Cast = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(V)) { 9243 const SCEV *Op = getSCEVAtScope(Cast->getOperand(), L); 9244 if (Op == Cast->getOperand()) 9245 return Cast; // must be loop invariant 9246 return getZeroExtendExpr(Op, Cast->getType()); 9247 } 9248 9249 if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *Cast = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(V)) { 9250 const SCEV *Op = getSCEVAtScope(Cast->getOperand(), L); 9251 if (Op == Cast->getOperand()) 9252 return Cast; // must be loop invariant 9253 return getSignExtendExpr(Op, Cast->getType()); 9254 } 9255 9256 if (const SCEVTruncateExpr *Cast = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(V)) { 9257 const SCEV *Op = getSCEVAtScope(Cast->getOperand(), L); 9258 if (Op == Cast->getOperand()) 9259 return Cast; // must be loop invariant 9260 return getTruncateExpr(Op, Cast->getType()); 9261 } 9262 9263 if (const SCEVPtrToIntExpr *Cast = dyn_cast<SCEVPtrToIntExpr>(V)) { 9264 const SCEV *Op = getSCEVAtScope(Cast->getOperand(), L); 9265 if (Op == Cast->getOperand()) 9266 return Cast; // must be loop invariant 9267 return getPtrToIntExpr(Op, Cast->getType()); 9268 } 9269 9270 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV type!"); 9271 } 9272 9273 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getSCEVAtScope(Value *V, const Loop *L) { 9274 return getSCEVAtScope(getSCEV(V), L); 9275 } 9276 9277 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::stripInjectiveFunctions(const SCEV *S) const { 9278 if (const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(S)) 9279 return stripInjectiveFunctions(ZExt->getOperand()); 9280 if (const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(S)) 9281 return stripInjectiveFunctions(SExt->getOperand()); 9282 return S; 9283 } 9284 9285 /// Finds the minimum unsigned root of the following equation: 9286 /// 9287 /// A * X = B (mod N) 9288 /// 9289 /// where N = 2^BW and BW is the common bit width of A and B. The signedness of 9290 /// A and B isn't important. 9291 /// 9292 /// If the equation does not have a solution, SCEVCouldNotCompute is returned. 9293 static const SCEV *SolveLinEquationWithOverflow(const APInt &A, const SCEV *B, 9294 ScalarEvolution &SE) { 9295 uint32_t BW = A.getBitWidth(); 9296 assert(BW == SE.getTypeSizeInBits(B->getType())); 9297 assert(A != 0 && "A must be non-zero."); 9298 9299 // 1. D = gcd(A, N) 9300 // 9301 // The gcd of A and N may have only one prime factor: 2. The number of 9302 // trailing zeros in A is its multiplicity 9303 uint32_t Mult2 = A.countTrailingZeros(); 9304 // D = 2^Mult2 9305 9306 // 2. Check if B is divisible by D. 9307 // 9308 // B is divisible by D if and only if the multiplicity of prime factor 2 for B 9309 // is not less than multiplicity of this prime factor for D. 9310 if (SE.GetMinTrailingZeros(B) < Mult2) 9311 return SE.getCouldNotCompute(); 9312 9313 // 3. Compute I: the multiplicative inverse of (A / D) in arithmetic 9314 // modulo (N / D). 9315 // 9316 // If D == 1, (N / D) == N == 2^BW, so we need one extra bit to represent 9317 // (N / D) in general. The inverse itself always fits into BW bits, though, 9318 // so we immediately truncate it. 9319 APInt AD = A.lshr(Mult2).zext(BW + 1); // AD = A / D 9320 APInt Mod(BW + 1, 0); 9321 Mod.setBit(BW - Mult2); // Mod = N / D 9322 APInt I = AD.multiplicativeInverse(Mod).trunc(BW); 9323 9324 // 4. Compute the minimum unsigned root of the equation: 9325 // I * (B / D) mod (N / D) 9326 // To simplify the computation, we factor out the divide by D: 9327 // (I * B mod N) / D 9328 const SCEV *D = SE.getConstant(APInt::getOneBitSet(BW, Mult2)); 9329 return SE.getUDivExactExpr(SE.getMulExpr(B, SE.getConstant(I)), D); 9330 } 9331 9332 /// For a given quadratic addrec, generate coefficients of the corresponding 9333 /// quadratic equation, multiplied by a common value to ensure that they are 9334 /// integers. 9335 /// The returned value is a tuple { A, B, C, M, BitWidth }, where 9336 /// Ax^2 + Bx + C is the quadratic function, M is the value that A, B and C 9337 /// were multiplied by, and BitWidth is the bit width of the original addrec 9338 /// coefficients. 9339 /// This function returns None if the addrec coefficients are not compile- 9340 /// time constants. 9341 static Optional<std::tuple<APInt, APInt, APInt, APInt, unsigned>> 9342 GetQuadraticEquation(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec) { 9343 assert(AddRec->getNumOperands() == 3 && "This is not a quadratic chrec!"); 9344 const SCEVConstant *LC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AddRec->getOperand(0)); 9345 const SCEVConstant *MC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AddRec->getOperand(1)); 9346 const SCEVConstant *NC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AddRec->getOperand(2)); 9347 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": analyzing quadratic addrec: " 9348 << *AddRec << '\n'); 9349 9350 // We currently can only solve this if the coefficients are constants. 9351 if (!LC || !MC || !NC) { 9352 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": coefficients are not constant\n"); 9353 return None; 9354 } 9355 9356 APInt L = LC->getAPInt(); 9357 APInt M = MC->getAPInt(); 9358 APInt N = NC->getAPInt(); 9359 assert(!N.isZero() && "This is not a quadratic addrec"); 9360 9361 unsigned BitWidth = LC->getAPInt().getBitWidth(); 9362 unsigned NewWidth = BitWidth + 1; 9363 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": addrec coeff bw: " 9364 << BitWidth << '\n'); 9365 // The sign-extension (as opposed to a zero-extension) here matches the 9366 // extension used in SolveQuadraticEquationWrap (with the same motivation). 9367 N = N.sext(NewWidth); 9368 M = M.sext(NewWidth); 9369 L = L.sext(NewWidth); 9370 9371 // The increments are M, M+N, M+2N, ..., so the accumulated values are 9372 // L+M, (L+M)+(M+N), (L+M)+(M+N)+(M+2N), ..., that is, 9373 // L+M, L+2M+N, L+3M+3N, ... 9374 // After n iterations the accumulated value Acc is L + nM + n(n-1)/2 N. 9375 // 9376 // The equation Acc = 0 is then 9377 // L + nM + n(n-1)/2 N = 0, or 2L + 2M n + n(n-1) N = 0. 9378 // In a quadratic form it becomes: 9379 // N n^2 + (2M-N) n + 2L = 0. 9380 9381 APInt A = N; 9382 APInt B = 2 * M - A; 9383 APInt C = 2 * L; 9384 APInt T = APInt(NewWidth, 2); 9385 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": equation " << A << "x^2 + " << B 9386 << "x + " << C << ", coeff bw: " << NewWidth 9387 << ", multiplied by " << T << '\n'); 9388 return std::make_tuple(A, B, C, T, BitWidth); 9389 } 9390 9391 /// Helper function to compare optional APInts: 9392 /// (a) if X and Y both exist, return min(X, Y), 9393 /// (b) if neither X nor Y exist, return None, 9394 /// (c) if exactly one of X and Y exists, return that value. 9395 static Optional<APInt> MinOptional(Optional<APInt> X, Optional<APInt> Y) { 9396 if (X.hasValue() && Y.hasValue()) { 9397 unsigned W = std::max(X->getBitWidth(), Y->getBitWidth()); 9398 APInt XW = X->sextOrSelf(W); 9399 APInt YW = Y->sextOrSelf(W); 9400 return XW.slt(YW) ? *X : *Y; 9401 } 9402 if (!X.hasValue() && !Y.hasValue()) 9403 return None; 9404 return X.hasValue() ? *X : *Y; 9405 } 9406 9407 /// Helper function to truncate an optional APInt to a given BitWidth. 9408 /// When solving addrec-related equations, it is preferable to return a value 9409 /// that has the same bit width as the original addrec's coefficients. If the 9410 /// solution fits in the original bit width, truncate it (except for i1). 9411 /// Returning a value of a different bit width may inhibit some optimizations. 9412 /// 9413 /// In general, a solution to a quadratic equation generated from an addrec 9414 /// may require BW+1 bits, where BW is the bit width of the addrec's 9415 /// coefficients. The reason is that the coefficients of the quadratic 9416 /// equation are BW+1 bits wide (to avoid truncation when converting from 9417 /// the addrec to the equation). 9418 static Optional<APInt> TruncIfPossible(Optional<APInt> X, unsigned BitWidth) { 9419 if (!X.hasValue()) 9420 return None; 9421 unsigned W = X->getBitWidth(); 9422 if (BitWidth > 1 && BitWidth < W && X->isIntN(BitWidth)) 9423 return X->trunc(BitWidth); 9424 return X; 9425 } 9426 9427 /// Let c(n) be the value of the quadratic chrec {L,+,M,+,N} after n 9428 /// iterations. The values L, M, N are assumed to be signed, and they 9429 /// should all have the same bit widths. 9430 /// Find the least n >= 0 such that c(n) = 0 in the arithmetic modulo 2^BW, 9431 /// where BW is the bit width of the addrec's coefficients. 9432 /// If the calculated value is a BW-bit integer (for BW > 1), it will be 9433 /// returned as such, otherwise the bit width of the returned value may 9434 /// be greater than BW. 9435 /// 9436 /// This function returns None if 9437 /// (a) the addrec coefficients are not constant, or 9438 /// (b) SolveQuadraticEquationWrap was unable to find a solution. For cases 9439 /// like x^2 = 5, no integer solutions exist, in other cases an integer 9440 /// solution may exist, but SolveQuadraticEquationWrap may fail to find it. 9441 static Optional<APInt> 9442 SolveQuadraticAddRecExact(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec, ScalarEvolution &SE) { 9443 APInt A, B, C, M; 9444 unsigned BitWidth; 9445 auto T = GetQuadraticEquation(AddRec); 9446 if (!T.hasValue()) 9447 return None; 9448 9449 std::tie(A, B, C, M, BitWidth) = *T; 9450 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": solving for unsigned overflow\n"); 9451 Optional<APInt> X = APIntOps::SolveQuadraticEquationWrap(A, B, C, BitWidth+1); 9452 if (!X.hasValue()) 9453 return None; 9454 9455 ConstantInt *CX = ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), *X); 9456 ConstantInt *V = EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(AddRec, CX, SE); 9457 if (!V->isZero()) 9458 return None; 9459 9460 return TruncIfPossible(X, BitWidth); 9461 } 9462 9463 /// Let c(n) be the value of the quadratic chrec {0,+,M,+,N} after n 9464 /// iterations. The values M, N are assumed to be signed, and they 9465 /// should all have the same bit widths. 9466 /// Find the least n such that c(n) does not belong to the given range, 9467 /// while c(n-1) does. 9468 /// 9469 /// This function returns None if 9470 /// (a) the addrec coefficients are not constant, or 9471 /// (b) SolveQuadraticEquationWrap was unable to find a solution for the 9472 /// bounds of the range. 9473 static Optional<APInt> 9474 SolveQuadraticAddRecRange(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec, 9475 const ConstantRange &Range, ScalarEvolution &SE) { 9476 assert(AddRec->getOperand(0)->isZero() && 9477 "Starting value of addrec should be 0"); 9478 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << __func__ << ": solving boundary crossing for range " 9479 << Range << ", addrec " << *AddRec << '\n'); 9480 // This case is handled in getNumIterationsInRange. Here we can assume that 9481 // we start in the range. 9482 assert(Range.contains(APInt(SE.getTypeSizeInBits(AddRec->getType()), 0)) && 9483 "Addrec's initial value should be in range"); 9484 9485 APInt A, B, C, M; 9486 unsigned BitWidth; 9487 auto T = GetQuadraticEquation(AddRec); 9488 if (!T.hasValue()) 9489 return None; 9490 9491 // Be careful about the return value: there can be two reasons for not 9492 // returning an actual number. First, if no solutions to the equations 9493 // were found, and second, if the solutions don't leave the given range. 9494 // The first case means that the actual solution is "unknown", the second 9495 // means that it's known, but not valid. If the solution is unknown, we 9496 // cannot make any conclusions. 9497 // Return a pair: the optional solution and a flag indicating if the 9498 // solution was found. 9499 auto SolveForBoundary = [&](APInt Bound) -> std::pair<Optional<APInt>,bool> { 9500 // Solve for signed overflow and unsigned overflow, pick the lower 9501 // solution. 9502 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "SolveQuadraticAddRecRange: checking boundary " 9503 << Bound << " (before multiplying by " << M << ")\n"); 9504 Bound *= M; // The quadratic equation multiplier. 9505 9506 Optional<APInt> SO = None; 9507 if (BitWidth > 1) { 9508 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "SolveQuadraticAddRecRange: solving for " 9509 "signed overflow\n"); 9510 SO = APIntOps::SolveQuadraticEquationWrap(A, B, -Bound, BitWidth); 9511 } 9512 LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "SolveQuadraticAddRecRange: solving for " 9513 "unsigned overflow\n"); 9514 Optional<APInt> UO = APIntOps::SolveQuadraticEquationWrap(A, B, -Bound, 9515 BitWidth+1); 9516 9517 auto LeavesRange = [&] (const APInt &X) { 9518 ConstantInt *C0 = ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), X); 9519 ConstantInt *V0 = EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(AddRec, C0, SE); 9520 if (Range.contains(V0->getValue())) 9521 return false; 9522 // X should be at least 1, so X-1 is non-negative. 9523 ConstantInt *C1 = ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), X-1); 9524 ConstantInt *V1 = EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(AddRec, C1, SE); 9525 if (Range.contains(V1->getValue())) 9526 return true; 9527 return false; 9528 }; 9529 9530 // If SolveQuadraticEquationWrap returns None, it means that there can 9531 // be a solution, but the function failed to find it. We cannot treat it 9532 // as "no solution". 9533 if (!SO.hasValue() || !UO.hasValue()) 9534 return { None, false }; 9535 9536 // Check the smaller value first to see if it leaves the range. 9537 // At this point, both SO and UO must have values. 9538 Optional<APInt> Min = MinOptional(SO, UO); 9539 if (LeavesRange(*Min)) 9540 return { Min, true }; 9541 Optional<APInt> Max = Min == SO ? UO : SO; 9542 if (LeavesRange(*Max)) 9543 return { Max, true }; 9544 9545 // Solutions were found, but were eliminated, hence the "true". 9546 return { None, true }; 9547 }; 9548 9549 std::tie(A, B, C, M, BitWidth) = *T; 9550 // Lower bound is inclusive, subtract 1 to represent the exiting value. 9551 APInt Lower = Range.getLower().sextOrSelf(A.getBitWidth()) - 1; 9552 APInt Upper = Range.getUpper().sextOrSelf(A.getBitWidth()); 9553 auto SL = SolveForBoundary(Lower); 9554 auto SU = SolveForBoundary(Upper); 9555 // If any of the solutions was unknown, no meaninigful conclusions can 9556 // be made. 9557 if (!SL.second || !SU.second) 9558 return None; 9559 9560 // Claim: The correct solution is not some value between Min and Max. 9561 // 9562 // Justification: Assuming that Min and Max are different values, one of 9563 // them is when the first signed overflow happens, the other is when the 9564 // first unsigned overflow happens. Crossing the range boundary is only 9565 // possible via an overflow (treating 0 as a special case of it, modeling 9566 // an overflow as crossing k*2^W for some k). 9567 // 9568 // The interesting case here is when Min was eliminated as an invalid 9569 // solution, but Max was not. The argument is that if there was another 9570 // overflow between Min and Max, it would also have been eliminated if 9571 // it was considered. 9572 // 9573 // For a given boundary, it is possible to have two overflows of the same 9574 // type (signed/unsigned) without having the other type in between: this 9575 // can happen when the vertex of the parabola is between the iterations 9576 // corresponding to the overflows. This is only possible when the two 9577 // overflows cross k*2^W for the same k. In such case, if the second one 9578 // left the range (and was the first one to do so), the first overflow 9579 // would have to enter the range, which would mean that either we had left 9580 // the range before or that we started outside of it. Both of these cases 9581 // are contradictions. 9582 // 9583 // Claim: In the case where SolveForBoundary returns None, the correct 9584 // solution is not some value between the Max for this boundary and the 9585 // Min of the other boundary. 9586 // 9587 // Justification: Assume that we had such Max_A and Min_B corresponding 9588 // to range boundaries A and B and such that Max_A < Min_B. If there was 9589 // a solution between Max_A and Min_B, it would have to be caused by an 9590 // overflow corresponding to either A or B. It cannot correspond to B, 9591 // since Min_B is the first occurrence of such an overflow. If it 9592 // corresponded to A, it would have to be either a signed or an unsigned 9593 // overflow that is larger than both eliminated overflows for A. But 9594 // between the eliminated overflows and this overflow, the values would 9595 // cover the entire value space, thus crossing the other boundary, which 9596 // is a contradiction. 9597 9598 return TruncIfPossible(MinOptional(SL.first, SU.first), BitWidth); 9599 } 9600 9601 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit 9602 ScalarEvolution::howFarToZero(const SCEV *V, const Loop *L, bool ControlsExit, 9603 bool AllowPredicates) { 9604 9605 // This is only used for loops with a "x != y" exit test. The exit condition 9606 // is now expressed as a single expression, V = x-y. So the exit test is 9607 // effectively V != 0. We know and take advantage of the fact that this 9608 // expression only being used in a comparison by zero context. 9609 9610 SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> Predicates; 9611 // If the value is a constant 9612 if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(V)) { 9613 // If the value is already zero, the branch will execute zero times. 9614 if (C->getValue()->isZero()) return C; 9615 return getCouldNotCompute(); // Otherwise it will loop infinitely. 9616 } 9617 9618 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AddRec = 9619 dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(stripInjectiveFunctions(V)); 9620 9621 if (!AddRec && AllowPredicates) 9622 // Try to make this an AddRec using runtime tests, in the first X 9623 // iterations of this loop, where X is the SCEV expression found by the 9624 // algorithm below. 9625 AddRec = convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates(V, L, Predicates); 9626 9627 if (!AddRec || AddRec->getLoop() != L) 9628 return getCouldNotCompute(); 9629 9630 // If this is a quadratic (3-term) AddRec {L,+,M,+,N}, find the roots of 9631 // the quadratic equation to solve it. 9632 if (AddRec->isQuadratic() && AddRec->getType()->isIntegerTy()) { 9633 // We can only use this value if the chrec ends up with an exact zero 9634 // value at this index. When solving for "X*X != 5", for example, we 9635 // should not accept a root of 2. 9636 if (auto S = SolveQuadraticAddRecExact(AddRec, *this)) { 9637 const auto *R = cast<SCEVConstant>(getConstant(S.getValue())); 9638 return ExitLimit(R, R, false, Predicates); 9639 } 9640 return getCouldNotCompute(); 9641 } 9642 9643 // Otherwise we can only handle this if it is affine. 9644 if (!AddRec->isAffine()) 9645 return getCouldNotCompute(); 9646 9647 // If this is an affine expression, the execution count of this branch is 9648 // the minimum unsigned root of the following equation: 9649 // 9650 // Start + Step*N = 0 (mod 2^BW) 9651 // 9652 // equivalent to: 9653 // 9654 // Step*N = -Start (mod 2^BW) 9655 // 9656 // where BW is the common bit width of Start and Step. 9657 9658 // Get the initial value for the loop. 9659 const SCEV *Start = getSCEVAtScope(AddRec->getStart(), L->getParentLoop()); 9660 const SCEV *Step = getSCEVAtScope(AddRec->getOperand(1), L->getParentLoop()); 9661 9662 // For now we handle only constant steps. 9663 // 9664 // TODO: Handle a nonconstant Step given AddRec<NUW>. If the 9665 // AddRec is NUW, then (in an unsigned sense) it cannot be counting up to wrap 9666 // to 0, it must be counting down to equal 0. Consequently, N = Start / -Step. 9667 // We have not yet seen any such cases. 9668 const SCEVConstant *StepC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Step); 9669 if (!StepC || StepC->getValue()->isZero()) 9670 return getCouldNotCompute(); 9671 9672 // For positive steps (counting up until unsigned overflow): 9673 // N = -Start/Step (as unsigned) 9674 // For negative steps (counting down to zero): 9675 // N = Start/-Step 9676 // First compute the unsigned distance from zero in the direction of Step. 9677 bool CountDown = StepC->getAPInt().isNegative(); 9678 const SCEV *Distance = CountDown ? Start : getNegativeSCEV(Start); 9679 9680 // Handle unitary steps, which cannot wraparound. 9681 // 1*N = -Start; -1*N = Start (mod 2^BW), so: 9682 // N = Distance (as unsigned) 9683 if (StepC->getValue()->isOne() || StepC->getValue()->isMinusOne()) { 9684 APInt MaxBECount = getUnsignedRangeMax(applyLoopGuards(Distance, L)); 9685 MaxBECount = APIntOps::umin(MaxBECount, getUnsignedRangeMax(Distance)); 9686 9687 // When a loop like "for (int i = 0; i != n; ++i) { /* body */ }" is rotated, 9688 // we end up with a loop whose backedge-taken count is n - 1. Detect this 9689 // case, and see if we can improve the bound. 9690 // 9691 // Explicitly handling this here is necessary because getUnsignedRange 9692 // isn't context-sensitive; it doesn't know that we only care about the 9693 // range inside the loop. 9694 const SCEV *Zero = getZero(Distance->getType()); 9695 const SCEV *One = getOne(Distance->getType()); 9696 const SCEV *DistancePlusOne = getAddExpr(Distance, One); 9697 if (isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, DistancePlusOne, Zero)) { 9698 // If Distance + 1 doesn't overflow, we can compute the maximum distance 9699 // as "unsigned_max(Distance + 1) - 1". 9700 ConstantRange CR = getUnsignedRange(DistancePlusOne); 9701 MaxBECount = APIntOps::umin(MaxBECount, CR.getUnsignedMax() - 1); 9702 } 9703 return ExitLimit(Distance, getConstant(MaxBECount), false, Predicates); 9704 } 9705 9706 // If the condition controls loop exit (the loop exits only if the expression 9707 // is true) and the addition is no-wrap we can use unsigned divide to 9708 // compute the backedge count. In this case, the step may not divide the 9709 // distance, but we don't care because if the condition is "missed" the loop 9710 // will have undefined behavior due to wrapping. 9711 if (ControlsExit && AddRec->hasNoSelfWrap() && 9712 loopHasNoAbnormalExits(AddRec->getLoop())) { 9713 const SCEV *Exact = 9714 getUDivExpr(Distance, CountDown ? getNegativeSCEV(Step) : Step); 9715 const SCEV *Max = getCouldNotCompute(); 9716 if (Exact != getCouldNotCompute()) { 9717 APInt MaxInt = getUnsignedRangeMax(applyLoopGuards(Exact, L)); 9718 Max = getConstant(APIntOps::umin(MaxInt, getUnsignedRangeMax(Exact))); 9719 } 9720 return ExitLimit(Exact, Max, false, Predicates); 9721 } 9722 9723 // Solve the general equation. 9724 const SCEV *E = SolveLinEquationWithOverflow(StepC->getAPInt(), 9725 getNegativeSCEV(Start), *this); 9726 9727 const SCEV *M = E; 9728 if (E != getCouldNotCompute()) { 9729 APInt MaxWithGuards = getUnsignedRangeMax(applyLoopGuards(E, L)); 9730 M = getConstant(APIntOps::umin(MaxWithGuards, getUnsignedRangeMax(E))); 9731 } 9732 return ExitLimit(E, M, false, Predicates); 9733 } 9734 9735 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit 9736 ScalarEvolution::howFarToNonZero(const SCEV *V, const Loop *L) { 9737 // Loops that look like: while (X == 0) are very strange indeed. We don't 9738 // handle them yet except for the trivial case. This could be expanded in the 9739 // future as needed. 9740 9741 // If the value is a constant, check to see if it is known to be non-zero 9742 // already. If so, the backedge will execute zero times. 9743 if (const SCEVConstant *C = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(V)) { 9744 if (!C->getValue()->isZero()) 9745 return getZero(C->getType()); 9746 return getCouldNotCompute(); // Otherwise it will loop infinitely. 9747 } 9748 9749 // We could implement others, but I really doubt anyone writes loops like 9750 // this, and if they did, they would already be constant folded. 9751 return getCouldNotCompute(); 9752 } 9753 9754 std::pair<const BasicBlock *, const BasicBlock *> 9755 ScalarEvolution::getPredecessorWithUniqueSuccessorForBB(const BasicBlock *BB) 9756 const { 9757 // If the block has a unique predecessor, then there is no path from the 9758 // predecessor to the block that does not go through the direct edge 9759 // from the predecessor to the block. 9760 if (const BasicBlock *Pred = BB->getSinglePredecessor()) 9761 return {Pred, BB}; 9762 9763 // A loop's header is defined to be a block that dominates the loop. 9764 // If the header has a unique predecessor outside the loop, it must be 9765 // a block that has exactly one successor that can reach the loop. 9766 if (const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(BB)) 9767 return {L->getLoopPredecessor(), L->getHeader()}; 9768 9769 return {nullptr, nullptr}; 9770 } 9771 9772 /// SCEV structural equivalence is usually sufficient for testing whether two 9773 /// expressions are equal, however for the purposes of looking for a condition 9774 /// guarding a loop, it can be useful to be a little more general, since a 9775 /// front-end may have replicated the controlling expression. 9776 static bool HasSameValue(const SCEV *A, const SCEV *B) { 9777 // Quick check to see if they are the same SCEV. 9778 if (A == B) return true; 9779 9780 auto ComputesEqualValues = [](const Instruction *A, const Instruction *B) { 9781 // Not all instructions that are "identical" compute the same value. For 9782 // instance, two distinct alloca instructions allocating the same type are 9783 // identical and do not read memory; but compute distinct values. 9784 return A->isIdenticalTo(B) && (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A)); 9785 }; 9786 9787 // Otherwise, if they're both SCEVUnknown, it's possible that they hold 9788 // two different instructions with the same value. Check for this case. 9789 if (const SCEVUnknown *AU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(A)) 9790 if (const SCEVUnknown *BU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(B)) 9791 if (const Instruction *AI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(AU->getValue())) 9792 if (const Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BU->getValue())) 9793 if (ComputesEqualValues(AI, BI)) 9794 return true; 9795 9796 // Otherwise assume they may have a different value. 9797 return false; 9798 } 9799 9800 bool ScalarEvolution::SimplifyICmpOperands(ICmpInst::Predicate &Pred, 9801 const SCEV *&LHS, const SCEV *&RHS, 9802 unsigned Depth) { 9803 bool Changed = false; 9804 // Simplifies ICMP to trivial true or false by turning it into '0 == 0' or 9805 // '0 != 0'. 9806 auto TrivialCase = [&](bool TriviallyTrue) { 9807 LHS = RHS = getConstant(ConstantInt::getFalse(getContext())); 9808 Pred = TriviallyTrue ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ : ICmpInst::ICMP_NE; 9809 return true; 9810 }; 9811 // If we hit the max recursion limit bail out. 9812 if (Depth >= 3) 9813 return false; 9814 9815 // Canonicalize a constant to the right side. 9816 if (const SCEVConstant *LHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LHS)) { 9817 // Check for both operands constant. 9818 if (const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) { 9819 if (ConstantExpr::getICmp(Pred, 9820 LHSC->getValue(), 9821 RHSC->getValue())->isNullValue()) 9822 return TrivialCase(false); 9823 else 9824 return TrivialCase(true); 9825 } 9826 // Otherwise swap the operands to put the constant on the right. 9827 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 9828 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred); 9829 Changed = true; 9830 } 9831 9832 // If we're comparing an addrec with a value which is loop-invariant in the 9833 // addrec's loop, put the addrec on the left. Also make a dominance check, 9834 // as both operands could be addrecs loop-invariant in each other's loop. 9835 if (const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(RHS)) { 9836 const Loop *L = AR->getLoop(); 9837 if (isLoopInvariant(LHS, L) && properlyDominates(LHS, L->getHeader())) { 9838 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 9839 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred); 9840 Changed = true; 9841 } 9842 } 9843 9844 // If there's a constant operand, canonicalize comparisons with boundary 9845 // cases, and canonicalize *-or-equal comparisons to regular comparisons. 9846 if (const SCEVConstant *RC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) { 9847 const APInt &RA = RC->getAPInt(); 9848 9849 bool SimplifiedByConstantRange = false; 9850 9851 if (!ICmpInst::isEquality(Pred)) { 9852 ConstantRange ExactCR = ConstantRange::makeExactICmpRegion(Pred, RA); 9853 if (ExactCR.isFullSet()) 9854 return TrivialCase(true); 9855 else if (ExactCR.isEmptySet()) 9856 return TrivialCase(false); 9857 9858 APInt NewRHS; 9859 CmpInst::Predicate NewPred; 9860 if (ExactCR.getEquivalentICmp(NewPred, NewRHS) && 9861 ICmpInst::isEquality(NewPred)) { 9862 // We were able to convert an inequality to an equality. 9863 Pred = NewPred; 9864 RHS = getConstant(NewRHS); 9865 Changed = SimplifiedByConstantRange = true; 9866 } 9867 } 9868 9869 if (!SimplifiedByConstantRange) { 9870 switch (Pred) { 9871 default: 9872 break; 9873 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: 9874 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: 9875 // Fold ((-1) * %a) + %b == 0 (equivalent to %b-%a == 0) into %a == %b. 9876 if (!RA) 9877 if (const SCEVAddExpr *AE = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(LHS)) 9878 if (const SCEVMulExpr *ME = 9879 dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(AE->getOperand(0))) 9880 if (AE->getNumOperands() == 2 && ME->getNumOperands() == 2 && 9881 ME->getOperand(0)->isAllOnesValue()) { 9882 RHS = AE->getOperand(1); 9883 LHS = ME->getOperand(1); 9884 Changed = true; 9885 } 9886 break; 9887 9888 9889 // The "Should have been caught earlier!" messages refer to the fact 9890 // that the ExactCR.isFullSet() or ExactCR.isEmptySet() check above 9891 // should have fired on the corresponding cases, and canonicalized the 9892 // check to trivial case. 9893 9894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: 9895 assert(!RA.isMinValue() && "Should have been caught earlier!"); 9896 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT; 9897 RHS = getConstant(RA - 1); 9898 Changed = true; 9899 break; 9900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: 9901 assert(!RA.isMaxValue() && "Should have been caught earlier!"); 9902 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT; 9903 RHS = getConstant(RA + 1); 9904 Changed = true; 9905 break; 9906 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: 9907 assert(!RA.isMinSignedValue() && "Should have been caught earlier!"); 9908 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; 9909 RHS = getConstant(RA - 1); 9910 Changed = true; 9911 break; 9912 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: 9913 assert(!RA.isMaxSignedValue() && "Should have been caught earlier!"); 9914 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; 9915 RHS = getConstant(RA + 1); 9916 Changed = true; 9917 break; 9918 } 9919 } 9920 } 9921 9922 // Check for obvious equality. 9923 if (HasSameValue(LHS, RHS)) { 9924 if (ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred)) 9925 return TrivialCase(true); 9926 if (ICmpInst::isFalseWhenEqual(Pred)) 9927 return TrivialCase(false); 9928 } 9929 9930 // If possible, canonicalize GE/LE comparisons to GT/LT comparisons, by 9931 // adding or subtracting 1 from one of the operands. 9932 switch (Pred) { 9933 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: 9934 if (!getSignedRangeMax(RHS).isMaxSignedValue()) { 9935 RHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), 1, true), RHS, 9936 SCEV::FlagNSW); 9937 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; 9938 Changed = true; 9939 } else if (!getSignedRangeMin(LHS).isMinSignedValue()) { 9940 LHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), (uint64_t)-1, true), LHS, 9941 SCEV::FlagNSW); 9942 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; 9943 Changed = true; 9944 } 9945 break; 9946 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: 9947 if (!getSignedRangeMin(RHS).isMinSignedValue()) { 9948 RHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), (uint64_t)-1, true), RHS, 9949 SCEV::FlagNSW); 9950 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; 9951 Changed = true; 9952 } else if (!getSignedRangeMax(LHS).isMaxSignedValue()) { 9953 LHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), 1, true), LHS, 9954 SCEV::FlagNSW); 9955 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; 9956 Changed = true; 9957 } 9958 break; 9959 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: 9960 if (!getUnsignedRangeMax(RHS).isMaxValue()) { 9961 RHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), 1, true), RHS, 9962 SCEV::FlagNUW); 9963 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT; 9964 Changed = true; 9965 } else if (!getUnsignedRangeMin(LHS).isMinValue()) { 9966 LHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), (uint64_t)-1, true), LHS); 9967 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT; 9968 Changed = true; 9969 } 9970 break; 9971 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: 9972 if (!getUnsignedRangeMin(RHS).isMinValue()) { 9973 RHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), (uint64_t)-1, true), RHS); 9974 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT; 9975 Changed = true; 9976 } else if (!getUnsignedRangeMax(LHS).isMaxValue()) { 9977 LHS = getAddExpr(getConstant(RHS->getType(), 1, true), LHS, 9978 SCEV::FlagNUW); 9979 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT; 9980 Changed = true; 9981 } 9982 break; 9983 default: 9984 break; 9985 } 9986 9987 // TODO: More simplifications are possible here. 9988 9989 // Recursively simplify until we either hit a recursion limit or nothing 9990 // changes. 9991 if (Changed) 9992 return SimplifyICmpOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, Depth+1); 9993 9994 return Changed; 9995 } 9996 9997 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownNegative(const SCEV *S) { 9998 return getSignedRangeMax(S).isNegative(); 9999 } 10000 10001 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPositive(const SCEV *S) { 10002 return getSignedRangeMin(S).isStrictlyPositive(); 10003 } 10004 10005 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownNonNegative(const SCEV *S) { 10006 return !getSignedRangeMin(S).isNegative(); 10007 } 10008 10009 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownNonPositive(const SCEV *S) { 10010 return !getSignedRangeMax(S).isStrictlyPositive(); 10011 } 10012 10013 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownNonZero(const SCEV *S) { 10014 return getUnsignedRangeMin(S) != 0; 10015 } 10016 10017 std::pair<const SCEV *, const SCEV *> 10018 ScalarEvolution::SplitIntoInitAndPostInc(const Loop *L, const SCEV *S) { 10019 // Compute SCEV on entry of loop L. 10020 const SCEV *Start = SCEVInitRewriter::rewrite(S, L, *this); 10021 if (Start == getCouldNotCompute()) 10022 return { Start, Start }; 10023 // Compute post increment SCEV for loop L. 10024 const SCEV *PostInc = SCEVPostIncRewriter::rewrite(S, L, *this); 10025 assert(PostInc != getCouldNotCompute() && "Unexpected could not compute"); 10026 return { Start, PostInc }; 10027 } 10028 10029 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownViaInduction(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10030 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 10031 // First collect all loops. 10032 SmallPtrSet<const Loop *, 8> LoopsUsed; 10033 getUsedLoops(LHS, LoopsUsed); 10034 getUsedLoops(RHS, LoopsUsed); 10035 10036 if (LoopsUsed.empty()) 10037 return false; 10038 10039 // Domination relationship must be a linear order on collected loops. 10040 #ifndef NDEBUG 10041 for (auto *L1 : LoopsUsed) 10042 for (auto *L2 : LoopsUsed) 10043 assert((DT.dominates(L1->getHeader(), L2->getHeader()) || 10044 DT.dominates(L2->getHeader(), L1->getHeader())) && 10045 "Domination relationship is not a linear order"); 10046 #endif 10047 10048 const Loop *MDL = 10049 *std::max_element(LoopsUsed.begin(), LoopsUsed.end(), 10050 [&](const Loop *L1, const Loop *L2) { 10051 return DT.properlyDominates(L1->getHeader(), L2->getHeader()); 10052 }); 10053 10054 // Get init and post increment value for LHS. 10055 auto SplitLHS = SplitIntoInitAndPostInc(MDL, LHS); 10056 // if LHS contains unknown non-invariant SCEV then bail out. 10057 if (SplitLHS.first == getCouldNotCompute()) 10058 return false; 10059 assert (SplitLHS.second != getCouldNotCompute() && "Unexpected CNC"); 10060 // Get init and post increment value for RHS. 10061 auto SplitRHS = SplitIntoInitAndPostInc(MDL, RHS); 10062 // if RHS contains unknown non-invariant SCEV then bail out. 10063 if (SplitRHS.first == getCouldNotCompute()) 10064 return false; 10065 assert (SplitRHS.second != getCouldNotCompute() && "Unexpected CNC"); 10066 // It is possible that init SCEV contains an invariant load but it does 10067 // not dominate MDL and is not available at MDL loop entry, so we should 10068 // check it here. 10069 if (!isAvailableAtLoopEntry(SplitLHS.first, MDL) || 10070 !isAvailableAtLoopEntry(SplitRHS.first, MDL)) 10071 return false; 10072 10073 // It seems backedge guard check is faster than entry one so in some cases 10074 // it can speed up whole estimation by short circuit 10075 return isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(MDL, Pred, SplitLHS.second, 10076 SplitRHS.second) && 10077 isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(MDL, Pred, SplitLHS.first, SplitRHS.first); 10078 } 10079 10080 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPredicate(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10081 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 10082 // Canonicalize the inputs first. 10083 (void)SimplifyICmpOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS); 10084 10085 if (isKnownViaInduction(Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10086 return true; 10087 10088 if (isKnownPredicateViaSplitting(Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10089 return true; 10090 10091 // Otherwise see what can be done with some simple reasoning. 10092 return isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(Pred, LHS, RHS); 10093 } 10094 10095 Optional<bool> ScalarEvolution::evaluatePredicate(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10096 const SCEV *LHS, 10097 const SCEV *RHS) { 10098 if (isKnownPredicate(Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10099 return true; 10100 else if (isKnownPredicate(ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred), LHS, RHS)) 10101 return false; 10102 return None; 10103 } 10104 10105 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPredicateAt(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10106 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 10107 const Instruction *CtxI) { 10108 // TODO: Analyze guards and assumes from Context's block. 10109 return isKnownPredicate(Pred, LHS, RHS) || 10110 isBasicBlockEntryGuardedByCond(CtxI->getParent(), Pred, LHS, RHS); 10111 } 10112 10113 Optional<bool> ScalarEvolution::evaluatePredicateAt(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10114 const SCEV *LHS, 10115 const SCEV *RHS, 10116 const Instruction *CtxI) { 10117 Optional<bool> KnownWithoutContext = evaluatePredicate(Pred, LHS, RHS); 10118 if (KnownWithoutContext) 10119 return KnownWithoutContext; 10120 10121 if (isBasicBlockEntryGuardedByCond(CtxI->getParent(), Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10122 return true; 10123 else if (isBasicBlockEntryGuardedByCond(CtxI->getParent(), 10124 ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred), 10125 LHS, RHS)) 10126 return false; 10127 return None; 10128 } 10129 10130 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownOnEveryIteration(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10131 const SCEVAddRecExpr *LHS, 10132 const SCEV *RHS) { 10133 const Loop *L = LHS->getLoop(); 10134 return isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Pred, LHS->getStart(), RHS) && 10135 isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, Pred, LHS->getPostIncExpr(*this), RHS); 10136 } 10137 10138 Optional<ScalarEvolution::MonotonicPredicateType> 10139 ScalarEvolution::getMonotonicPredicateType(const SCEVAddRecExpr *LHS, 10140 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred) { 10141 auto Result = getMonotonicPredicateTypeImpl(LHS, Pred); 10142 10143 #ifndef NDEBUG 10144 // Verify an invariant: inverting the predicate should turn a monotonically 10145 // increasing change to a monotonically decreasing one, and vice versa. 10146 if (Result) { 10147 auto ResultSwapped = 10148 getMonotonicPredicateTypeImpl(LHS, ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred)); 10149 10150 assert(ResultSwapped.hasValue() && "should be able to analyze both!"); 10151 assert(ResultSwapped.getValue() != Result.getValue() && 10152 "monotonicity should flip as we flip the predicate"); 10153 } 10154 #endif 10155 10156 return Result; 10157 } 10158 10159 Optional<ScalarEvolution::MonotonicPredicateType> 10160 ScalarEvolution::getMonotonicPredicateTypeImpl(const SCEVAddRecExpr *LHS, 10161 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred) { 10162 // A zero step value for LHS means the induction variable is essentially a 10163 // loop invariant value. We don't really depend on the predicate actually 10164 // flipping from false to true (for increasing predicates, and the other way 10165 // around for decreasing predicates), all we care about is that *if* the 10166 // predicate changes then it only changes from false to true. 10167 // 10168 // A zero step value in itself is not very useful, but there may be places 10169 // where SCEV can prove X >= 0 but not prove X > 0, so it is helpful to be 10170 // as general as possible. 10171 10172 // Only handle LE/LT/GE/GT predicates. 10173 if (!ICmpInst::isRelational(Pred)) 10174 return None; 10175 10176 bool IsGreater = ICmpInst::isGE(Pred) || ICmpInst::isGT(Pred); 10177 assert((IsGreater || ICmpInst::isLE(Pred) || ICmpInst::isLT(Pred)) && 10178 "Should be greater or less!"); 10179 10180 // Check that AR does not wrap. 10181 if (ICmpInst::isUnsigned(Pred)) { 10182 if (!LHS->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) 10183 return None; 10184 return IsGreater ? MonotonicallyIncreasing : MonotonicallyDecreasing; 10185 } else { 10186 assert(ICmpInst::isSigned(Pred) && 10187 "Relational predicate is either signed or unsigned!"); 10188 if (!LHS->hasNoSignedWrap()) 10189 return None; 10190 10191 const SCEV *Step = LHS->getStepRecurrence(*this); 10192 10193 if (isKnownNonNegative(Step)) 10194 return IsGreater ? MonotonicallyIncreasing : MonotonicallyDecreasing; 10195 10196 if (isKnownNonPositive(Step)) 10197 return !IsGreater ? MonotonicallyIncreasing : MonotonicallyDecreasing; 10198 10199 return None; 10200 } 10201 } 10202 10203 Optional<ScalarEvolution::LoopInvariantPredicate> 10204 ScalarEvolution::getLoopInvariantPredicate(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10205 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 10206 const Loop *L) { 10207 10208 // If there is a loop-invariant, force it into the RHS, otherwise bail out. 10209 if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) { 10210 if (!isLoopInvariant(LHS, L)) 10211 return None; 10212 10213 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 10214 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred); 10215 } 10216 10217 const SCEVAddRecExpr *ArLHS = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS); 10218 if (!ArLHS || ArLHS->getLoop() != L) 10219 return None; 10220 10221 auto MonotonicType = getMonotonicPredicateType(ArLHS, Pred); 10222 if (!MonotonicType) 10223 return None; 10224 // If the predicate "ArLHS `Pred` RHS" monotonically increases from false to 10225 // true as the loop iterates, and the backedge is control dependent on 10226 // "ArLHS `Pred` RHS" == true then we can reason as follows: 10227 // 10228 // * if the predicate was false in the first iteration then the predicate 10229 // is never evaluated again, since the loop exits without taking the 10230 // backedge. 10231 // * if the predicate was true in the first iteration then it will 10232 // continue to be true for all future iterations since it is 10233 // monotonically increasing. 10234 // 10235 // For both the above possibilities, we can replace the loop varying 10236 // predicate with its value on the first iteration of the loop (which is 10237 // loop invariant). 10238 // 10239 // A similar reasoning applies for a monotonically decreasing predicate, by 10240 // replacing true with false and false with true in the above two bullets. 10241 bool Increasing = *MonotonicType == ScalarEvolution::MonotonicallyIncreasing; 10242 auto P = Increasing ? Pred : ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(Pred); 10243 10244 if (!isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, P, LHS, RHS)) 10245 return None; 10246 10247 return ScalarEvolution::LoopInvariantPredicate(Pred, ArLHS->getStart(), RHS); 10248 } 10249 10250 Optional<ScalarEvolution::LoopInvariantPredicate> 10251 ScalarEvolution::getLoopInvariantExitCondDuringFirstIterations( 10252 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, const Loop *L, 10253 const Instruction *CtxI, const SCEV *MaxIter) { 10254 // Try to prove the following set of facts: 10255 // - The predicate is monotonic in the iteration space. 10256 // - If the check does not fail on the 1st iteration: 10257 // - No overflow will happen during first MaxIter iterations; 10258 // - It will not fail on the MaxIter'th iteration. 10259 // If the check does fail on the 1st iteration, we leave the loop and no 10260 // other checks matter. 10261 10262 // If there is a loop-invariant, force it into the RHS, otherwise bail out. 10263 if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) { 10264 if (!isLoopInvariant(LHS, L)) 10265 return None; 10266 10267 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 10268 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred); 10269 } 10270 10271 auto *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS); 10272 if (!AR || AR->getLoop() != L) 10273 return None; 10274 10275 // The predicate must be relational (i.e. <, <=, >=, >). 10276 if (!ICmpInst::isRelational(Pred)) 10277 return None; 10278 10279 // TODO: Support steps other than +/- 1. 10280 const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*this); 10281 auto *One = getOne(Step->getType()); 10282 auto *MinusOne = getNegativeSCEV(One); 10283 if (Step != One && Step != MinusOne) 10284 return None; 10285 10286 // Type mismatch here means that MaxIter is potentially larger than max 10287 // unsigned value in start type, which mean we cannot prove no wrap for the 10288 // indvar. 10289 if (AR->getType() != MaxIter->getType()) 10290 return None; 10291 10292 // Value of IV on suggested last iteration. 10293 const SCEV *Last = AR->evaluateAtIteration(MaxIter, *this); 10294 // Does it still meet the requirement? 10295 if (!isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(L, Pred, Last, RHS)) 10296 return None; 10297 // Because step is +/- 1 and MaxIter has same type as Start (i.e. it does 10298 // not exceed max unsigned value of this type), this effectively proves 10299 // that there is no wrap during the iteration. To prove that there is no 10300 // signed/unsigned wrap, we need to check that 10301 // Start <= Last for step = 1 or Start >= Last for step = -1. 10302 ICmpInst::Predicate NoOverflowPred = 10303 CmpInst::isSigned(Pred) ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE; 10304 if (Step == MinusOne) 10305 NoOverflowPred = CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(NoOverflowPred); 10306 const SCEV *Start = AR->getStart(); 10307 if (!isKnownPredicateAt(NoOverflowPred, Start, Last, CtxI)) 10308 return None; 10309 10310 // Everything is fine. 10311 return ScalarEvolution::LoopInvariantPredicate(Pred, Start, RHS); 10312 } 10313 10314 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPredicateViaConstantRanges( 10315 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 10316 if (HasSameValue(LHS, RHS)) 10317 return ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred); 10318 10319 // This code is split out from isKnownPredicate because it is called from 10320 // within isLoopEntryGuardedByCond. 10321 10322 auto CheckRanges = [&](const ConstantRange &RangeLHS, 10323 const ConstantRange &RangeRHS) { 10324 return RangeLHS.icmp(Pred, RangeRHS); 10325 }; 10326 10327 // The check at the top of the function catches the case where the values are 10328 // known to be equal. 10329 if (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_EQ) 10330 return false; 10331 10332 if (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_NE) { 10333 if (CheckRanges(getSignedRange(LHS), getSignedRange(RHS)) || 10334 CheckRanges(getUnsignedRange(LHS), getUnsignedRange(RHS))) 10335 return true; 10336 auto *Diff = getMinusSCEV(LHS, RHS); 10337 return !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(Diff) && isKnownNonZero(Diff); 10338 } 10339 10340 if (CmpInst::isSigned(Pred)) 10341 return CheckRanges(getSignedRange(LHS), getSignedRange(RHS)); 10342 10343 return CheckRanges(getUnsignedRange(LHS), getUnsignedRange(RHS)); 10344 } 10345 10346 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPredicateViaNoOverflow(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10347 const SCEV *LHS, 10348 const SCEV *RHS) { 10349 // Match X to (A + C1)<ExpectedFlags> and Y to (A + C2)<ExpectedFlags>, where 10350 // C1 and C2 are constant integers. If either X or Y are not add expressions, 10351 // consider them as X + 0 and Y + 0 respectively. C1 and C2 are returned via 10352 // OutC1 and OutC2. 10353 auto MatchBinaryAddToConst = [this](const SCEV *X, const SCEV *Y, 10354 APInt &OutC1, APInt &OutC2, 10355 SCEV::NoWrapFlags ExpectedFlags) { 10356 const SCEV *XNonConstOp, *XConstOp; 10357 const SCEV *YNonConstOp, *YConstOp; 10358 SCEV::NoWrapFlags XFlagsPresent; 10359 SCEV::NoWrapFlags YFlagsPresent; 10360 10361 if (!splitBinaryAdd(X, XConstOp, XNonConstOp, XFlagsPresent)) { 10362 XConstOp = getZero(X->getType()); 10363 XNonConstOp = X; 10364 XFlagsPresent = ExpectedFlags; 10365 } 10366 if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(XConstOp) || 10367 (XFlagsPresent & ExpectedFlags) != ExpectedFlags) 10368 return false; 10369 10370 if (!splitBinaryAdd(Y, YConstOp, YNonConstOp, YFlagsPresent)) { 10371 YConstOp = getZero(Y->getType()); 10372 YNonConstOp = Y; 10373 YFlagsPresent = ExpectedFlags; 10374 } 10375 10376 if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(YConstOp) || 10377 (YFlagsPresent & ExpectedFlags) != ExpectedFlags) 10378 return false; 10379 10380 if (YNonConstOp != XNonConstOp) 10381 return false; 10382 10383 OutC1 = cast<SCEVConstant>(XConstOp)->getAPInt(); 10384 OutC2 = cast<SCEVConstant>(YConstOp)->getAPInt(); 10385 10386 return true; 10387 }; 10388 10389 APInt C1; 10390 APInt C2; 10391 10392 switch (Pred) { 10393 default: 10394 break; 10395 10396 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: 10397 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 10398 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 10399 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: 10400 // (X + C1)<nsw> s<= (X + C2)<nsw> if C1 s<= C2. 10401 if (MatchBinaryAddToConst(LHS, RHS, C1, C2, SCEV::FlagNSW) && C1.sle(C2)) 10402 return true; 10403 10404 break; 10405 10406 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: 10407 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 10408 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 10409 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: 10410 // (X + C1)<nsw> s< (X + C2)<nsw> if C1 s< C2. 10411 if (MatchBinaryAddToConst(LHS, RHS, C1, C2, SCEV::FlagNSW) && C1.slt(C2)) 10412 return true; 10413 10414 break; 10415 10416 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: 10417 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 10418 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 10419 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: 10420 // (X + C1)<nuw> u<= (X + C2)<nuw> for C1 u<= C2. 10421 if (MatchBinaryAddToConst(RHS, LHS, C2, C1, SCEV::FlagNUW) && C1.ule(C2)) 10422 return true; 10423 10424 break; 10425 10426 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: 10427 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 10428 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 10429 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: 10430 // (X + C1)<nuw> u< (X + C2)<nuw> if C1 u< C2. 10431 if (MatchBinaryAddToConst(RHS, LHS, C2, C1, SCEV::FlagNUW) && C1.ult(C2)) 10432 return true; 10433 break; 10434 } 10435 10436 return false; 10437 } 10438 10439 bool ScalarEvolution::isKnownPredicateViaSplitting(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10440 const SCEV *LHS, 10441 const SCEV *RHS) { 10442 if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT || ProvingSplitPredicate) 10443 return false; 10444 10445 // Allowing arbitrary number of activations of isKnownPredicateViaSplitting on 10446 // the stack can result in exponential time complexity. 10447 SaveAndRestore<bool> Restore(ProvingSplitPredicate, true); 10448 10449 // If L >= 0 then I `ult` L <=> I >= 0 && I `slt` L 10450 // 10451 // To prove L >= 0 we use isKnownNonNegative whereas to prove I >= 0 we use 10452 // isKnownPredicate. isKnownPredicate is more powerful, but also more 10453 // expensive; and using isKnownNonNegative(RHS) is sufficient for most of the 10454 // interesting cases seen in practice. We can consider "upgrading" L >= 0 to 10455 // use isKnownPredicate later if needed. 10456 return isKnownNonNegative(RHS) && 10457 isKnownPredicate(CmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, getZero(LHS->getType())) && 10458 isKnownPredicate(CmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS); 10459 } 10460 10461 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedViaGuard(const BasicBlock *BB, 10462 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10463 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 10464 // No need to even try if we know the module has no guards. 10465 if (!HasGuards) 10466 return false; 10467 10468 return any_of(*BB, [&](const Instruction &I) { 10469 using namespace llvm::PatternMatch; 10470 10471 Value *Condition; 10472 return match(&I, m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::experimental_guard>( 10473 m_Value(Condition))) && 10474 isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Condition, false); 10475 }); 10476 } 10477 10478 /// isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond - Test whether the backedge of the loop is 10479 /// protected by a conditional between LHS and RHS. This is used to 10480 /// to eliminate casts. 10481 bool 10482 ScalarEvolution::isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond(const Loop *L, 10483 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10484 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 10485 // Interpret a null as meaning no loop, where there is obviously no guard 10486 // (interprocedural conditions notwithstanding). 10487 if (!L) return true; 10488 10489 if (VerifyIR) 10490 assert(!verifyFunction(*L->getHeader()->getParent(), &dbgs()) && 10491 "This cannot be done on broken IR!"); 10492 10493 10494 if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10495 return true; 10496 10497 BasicBlock *Latch = L->getLoopLatch(); 10498 if (!Latch) 10499 return false; 10500 10501 BranchInst *LoopContinuePredicate = 10502 dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Latch->getTerminator()); 10503 if (LoopContinuePredicate && LoopContinuePredicate->isConditional() && 10504 isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, 10505 LoopContinuePredicate->getCondition(), 10506 LoopContinuePredicate->getSuccessor(0) != L->getHeader())) 10507 return true; 10508 10509 // We don't want more than one activation of the following loops on the stack 10510 // -- that can lead to O(n!) time complexity. 10511 if (WalkingBEDominatingConds) 10512 return false; 10513 10514 SaveAndRestore<bool> ClearOnExit(WalkingBEDominatingConds, true); 10515 10516 // See if we can exploit a trip count to prove the predicate. 10517 const auto &BETakenInfo = getBackedgeTakenInfo(L); 10518 const SCEV *LatchBECount = BETakenInfo.getExact(Latch, this); 10519 if (LatchBECount != getCouldNotCompute()) { 10520 // We know that Latch branches back to the loop header exactly 10521 // LatchBECount times. This means the backdege condition at Latch is 10522 // equivalent to "{0,+,1} u< LatchBECount". 10523 Type *Ty = LatchBECount->getType(); 10524 auto NoWrapFlags = SCEV::NoWrapFlags(SCEV::FlagNUW | SCEV::FlagNW); 10525 const SCEV *LoopCounter = 10526 getAddRecExpr(getZero(Ty), getOne(Ty), L, NoWrapFlags); 10527 if (isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LoopCounter, 10528 LatchBECount)) 10529 return true; 10530 } 10531 10532 // Check conditions due to any @llvm.assume intrinsics. 10533 for (auto &AssumeVH : AC.assumptions()) { 10534 if (!AssumeVH) 10535 continue; 10536 auto *CI = cast<CallInst>(AssumeVH); 10537 if (!DT.dominates(CI, Latch->getTerminator())) 10538 continue; 10539 10540 if (isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, CI->getArgOperand(0), false)) 10541 return true; 10542 } 10543 10544 // If the loop is not reachable from the entry block, we risk running into an 10545 // infinite loop as we walk up into the dom tree. These loops do not matter 10546 // anyway, so we just return a conservative answer when we see them. 10547 if (!DT.isReachableFromEntry(L->getHeader())) 10548 return false; 10549 10550 if (isImpliedViaGuard(Latch, Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10551 return true; 10552 10553 for (DomTreeNode *DTN = DT[Latch], *HeaderDTN = DT[L->getHeader()]; 10554 DTN != HeaderDTN; DTN = DTN->getIDom()) { 10555 assert(DTN && "should reach the loop header before reaching the root!"); 10556 10557 BasicBlock *BB = DTN->getBlock(); 10558 if (isImpliedViaGuard(BB, Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10559 return true; 10560 10561 BasicBlock *PBB = BB->getSinglePredecessor(); 10562 if (!PBB) 10563 continue; 10564 10565 BranchInst *ContinuePredicate = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(PBB->getTerminator()); 10566 if (!ContinuePredicate || !ContinuePredicate->isConditional()) 10567 continue; 10568 10569 Value *Condition = ContinuePredicate->getCondition(); 10570 10571 // If we have an edge `E` within the loop body that dominates the only 10572 // latch, the condition guarding `E` also guards the backedge. This 10573 // reasoning works only for loops with a single latch. 10574 10575 BasicBlockEdge DominatingEdge(PBB, BB); 10576 if (DominatingEdge.isSingleEdge()) { 10577 // We're constructively (and conservatively) enumerating edges within the 10578 // loop body that dominate the latch. The dominator tree better agree 10579 // with us on this: 10580 assert(DT.dominates(DominatingEdge, Latch) && "should be!"); 10581 10582 if (isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Condition, 10583 BB != ContinuePredicate->getSuccessor(0))) 10584 return true; 10585 } 10586 } 10587 10588 return false; 10589 } 10590 10591 bool ScalarEvolution::isBasicBlockEntryGuardedByCond(const BasicBlock *BB, 10592 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10593 const SCEV *LHS, 10594 const SCEV *RHS) { 10595 if (VerifyIR) 10596 assert(!verifyFunction(*BB->getParent(), &dbgs()) && 10597 "This cannot be done on broken IR!"); 10598 10599 // If we cannot prove strict comparison (e.g. a > b), maybe we can prove 10600 // the facts (a >= b && a != b) separately. A typical situation is when the 10601 // non-strict comparison is known from ranges and non-equality is known from 10602 // dominating predicates. If we are proving strict comparison, we always try 10603 // to prove non-equality and non-strict comparison separately. 10604 auto NonStrictPredicate = ICmpInst::getNonStrictPredicate(Pred); 10605 const bool ProvingStrictComparison = (Pred != NonStrictPredicate); 10606 bool ProvedNonStrictComparison = false; 10607 bool ProvedNonEquality = false; 10608 10609 auto SplitAndProve = 10610 [&](std::function<bool(ICmpInst::Predicate)> Fn) -> bool { 10611 if (!ProvedNonStrictComparison) 10612 ProvedNonStrictComparison = Fn(NonStrictPredicate); 10613 if (!ProvedNonEquality) 10614 ProvedNonEquality = Fn(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE); 10615 if (ProvedNonStrictComparison && ProvedNonEquality) 10616 return true; 10617 return false; 10618 }; 10619 10620 if (ProvingStrictComparison) { 10621 auto ProofFn = [&](ICmpInst::Predicate P) { 10622 return isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(P, LHS, RHS); 10623 }; 10624 if (SplitAndProve(ProofFn)) 10625 return true; 10626 } 10627 10628 // Try to prove (Pred, LHS, RHS) using isImpliedViaGuard. 10629 auto ProveViaGuard = [&](const BasicBlock *Block) { 10630 if (isImpliedViaGuard(Block, Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10631 return true; 10632 if (ProvingStrictComparison) { 10633 auto ProofFn = [&](ICmpInst::Predicate P) { 10634 return isImpliedViaGuard(Block, P, LHS, RHS); 10635 }; 10636 if (SplitAndProve(ProofFn)) 10637 return true; 10638 } 10639 return false; 10640 }; 10641 10642 // Try to prove (Pred, LHS, RHS) using isImpliedCond. 10643 auto ProveViaCond = [&](const Value *Condition, bool Inverse) { 10644 const Instruction *CtxI = &BB->front(); 10645 if (isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Condition, Inverse, CtxI)) 10646 return true; 10647 if (ProvingStrictComparison) { 10648 auto ProofFn = [&](ICmpInst::Predicate P) { 10649 return isImpliedCond(P, LHS, RHS, Condition, Inverse, CtxI); 10650 }; 10651 if (SplitAndProve(ProofFn)) 10652 return true; 10653 } 10654 return false; 10655 }; 10656 10657 // Starting at the block's predecessor, climb up the predecessor chain, as long 10658 // as there are predecessors that can be found that have unique successors 10659 // leading to the original block. 10660 const Loop *ContainingLoop = LI.getLoopFor(BB); 10661 const BasicBlock *PredBB; 10662 if (ContainingLoop && ContainingLoop->getHeader() == BB) 10663 PredBB = ContainingLoop->getLoopPredecessor(); 10664 else 10665 PredBB = BB->getSinglePredecessor(); 10666 for (std::pair<const BasicBlock *, const BasicBlock *> Pair(PredBB, BB); 10667 Pair.first; Pair = getPredecessorWithUniqueSuccessorForBB(Pair.first)) { 10668 if (ProveViaGuard(Pair.first)) 10669 return true; 10670 10671 const BranchInst *LoopEntryPredicate = 10672 dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Pair.first->getTerminator()); 10673 if (!LoopEntryPredicate || 10674 LoopEntryPredicate->isUnconditional()) 10675 continue; 10676 10677 if (ProveViaCond(LoopEntryPredicate->getCondition(), 10678 LoopEntryPredicate->getSuccessor(0) != Pair.second)) 10679 return true; 10680 } 10681 10682 // Check conditions due to any @llvm.assume intrinsics. 10683 for (auto &AssumeVH : AC.assumptions()) { 10684 if (!AssumeVH) 10685 continue; 10686 auto *CI = cast<CallInst>(AssumeVH); 10687 if (!DT.dominates(CI, BB)) 10688 continue; 10689 10690 if (ProveViaCond(CI->getArgOperand(0), false)) 10691 return true; 10692 } 10693 10694 return false; 10695 } 10696 10697 bool ScalarEvolution::isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(const Loop *L, 10698 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 10699 const SCEV *LHS, 10700 const SCEV *RHS) { 10701 // Interpret a null as meaning no loop, where there is obviously no guard 10702 // (interprocedural conditions notwithstanding). 10703 if (!L) 10704 return false; 10705 10706 // Both LHS and RHS must be available at loop entry. 10707 assert(isAvailableAtLoopEntry(LHS, L) && 10708 "LHS is not available at Loop Entry"); 10709 assert(isAvailableAtLoopEntry(RHS, L) && 10710 "RHS is not available at Loop Entry"); 10711 10712 if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10713 return true; 10714 10715 return isBasicBlockEntryGuardedByCond(L->getHeader(), Pred, LHS, RHS); 10716 } 10717 10718 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCond(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, 10719 const SCEV *RHS, 10720 const Value *FoundCondValue, bool Inverse, 10721 const Instruction *CtxI) { 10722 // False conditions implies anything. Do not bother analyzing it further. 10723 if (FoundCondValue == 10724 ConstantInt::getBool(FoundCondValue->getContext(), Inverse)) 10725 return true; 10726 10727 if (!PendingLoopPredicates.insert(FoundCondValue).second) 10728 return false; 10729 10730 auto ClearOnExit = 10731 make_scope_exit([&]() { PendingLoopPredicates.erase(FoundCondValue); }); 10732 10733 // Recursively handle And and Or conditions. 10734 const Value *Op0, *Op1; 10735 if (match(FoundCondValue, m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(Op0), m_Value(Op1)))) { 10736 if (!Inverse) 10737 return isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Op0, Inverse, CtxI) || 10738 isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Op1, Inverse, CtxI); 10739 } else if (match(FoundCondValue, m_LogicalOr(m_Value(Op0), m_Value(Op1)))) { 10740 if (Inverse) 10741 return isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Op0, Inverse, CtxI) || 10742 isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, Op1, Inverse, CtxI); 10743 } 10744 10745 const ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(FoundCondValue); 10746 if (!ICI) return false; 10747 10748 // Now that we found a conditional branch that dominates the loop or controls 10749 // the loop latch. Check to see if it is the comparison we are looking for. 10750 ICmpInst::Predicate FoundPred; 10751 if (Inverse) 10752 FoundPred = ICI->getInversePredicate(); 10753 else 10754 FoundPred = ICI->getPredicate(); 10755 10756 const SCEV *FoundLHS = getSCEV(ICI->getOperand(0)); 10757 const SCEV *FoundRHS = getSCEV(ICI->getOperand(1)); 10758 10759 return isImpliedCond(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundPred, FoundLHS, FoundRHS, CtxI); 10760 } 10761 10762 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCond(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, 10763 const SCEV *RHS, 10764 ICmpInst::Predicate FoundPred, 10765 const SCEV *FoundLHS, const SCEV *FoundRHS, 10766 const Instruction *CtxI) { 10767 // Balance the types. 10768 if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) < 10769 getTypeSizeInBits(FoundLHS->getType())) { 10770 // For unsigned and equality predicates, try to prove that both found 10771 // operands fit into narrow unsigned range. If so, try to prove facts in 10772 // narrow types. 10773 if (!CmpInst::isSigned(FoundPred) && !FoundLHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 10774 auto *NarrowType = LHS->getType(); 10775 auto *WideType = FoundLHS->getType(); 10776 auto BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(NarrowType); 10777 const SCEV *MaxValue = getZeroExtendExpr( 10778 getConstant(APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth)), WideType); 10779 if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, FoundLHS, 10780 MaxValue) && 10781 isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, FoundRHS, 10782 MaxValue)) { 10783 const SCEV *TruncFoundLHS = getTruncateExpr(FoundLHS, NarrowType); 10784 const SCEV *TruncFoundRHS = getTruncateExpr(FoundRHS, NarrowType); 10785 if (isImpliedCondBalancedTypes(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundPred, TruncFoundLHS, 10786 TruncFoundRHS, CtxI)) 10787 return true; 10788 } 10789 } 10790 10791 if (LHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) 10792 return false; 10793 if (CmpInst::isSigned(Pred)) { 10794 LHS = getSignExtendExpr(LHS, FoundLHS->getType()); 10795 RHS = getSignExtendExpr(RHS, FoundLHS->getType()); 10796 } else { 10797 LHS = getZeroExtendExpr(LHS, FoundLHS->getType()); 10798 RHS = getZeroExtendExpr(RHS, FoundLHS->getType()); 10799 } 10800 } else if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) > 10801 getTypeSizeInBits(FoundLHS->getType())) { 10802 if (FoundLHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) 10803 return false; 10804 if (CmpInst::isSigned(FoundPred)) { 10805 FoundLHS = getSignExtendExpr(FoundLHS, LHS->getType()); 10806 FoundRHS = getSignExtendExpr(FoundRHS, LHS->getType()); 10807 } else { 10808 FoundLHS = getZeroExtendExpr(FoundLHS, LHS->getType()); 10809 FoundRHS = getZeroExtendExpr(FoundRHS, LHS->getType()); 10810 } 10811 } 10812 return isImpliedCondBalancedTypes(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundPred, FoundLHS, 10813 FoundRHS, CtxI); 10814 } 10815 10816 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondBalancedTypes( 10817 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 10818 ICmpInst::Predicate FoundPred, const SCEV *FoundLHS, const SCEV *FoundRHS, 10819 const Instruction *CtxI) { 10820 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) == 10821 getTypeSizeInBits(FoundLHS->getType()) && 10822 "Types should be balanced!"); 10823 // Canonicalize the query to match the way instcombine will have 10824 // canonicalized the comparison. 10825 if (SimplifyICmpOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS)) 10826 if (LHS == RHS) 10827 return CmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred); 10828 if (SimplifyICmpOperands(FoundPred, FoundLHS, FoundRHS)) 10829 if (FoundLHS == FoundRHS) 10830 return CmpInst::isFalseWhenEqual(FoundPred); 10831 10832 // Check to see if we can make the LHS or RHS match. 10833 if (LHS == FoundRHS || RHS == FoundLHS) { 10834 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) { 10835 std::swap(FoundLHS, FoundRHS); 10836 FoundPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(FoundPred); 10837 } else { 10838 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 10839 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred); 10840 } 10841 } 10842 10843 // Check whether the found predicate is the same as the desired predicate. 10844 if (FoundPred == Pred) 10845 return isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS, CtxI); 10846 10847 // Check whether swapping the found predicate makes it the same as the 10848 // desired predicate. 10849 if (ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(FoundPred) == Pred) { 10850 // We can write the implication 10851 // 0. LHS Pred RHS <- FoundLHS SwapPred FoundRHS 10852 // using one of the following ways: 10853 // 1. LHS Pred RHS <- FoundRHS Pred FoundLHS 10854 // 2. RHS SwapPred LHS <- FoundLHS SwapPred FoundRHS 10855 // 3. LHS Pred RHS <- ~FoundLHS Pred ~FoundRHS 10856 // 4. ~LHS SwapPred ~RHS <- FoundLHS SwapPred FoundRHS 10857 // Forms 1. and 2. require swapping the operands of one condition. Don't 10858 // do this if it would break canonical constant/addrec ordering. 10859 if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(RHS) && !isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS)) 10860 return isImpliedCondOperands(FoundPred, RHS, LHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS, 10861 CtxI); 10862 if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(FoundRHS) && !isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(FoundLHS)) 10863 return isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundRHS, FoundLHS, CtxI); 10864 10865 // There's no clear preference between forms 3. and 4., try both. Avoid 10866 // forming getNotSCEV of pointer values as the resulting subtract is 10867 // not legal. 10868 if (!LHS->getType()->isPointerTy() && !RHS->getType()->isPointerTy() && 10869 isImpliedCondOperands(FoundPred, getNotSCEV(LHS), getNotSCEV(RHS), 10870 FoundLHS, FoundRHS, CtxI)) 10871 return true; 10872 10873 if (!FoundLHS->getType()->isPointerTy() && 10874 !FoundRHS->getType()->isPointerTy() && 10875 isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, getNotSCEV(FoundLHS), 10876 getNotSCEV(FoundRHS), CtxI)) 10877 return true; 10878 10879 return false; 10880 } 10881 10882 auto IsSignFlippedPredicate = [](CmpInst::Predicate P1, 10883 CmpInst::Predicate P2) { 10884 assert(P1 != P2 && "Handled earlier!"); 10885 return CmpInst::isRelational(P2) && 10886 P1 == CmpInst::getFlippedSignednessPredicate(P2); 10887 }; 10888 if (IsSignFlippedPredicate(Pred, FoundPred)) { 10889 // Unsigned comparison is the same as signed comparison when both the 10890 // operands are non-negative or negative. 10891 if ((isKnownNonNegative(FoundLHS) && isKnownNonNegative(FoundRHS)) || 10892 (isKnownNegative(FoundLHS) && isKnownNegative(FoundRHS))) 10893 return isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS, CtxI); 10894 // Create local copies that we can freely swap and canonicalize our 10895 // conditions to "le/lt". 10896 ICmpInst::Predicate CanonicalPred = Pred, CanonicalFoundPred = FoundPred; 10897 const SCEV *CanonicalLHS = LHS, *CanonicalRHS = RHS, 10898 *CanonicalFoundLHS = FoundLHS, *CanonicalFoundRHS = FoundRHS; 10899 if (ICmpInst::isGT(CanonicalPred) || ICmpInst::isGE(CanonicalPred)) { 10900 CanonicalPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(CanonicalPred); 10901 CanonicalFoundPred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(CanonicalFoundPred); 10902 std::swap(CanonicalLHS, CanonicalRHS); 10903 std::swap(CanonicalFoundLHS, CanonicalFoundRHS); 10904 } 10905 assert((ICmpInst::isLT(CanonicalPred) || ICmpInst::isLE(CanonicalPred)) && 10906 "Must be!"); 10907 assert((ICmpInst::isLT(CanonicalFoundPred) || 10908 ICmpInst::isLE(CanonicalFoundPred)) && 10909 "Must be!"); 10910 if (ICmpInst::isSigned(CanonicalPred) && isKnownNonNegative(CanonicalRHS)) 10911 // Use implication: 10912 // x <u y && y >=s 0 --> x <s y. 10913 // If we can prove the left part, the right part is also proven. 10914 return isImpliedCondOperands(CanonicalFoundPred, CanonicalLHS, 10915 CanonicalRHS, CanonicalFoundLHS, 10916 CanonicalFoundRHS); 10917 if (ICmpInst::isUnsigned(CanonicalPred) && isKnownNegative(CanonicalRHS)) 10918 // Use implication: 10919 // x <s y && y <s 0 --> x <u y. 10920 // If we can prove the left part, the right part is also proven. 10921 return isImpliedCondOperands(CanonicalFoundPred, CanonicalLHS, 10922 CanonicalRHS, CanonicalFoundLHS, 10923 CanonicalFoundRHS); 10924 } 10925 10926 // Check if we can make progress by sharpening ranges. 10927 if (FoundPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && 10928 (isa<SCEVConstant>(FoundLHS) || isa<SCEVConstant>(FoundRHS))) { 10929 10930 const SCEVConstant *C = nullptr; 10931 const SCEV *V = nullptr; 10932 10933 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(FoundLHS)) { 10934 C = cast<SCEVConstant>(FoundLHS); 10935 V = FoundRHS; 10936 } else { 10937 C = cast<SCEVConstant>(FoundRHS); 10938 V = FoundLHS; 10939 } 10940 10941 // The guarding predicate tells us that C != V. If the known range 10942 // of V is [C, t), we can sharpen the range to [C + 1, t). The 10943 // range we consider has to correspond to same signedness as the 10944 // predicate we're interested in folding. 10945 10946 APInt Min = ICmpInst::isSigned(Pred) ? 10947 getSignedRangeMin(V) : getUnsignedRangeMin(V); 10948 10949 if (Min == C->getAPInt()) { 10950 // Given (V >= Min && V != Min) we conclude V >= (Min + 1). 10951 // This is true even if (Min + 1) wraps around -- in case of 10952 // wraparound, (Min + 1) < Min, so (V >= Min => V >= (Min + 1)). 10953 10954 APInt SharperMin = Min + 1; 10955 10956 switch (Pred) { 10957 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: 10958 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: 10959 // We know V `Pred` SharperMin. If this implies LHS `Pred` 10960 // RHS, we're done. 10961 if (isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, V, getConstant(SharperMin), 10962 CtxI)) 10963 return true; 10964 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 10965 10966 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: 10967 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: 10968 // We know from the range information that (V `Pred` Min || 10969 // V == Min). We know from the guarding condition that !(V 10970 // == Min). This gives us 10971 // 10972 // V `Pred` Min || V == Min && !(V == Min) 10973 // => V `Pred` Min 10974 // 10975 // If V `Pred` Min implies LHS `Pred` RHS, we're done. 10976 10977 if (isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, V, getConstant(Min), CtxI)) 10978 return true; 10979 break; 10980 10981 // `LHS < RHS` and `LHS <= RHS` are handled in the same way as `RHS > LHS` and `RHS >= LHS` respectively. 10982 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: 10983 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: 10984 if (isImpliedCondOperands(CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred), RHS, 10985 LHS, V, getConstant(SharperMin), CtxI)) 10986 return true; 10987 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 10988 10989 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: 10990 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: 10991 if (isImpliedCondOperands(CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred), RHS, 10992 LHS, V, getConstant(Min), CtxI)) 10993 return true; 10994 break; 10995 10996 default: 10997 // No change 10998 break; 10999 } 11000 } 11001 } 11002 11003 // Check whether the actual condition is beyond sufficient. 11004 if (FoundPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ) 11005 if (ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Pred)) 11006 if (isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS, CtxI)) 11007 return true; 11008 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) 11009 if (!ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(FoundPred)) 11010 if (isImpliedCondOperands(FoundPred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS, CtxI)) 11011 return true; 11012 11013 // Otherwise assume the worst. 11014 return false; 11015 } 11016 11017 bool ScalarEvolution::splitBinaryAdd(const SCEV *Expr, 11018 const SCEV *&L, const SCEV *&R, 11019 SCEV::NoWrapFlags &Flags) { 11020 const auto *AE = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Expr); 11021 if (!AE || AE->getNumOperands() != 2) 11022 return false; 11023 11024 L = AE->getOperand(0); 11025 R = AE->getOperand(1); 11026 Flags = AE->getNoWrapFlags(); 11027 return true; 11028 } 11029 11030 Optional<APInt> ScalarEvolution::computeConstantDifference(const SCEV *More, 11031 const SCEV *Less) { 11032 // We avoid subtracting expressions here because this function is usually 11033 // fairly deep in the call stack (i.e. is called many times). 11034 11035 // X - X = 0. 11036 if (More == Less) 11037 return APInt(getTypeSizeInBits(More->getType()), 0); 11038 11039 if (isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Less) && isa<SCEVAddRecExpr>(More)) { 11040 const auto *LAR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Less); 11041 const auto *MAR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(More); 11042 11043 if (LAR->getLoop() != MAR->getLoop()) 11044 return None; 11045 11046 // We look at affine expressions only; not for correctness but to keep 11047 // getStepRecurrence cheap. 11048 if (!LAR->isAffine() || !MAR->isAffine()) 11049 return None; 11050 11051 if (LAR->getStepRecurrence(*this) != MAR->getStepRecurrence(*this)) 11052 return None; 11053 11054 Less = LAR->getStart(); 11055 More = MAR->getStart(); 11056 11057 // fall through 11058 } 11059 11060 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(Less) && isa<SCEVConstant>(More)) { 11061 const auto &M = cast<SCEVConstant>(More)->getAPInt(); 11062 const auto &L = cast<SCEVConstant>(Less)->getAPInt(); 11063 return M - L; 11064 } 11065 11066 SCEV::NoWrapFlags Flags; 11067 const SCEV *LLess = nullptr, *RLess = nullptr; 11068 const SCEV *LMore = nullptr, *RMore = nullptr; 11069 const SCEVConstant *C1 = nullptr, *C2 = nullptr; 11070 // Compare (X + C1) vs X. 11071 if (splitBinaryAdd(Less, LLess, RLess, Flags)) 11072 if ((C1 = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LLess))) 11073 if (RLess == More) 11074 return -(C1->getAPInt()); 11075 11076 // Compare X vs (X + C2). 11077 if (splitBinaryAdd(More, LMore, RMore, Flags)) 11078 if ((C2 = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(LMore))) 11079 if (RMore == Less) 11080 return C2->getAPInt(); 11081 11082 // Compare (X + C1) vs (X + C2). 11083 if (C1 && C2 && RLess == RMore) 11084 return C2->getAPInt() - C1->getAPInt(); 11085 11086 return None; 11087 } 11088 11089 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondOperandsViaAddRecStart( 11090 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 11091 const SCEV *FoundLHS, const SCEV *FoundRHS, const Instruction *CtxI) { 11092 // Try to recognize the following pattern: 11093 // 11094 // FoundRHS = ... 11095 // ... 11096 // loop: 11097 // FoundLHS = {Start,+,W} 11098 // context_bb: // Basic block from the same loop 11099 // known(Pred, FoundLHS, FoundRHS) 11100 // 11101 // If some predicate is known in the context of a loop, it is also known on 11102 // each iteration of this loop, including the first iteration. Therefore, in 11103 // this case, `FoundLHS Pred FoundRHS` implies `Start Pred FoundRHS`. Try to 11104 // prove the original pred using this fact. 11105 if (!CtxI) 11106 return false; 11107 const BasicBlock *ContextBB = CtxI->getParent(); 11108 // Make sure AR varies in the context block. 11109 if (auto *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(FoundLHS)) { 11110 const Loop *L = AR->getLoop(); 11111 // Make sure that context belongs to the loop and executes on 1st iteration 11112 // (if it ever executes at all). 11113 if (!L->contains(ContextBB) || !DT.dominates(ContextBB, L->getLoopLatch())) 11114 return false; 11115 if (!isAvailableAtLoopEntry(FoundRHS, AR->getLoop())) 11116 return false; 11117 return isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, AR->getStart(), FoundRHS); 11118 } 11119 11120 if (auto *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(FoundRHS)) { 11121 const Loop *L = AR->getLoop(); 11122 // Make sure that context belongs to the loop and executes on 1st iteration 11123 // (if it ever executes at all). 11124 if (!L->contains(ContextBB) || !DT.dominates(ContextBB, L->getLoopLatch())) 11125 return false; 11126 if (!isAvailableAtLoopEntry(FoundLHS, AR->getLoop())) 11127 return false; 11128 return isImpliedCondOperands(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, AR->getStart()); 11129 } 11130 11131 return false; 11132 } 11133 11134 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondOperandsViaNoOverflow( 11135 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 11136 const SCEV *FoundLHS, const SCEV *FoundRHS) { 11137 if (Pred != CmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Pred != CmpInst::ICMP_ULT) 11138 return false; 11139 11140 const auto *AddRecLHS = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS); 11141 if (!AddRecLHS) 11142 return false; 11143 11144 const auto *AddRecFoundLHS = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(FoundLHS); 11145 if (!AddRecFoundLHS) 11146 return false; 11147 11148 // We'd like to let SCEV reason about control dependencies, so we constrain 11149 // both the inequalities to be about add recurrences on the same loop. This 11150 // way we can use isLoopEntryGuardedByCond later. 11151 11152 const Loop *L = AddRecFoundLHS->getLoop(); 11153 if (L != AddRecLHS->getLoop()) 11154 return false; 11155 11156 // FoundLHS u< FoundRHS u< -C => (FoundLHS + C) u< (FoundRHS + C) ... (1) 11157 // 11158 // FoundLHS s< FoundRHS s< INT_MIN - C => (FoundLHS + C) s< (FoundRHS + C) 11159 // ... (2) 11160 // 11161 // Informal proof for (2), assuming (1) [*]: 11162 // 11163 // We'll also assume (A s< B) <=> ((A + INT_MIN) u< (B + INT_MIN)) ... (3)[**] 11164 // 11165 // Then 11166 // 11167 // FoundLHS s< FoundRHS s< INT_MIN - C 11168 // <=> (FoundLHS + INT_MIN) u< (FoundRHS + INT_MIN) u< -C [ using (3) ] 11169 // <=> (FoundLHS + INT_MIN + C) u< (FoundRHS + INT_MIN + C) [ using (1) ] 11170 // <=> (FoundLHS + INT_MIN + C + INT_MIN) s< 11171 // (FoundRHS + INT_MIN + C + INT_MIN) [ using (3) ] 11172 // <=> FoundLHS + C s< FoundRHS + C 11173 // 11174 // [*]: (1) can be proved by ruling out overflow. 11175 // 11176 // [**]: This can be proved by analyzing all the four possibilities: 11177 // (A s< 0, B s< 0), (A s< 0, B s>= 0), (A s>= 0, B s< 0) and 11178 // (A s>= 0, B s>= 0). 11179 // 11180 // Note: 11181 // Despite (2), "FoundRHS s< INT_MIN - C" does not mean that "FoundRHS + C" 11182 // will not sign underflow. For instance, say FoundLHS = (i8 -128), FoundRHS 11183 // = (i8 -127) and C = (i8 -100). Then INT_MIN - C = (i8 -28), and FoundRHS 11184 // s< (INT_MIN - C). Lack of sign overflow / underflow in "FoundRHS + C" is 11185 // neither necessary nor sufficient to prove "(FoundLHS + C) s< (FoundRHS + 11186 // C)". 11187 11188 Optional<APInt> LDiff = computeConstantDifference(LHS, FoundLHS); 11189 Optional<APInt> RDiff = computeConstantDifference(RHS, FoundRHS); 11190 if (!LDiff || !RDiff || *LDiff != *RDiff) 11191 return false; 11192 11193 if (LDiff->isMinValue()) 11194 return true; 11195 11196 APInt FoundRHSLimit; 11197 11198 if (Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_ULT) { 11199 FoundRHSLimit = -(*RDiff); 11200 } else { 11201 assert(Pred == CmpInst::ICMP_SLT && "Checked above!"); 11202 FoundRHSLimit = APInt::getSignedMinValue(getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType())) - *RDiff; 11203 } 11204 11205 // Try to prove (1) or (2), as needed. 11206 return isAvailableAtLoopEntry(FoundRHS, L) && 11207 isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Pred, FoundRHS, 11208 getConstant(FoundRHSLimit)); 11209 } 11210 11211 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedViaMerge(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 11212 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 11213 const SCEV *FoundLHS, 11214 const SCEV *FoundRHS, unsigned Depth) { 11215 const PHINode *LPhi = nullptr, *RPhi = nullptr; 11216 11217 auto ClearOnExit = make_scope_exit([&]() { 11218 if (LPhi) { 11219 bool Erased = PendingMerges.erase(LPhi); 11220 assert(Erased && "Failed to erase LPhi!"); 11221 (void)Erased; 11222 } 11223 if (RPhi) { 11224 bool Erased = PendingMerges.erase(RPhi); 11225 assert(Erased && "Failed to erase RPhi!"); 11226 (void)Erased; 11227 } 11228 }); 11229 11230 // Find respective Phis and check that they are not being pending. 11231 if (const SCEVUnknown *LU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(LHS)) 11232 if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(LU->getValue())) { 11233 if (!PendingMerges.insert(Phi).second) 11234 return false; 11235 LPhi = Phi; 11236 } 11237 if (const SCEVUnknown *RU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(RHS)) 11238 if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(RU->getValue())) { 11239 // If we detect a loop of Phi nodes being processed by this method, for 11240 // example: 11241 // 11242 // %a = phi i32 [ %some1, %preheader ], [ %b, %latch ] 11243 // %b = phi i32 [ %some2, %preheader ], [ %a, %latch ] 11244 // 11245 // we don't want to deal with a case that complex, so return conservative 11246 // answer false. 11247 if (!PendingMerges.insert(Phi).second) 11248 return false; 11249 RPhi = Phi; 11250 } 11251 11252 // If none of LHS, RHS is a Phi, nothing to do here. 11253 if (!LPhi && !RPhi) 11254 return false; 11255 11256 // If there is a SCEVUnknown Phi we are interested in, make it left. 11257 if (!LPhi) { 11258 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 11259 std::swap(FoundLHS, FoundRHS); 11260 std::swap(LPhi, RPhi); 11261 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred); 11262 } 11263 11264 assert(LPhi && "LPhi should definitely be a SCEVUnknown Phi!"); 11265 const BasicBlock *LBB = LPhi->getParent(); 11266 const SCEVAddRecExpr *RAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(RHS); 11267 11268 auto ProvedEasily = [&](const SCEV *S1, const SCEV *S2) { 11269 return isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(Pred, S1, S2) || 11270 isImpliedCondOperandsViaRanges(Pred, S1, S2, FoundLHS, FoundRHS) || 11271 isImpliedViaOperations(Pred, S1, S2, FoundLHS, FoundRHS, Depth); 11272 }; 11273 11274 if (RPhi && RPhi->getParent() == LBB) { 11275 // Case one: RHS is also a SCEVUnknown Phi from the same basic block. 11276 // If we compare two Phis from the same block, and for each entry block 11277 // the predicate is true for incoming values from this block, then the 11278 // predicate is also true for the Phis. 11279 for (const BasicBlock *IncBB : predecessors(LBB)) { 11280 const SCEV *L = getSCEV(LPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(IncBB)); 11281 const SCEV *R = getSCEV(RPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(IncBB)); 11282 if (!ProvedEasily(L, R)) 11283 return false; 11284 } 11285 } else if (RAR && RAR->getLoop()->getHeader() == LBB) { 11286 // Case two: RHS is also a Phi from the same basic block, and it is an 11287 // AddRec. It means that there is a loop which has both AddRec and Unknown 11288 // PHIs, for it we can compare incoming values of AddRec from above the loop 11289 // and latch with their respective incoming values of LPhi. 11290 // TODO: Generalize to handle loops with many inputs in a header. 11291 if (LPhi->getNumIncomingValues() != 2) return false; 11292 11293 auto *RLoop = RAR->getLoop(); 11294 auto *Predecessor = RLoop->getLoopPredecessor(); 11295 assert(Predecessor && "Loop with AddRec with no predecessor?"); 11296 const SCEV *L1 = getSCEV(LPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(Predecessor)); 11297 if (!ProvedEasily(L1, RAR->getStart())) 11298 return false; 11299 auto *Latch = RLoop->getLoopLatch(); 11300 assert(Latch && "Loop with AddRec with no latch?"); 11301 const SCEV *L2 = getSCEV(LPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(Latch)); 11302 if (!ProvedEasily(L2, RAR->getPostIncExpr(*this))) 11303 return false; 11304 } else { 11305 // In all other cases go over inputs of LHS and compare each of them to RHS, 11306 // the predicate is true for (LHS, RHS) if it is true for all such pairs. 11307 // At this point RHS is either a non-Phi, or it is a Phi from some block 11308 // different from LBB. 11309 for (const BasicBlock *IncBB : predecessors(LBB)) { 11310 // Check that RHS is available in this block. 11311 if (!dominates(RHS, IncBB)) 11312 return false; 11313 const SCEV *L = getSCEV(LPhi->getIncomingValueForBlock(IncBB)); 11314 // Make sure L does not refer to a value from a potentially previous 11315 // iteration of a loop. 11316 if (!properlyDominates(L, IncBB)) 11317 return false; 11318 if (!ProvedEasily(L, RHS)) 11319 return false; 11320 } 11321 } 11322 return true; 11323 } 11324 11325 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondOperands(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 11326 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 11327 const SCEV *FoundLHS, 11328 const SCEV *FoundRHS, 11329 const Instruction *CtxI) { 11330 if (isImpliedCondOperandsViaRanges(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS)) 11331 return true; 11332 11333 if (isImpliedCondOperandsViaNoOverflow(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS)) 11334 return true; 11335 11336 if (isImpliedCondOperandsViaAddRecStart(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS, 11337 CtxI)) 11338 return true; 11339 11340 return isImpliedCondOperandsHelper(Pred, LHS, RHS, 11341 FoundLHS, FoundRHS); 11342 } 11343 11344 /// Is MaybeMinMaxExpr an (U|S)(Min|Max) of Candidate and some other values? 11345 template <typename MinMaxExprType> 11346 static bool IsMinMaxConsistingOf(const SCEV *MaybeMinMaxExpr, 11347 const SCEV *Candidate) { 11348 const MinMaxExprType *MinMaxExpr = dyn_cast<MinMaxExprType>(MaybeMinMaxExpr); 11349 if (!MinMaxExpr) 11350 return false; 11351 11352 return is_contained(MinMaxExpr->operands(), Candidate); 11353 } 11354 11355 static bool IsKnownPredicateViaAddRecStart(ScalarEvolution &SE, 11356 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 11357 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 11358 // If both sides are affine addrecs for the same loop, with equal 11359 // steps, and we know the recurrences don't wrap, then we only 11360 // need to check the predicate on the starting values. 11361 11362 if (!ICmpInst::isRelational(Pred)) 11363 return false; 11364 11365 const SCEVAddRecExpr *LAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS); 11366 if (!LAR) 11367 return false; 11368 const SCEVAddRecExpr *RAR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(RHS); 11369 if (!RAR) 11370 return false; 11371 if (LAR->getLoop() != RAR->getLoop()) 11372 return false; 11373 if (!LAR->isAffine() || !RAR->isAffine()) 11374 return false; 11375 11376 if (LAR->getStepRecurrence(SE) != RAR->getStepRecurrence(SE)) 11377 return false; 11378 11379 SCEV::NoWrapFlags NW = ICmpInst::isSigned(Pred) ? 11380 SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagNUW; 11381 if (!LAR->getNoWrapFlags(NW) || !RAR->getNoWrapFlags(NW)) 11382 return false; 11383 11384 return SE.isKnownPredicate(Pred, LAR->getStart(), RAR->getStart()); 11385 } 11386 11387 /// Is LHS `Pred` RHS true on the virtue of LHS or RHS being a Min or Max 11388 /// expression? 11389 static bool IsKnownPredicateViaMinOrMax(ScalarEvolution &SE, 11390 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 11391 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 11392 switch (Pred) { 11393 default: 11394 return false; 11395 11396 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: 11397 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 11398 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 11399 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: 11400 return 11401 // min(A, ...) <= A 11402 IsMinMaxConsistingOf<SCEVSMinExpr>(LHS, RHS) || 11403 // A <= max(A, ...) 11404 IsMinMaxConsistingOf<SCEVSMaxExpr>(RHS, LHS); 11405 11406 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: 11407 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 11408 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 11409 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: 11410 return 11411 // min(A, ...) <= A 11412 IsMinMaxConsistingOf<SCEVUMinExpr>(LHS, RHS) || 11413 // A <= max(A, ...) 11414 IsMinMaxConsistingOf<SCEVUMaxExpr>(RHS, LHS); 11415 } 11416 11417 llvm_unreachable("covered switch fell through?!"); 11418 } 11419 11420 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedViaOperations(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 11421 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 11422 const SCEV *FoundLHS, 11423 const SCEV *FoundRHS, 11424 unsigned Depth) { 11425 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) == 11426 getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType()) && 11427 "LHS and RHS have different sizes?"); 11428 assert(getTypeSizeInBits(FoundLHS->getType()) == 11429 getTypeSizeInBits(FoundRHS->getType()) && 11430 "FoundLHS and FoundRHS have different sizes?"); 11431 // We want to avoid hurting the compile time with analysis of too big trees. 11432 if (Depth > MaxSCEVOperationsImplicationDepth) 11433 return false; 11434 11435 // We only want to work with GT comparison so far. 11436 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) { 11437 Pred = CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred); 11438 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 11439 std::swap(FoundLHS, FoundRHS); 11440 } 11441 11442 // For unsigned, try to reduce it to corresponding signed comparison. 11443 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT) 11444 // We can replace unsigned predicate with its signed counterpart if all 11445 // involved values are non-negative. 11446 // TODO: We could have better support for unsigned. 11447 if (isKnownNonNegative(FoundLHS) && isKnownNonNegative(FoundRHS)) { 11448 // Knowing that both FoundLHS and FoundRHS are non-negative, and knowing 11449 // FoundLHS >u FoundRHS, we also know that FoundLHS >s FoundRHS. Let us 11450 // use this fact to prove that LHS and RHS are non-negative. 11451 const SCEV *MinusOne = getMinusOne(LHS->getType()); 11452 if (isImpliedCondOperands(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, MinusOne, FoundLHS, 11453 FoundRHS) && 11454 isImpliedCondOperands(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, RHS, MinusOne, FoundLHS, 11455 FoundRHS)) 11456 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; 11457 } 11458 11459 if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) 11460 return false; 11461 11462 auto GetOpFromSExt = [&](const SCEV *S) { 11463 if (auto *Ext = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(S)) 11464 return Ext->getOperand(); 11465 // TODO: If S is a SCEVConstant then you can cheaply "strip" the sext off 11466 // the constant in some cases. 11467 return S; 11468 }; 11469 11470 // Acquire values from extensions. 11471 auto *OrigLHS = LHS; 11472 auto *OrigFoundLHS = FoundLHS; 11473 LHS = GetOpFromSExt(LHS); 11474 FoundLHS = GetOpFromSExt(FoundLHS); 11475 11476 // Is the SGT predicate can be proved trivially or using the found context. 11477 auto IsSGTViaContext = [&](const SCEV *S1, const SCEV *S2) { 11478 return isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, S1, S2) || 11479 isImpliedViaOperations(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, S1, S2, OrigFoundLHS, 11480 FoundRHS, Depth + 1); 11481 }; 11482 11483 if (auto *LHSAddExpr = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(LHS)) { 11484 // We want to avoid creation of any new non-constant SCEV. Since we are 11485 // going to compare the operands to RHS, we should be certain that we don't 11486 // need any size extensions for this. So let's decline all cases when the 11487 // sizes of types of LHS and RHS do not match. 11488 // TODO: Maybe try to get RHS from sext to catch more cases? 11489 if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) != getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType())) 11490 return false; 11491 11492 // Should not overflow. 11493 if (!LHSAddExpr->hasNoSignedWrap()) 11494 return false; 11495 11496 auto *LL = LHSAddExpr->getOperand(0); 11497 auto *LR = LHSAddExpr->getOperand(1); 11498 auto *MinusOne = getMinusOne(RHS->getType()); 11499 11500 // Checks that S1 >= 0 && S2 > RHS, trivially or using the found context. 11501 auto IsSumGreaterThanRHS = [&](const SCEV *S1, const SCEV *S2) { 11502 return IsSGTViaContext(S1, MinusOne) && IsSGTViaContext(S2, RHS); 11503 }; 11504 // Try to prove the following rule: 11505 // (LHS = LL + LR) && (LL >= 0) && (LR > RHS) => (LHS > RHS). 11506 // (LHS = LL + LR) && (LR >= 0) && (LL > RHS) => (LHS > RHS). 11507 if (IsSumGreaterThanRHS(LL, LR) || IsSumGreaterThanRHS(LR, LL)) 11508 return true; 11509 } else if (auto *LHSUnknownExpr = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(LHS)) { 11510 Value *LL, *LR; 11511 // FIXME: Once we have SDiv implemented, we can get rid of this matching. 11512 11513 using namespace llvm::PatternMatch; 11514 11515 if (match(LHSUnknownExpr->getValue(), m_SDiv(m_Value(LL), m_Value(LR)))) { 11516 // Rules for division. 11517 // We are going to perform some comparisons with Denominator and its 11518 // derivative expressions. In general case, creating a SCEV for it may 11519 // lead to a complex analysis of the entire graph, and in particular it 11520 // can request trip count recalculation for the same loop. This would 11521 // cache as SCEVCouldNotCompute to avoid the infinite recursion. To avoid 11522 // this, we only want to create SCEVs that are constants in this section. 11523 // So we bail if Denominator is not a constant. 11524 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(LR)) 11525 return false; 11526 11527 auto *Denominator = cast<SCEVConstant>(getSCEV(LR)); 11528 11529 // We want to make sure that LHS = FoundLHS / Denominator. If it is so, 11530 // then a SCEV for the numerator already exists and matches with FoundLHS. 11531 auto *Numerator = getExistingSCEV(LL); 11532 if (!Numerator || Numerator->getType() != FoundLHS->getType()) 11533 return false; 11534 11535 // Make sure that the numerator matches with FoundLHS and the denominator 11536 // is positive. 11537 if (!HasSameValue(Numerator, FoundLHS) || !isKnownPositive(Denominator)) 11538 return false; 11539 11540 auto *DTy = Denominator->getType(); 11541 auto *FRHSTy = FoundRHS->getType(); 11542 if (DTy->isPointerTy() != FRHSTy->isPointerTy()) 11543 // One of types is a pointer and another one is not. We cannot extend 11544 // them properly to a wider type, so let us just reject this case. 11545 // TODO: Usage of getEffectiveSCEVType for DTy, FRHSTy etc should help 11546 // to avoid this check. 11547 return false; 11548 11549 // Given that: 11550 // FoundLHS > FoundRHS, LHS = FoundLHS / Denominator, Denominator > 0. 11551 auto *WTy = getWiderType(DTy, FRHSTy); 11552 auto *DenominatorExt = getNoopOrSignExtend(Denominator, WTy); 11553 auto *FoundRHSExt = getNoopOrSignExtend(FoundRHS, WTy); 11554 11555 // Try to prove the following rule: 11556 // (FoundRHS > Denominator - 2) && (RHS <= 0) => (LHS > RHS). 11557 // For example, given that FoundLHS > 2. It means that FoundLHS is at 11558 // least 3. If we divide it by Denominator < 4, we will have at least 1. 11559 auto *DenomMinusTwo = getMinusSCEV(DenominatorExt, getConstant(WTy, 2)); 11560 if (isKnownNonPositive(RHS) && 11561 IsSGTViaContext(FoundRHSExt, DenomMinusTwo)) 11562 return true; 11563 11564 // Try to prove the following rule: 11565 // (FoundRHS > -1 - Denominator) && (RHS < 0) => (LHS > RHS). 11566 // For example, given that FoundLHS > -3. Then FoundLHS is at least -2. 11567 // If we divide it by Denominator > 2, then: 11568 // 1. If FoundLHS is negative, then the result is 0. 11569 // 2. If FoundLHS is non-negative, then the result is non-negative. 11570 // Anyways, the result is non-negative. 11571 auto *MinusOne = getMinusOne(WTy); 11572 auto *NegDenomMinusOne = getMinusSCEV(MinusOne, DenominatorExt); 11573 if (isKnownNegative(RHS) && 11574 IsSGTViaContext(FoundRHSExt, NegDenomMinusOne)) 11575 return true; 11576 } 11577 } 11578 11579 // If our expression contained SCEVUnknown Phis, and we split it down and now 11580 // need to prove something for them, try to prove the predicate for every 11581 // possible incoming values of those Phis. 11582 if (isImpliedViaMerge(Pred, OrigLHS, RHS, OrigFoundLHS, FoundRHS, Depth + 1)) 11583 return true; 11584 11585 return false; 11586 } 11587 11588 static bool isKnownPredicateExtendIdiom(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 11589 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 11590 // zext x u<= sext x, sext x s<= zext x 11591 switch (Pred) { 11592 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: 11593 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 11594 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 11595 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { 11596 // If operand >=s 0 then ZExt == SExt. If operand <s 0 then SExt <s ZExt. 11597 const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(LHS); 11598 const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(RHS); 11599 if (SExt && ZExt && SExt->getOperand() == ZExt->getOperand()) 11600 return true; 11601 break; 11602 } 11603 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: 11604 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 11605 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 11606 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { 11607 // If operand >=s 0 then ZExt == SExt. If operand <s 0 then ZExt <u SExt. 11608 const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(LHS); 11609 const SCEVSignExtendExpr *SExt = dyn_cast<SCEVSignExtendExpr>(RHS); 11610 if (SExt && ZExt && SExt->getOperand() == ZExt->getOperand()) 11611 return true; 11612 break; 11613 } 11614 default: 11615 break; 11616 }; 11617 return false; 11618 } 11619 11620 bool 11621 ScalarEvolution::isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 11622 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) { 11623 return isKnownPredicateExtendIdiom(Pred, LHS, RHS) || 11624 isKnownPredicateViaConstantRanges(Pred, LHS, RHS) || 11625 IsKnownPredicateViaMinOrMax(*this, Pred, LHS, RHS) || 11626 IsKnownPredicateViaAddRecStart(*this, Pred, LHS, RHS) || 11627 isKnownPredicateViaNoOverflow(Pred, LHS, RHS); 11628 } 11629 11630 bool 11631 ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondOperandsHelper(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 11632 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 11633 const SCEV *FoundLHS, 11634 const SCEV *FoundRHS) { 11635 switch (Pred) { 11636 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected ICmpInst::Predicate value!"); 11637 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: 11638 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: 11639 if (HasSameValue(LHS, FoundLHS) && HasSameValue(RHS, FoundRHS)) 11640 return true; 11641 break; 11642 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: 11643 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: 11644 if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, FoundLHS) && 11645 isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, RHS, FoundRHS)) 11646 return true; 11647 break; 11648 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: 11649 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: 11650 if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, FoundLHS) && 11651 isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, RHS, FoundRHS)) 11652 return true; 11653 break; 11654 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: 11655 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: 11656 if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, FoundLHS) && 11657 isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, RHS, FoundRHS)) 11658 return true; 11659 break; 11660 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: 11661 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: 11662 if (isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, FoundLHS) && 11663 isKnownViaNonRecursiveReasoning(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, RHS, FoundRHS)) 11664 return true; 11665 break; 11666 } 11667 11668 // Maybe it can be proved via operations? 11669 if (isImpliedViaOperations(Pred, LHS, RHS, FoundLHS, FoundRHS)) 11670 return true; 11671 11672 return false; 11673 } 11674 11675 bool ScalarEvolution::isImpliedCondOperandsViaRanges(ICmpInst::Predicate Pred, 11676 const SCEV *LHS, 11677 const SCEV *RHS, 11678 const SCEV *FoundLHS, 11679 const SCEV *FoundRHS) { 11680 if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(RHS) || !isa<SCEVConstant>(FoundRHS)) 11681 // The restriction on `FoundRHS` be lifted easily -- it exists only to 11682 // reduce the compile time impact of this optimization. 11683 return false; 11684 11685 Optional<APInt> Addend = computeConstantDifference(LHS, FoundLHS); 11686 if (!Addend) 11687 return false; 11688 11689 const APInt &ConstFoundRHS = cast<SCEVConstant>(FoundRHS)->getAPInt(); 11690 11691 // `FoundLHSRange` is the range we know `FoundLHS` to be in by virtue of the 11692 // antecedent "`FoundLHS` `Pred` `FoundRHS`". 11693 ConstantRange FoundLHSRange = 11694 ConstantRange::makeExactICmpRegion(Pred, ConstFoundRHS); 11695 11696 // Since `LHS` is `FoundLHS` + `Addend`, we can compute a range for `LHS`: 11697 ConstantRange LHSRange = FoundLHSRange.add(ConstantRange(*Addend)); 11698 11699 // We can also compute the range of values for `LHS` that satisfy the 11700 // consequent, "`LHS` `Pred` `RHS`": 11701 const APInt &ConstRHS = cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)->getAPInt(); 11702 // The antecedent implies the consequent if every value of `LHS` that 11703 // satisfies the antecedent also satisfies the consequent. 11704 return LHSRange.icmp(Pred, ConstRHS); 11705 } 11706 11707 bool ScalarEvolution::canIVOverflowOnLT(const SCEV *RHS, const SCEV *Stride, 11708 bool IsSigned) { 11709 assert(isKnownPositive(Stride) && "Positive stride expected!"); 11710 11711 unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType()); 11712 const SCEV *One = getOne(Stride->getType()); 11713 11714 if (IsSigned) { 11715 APInt MaxRHS = getSignedRangeMax(RHS); 11716 APInt MaxValue = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth); 11717 APInt MaxStrideMinusOne = getSignedRangeMax(getMinusSCEV(Stride, One)); 11718 11719 // SMaxRHS + SMaxStrideMinusOne > SMaxValue => overflow! 11720 return (std::move(MaxValue) - MaxStrideMinusOne).slt(MaxRHS); 11721 } 11722 11723 APInt MaxRHS = getUnsignedRangeMax(RHS); 11724 APInt MaxValue = APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth); 11725 APInt MaxStrideMinusOne = getUnsignedRangeMax(getMinusSCEV(Stride, One)); 11726 11727 // UMaxRHS + UMaxStrideMinusOne > UMaxValue => overflow! 11728 return (std::move(MaxValue) - MaxStrideMinusOne).ult(MaxRHS); 11729 } 11730 11731 bool ScalarEvolution::canIVOverflowOnGT(const SCEV *RHS, const SCEV *Stride, 11732 bool IsSigned) { 11733 11734 unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType()); 11735 const SCEV *One = getOne(Stride->getType()); 11736 11737 if (IsSigned) { 11738 APInt MinRHS = getSignedRangeMin(RHS); 11739 APInt MinValue = APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth); 11740 APInt MaxStrideMinusOne = getSignedRangeMax(getMinusSCEV(Stride, One)); 11741 11742 // SMinRHS - SMaxStrideMinusOne < SMinValue => overflow! 11743 return (std::move(MinValue) + MaxStrideMinusOne).sgt(MinRHS); 11744 } 11745 11746 APInt MinRHS = getUnsignedRangeMin(RHS); 11747 APInt MinValue = APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth); 11748 APInt MaxStrideMinusOne = getUnsignedRangeMax(getMinusSCEV(Stride, One)); 11749 11750 // UMinRHS - UMaxStrideMinusOne < UMinValue => overflow! 11751 return (std::move(MinValue) + MaxStrideMinusOne).ugt(MinRHS); 11752 } 11753 11754 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getUDivCeilSCEV(const SCEV *N, const SCEV *D) { 11755 // umin(N, 1) + floor((N - umin(N, 1)) / D) 11756 // This is equivalent to "1 + floor((N - 1) / D)" for N != 0. The umin 11757 // expression fixes the case of N=0. 11758 const SCEV *MinNOne = getUMinExpr(N, getOne(N->getType())); 11759 const SCEV *NMinusOne = getMinusSCEV(N, MinNOne); 11760 return getAddExpr(MinNOne, getUDivExpr(NMinusOne, D)); 11761 } 11762 11763 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::computeMaxBECountForLT(const SCEV *Start, 11764 const SCEV *Stride, 11765 const SCEV *End, 11766 unsigned BitWidth, 11767 bool IsSigned) { 11768 // The logic in this function assumes we can represent a positive stride. 11769 // If we can't, the backedge-taken count must be zero. 11770 if (IsSigned && BitWidth == 1) 11771 return getZero(Stride->getType()); 11772 11773 // This code has only been closely audited for negative strides in the 11774 // unsigned comparison case, it may be correct for signed comparison, but 11775 // that needs to be established. 11776 assert((!IsSigned || !isKnownNonPositive(Stride)) && 11777 "Stride is expected strictly positive for signed case!"); 11778 11779 // Calculate the maximum backedge count based on the range of values 11780 // permitted by Start, End, and Stride. 11781 APInt MinStart = 11782 IsSigned ? getSignedRangeMin(Start) : getUnsignedRangeMin(Start); 11783 11784 APInt MinStride = 11785 IsSigned ? getSignedRangeMin(Stride) : getUnsignedRangeMin(Stride); 11786 11787 // We assume either the stride is positive, or the backedge-taken count 11788 // is zero. So force StrideForMaxBECount to be at least one. 11789 APInt One(BitWidth, 1); 11790 APInt StrideForMaxBECount = IsSigned ? APIntOps::smax(One, MinStride) 11791 : APIntOps::umax(One, MinStride); 11792 11793 APInt MaxValue = IsSigned ? APInt::getSignedMaxValue(BitWidth) 11794 : APInt::getMaxValue(BitWidth); 11795 APInt Limit = MaxValue - (StrideForMaxBECount - 1); 11796 11797 // Although End can be a MAX expression we estimate MaxEnd considering only 11798 // the case End = RHS of the loop termination condition. This is safe because 11799 // in the other case (End - Start) is zero, leading to a zero maximum backedge 11800 // taken count. 11801 APInt MaxEnd = IsSigned ? APIntOps::smin(getSignedRangeMax(End), Limit) 11802 : APIntOps::umin(getUnsignedRangeMax(End), Limit); 11803 11804 // MaxBECount = ceil((max(MaxEnd, MinStart) - MinStart) / Stride) 11805 MaxEnd = IsSigned ? APIntOps::smax(MaxEnd, MinStart) 11806 : APIntOps::umax(MaxEnd, MinStart); 11807 11808 return getUDivCeilSCEV(getConstant(MaxEnd - MinStart) /* Delta */, 11809 getConstant(StrideForMaxBECount) /* Step */); 11810 } 11811 11812 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit 11813 ScalarEvolution::howManyLessThans(const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 11814 const Loop *L, bool IsSigned, 11815 bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) { 11816 SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> Predicates; 11817 11818 const SCEVAddRecExpr *IV = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS); 11819 bool PredicatedIV = false; 11820 11821 auto canAssumeNoSelfWrap = [&](const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR) { 11822 // Can we prove this loop *must* be UB if overflow of IV occurs? 11823 // Reasoning goes as follows: 11824 // * Suppose the IV did self wrap. 11825 // * If Stride evenly divides the iteration space, then once wrap 11826 // occurs, the loop must revisit the same values. 11827 // * We know that RHS is invariant, and that none of those values 11828 // caused this exit to be taken previously. Thus, this exit is 11829 // dynamically dead. 11830 // * If this is the sole exit, then a dead exit implies the loop 11831 // must be infinite if there are no abnormal exits. 11832 // * If the loop were infinite, then it must either not be mustprogress 11833 // or have side effects. Otherwise, it must be UB. 11834 // * It can't (by assumption), be UB so we have contradicted our 11835 // premise and can conclude the IV did not in fact self-wrap. 11836 if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) 11837 return false; 11838 11839 auto *StrideC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this)); 11840 if (!StrideC || !StrideC->getAPInt().isPowerOf2()) 11841 return false; 11842 11843 if (!ControlsExit || !loopHasNoAbnormalExits(L)) 11844 return false; 11845 11846 return loopIsFiniteByAssumption(L); 11847 }; 11848 11849 if (!IV) { 11850 if (auto *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(LHS)) { 11851 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(ZExt->getOperand()); 11852 if (AR && AR->getLoop() == L && AR->isAffine()) { 11853 auto canProveNUW = [&]() { 11854 if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) 11855 return false; 11856 11857 if (!isKnownNonZero(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this))) 11858 // We need the sequence defined by AR to strictly increase in the 11859 // unsigned integer domain for the logic below to hold. 11860 return false; 11861 11862 const unsigned InnerBitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(AR->getType()); 11863 const unsigned OuterBitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(RHS->getType()); 11864 // If RHS <=u Limit, then there must exist a value V in the sequence 11865 // defined by AR (e.g. {Start,+,Step}) such that V >u RHS, and 11866 // V <=u UINT_MAX. Thus, we must exit the loop before unsigned 11867 // overflow occurs. This limit also implies that a signed comparison 11868 // (in the wide bitwidth) is equivalent to an unsigned comparison as 11869 // the high bits on both sides must be zero. 11870 APInt StrideMax = getUnsignedRangeMax(AR->getStepRecurrence(*this)); 11871 APInt Limit = APInt::getMaxValue(InnerBitWidth) - (StrideMax - 1); 11872 Limit = Limit.zext(OuterBitWidth); 11873 return getUnsignedRangeMax(applyLoopGuards(RHS, L)).ule(Limit); 11874 }; 11875 auto Flags = AR->getNoWrapFlags(); 11876 if (!hasFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW) && canProveNUW()) 11877 Flags = setFlags(Flags, SCEV::FlagNUW); 11878 11879 setNoWrapFlags(const_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr *>(AR), Flags); 11880 if (AR->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) { 11881 // Emulate what getZeroExtendExpr would have done during construction 11882 // if we'd been able to infer the fact just above at that time. 11883 const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(*this); 11884 Type *Ty = ZExt->getType(); 11885 auto *S = getAddRecExpr( 11886 getExtendAddRecStart<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(AR, Ty, this, 0), 11887 getZeroExtendExpr(Step, Ty, 0), L, AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 11888 IV = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S); 11889 } 11890 } 11891 } 11892 } 11893 11894 11895 if (!IV && AllowPredicates) { 11896 // Try to make this an AddRec using runtime tests, in the first X 11897 // iterations of this loop, where X is the SCEV expression found by the 11898 // algorithm below. 11899 IV = convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates(LHS, L, Predicates); 11900 PredicatedIV = true; 11901 } 11902 11903 // Avoid weird loops 11904 if (!IV || IV->getLoop() != L || !IV->isAffine()) 11905 return getCouldNotCompute(); 11906 11907 // A precondition of this method is that the condition being analyzed 11908 // reaches an exiting branch which dominates the latch. Given that, we can 11909 // assume that an increment which violates the nowrap specification and 11910 // produces poison must cause undefined behavior when the resulting poison 11911 // value is branched upon and thus we can conclude that the backedge is 11912 // taken no more often than would be required to produce that poison value. 11913 // Note that a well defined loop can exit on the iteration which violates 11914 // the nowrap specification if there is another exit (either explicit or 11915 // implicit/exceptional) which causes the loop to execute before the 11916 // exiting instruction we're analyzing would trigger UB. 11917 auto WrapType = IsSigned ? SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagNUW; 11918 bool NoWrap = ControlsExit && IV->getNoWrapFlags(WrapType); 11919 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond = IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT; 11920 11921 const SCEV *Stride = IV->getStepRecurrence(*this); 11922 11923 bool PositiveStride = isKnownPositive(Stride); 11924 11925 // Avoid negative or zero stride values. 11926 if (!PositiveStride) { 11927 // We can compute the correct backedge taken count for loops with unknown 11928 // strides if we can prove that the loop is not an infinite loop with side 11929 // effects. Here's the loop structure we are trying to handle - 11930 // 11931 // i = start 11932 // do { 11933 // A[i] = i; 11934 // i += s; 11935 // } while (i < end); 11936 // 11937 // The backedge taken count for such loops is evaluated as - 11938 // (max(end, start + stride) - start - 1) /u stride 11939 // 11940 // The additional preconditions that we need to check to prove correctness 11941 // of the above formula is as follows - 11942 // 11943 // a) IV is either nuw or nsw depending upon signedness (indicated by the 11944 // NoWrap flag). 11945 // b) the loop is guaranteed to be finite (e.g. is mustprogress and has 11946 // no side effects within the loop) 11947 // c) loop has a single static exit (with no abnormal exits) 11948 // 11949 // Precondition a) implies that if the stride is negative, this is a single 11950 // trip loop. The backedge taken count formula reduces to zero in this case. 11951 // 11952 // Precondition b) and c) combine to imply that if rhs is invariant in L, 11953 // then a zero stride means the backedge can't be taken without executing 11954 // undefined behavior. 11955 // 11956 // The positive stride case is the same as isKnownPositive(Stride) returning 11957 // true (original behavior of the function). 11958 // 11959 if (PredicatedIV || !NoWrap || !loopIsFiniteByAssumption(L) || 11960 !loopHasNoAbnormalExits(L)) 11961 return getCouldNotCompute(); 11962 11963 // This bailout is protecting the logic in computeMaxBECountForLT which 11964 // has not yet been sufficiently auditted or tested with negative strides. 11965 // We used to filter out all known-non-positive cases here, we're in the 11966 // process of being less restrictive bit by bit. 11967 if (IsSigned && isKnownNonPositive(Stride)) 11968 return getCouldNotCompute(); 11969 11970 if (!isKnownNonZero(Stride)) { 11971 // If we have a step of zero, and RHS isn't invariant in L, we don't know 11972 // if it might eventually be greater than start and if so, on which 11973 // iteration. We can't even produce a useful upper bound. 11974 if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) 11975 return getCouldNotCompute(); 11976 11977 // We allow a potentially zero stride, but we need to divide by stride 11978 // below. Since the loop can't be infinite and this check must control 11979 // the sole exit, we can infer the exit must be taken on the first 11980 // iteration (e.g. backedge count = 0) if the stride is zero. Given that, 11981 // we know the numerator in the divides below must be zero, so we can 11982 // pick an arbitrary non-zero value for the denominator (e.g. stride) 11983 // and produce the right result. 11984 // FIXME: Handle the case where Stride is poison? 11985 auto wouldZeroStrideBeUB = [&]() { 11986 // Proof by contradiction. Suppose the stride were zero. If we can 11987 // prove that the backedge *is* taken on the first iteration, then since 11988 // we know this condition controls the sole exit, we must have an 11989 // infinite loop. We can't have a (well defined) infinite loop per 11990 // check just above. 11991 // Note: The (Start - Stride) term is used to get the start' term from 11992 // (start' + stride,+,stride). Remember that we only care about the 11993 // result of this expression when stride == 0 at runtime. 11994 auto *StartIfZero = getMinusSCEV(IV->getStart(), Stride); 11995 return isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Cond, StartIfZero, RHS); 11996 }; 11997 if (!wouldZeroStrideBeUB()) { 11998 Stride = getUMaxExpr(Stride, getOne(Stride->getType())); 11999 } 12000 } 12001 } else if (!Stride->isOne() && !NoWrap) { 12002 auto isUBOnWrap = [&]() { 12003 // From no-self-wrap, we need to then prove no-(un)signed-wrap. This 12004 // follows trivially from the fact that every (un)signed-wrapped, but 12005 // not self-wrapped value must be LT than the last value before 12006 // (un)signed wrap. Since we know that last value didn't exit, nor 12007 // will any smaller one. 12008 return canAssumeNoSelfWrap(IV); 12009 }; 12010 12011 // Avoid proven overflow cases: this will ensure that the backedge taken 12012 // count will not generate any unsigned overflow. Relaxed no-overflow 12013 // conditions exploit NoWrapFlags, allowing to optimize in presence of 12014 // undefined behaviors like the case of C language. 12015 if (canIVOverflowOnLT(RHS, Stride, IsSigned) && !isUBOnWrap()) 12016 return getCouldNotCompute(); 12017 } 12018 12019 // On all paths just preceeding, we established the following invariant: 12020 // IV can be assumed not to overflow up to and including the exiting 12021 // iteration. We proved this in one of two ways: 12022 // 1) We can show overflow doesn't occur before the exiting iteration 12023 // 1a) canIVOverflowOnLT, and b) step of one 12024 // 2) We can show that if overflow occurs, the loop must execute UB 12025 // before any possible exit. 12026 // Note that we have not yet proved RHS invariant (in general). 12027 12028 const SCEV *Start = IV->getStart(); 12029 12030 // Preserve pointer-typed Start/RHS to pass to isLoopEntryGuardedByCond. 12031 // If we convert to integers, isLoopEntryGuardedByCond will miss some cases. 12032 // Use integer-typed versions for actual computation; we can't subtract 12033 // pointers in general. 12034 const SCEV *OrigStart = Start; 12035 const SCEV *OrigRHS = RHS; 12036 if (Start->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 12037 Start = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(Start); 12038 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(Start)) 12039 return Start; 12040 } 12041 if (RHS->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 12042 RHS = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(RHS); 12043 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(RHS)) 12044 return RHS; 12045 } 12046 12047 // When the RHS is not invariant, we do not know the end bound of the loop and 12048 // cannot calculate the ExactBECount needed by ExitLimit. However, we can 12049 // calculate the MaxBECount, given the start, stride and max value for the end 12050 // bound of the loop (RHS), and the fact that IV does not overflow (which is 12051 // checked above). 12052 if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) { 12053 const SCEV *MaxBECount = computeMaxBECountForLT( 12054 Start, Stride, RHS, getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()), IsSigned); 12055 return ExitLimit(getCouldNotCompute() /* ExactNotTaken */, MaxBECount, 12056 false /*MaxOrZero*/, Predicates); 12057 } 12058 12059 // We use the expression (max(End,Start)-Start)/Stride to describe the 12060 // backedge count, as if the backedge is taken at least once max(End,Start) 12061 // is End and so the result is as above, and if not max(End,Start) is Start 12062 // so we get a backedge count of zero. 12063 const SCEV *BECount = nullptr; 12064 auto *OrigStartMinusStride = getMinusSCEV(OrigStart, Stride); 12065 assert(isAvailableAtLoopEntry(OrigStartMinusStride, L) && "Must be!"); 12066 assert(isAvailableAtLoopEntry(OrigStart, L) && "Must be!"); 12067 assert(isAvailableAtLoopEntry(OrigRHS, L) && "Must be!"); 12068 // Can we prove (max(RHS,Start) > Start - Stride? 12069 if (isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Cond, OrigStartMinusStride, OrigStart) && 12070 isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Cond, OrigStartMinusStride, OrigRHS)) { 12071 // In this case, we can use a refined formula for computing backedge taken 12072 // count. The general formula remains: 12073 // "End-Start /uceiling Stride" where "End = max(RHS,Start)" 12074 // We want to use the alternate formula: 12075 // "((End - 1) - (Start - Stride)) /u Stride" 12076 // Let's do a quick case analysis to show these are equivalent under 12077 // our precondition that max(RHS,Start) > Start - Stride. 12078 // * For RHS <= Start, the backedge-taken count must be zero. 12079 // "((End - 1) - (Start - Stride)) /u Stride" reduces to 12080 // "((Start - 1) - (Start - Stride)) /u Stride" which simplies to 12081 // "Stride - 1 /u Stride" which is indeed zero for all non-zero values 12082 // of Stride. For 0 stride, we've use umin(1,Stride) above, reducing 12083 // this to the stride of 1 case. 12084 // * For RHS >= Start, the backedge count must be "RHS-Start /uceil Stride". 12085 // "((End - 1) - (Start - Stride)) /u Stride" reduces to 12086 // "((RHS - 1) - (Start - Stride)) /u Stride" reassociates to 12087 // "((RHS - (Start - Stride) - 1) /u Stride". 12088 // Our preconditions trivially imply no overflow in that form. 12089 const SCEV *MinusOne = getMinusOne(Stride->getType()); 12090 const SCEV *Numerator = 12091 getMinusSCEV(getAddExpr(RHS, MinusOne), getMinusSCEV(Start, Stride)); 12092 BECount = getUDivExpr(Numerator, Stride); 12093 } 12094 12095 const SCEV *BECountIfBackedgeTaken = nullptr; 12096 if (!BECount) { 12097 auto canProveRHSGreaterThanEqualStart = [&]() { 12098 auto CondGE = IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE; 12099 if (isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, CondGE, OrigRHS, OrigStart)) 12100 return true; 12101 12102 // (RHS > Start - 1) implies RHS >= Start. 12103 // * "RHS >= Start" is trivially equivalent to "RHS > Start - 1" if 12104 // "Start - 1" doesn't overflow. 12105 // * For signed comparison, if Start - 1 does overflow, it's equal 12106 // to INT_MAX, and "RHS >s INT_MAX" is trivially false. 12107 // * For unsigned comparison, if Start - 1 does overflow, it's equal 12108 // to UINT_MAX, and "RHS >u UINT_MAX" is trivially false. 12109 // 12110 // FIXME: Should isLoopEntryGuardedByCond do this for us? 12111 auto CondGT = IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT; 12112 auto *StartMinusOne = getAddExpr(OrigStart, 12113 getMinusOne(OrigStart->getType())); 12114 return isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, CondGT, OrigRHS, StartMinusOne); 12115 }; 12116 12117 // If we know that RHS >= Start in the context of loop, then we know that 12118 // max(RHS, Start) = RHS at this point. 12119 const SCEV *End; 12120 if (canProveRHSGreaterThanEqualStart()) { 12121 End = RHS; 12122 } else { 12123 // If RHS < Start, the backedge will be taken zero times. So in 12124 // general, we can write the backedge-taken count as: 12125 // 12126 // RHS >= Start ? ceil(RHS - Start) / Stride : 0 12127 // 12128 // We convert it to the following to make it more convenient for SCEV: 12129 // 12130 // ceil(max(RHS, Start) - Start) / Stride 12131 End = IsSigned ? getSMaxExpr(RHS, Start) : getUMaxExpr(RHS, Start); 12132 12133 // See what would happen if we assume the backedge is taken. This is 12134 // used to compute MaxBECount. 12135 BECountIfBackedgeTaken = getUDivCeilSCEV(getMinusSCEV(RHS, Start), Stride); 12136 } 12137 12138 // At this point, we know: 12139 // 12140 // 1. If IsSigned, Start <=s End; otherwise, Start <=u End 12141 // 2. The index variable doesn't overflow. 12142 // 12143 // Therefore, we know N exists such that 12144 // (Start + Stride * N) >= End, and computing "(Start + Stride * N)" 12145 // doesn't overflow. 12146 // 12147 // Using this information, try to prove whether the addition in 12148 // "(Start - End) + (Stride - 1)" has unsigned overflow. 12149 const SCEV *One = getOne(Stride->getType()); 12150 bool MayAddOverflow = [&] { 12151 if (auto *StrideC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(Stride)) { 12152 if (StrideC->getAPInt().isPowerOf2()) { 12153 // Suppose Stride is a power of two, and Start/End are unsigned 12154 // integers. Let UMAX be the largest representable unsigned 12155 // integer. 12156 // 12157 // By the preconditions of this function, we know 12158 // "(Start + Stride * N) >= End", and this doesn't overflow. 12159 // As a formula: 12160 // 12161 // End <= (Start + Stride * N) <= UMAX 12162 // 12163 // Subtracting Start from all the terms: 12164 // 12165 // End - Start <= Stride * N <= UMAX - Start 12166 // 12167 // Since Start is unsigned, UMAX - Start <= UMAX. Therefore: 12168 // 12169 // End - Start <= Stride * N <= UMAX 12170 // 12171 // Stride * N is a multiple of Stride. Therefore, 12172 // 12173 // End - Start <= Stride * N <= UMAX - (UMAX mod Stride) 12174 // 12175 // Since Stride is a power of two, UMAX + 1 is divisible by Stride. 12176 // Therefore, UMAX mod Stride == Stride - 1. So we can write: 12177 // 12178 // End - Start <= Stride * N <= UMAX - Stride - 1 12179 // 12180 // Dropping the middle term: 12181 // 12182 // End - Start <= UMAX - Stride - 1 12183 // 12184 // Adding Stride - 1 to both sides: 12185 // 12186 // (End - Start) + (Stride - 1) <= UMAX 12187 // 12188 // In other words, the addition doesn't have unsigned overflow. 12189 // 12190 // A similar proof works if we treat Start/End as signed values. 12191 // Just rewrite steps before "End - Start <= Stride * N <= UMAX" to 12192 // use signed max instead of unsigned max. Note that we're trying 12193 // to prove a lack of unsigned overflow in either case. 12194 return false; 12195 } 12196 } 12197 if (Start == Stride || Start == getMinusSCEV(Stride, One)) { 12198 // If Start is equal to Stride, (End - Start) + (Stride - 1) == End - 1. 12199 // If !IsSigned, 0 <u Stride == Start <=u End; so 0 <u End - 1 <u End. 12200 // If IsSigned, 0 <s Stride == Start <=s End; so 0 <s End - 1 <s End. 12201 // 12202 // If Start is equal to Stride - 1, (End - Start) + Stride - 1 == End. 12203 return false; 12204 } 12205 return true; 12206 }(); 12207 12208 const SCEV *Delta = getMinusSCEV(End, Start); 12209 if (!MayAddOverflow) { 12210 // floor((D + (S - 1)) / S) 12211 // We prefer this formulation if it's legal because it's fewer operations. 12212 BECount = 12213 getUDivExpr(getAddExpr(Delta, getMinusSCEV(Stride, One)), Stride); 12214 } else { 12215 BECount = getUDivCeilSCEV(Delta, Stride); 12216 } 12217 } 12218 12219 const SCEV *MaxBECount; 12220 bool MaxOrZero = false; 12221 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(BECount)) { 12222 MaxBECount = BECount; 12223 } else if (BECountIfBackedgeTaken && 12224 isa<SCEVConstant>(BECountIfBackedgeTaken)) { 12225 // If we know exactly how many times the backedge will be taken if it's 12226 // taken at least once, then the backedge count will either be that or 12227 // zero. 12228 MaxBECount = BECountIfBackedgeTaken; 12229 MaxOrZero = true; 12230 } else { 12231 MaxBECount = computeMaxBECountForLT( 12232 Start, Stride, RHS, getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()), IsSigned); 12233 } 12234 12235 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount) && 12236 !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(BECount)) 12237 MaxBECount = getConstant(getUnsignedRangeMax(BECount)); 12238 12239 return ExitLimit(BECount, MaxBECount, MaxOrZero, Predicates); 12240 } 12241 12242 ScalarEvolution::ExitLimit 12243 ScalarEvolution::howManyGreaterThans(const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS, 12244 const Loop *L, bool IsSigned, 12245 bool ControlsExit, bool AllowPredicates) { 12246 SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> Predicates; 12247 // We handle only IV > Invariant 12248 if (!isLoopInvariant(RHS, L)) 12249 return getCouldNotCompute(); 12250 12251 const SCEVAddRecExpr *IV = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(LHS); 12252 if (!IV && AllowPredicates) 12253 // Try to make this an AddRec using runtime tests, in the first X 12254 // iterations of this loop, where X is the SCEV expression found by the 12255 // algorithm below. 12256 IV = convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates(LHS, L, Predicates); 12257 12258 // Avoid weird loops 12259 if (!IV || IV->getLoop() != L || !IV->isAffine()) 12260 return getCouldNotCompute(); 12261 12262 auto WrapType = IsSigned ? SCEV::FlagNSW : SCEV::FlagNUW; 12263 bool NoWrap = ControlsExit && IV->getNoWrapFlags(WrapType); 12264 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond = IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT; 12265 12266 const SCEV *Stride = getNegativeSCEV(IV->getStepRecurrence(*this)); 12267 12268 // Avoid negative or zero stride values 12269 if (!isKnownPositive(Stride)) 12270 return getCouldNotCompute(); 12271 12272 // Avoid proven overflow cases: this will ensure that the backedge taken count 12273 // will not generate any unsigned overflow. Relaxed no-overflow conditions 12274 // exploit NoWrapFlags, allowing to optimize in presence of undefined 12275 // behaviors like the case of C language. 12276 if (!Stride->isOne() && !NoWrap) 12277 if (canIVOverflowOnGT(RHS, Stride, IsSigned)) 12278 return getCouldNotCompute(); 12279 12280 const SCEV *Start = IV->getStart(); 12281 const SCEV *End = RHS; 12282 if (!isLoopEntryGuardedByCond(L, Cond, getAddExpr(Start, Stride), RHS)) { 12283 // If we know that Start >= RHS in the context of loop, then we know that 12284 // min(RHS, Start) = RHS at this point. 12285 if (isLoopEntryGuardedByCond( 12286 L, IsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, Start, RHS)) 12287 End = RHS; 12288 else 12289 End = IsSigned ? getSMinExpr(RHS, Start) : getUMinExpr(RHS, Start); 12290 } 12291 12292 if (Start->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 12293 Start = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(Start); 12294 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(Start)) 12295 return Start; 12296 } 12297 if (End->getType()->isPointerTy()) { 12298 End = getLosslessPtrToIntExpr(End); 12299 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(End)) 12300 return End; 12301 } 12302 12303 // Compute ((Start - End) + (Stride - 1)) / Stride. 12304 // FIXME: This can overflow. Holding off on fixing this for now; 12305 // howManyGreaterThans will hopefully be gone soon. 12306 const SCEV *One = getOne(Stride->getType()); 12307 const SCEV *BECount = getUDivExpr( 12308 getAddExpr(getMinusSCEV(Start, End), getMinusSCEV(Stride, One)), Stride); 12309 12310 APInt MaxStart = IsSigned ? getSignedRangeMax(Start) 12311 : getUnsignedRangeMax(Start); 12312 12313 APInt MinStride = IsSigned ? getSignedRangeMin(Stride) 12314 : getUnsignedRangeMin(Stride); 12315 12316 unsigned BitWidth = getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()); 12317 APInt Limit = IsSigned ? APInt::getSignedMinValue(BitWidth) + (MinStride - 1) 12318 : APInt::getMinValue(BitWidth) + (MinStride - 1); 12319 12320 // Although End can be a MIN expression we estimate MinEnd considering only 12321 // the case End = RHS. This is safe because in the other case (Start - End) 12322 // is zero, leading to a zero maximum backedge taken count. 12323 APInt MinEnd = 12324 IsSigned ? APIntOps::smax(getSignedRangeMin(RHS), Limit) 12325 : APIntOps::umax(getUnsignedRangeMin(RHS), Limit); 12326 12327 const SCEV *MaxBECount = isa<SCEVConstant>(BECount) 12328 ? BECount 12329 : getUDivCeilSCEV(getConstant(MaxStart - MinEnd), 12330 getConstant(MinStride)); 12331 12332 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(MaxBECount)) 12333 MaxBECount = BECount; 12334 12335 return ExitLimit(BECount, MaxBECount, false, Predicates); 12336 } 12337 12338 const SCEV *SCEVAddRecExpr::getNumIterationsInRange(const ConstantRange &Range, 12339 ScalarEvolution &SE) const { 12340 if (Range.isFullSet()) // Infinite loop. 12341 return SE.getCouldNotCompute(); 12342 12343 // If the start is a non-zero constant, shift the range to simplify things. 12344 if (const SCEVConstant *SC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(getStart())) 12345 if (!SC->getValue()->isZero()) { 12346 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Operands(operands()); 12347 Operands[0] = SE.getZero(SC->getType()); 12348 const SCEV *Shifted = SE.getAddRecExpr(Operands, getLoop(), 12349 getNoWrapFlags(FlagNW)); 12350 if (const auto *ShiftedAddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Shifted)) 12351 return ShiftedAddRec->getNumIterationsInRange( 12352 Range.subtract(SC->getAPInt()), SE); 12353 // This is strange and shouldn't happen. 12354 return SE.getCouldNotCompute(); 12355 } 12356 12357 // The only time we can solve this is when we have all constant indices. 12358 // Otherwise, we cannot determine the overflow conditions. 12359 if (any_of(operands(), [](const SCEV *Op) { return !isa<SCEVConstant>(Op); })) 12360 return SE.getCouldNotCompute(); 12361 12362 // Okay at this point we know that all elements of the chrec are constants and 12363 // that the start element is zero. 12364 12365 // First check to see if the range contains zero. If not, the first 12366 // iteration exits. 12367 unsigned BitWidth = SE.getTypeSizeInBits(getType()); 12368 if (!Range.contains(APInt(BitWidth, 0))) 12369 return SE.getZero(getType()); 12370 12371 if (isAffine()) { 12372 // If this is an affine expression then we have this situation: 12373 // Solve {0,+,A} in Range === Ax in Range 12374 12375 // We know that zero is in the range. If A is positive then we know that 12376 // the upper value of the range must be the first possible exit value. 12377 // If A is negative then the lower of the range is the last possible loop 12378 // value. Also note that we already checked for a full range. 12379 APInt A = cast<SCEVConstant>(getOperand(1))->getAPInt(); 12380 APInt End = A.sge(1) ? (Range.getUpper() - 1) : Range.getLower(); 12381 12382 // The exit value should be (End+A)/A. 12383 APInt ExitVal = (End + A).udiv(A); 12384 ConstantInt *ExitValue = ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), ExitVal); 12385 12386 // Evaluate at the exit value. If we really did fall out of the valid 12387 // range, then we computed our trip count, otherwise wrap around or other 12388 // things must have happened. 12389 ConstantInt *Val = EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(this, ExitValue, SE); 12390 if (Range.contains(Val->getValue())) 12391 return SE.getCouldNotCompute(); // Something strange happened 12392 12393 // Ensure that the previous value is in the range. 12394 assert(Range.contains( 12395 EvaluateConstantChrecAtConstant(this, 12396 ConstantInt::get(SE.getContext(), ExitVal - 1), SE)->getValue()) && 12397 "Linear scev computation is off in a bad way!"); 12398 return SE.getConstant(ExitValue); 12399 } 12400 12401 if (isQuadratic()) { 12402 if (auto S = SolveQuadraticAddRecRange(this, Range, SE)) 12403 return SE.getConstant(S.getValue()); 12404 } 12405 12406 return SE.getCouldNotCompute(); 12407 } 12408 12409 const SCEVAddRecExpr * 12410 SCEVAddRecExpr::getPostIncExpr(ScalarEvolution &SE) const { 12411 assert(getNumOperands() > 1 && "AddRec with zero step?"); 12412 // There is a temptation to just call getAddExpr(this, getStepRecurrence(SE)), 12413 // but in this case we cannot guarantee that the value returned will be an 12414 // AddRec because SCEV does not have a fixed point where it stops 12415 // simplification: it is legal to return ({rec1} + {rec2}). For example, it 12416 // may happen if we reach arithmetic depth limit while simplifying. So we 12417 // construct the returned value explicitly. 12418 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 3> Ops; 12419 // If this is {A,+,B,+,C,...,+,N}, then its step is {B,+,C,+,...,+,N}, and 12420 // (this + Step) is {A+B,+,B+C,+...,+,N}. 12421 for (unsigned i = 0, e = getNumOperands() - 1; i < e; ++i) 12422 Ops.push_back(SE.getAddExpr(getOperand(i), getOperand(i + 1))); 12423 // We know that the last operand is not a constant zero (otherwise it would 12424 // have been popped out earlier). This guarantees us that if the result has 12425 // the same last operand, then it will also not be popped out, meaning that 12426 // the returned value will be an AddRec. 12427 const SCEV *Last = getOperand(getNumOperands() - 1); 12428 assert(!Last->isZero() && "Recurrency with zero step?"); 12429 Ops.push_back(Last); 12430 return cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(SE.getAddRecExpr(Ops, getLoop(), 12431 SCEV::FlagAnyWrap)); 12432 } 12433 12434 // Return true when S contains at least an undef value. 12435 bool ScalarEvolution::containsUndefs(const SCEV *S) const { 12436 return SCEVExprContains(S, [](const SCEV *S) { 12437 if (const auto *SU = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)) 12438 return isa<UndefValue>(SU->getValue()); 12439 return false; 12440 }); 12441 } 12442 12443 /// Return the size of an element read or written by Inst. 12444 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::getElementSize(Instruction *Inst) { 12445 Type *Ty; 12446 if (StoreInst *Store = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(Inst)) 12447 Ty = Store->getValueOperand()->getType(); 12448 else if (LoadInst *Load = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(Inst)) 12449 Ty = Load->getType(); 12450 else 12451 return nullptr; 12452 12453 Type *ETy = getEffectiveSCEVType(PointerType::getUnqual(Ty)); 12454 return getSizeOfExpr(ETy, Ty); 12455 } 12456 12457 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12458 // SCEVCallbackVH Class Implementation 12459 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12460 12461 void ScalarEvolution::SCEVCallbackVH::deleted() { 12462 assert(SE && "SCEVCallbackVH called with a null ScalarEvolution!"); 12463 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(getValPtr())) 12464 SE->ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN); 12465 SE->eraseValueFromMap(getValPtr()); 12466 // this now dangles! 12467 } 12468 12469 void ScalarEvolution::SCEVCallbackVH::allUsesReplacedWith(Value *V) { 12470 assert(SE && "SCEVCallbackVH called with a null ScalarEvolution!"); 12471 12472 // Forget all the expressions associated with users of the old value, 12473 // so that future queries will recompute the expressions using the new 12474 // value. 12475 Value *Old = getValPtr(); 12476 SmallVector<User *, 16> Worklist(Old->users()); 12477 SmallPtrSet<User *, 8> Visited; 12478 while (!Worklist.empty()) { 12479 User *U = Worklist.pop_back_val(); 12480 // Deleting the Old value will cause this to dangle. Postpone 12481 // that until everything else is done. 12482 if (U == Old) 12483 continue; 12484 if (!Visited.insert(U).second) 12485 continue; 12486 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(U)) 12487 SE->ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN); 12488 SE->eraseValueFromMap(U); 12489 llvm::append_range(Worklist, U->users()); 12490 } 12491 // Delete the Old value. 12492 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Old)) 12493 SE->ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue.erase(PN); 12494 SE->eraseValueFromMap(Old); 12495 // this now dangles! 12496 } 12497 12498 ScalarEvolution::SCEVCallbackVH::SCEVCallbackVH(Value *V, ScalarEvolution *se) 12499 : CallbackVH(V), SE(se) {} 12500 12501 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12502 // ScalarEvolution Class Implementation 12503 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12504 12505 ScalarEvolution::ScalarEvolution(Function &F, TargetLibraryInfo &TLI, 12506 AssumptionCache &AC, DominatorTree &DT, 12507 LoopInfo &LI) 12508 : F(F), TLI(TLI), AC(AC), DT(DT), LI(LI), 12509 CouldNotCompute(new SCEVCouldNotCompute()), ValuesAtScopes(64), 12510 LoopDispositions(64), BlockDispositions(64) { 12511 // To use guards for proving predicates, we need to scan every instruction in 12512 // relevant basic blocks, and not just terminators. Doing this is a waste of 12513 // time if the IR does not actually contain any calls to 12514 // @llvm.experimental.guard, so do a quick check and remember this beforehand. 12515 // 12516 // This pessimizes the case where a pass that preserves ScalarEvolution wants 12517 // to _add_ guards to the module when there weren't any before, and wants 12518 // ScalarEvolution to optimize based on those guards. For now we prefer to be 12519 // efficient in lieu of being smart in that rather obscure case. 12520 12521 auto *GuardDecl = F.getParent()->getFunction( 12522 Intrinsic::getName(Intrinsic::experimental_guard)); 12523 HasGuards = GuardDecl && !GuardDecl->use_empty(); 12524 } 12525 12526 ScalarEvolution::ScalarEvolution(ScalarEvolution &&Arg) 12527 : F(Arg.F), HasGuards(Arg.HasGuards), TLI(Arg.TLI), AC(Arg.AC), DT(Arg.DT), 12528 LI(Arg.LI), CouldNotCompute(std::move(Arg.CouldNotCompute)), 12529 ValueExprMap(std::move(Arg.ValueExprMap)), 12530 PendingLoopPredicates(std::move(Arg.PendingLoopPredicates)), 12531 PendingPhiRanges(std::move(Arg.PendingPhiRanges)), 12532 PendingMerges(std::move(Arg.PendingMerges)), 12533 MinTrailingZerosCache(std::move(Arg.MinTrailingZerosCache)), 12534 BackedgeTakenCounts(std::move(Arg.BackedgeTakenCounts)), 12535 PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts( 12536 std::move(Arg.PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts)), 12537 ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue( 12538 std::move(Arg.ConstantEvolutionLoopExitValue)), 12539 ValuesAtScopes(std::move(Arg.ValuesAtScopes)), 12540 LoopDispositions(std::move(Arg.LoopDispositions)), 12541 LoopPropertiesCache(std::move(Arg.LoopPropertiesCache)), 12542 BlockDispositions(std::move(Arg.BlockDispositions)), 12543 SCEVUsers(std::move(Arg.SCEVUsers)), 12544 UnsignedRanges(std::move(Arg.UnsignedRanges)), 12545 SignedRanges(std::move(Arg.SignedRanges)), 12546 UniqueSCEVs(std::move(Arg.UniqueSCEVs)), 12547 UniquePreds(std::move(Arg.UniquePreds)), 12548 SCEVAllocator(std::move(Arg.SCEVAllocator)), 12549 LoopUsers(std::move(Arg.LoopUsers)), 12550 PredicatedSCEVRewrites(std::move(Arg.PredicatedSCEVRewrites)), 12551 FirstUnknown(Arg.FirstUnknown) { 12552 Arg.FirstUnknown = nullptr; 12553 } 12554 12555 ScalarEvolution::~ScalarEvolution() { 12556 // Iterate through all the SCEVUnknown instances and call their 12557 // destructors, so that they release their references to their values. 12558 for (SCEVUnknown *U = FirstUnknown; U;) { 12559 SCEVUnknown *Tmp = U; 12560 U = U->Next; 12561 Tmp->~SCEVUnknown(); 12562 } 12563 FirstUnknown = nullptr; 12564 12565 ExprValueMap.clear(); 12566 ValueExprMap.clear(); 12567 HasRecMap.clear(); 12568 BackedgeTakenCounts.clear(); 12569 PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts.clear(); 12570 12571 assert(PendingLoopPredicates.empty() && "isImpliedCond garbage"); 12572 assert(PendingPhiRanges.empty() && "getRangeRef garbage"); 12573 assert(PendingMerges.empty() && "isImpliedViaMerge garbage"); 12574 assert(!WalkingBEDominatingConds && "isLoopBackedgeGuardedByCond garbage!"); 12575 assert(!ProvingSplitPredicate && "ProvingSplitPredicate garbage!"); 12576 } 12577 12578 bool ScalarEvolution::hasLoopInvariantBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L) { 12579 return !isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(getBackedgeTakenCount(L)); 12580 } 12581 12582 static void PrintLoopInfo(raw_ostream &OS, ScalarEvolution *SE, 12583 const Loop *L) { 12584 // Print all inner loops first 12585 for (Loop *I : *L) 12586 PrintLoopInfo(OS, SE, I); 12587 12588 OS << "Loop "; 12589 L->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false); 12590 OS << ": "; 12591 12592 SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 8> ExitingBlocks; 12593 L->getExitingBlocks(ExitingBlocks); 12594 if (ExitingBlocks.size() != 1) 12595 OS << "<multiple exits> "; 12596 12597 if (SE->hasLoopInvariantBackedgeTakenCount(L)) 12598 OS << "backedge-taken count is " << *SE->getBackedgeTakenCount(L) << "\n"; 12599 else 12600 OS << "Unpredictable backedge-taken count.\n"; 12601 12602 if (ExitingBlocks.size() > 1) 12603 for (BasicBlock *ExitingBlock : ExitingBlocks) { 12604 OS << " exit count for " << ExitingBlock->getName() << ": " 12605 << *SE->getExitCount(L, ExitingBlock) << "\n"; 12606 } 12607 12608 OS << "Loop "; 12609 L->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false); 12610 OS << ": "; 12611 12612 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(SE->getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L))) { 12613 OS << "max backedge-taken count is " << *SE->getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount(L); 12614 if (SE->isBackedgeTakenCountMaxOrZero(L)) 12615 OS << ", actual taken count either this or zero."; 12616 } else { 12617 OS << "Unpredictable max backedge-taken count. "; 12618 } 12619 12620 OS << "\n" 12621 "Loop "; 12622 L->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false); 12623 OS << ": "; 12624 12625 SCEVUnionPredicate Pred; 12626 auto PBT = SE->getPredicatedBackedgeTakenCount(L, Pred); 12627 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(PBT)) { 12628 OS << "Predicated backedge-taken count is " << *PBT << "\n"; 12629 OS << " Predicates:\n"; 12630 Pred.print(OS, 4); 12631 } else { 12632 OS << "Unpredictable predicated backedge-taken count. "; 12633 } 12634 OS << "\n"; 12635 12636 if (SE->hasLoopInvariantBackedgeTakenCount(L)) { 12637 OS << "Loop "; 12638 L->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false); 12639 OS << ": "; 12640 OS << "Trip multiple is " << SE->getSmallConstantTripMultiple(L) << "\n"; 12641 } 12642 } 12643 12644 static StringRef loopDispositionToStr(ScalarEvolution::LoopDisposition LD) { 12645 switch (LD) { 12646 case ScalarEvolution::LoopVariant: 12647 return "Variant"; 12648 case ScalarEvolution::LoopInvariant: 12649 return "Invariant"; 12650 case ScalarEvolution::LoopComputable: 12651 return "Computable"; 12652 } 12653 llvm_unreachable("Unknown ScalarEvolution::LoopDisposition kind!"); 12654 } 12655 12656 void ScalarEvolution::print(raw_ostream &OS) const { 12657 // ScalarEvolution's implementation of the print method is to print 12658 // out SCEV values of all instructions that are interesting. Doing 12659 // this potentially causes it to create new SCEV objects though, 12660 // which technically conflicts with the const qualifier. This isn't 12661 // observable from outside the class though, so casting away the 12662 // const isn't dangerous. 12663 ScalarEvolution &SE = *const_cast<ScalarEvolution *>(this); 12664 12665 if (ClassifyExpressions) { 12666 OS << "Classifying expressions for: "; 12667 F.printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false); 12668 OS << "\n"; 12669 for (Instruction &I : instructions(F)) 12670 if (isSCEVable(I.getType()) && !isa<CmpInst>(I)) { 12671 OS << I << '\n'; 12672 OS << " --> "; 12673 const SCEV *SV = SE.getSCEV(&I); 12674 SV->print(OS); 12675 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(SV)) { 12676 OS << " U: "; 12677 SE.getUnsignedRange(SV).print(OS); 12678 OS << " S: "; 12679 SE.getSignedRange(SV).print(OS); 12680 } 12681 12682 const Loop *L = LI.getLoopFor(I.getParent()); 12683 12684 const SCEV *AtUse = SE.getSCEVAtScope(SV, L); 12685 if (AtUse != SV) { 12686 OS << " --> "; 12687 AtUse->print(OS); 12688 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(AtUse)) { 12689 OS << " U: "; 12690 SE.getUnsignedRange(AtUse).print(OS); 12691 OS << " S: "; 12692 SE.getSignedRange(AtUse).print(OS); 12693 } 12694 } 12695 12696 if (L) { 12697 OS << "\t\t" "Exits: "; 12698 const SCEV *ExitValue = SE.getSCEVAtScope(SV, L->getParentLoop()); 12699 if (!SE.isLoopInvariant(ExitValue, L)) { 12700 OS << "<<Unknown>>"; 12701 } else { 12702 OS << *ExitValue; 12703 } 12704 12705 bool First = true; 12706 for (auto *Iter = L; Iter; Iter = Iter->getParentLoop()) { 12707 if (First) { 12708 OS << "\t\t" "LoopDispositions: { "; 12709 First = false; 12710 } else { 12711 OS << ", "; 12712 } 12713 12714 Iter->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false); 12715 OS << ": " << loopDispositionToStr(SE.getLoopDisposition(SV, Iter)); 12716 } 12717 12718 for (auto *InnerL : depth_first(L)) { 12719 if (InnerL == L) 12720 continue; 12721 if (First) { 12722 OS << "\t\t" "LoopDispositions: { "; 12723 First = false; 12724 } else { 12725 OS << ", "; 12726 } 12727 12728 InnerL->getHeader()->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false); 12729 OS << ": " << loopDispositionToStr(SE.getLoopDisposition(SV, InnerL)); 12730 } 12731 12732 OS << " }"; 12733 } 12734 12735 OS << "\n"; 12736 } 12737 } 12738 12739 OS << "Determining loop execution counts for: "; 12740 F.printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false); 12741 OS << "\n"; 12742 for (Loop *I : LI) 12743 PrintLoopInfo(OS, &SE, I); 12744 } 12745 12746 ScalarEvolution::LoopDisposition 12747 ScalarEvolution::getLoopDisposition(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) { 12748 auto &Values = LoopDispositions[S]; 12749 for (auto &V : Values) { 12750 if (V.getPointer() == L) 12751 return V.getInt(); 12752 } 12753 Values.emplace_back(L, LoopVariant); 12754 LoopDisposition D = computeLoopDisposition(S, L); 12755 auto &Values2 = LoopDispositions[S]; 12756 for (auto &V : llvm::reverse(Values2)) { 12757 if (V.getPointer() == L) { 12758 V.setInt(D); 12759 break; 12760 } 12761 } 12762 return D; 12763 } 12764 12765 ScalarEvolution::LoopDisposition 12766 ScalarEvolution::computeLoopDisposition(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) { 12767 switch (S->getSCEVType()) { 12768 case scConstant: 12769 return LoopInvariant; 12770 case scPtrToInt: 12771 case scTruncate: 12772 case scZeroExtend: 12773 case scSignExtend: 12774 return getLoopDisposition(cast<SCEVCastExpr>(S)->getOperand(), L); 12775 case scAddRecExpr: { 12776 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S); 12777 12778 // If L is the addrec's loop, it's computable. 12779 if (AR->getLoop() == L) 12780 return LoopComputable; 12781 12782 // Add recurrences are never invariant in the function-body (null loop). 12783 if (!L) 12784 return LoopVariant; 12785 12786 // Everything that is not defined at loop entry is variant. 12787 if (DT.dominates(L->getHeader(), AR->getLoop()->getHeader())) 12788 return LoopVariant; 12789 assert(!L->contains(AR->getLoop()) && "Containing loop's header does not" 12790 " dominate the contained loop's header?"); 12791 12792 // This recurrence is invariant w.r.t. L if AR's loop contains L. 12793 if (AR->getLoop()->contains(L)) 12794 return LoopInvariant; 12795 12796 // This recurrence is variant w.r.t. L if any of its operands 12797 // are variant. 12798 for (auto *Op : AR->operands()) 12799 if (!isLoopInvariant(Op, L)) 12800 return LoopVariant; 12801 12802 // Otherwise it's loop-invariant. 12803 return LoopInvariant; 12804 } 12805 case scAddExpr: 12806 case scMulExpr: 12807 case scUMaxExpr: 12808 case scSMaxExpr: 12809 case scUMinExpr: 12810 case scSMinExpr: { 12811 bool HasVarying = false; 12812 for (auto *Op : cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(S)->operands()) { 12813 LoopDisposition D = getLoopDisposition(Op, L); 12814 if (D == LoopVariant) 12815 return LoopVariant; 12816 if (D == LoopComputable) 12817 HasVarying = true; 12818 } 12819 return HasVarying ? LoopComputable : LoopInvariant; 12820 } 12821 case scUDivExpr: { 12822 const SCEVUDivExpr *UDiv = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(S); 12823 LoopDisposition LD = getLoopDisposition(UDiv->getLHS(), L); 12824 if (LD == LoopVariant) 12825 return LoopVariant; 12826 LoopDisposition RD = getLoopDisposition(UDiv->getRHS(), L); 12827 if (RD == LoopVariant) 12828 return LoopVariant; 12829 return (LD == LoopInvariant && RD == LoopInvariant) ? 12830 LoopInvariant : LoopComputable; 12831 } 12832 case scUnknown: 12833 // All non-instruction values are loop invariant. All instructions are loop 12834 // invariant if they are not contained in the specified loop. 12835 // Instructions are never considered invariant in the function body 12836 // (null loop) because they are defined within the "loop". 12837 if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)->getValue())) 12838 return (L && !L->contains(I)) ? LoopInvariant : LoopVariant; 12839 return LoopInvariant; 12840 case scCouldNotCompute: 12841 llvm_unreachable("Attempt to use a SCEVCouldNotCompute object!"); 12842 } 12843 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!"); 12844 } 12845 12846 bool ScalarEvolution::isLoopInvariant(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) { 12847 return getLoopDisposition(S, L) == LoopInvariant; 12848 } 12849 12850 bool ScalarEvolution::hasComputableLoopEvolution(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L) { 12851 return getLoopDisposition(S, L) == LoopComputable; 12852 } 12853 12854 ScalarEvolution::BlockDisposition 12855 ScalarEvolution::getBlockDisposition(const SCEV *S, const BasicBlock *BB) { 12856 auto &Values = BlockDispositions[S]; 12857 for (auto &V : Values) { 12858 if (V.getPointer() == BB) 12859 return V.getInt(); 12860 } 12861 Values.emplace_back(BB, DoesNotDominateBlock); 12862 BlockDisposition D = computeBlockDisposition(S, BB); 12863 auto &Values2 = BlockDispositions[S]; 12864 for (auto &V : llvm::reverse(Values2)) { 12865 if (V.getPointer() == BB) { 12866 V.setInt(D); 12867 break; 12868 } 12869 } 12870 return D; 12871 } 12872 12873 ScalarEvolution::BlockDisposition 12874 ScalarEvolution::computeBlockDisposition(const SCEV *S, const BasicBlock *BB) { 12875 switch (S->getSCEVType()) { 12876 case scConstant: 12877 return ProperlyDominatesBlock; 12878 case scPtrToInt: 12879 case scTruncate: 12880 case scZeroExtend: 12881 case scSignExtend: 12882 return getBlockDisposition(cast<SCEVCastExpr>(S)->getOperand(), BB); 12883 case scAddRecExpr: { 12884 // This uses a "dominates" query instead of "properly dominates" query 12885 // to test for proper dominance too, because the instruction which 12886 // produces the addrec's value is a PHI, and a PHI effectively properly 12887 // dominates its entire containing block. 12888 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S); 12889 if (!DT.dominates(AR->getLoop()->getHeader(), BB)) 12890 return DoesNotDominateBlock; 12891 12892 // Fall through into SCEVNAryExpr handling. 12893 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 12894 } 12895 case scAddExpr: 12896 case scMulExpr: 12897 case scUMaxExpr: 12898 case scSMaxExpr: 12899 case scUMinExpr: 12900 case scSMinExpr: { 12901 const SCEVNAryExpr *NAry = cast<SCEVNAryExpr>(S); 12902 bool Proper = true; 12903 for (const SCEV *NAryOp : NAry->operands()) { 12904 BlockDisposition D = getBlockDisposition(NAryOp, BB); 12905 if (D == DoesNotDominateBlock) 12906 return DoesNotDominateBlock; 12907 if (D == DominatesBlock) 12908 Proper = false; 12909 } 12910 return Proper ? ProperlyDominatesBlock : DominatesBlock; 12911 } 12912 case scUDivExpr: { 12913 const SCEVUDivExpr *UDiv = cast<SCEVUDivExpr>(S); 12914 const SCEV *LHS = UDiv->getLHS(), *RHS = UDiv->getRHS(); 12915 BlockDisposition LD = getBlockDisposition(LHS, BB); 12916 if (LD == DoesNotDominateBlock) 12917 return DoesNotDominateBlock; 12918 BlockDisposition RD = getBlockDisposition(RHS, BB); 12919 if (RD == DoesNotDominateBlock) 12920 return DoesNotDominateBlock; 12921 return (LD == ProperlyDominatesBlock && RD == ProperlyDominatesBlock) ? 12922 ProperlyDominatesBlock : DominatesBlock; 12923 } 12924 case scUnknown: 12925 if (Instruction *I = 12926 dyn_cast<Instruction>(cast<SCEVUnknown>(S)->getValue())) { 12927 if (I->getParent() == BB) 12928 return DominatesBlock; 12929 if (DT.properlyDominates(I->getParent(), BB)) 12930 return ProperlyDominatesBlock; 12931 return DoesNotDominateBlock; 12932 } 12933 return ProperlyDominatesBlock; 12934 case scCouldNotCompute: 12935 llvm_unreachable("Attempt to use a SCEVCouldNotCompute object!"); 12936 } 12937 llvm_unreachable("Unknown SCEV kind!"); 12938 } 12939 12940 bool ScalarEvolution::dominates(const SCEV *S, const BasicBlock *BB) { 12941 return getBlockDisposition(S, BB) >= DominatesBlock; 12942 } 12943 12944 bool ScalarEvolution::properlyDominates(const SCEV *S, const BasicBlock *BB) { 12945 return getBlockDisposition(S, BB) == ProperlyDominatesBlock; 12946 } 12947 12948 bool ScalarEvolution::hasOperand(const SCEV *S, const SCEV *Op) const { 12949 return SCEVExprContains(S, [&](const SCEV *Expr) { return Expr == Op; }); 12950 } 12951 12952 void ScalarEvolution::forgetMemoizedResults(ArrayRef<const SCEV *> SCEVs) { 12953 SmallPtrSet<const SCEV *, 8> ToForget(SCEVs.begin(), SCEVs.end()); 12954 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 8> Worklist(ToForget.begin(), ToForget.end()); 12955 12956 while (!Worklist.empty()) { 12957 const SCEV *Curr = Worklist.pop_back_val(); 12958 auto Users = SCEVUsers.find(Curr); 12959 if (Users != SCEVUsers.end()) 12960 for (auto *User : Users->second) 12961 if (ToForget.insert(User).second) 12962 Worklist.push_back(User); 12963 } 12964 12965 for (auto *S : ToForget) 12966 forgetMemoizedResultsImpl(S); 12967 12968 for (auto I = PredicatedSCEVRewrites.begin(); 12969 I != PredicatedSCEVRewrites.end();) { 12970 std::pair<const SCEV *, const Loop *> Entry = I->first; 12971 if (ToForget.count(Entry.first)) 12972 PredicatedSCEVRewrites.erase(I++); 12973 else 12974 ++I; 12975 } 12976 12977 auto RemoveSCEVFromBackedgeMap = [&ToForget]( 12978 DenseMap<const Loop *, BackedgeTakenInfo> &Map) { 12979 for (auto I = Map.begin(), E = Map.end(); I != E;) { 12980 BackedgeTakenInfo &BEInfo = I->second; 12981 if (any_of(ToForget, 12982 [&BEInfo](const SCEV *S) { return BEInfo.hasOperand(S); })) 12983 Map.erase(I++); 12984 else 12985 ++I; 12986 } 12987 }; 12988 12989 RemoveSCEVFromBackedgeMap(BackedgeTakenCounts); 12990 RemoveSCEVFromBackedgeMap(PredicatedBackedgeTakenCounts); 12991 } 12992 12993 void ScalarEvolution::forgetMemoizedResultsImpl(const SCEV *S) { 12994 ValuesAtScopes.erase(S); 12995 LoopDispositions.erase(S); 12996 BlockDispositions.erase(S); 12997 UnsignedRanges.erase(S); 12998 SignedRanges.erase(S); 12999 ExprValueMap.erase(S); 13000 HasRecMap.erase(S); 13001 MinTrailingZerosCache.erase(S); 13002 } 13003 13004 void 13005 ScalarEvolution::getUsedLoops(const SCEV *S, 13006 SmallPtrSetImpl<const Loop *> &LoopsUsed) { 13007 struct FindUsedLoops { 13008 FindUsedLoops(SmallPtrSetImpl<const Loop *> &LoopsUsed) 13009 : LoopsUsed(LoopsUsed) {} 13010 SmallPtrSetImpl<const Loop *> &LoopsUsed; 13011 bool follow(const SCEV *S) { 13012 if (auto *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S)) 13013 LoopsUsed.insert(AR->getLoop()); 13014 return true; 13015 } 13016 13017 bool isDone() const { return false; } 13018 }; 13019 13020 FindUsedLoops F(LoopsUsed); 13021 SCEVTraversal<FindUsedLoops>(F).visitAll(S); 13022 } 13023 13024 void ScalarEvolution::verify() const { 13025 ScalarEvolution &SE = *const_cast<ScalarEvolution *>(this); 13026 ScalarEvolution SE2(F, TLI, AC, DT, LI); 13027 13028 SmallVector<Loop *, 8> LoopStack(LI.begin(), LI.end()); 13029 13030 // Map's SCEV expressions from one ScalarEvolution "universe" to another. 13031 struct SCEVMapper : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVMapper> { 13032 SCEVMapper(ScalarEvolution &SE) : SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVMapper>(SE) {} 13033 13034 const SCEV *visitConstant(const SCEVConstant *Constant) { 13035 return SE.getConstant(Constant->getAPInt()); 13036 } 13037 13038 const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) { 13039 return SE.getUnknown(Expr->getValue()); 13040 } 13041 13042 const SCEV *visitCouldNotCompute(const SCEVCouldNotCompute *Expr) { 13043 return SE.getCouldNotCompute(); 13044 } 13045 }; 13046 13047 SCEVMapper SCM(SE2); 13048 13049 while (!LoopStack.empty()) { 13050 auto *L = LoopStack.pop_back_val(); 13051 llvm::append_range(LoopStack, *L); 13052 13053 auto *CurBECount = SCM.visit( 13054 const_cast<ScalarEvolution *>(this)->getBackedgeTakenCount(L)); 13055 auto *NewBECount = SE2.getBackedgeTakenCount(L); 13056 13057 if (CurBECount == SE2.getCouldNotCompute() || 13058 NewBECount == SE2.getCouldNotCompute()) { 13059 // NB! This situation is legal, but is very suspicious -- whatever pass 13060 // change the loop to make a trip count go from could not compute to 13061 // computable or vice-versa *should have* invalidated SCEV. However, we 13062 // choose not to assert here (for now) since we don't want false 13063 // positives. 13064 continue; 13065 } 13066 13067 if (containsUndefs(CurBECount) || containsUndefs(NewBECount)) { 13068 // SCEV treats "undef" as an unknown but consistent value (i.e. it does 13069 // not propagate undef aggressively). This means we can (and do) fail 13070 // verification in cases where a transform makes the trip count of a loop 13071 // go from "undef" to "undef+1" (say). The transform is fine, since in 13072 // both cases the loop iterates "undef" times, but SCEV thinks we 13073 // increased the trip count of the loop by 1 incorrectly. 13074 continue; 13075 } 13076 13077 if (SE.getTypeSizeInBits(CurBECount->getType()) > 13078 SE.getTypeSizeInBits(NewBECount->getType())) 13079 NewBECount = SE2.getZeroExtendExpr(NewBECount, CurBECount->getType()); 13080 else if (SE.getTypeSizeInBits(CurBECount->getType()) < 13081 SE.getTypeSizeInBits(NewBECount->getType())) 13082 CurBECount = SE2.getZeroExtendExpr(CurBECount, NewBECount->getType()); 13083 13084 const SCEV *Delta = SE2.getMinusSCEV(CurBECount, NewBECount); 13085 13086 // Unless VerifySCEVStrict is set, we only compare constant deltas. 13087 if ((VerifySCEVStrict || isa<SCEVConstant>(Delta)) && !Delta->isZero()) { 13088 dbgs() << "Trip Count for " << *L << " Changed!\n"; 13089 dbgs() << "Old: " << *CurBECount << "\n"; 13090 dbgs() << "New: " << *NewBECount << "\n"; 13091 dbgs() << "Delta: " << *Delta << "\n"; 13092 std::abort(); 13093 } 13094 } 13095 13096 // Collect all valid loops currently in LoopInfo. 13097 SmallPtrSet<Loop *, 32> ValidLoops; 13098 SmallVector<Loop *, 32> Worklist(LI.begin(), LI.end()); 13099 while (!Worklist.empty()) { 13100 Loop *L = Worklist.pop_back_val(); 13101 if (ValidLoops.contains(L)) 13102 continue; 13103 ValidLoops.insert(L); 13104 Worklist.append(L->begin(), L->end()); 13105 } 13106 // Check for SCEV expressions referencing invalid/deleted loops. 13107 for (auto &KV : ValueExprMap) { 13108 auto *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(KV.second); 13109 if (!AR) 13110 continue; 13111 assert(ValidLoops.contains(AR->getLoop()) && 13112 "AddRec references invalid loop"); 13113 } 13114 13115 // Verify intergity of SCEV users. 13116 for (const auto &S : UniqueSCEVs) { 13117 SmallVector<const SCEV *, 4> Ops; 13118 collectUniqueOps(&S, Ops); 13119 for (const auto *Op : Ops) { 13120 // We do not store dependencies of constants. 13121 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(Op)) 13122 continue; 13123 auto It = SCEVUsers.find(Op); 13124 if (It != SCEVUsers.end() && It->second.count(&S)) 13125 continue; 13126 dbgs() << "Use of operand " << *Op << " by user " << S 13127 << " is not being tracked!\n"; 13128 std::abort(); 13129 } 13130 } 13131 } 13132 13133 bool ScalarEvolution::invalidate( 13134 Function &F, const PreservedAnalyses &PA, 13135 FunctionAnalysisManager::Invalidator &Inv) { 13136 // Invalidate the ScalarEvolution object whenever it isn't preserved or one 13137 // of its dependencies is invalidated. 13138 auto PAC = PA.getChecker<ScalarEvolutionAnalysis>(); 13139 return !(PAC.preserved() || PAC.preservedSet<AllAnalysesOn<Function>>()) || 13140 Inv.invalidate<AssumptionAnalysis>(F, PA) || 13141 Inv.invalidate<DominatorTreeAnalysis>(F, PA) || 13142 Inv.invalidate<LoopAnalysis>(F, PA); 13143 } 13144 13145 AnalysisKey ScalarEvolutionAnalysis::Key; 13146 13147 ScalarEvolution ScalarEvolutionAnalysis::run(Function &F, 13148 FunctionAnalysisManager &AM) { 13149 return ScalarEvolution(F, AM.getResult<TargetLibraryAnalysis>(F), 13150 AM.getResult<AssumptionAnalysis>(F), 13151 AM.getResult<DominatorTreeAnalysis>(F), 13152 AM.getResult<LoopAnalysis>(F)); 13153 } 13154 13155 PreservedAnalyses 13156 ScalarEvolutionVerifierPass::run(Function &F, FunctionAnalysisManager &AM) { 13157 AM.getResult<ScalarEvolutionAnalysis>(F).verify(); 13158 return PreservedAnalyses::all(); 13159 } 13160 13161 PreservedAnalyses 13162 ScalarEvolutionPrinterPass::run(Function &F, FunctionAnalysisManager &AM) { 13163 // For compatibility with opt's -analyze feature under legacy pass manager 13164 // which was not ported to NPM. This keeps tests using 13165 // update_analyze_test_checks.py working. 13166 OS << "Printing analysis 'Scalar Evolution Analysis' for function '" 13167 << F.getName() << "':\n"; 13168 AM.getResult<ScalarEvolutionAnalysis>(F).print(OS); 13169 return PreservedAnalyses::all(); 13170 } 13171 13172 INITIALIZE_PASS_BEGIN(ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass, "scalar-evolution", 13173 "Scalar Evolution Analysis", false, true) 13174 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(AssumptionCacheTracker) 13175 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(LoopInfoWrapperPass) 13176 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(DominatorTreeWrapperPass) 13177 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass) 13178 INITIALIZE_PASS_END(ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass, "scalar-evolution", 13179 "Scalar Evolution Analysis", false, true) 13180 13181 char ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::ID = 0; 13182 13183 ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass() : FunctionPass(ID) { 13184 initializeScalarEvolutionWrapperPassPass(*PassRegistry::getPassRegistry()); 13185 } 13186 13187 bool ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::runOnFunction(Function &F) { 13188 SE.reset(new ScalarEvolution( 13189 F, getAnalysis<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>().getTLI(F), 13190 getAnalysis<AssumptionCacheTracker>().getAssumptionCache(F), 13191 getAnalysis<DominatorTreeWrapperPass>().getDomTree(), 13192 getAnalysis<LoopInfoWrapperPass>().getLoopInfo())); 13193 return false; 13194 } 13195 13196 void ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::releaseMemory() { SE.reset(); } 13197 13198 void ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::print(raw_ostream &OS, const Module *) const { 13199 SE->print(OS); 13200 } 13201 13202 void ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::verifyAnalysis() const { 13203 if (!VerifySCEV) 13204 return; 13205 13206 SE->verify(); 13207 } 13208 13209 void ScalarEvolutionWrapperPass::getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const { 13210 AU.setPreservesAll(); 13211 AU.addRequiredTransitive<AssumptionCacheTracker>(); 13212 AU.addRequiredTransitive<LoopInfoWrapperPass>(); 13213 AU.addRequiredTransitive<DominatorTreeWrapperPass>(); 13214 AU.addRequiredTransitive<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>(); 13215 } 13216 13217 const SCEVPredicate *ScalarEvolution::getEqualPredicate(const SCEV *LHS, 13218 const SCEV *RHS) { 13219 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 13220 assert(LHS->getType() == RHS->getType() && 13221 "Type mismatch between LHS and RHS"); 13222 // Unique this node based on the arguments 13223 ID.AddInteger(SCEVPredicate::P_Equal); 13224 ID.AddPointer(LHS); 13225 ID.AddPointer(RHS); 13226 void *IP = nullptr; 13227 if (const auto *S = UniquePreds.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) 13228 return S; 13229 SCEVEqualPredicate *Eq = new (SCEVAllocator) 13230 SCEVEqualPredicate(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), LHS, RHS); 13231 UniquePreds.InsertNode(Eq, IP); 13232 return Eq; 13233 } 13234 13235 const SCEVPredicate *ScalarEvolution::getWrapPredicate( 13236 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR, 13237 SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags AddedFlags) { 13238 FoldingSetNodeID ID; 13239 // Unique this node based on the arguments 13240 ID.AddInteger(SCEVPredicate::P_Wrap); 13241 ID.AddPointer(AR); 13242 ID.AddInteger(AddedFlags); 13243 void *IP = nullptr; 13244 if (const auto *S = UniquePreds.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, IP)) 13245 return S; 13246 auto *OF = new (SCEVAllocator) 13247 SCEVWrapPredicate(ID.Intern(SCEVAllocator), AR, AddedFlags); 13248 UniquePreds.InsertNode(OF, IP); 13249 return OF; 13250 } 13251 13252 namespace { 13253 13254 class SCEVPredicateRewriter : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVPredicateRewriter> { 13255 public: 13256 13257 /// Rewrites \p S in the context of a loop L and the SCEV predication 13258 /// infrastructure. 13259 /// 13260 /// If \p Pred is non-null, the SCEV expression is rewritten to respect the 13261 /// equivalences present in \p Pred. 13262 /// 13263 /// If \p NewPreds is non-null, rewrite is free to add further predicates to 13264 /// \p NewPreds such that the result will be an AddRecExpr. 13265 static const SCEV *rewrite(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE, 13266 SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> *NewPreds, 13267 SCEVUnionPredicate *Pred) { 13268 SCEVPredicateRewriter Rewriter(L, SE, NewPreds, Pred); 13269 return Rewriter.visit(S); 13270 } 13271 13272 const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) { 13273 if (Pred) { 13274 auto ExprPreds = Pred->getPredicatesForExpr(Expr); 13275 for (auto *Pred : ExprPreds) 13276 if (const auto *IPred = dyn_cast<SCEVEqualPredicate>(Pred)) 13277 if (IPred->getLHS() == Expr) 13278 return IPred->getRHS(); 13279 } 13280 return convertToAddRecWithPreds(Expr); 13281 } 13282 13283 const SCEV *visitZeroExtendExpr(const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *Expr) { 13284 const SCEV *Operand = visit(Expr->getOperand()); 13285 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Operand); 13286 if (AR && AR->getLoop() == L && AR->isAffine()) { 13287 // This couldn't be folded because the operand didn't have the nuw 13288 // flag. Add the nusw flag as an assumption that we could make. 13289 const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(SE); 13290 Type *Ty = Expr->getType(); 13291 if (addOverflowAssumption(AR, SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNUSW)) 13292 return SE.getAddRecExpr(SE.getZeroExtendExpr(AR->getStart(), Ty), 13293 SE.getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty), L, 13294 AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 13295 } 13296 return SE.getZeroExtendExpr(Operand, Expr->getType()); 13297 } 13298 13299 const SCEV *visitSignExtendExpr(const SCEVSignExtendExpr *Expr) { 13300 const SCEV *Operand = visit(Expr->getOperand()); 13301 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Operand); 13302 if (AR && AR->getLoop() == L && AR->isAffine()) { 13303 // This couldn't be folded because the operand didn't have the nsw 13304 // flag. Add the nssw flag as an assumption that we could make. 13305 const SCEV *Step = AR->getStepRecurrence(SE); 13306 Type *Ty = Expr->getType(); 13307 if (addOverflowAssumption(AR, SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNSSW)) 13308 return SE.getAddRecExpr(SE.getSignExtendExpr(AR->getStart(), Ty), 13309 SE.getSignExtendExpr(Step, Ty), L, 13310 AR->getNoWrapFlags()); 13311 } 13312 return SE.getSignExtendExpr(Operand, Expr->getType()); 13313 } 13314 13315 private: 13316 explicit SCEVPredicateRewriter(const Loop *L, ScalarEvolution &SE, 13317 SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> *NewPreds, 13318 SCEVUnionPredicate *Pred) 13319 : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), NewPreds(NewPreds), Pred(Pred), L(L) {} 13320 13321 bool addOverflowAssumption(const SCEVPredicate *P) { 13322 if (!NewPreds) { 13323 // Check if we've already made this assumption. 13324 return Pred && Pred->implies(P); 13325 } 13326 NewPreds->insert(P); 13327 return true; 13328 } 13329 13330 bool addOverflowAssumption(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR, 13331 SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags AddedFlags) { 13332 auto *A = SE.getWrapPredicate(AR, AddedFlags); 13333 return addOverflowAssumption(A); 13334 } 13335 13336 // If \p Expr represents a PHINode, we try to see if it can be represented 13337 // as an AddRec, possibly under a predicate (PHISCEVPred). If it is possible 13338 // to add this predicate as a runtime overflow check, we return the AddRec. 13339 // If \p Expr does not meet these conditions (is not a PHI node, or we 13340 // couldn't create an AddRec for it, or couldn't add the predicate), we just 13341 // return \p Expr. 13342 const SCEV *convertToAddRecWithPreds(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) { 13343 if (!isa<PHINode>(Expr->getValue())) 13344 return Expr; 13345 Optional<std::pair<const SCEV *, SmallVector<const SCEVPredicate *, 3>>> 13346 PredicatedRewrite = SE.createAddRecFromPHIWithCasts(Expr); 13347 if (!PredicatedRewrite) 13348 return Expr; 13349 for (auto *P : PredicatedRewrite->second){ 13350 // Wrap predicates from outer loops are not supported. 13351 if (auto *WP = dyn_cast<const SCEVWrapPredicate>(P)) { 13352 auto *AR = cast<const SCEVAddRecExpr>(WP->getExpr()); 13353 if (L != AR->getLoop()) 13354 return Expr; 13355 } 13356 if (!addOverflowAssumption(P)) 13357 return Expr; 13358 } 13359 return PredicatedRewrite->first; 13360 } 13361 13362 SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> *NewPreds; 13363 SCEVUnionPredicate *Pred; 13364 const Loop *L; 13365 }; 13366 13367 } // end anonymous namespace 13368 13369 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::rewriteUsingPredicate(const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, 13370 SCEVUnionPredicate &Preds) { 13371 return SCEVPredicateRewriter::rewrite(S, L, *this, nullptr, &Preds); 13372 } 13373 13374 const SCEVAddRecExpr *ScalarEvolution::convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates( 13375 const SCEV *S, const Loop *L, 13376 SmallPtrSetImpl<const SCEVPredicate *> &Preds) { 13377 SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> TransformPreds; 13378 S = SCEVPredicateRewriter::rewrite(S, L, *this, &TransformPreds, nullptr); 13379 auto *AddRec = dyn_cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(S); 13380 13381 if (!AddRec) 13382 return nullptr; 13383 13384 // Since the transformation was successful, we can now transfer the SCEV 13385 // predicates. 13386 for (auto *P : TransformPreds) 13387 Preds.insert(P); 13388 13389 return AddRec; 13390 } 13391 13392 /// SCEV predicates 13393 SCEVPredicate::SCEVPredicate(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID, 13394 SCEVPredicateKind Kind) 13395 : FastID(ID), Kind(Kind) {} 13396 13397 SCEVEqualPredicate::SCEVEqualPredicate(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID, 13398 const SCEV *LHS, const SCEV *RHS) 13399 : SCEVPredicate(ID, P_Equal), LHS(LHS), RHS(RHS) { 13400 assert(LHS->getType() == RHS->getType() && "LHS and RHS types don't match"); 13401 assert(LHS != RHS && "LHS and RHS are the same SCEV"); 13402 } 13403 13404 bool SCEVEqualPredicate::implies(const SCEVPredicate *N) const { 13405 const auto *Op = dyn_cast<SCEVEqualPredicate>(N); 13406 13407 if (!Op) 13408 return false; 13409 13410 return Op->LHS == LHS && Op->RHS == RHS; 13411 } 13412 13413 bool SCEVEqualPredicate::isAlwaysTrue() const { return false; } 13414 13415 const SCEV *SCEVEqualPredicate::getExpr() const { return LHS; } 13416 13417 void SCEVEqualPredicate::print(raw_ostream &OS, unsigned Depth) const { 13418 OS.indent(Depth) << "Equal predicate: " << *LHS << " == " << *RHS << "\n"; 13419 } 13420 13421 SCEVWrapPredicate::SCEVWrapPredicate(const FoldingSetNodeIDRef ID, 13422 const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR, 13423 IncrementWrapFlags Flags) 13424 : SCEVPredicate(ID, P_Wrap), AR(AR), Flags(Flags) {} 13425 13426 const SCEV *SCEVWrapPredicate::getExpr() const { return AR; } 13427 13428 bool SCEVWrapPredicate::implies(const SCEVPredicate *N) const { 13429 const auto *Op = dyn_cast<SCEVWrapPredicate>(N); 13430 13431 return Op && Op->AR == AR && setFlags(Flags, Op->Flags) == Flags; 13432 } 13433 13434 bool SCEVWrapPredicate::isAlwaysTrue() const { 13435 SCEV::NoWrapFlags ScevFlags = AR->getNoWrapFlags(); 13436 IncrementWrapFlags IFlags = Flags; 13437 13438 if (ScalarEvolution::setFlags(ScevFlags, SCEV::FlagNSW) == ScevFlags) 13439 IFlags = clearFlags(IFlags, IncrementNSSW); 13440 13441 return IFlags == IncrementAnyWrap; 13442 } 13443 13444 void SCEVWrapPredicate::print(raw_ostream &OS, unsigned Depth) const { 13445 OS.indent(Depth) << *getExpr() << " Added Flags: "; 13446 if (SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNUSW & getFlags()) 13447 OS << "<nusw>"; 13448 if (SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementNSSW & getFlags()) 13449 OS << "<nssw>"; 13450 OS << "\n"; 13451 } 13452 13453 SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags 13454 SCEVWrapPredicate::getImpliedFlags(const SCEVAddRecExpr *AR, 13455 ScalarEvolution &SE) { 13456 IncrementWrapFlags ImpliedFlags = IncrementAnyWrap; 13457 SCEV::NoWrapFlags StaticFlags = AR->getNoWrapFlags(); 13458 13459 // We can safely transfer the NSW flag as NSSW. 13460 if (ScalarEvolution::setFlags(StaticFlags, SCEV::FlagNSW) == StaticFlags) 13461 ImpliedFlags = IncrementNSSW; 13462 13463 if (ScalarEvolution::setFlags(StaticFlags, SCEV::FlagNUW) == StaticFlags) { 13464 // If the increment is positive, the SCEV NUW flag will also imply the 13465 // WrapPredicate NUSW flag. 13466 if (const auto *Step = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AR->getStepRecurrence(SE))) 13467 if (Step->getValue()->getValue().isNonNegative()) 13468 ImpliedFlags = setFlags(ImpliedFlags, IncrementNUSW); 13469 } 13470 13471 return ImpliedFlags; 13472 } 13473 13474 /// Union predicates don't get cached so create a dummy set ID for it. 13475 SCEVUnionPredicate::SCEVUnionPredicate() 13476 : SCEVPredicate(FoldingSetNodeIDRef(nullptr, 0), P_Union) {} 13477 13478 bool SCEVUnionPredicate::isAlwaysTrue() const { 13479 return all_of(Preds, 13480 [](const SCEVPredicate *I) { return I->isAlwaysTrue(); }); 13481 } 13482 13483 ArrayRef<const SCEVPredicate *> 13484 SCEVUnionPredicate::getPredicatesForExpr(const SCEV *Expr) { 13485 auto I = SCEVToPreds.find(Expr); 13486 if (I == SCEVToPreds.end()) 13487 return ArrayRef<const SCEVPredicate *>(); 13488 return I->second; 13489 } 13490 13491 bool SCEVUnionPredicate::implies(const SCEVPredicate *N) const { 13492 if (const auto *Set = dyn_cast<SCEVUnionPredicate>(N)) 13493 return all_of(Set->Preds, 13494 [this](const SCEVPredicate *I) { return this->implies(I); }); 13495 13496 auto ScevPredsIt = SCEVToPreds.find(N->getExpr()); 13497 if (ScevPredsIt == SCEVToPreds.end()) 13498 return false; 13499 auto &SCEVPreds = ScevPredsIt->second; 13500 13501 return any_of(SCEVPreds, 13502 [N](const SCEVPredicate *I) { return I->implies(N); }); 13503 } 13504 13505 const SCEV *SCEVUnionPredicate::getExpr() const { return nullptr; } 13506 13507 void SCEVUnionPredicate::print(raw_ostream &OS, unsigned Depth) const { 13508 for (auto Pred : Preds) 13509 Pred->print(OS, Depth); 13510 } 13511 13512 void SCEVUnionPredicate::add(const SCEVPredicate *N) { 13513 if (const auto *Set = dyn_cast<SCEVUnionPredicate>(N)) { 13514 for (auto Pred : Set->Preds) 13515 add(Pred); 13516 return; 13517 } 13518 13519 if (implies(N)) 13520 return; 13521 13522 const SCEV *Key = N->getExpr(); 13523 assert(Key && "Only SCEVUnionPredicate doesn't have an " 13524 " associated expression!"); 13525 13526 SCEVToPreds[Key].push_back(N); 13527 Preds.push_back(N); 13528 } 13529 13530 PredicatedScalarEvolution::PredicatedScalarEvolution(ScalarEvolution &SE, 13531 Loop &L) 13532 : SE(SE), L(L) {} 13533 13534 void ScalarEvolution::registerUser(const SCEV *User, 13535 ArrayRef<const SCEV *> Ops) { 13536 for (auto *Op : Ops) 13537 // We do not expect that forgetting cached data for SCEVConstants will ever 13538 // open any prospects for sharpening or introduce any correctness issues, 13539 // so we don't bother storing their dependencies. 13540 if (!isa<SCEVConstant>(Op)) 13541 SCEVUsers[Op].insert(User); 13542 } 13543 13544 const SCEV *PredicatedScalarEvolution::getSCEV(Value *V) { 13545 const SCEV *Expr = SE.getSCEV(V); 13546 RewriteEntry &Entry = RewriteMap[Expr]; 13547 13548 // If we already have an entry and the version matches, return it. 13549 if (Entry.second && Generation == Entry.first) 13550 return Entry.second; 13551 13552 // We found an entry but it's stale. Rewrite the stale entry 13553 // according to the current predicate. 13554 if (Entry.second) 13555 Expr = Entry.second; 13556 13557 const SCEV *NewSCEV = SE.rewriteUsingPredicate(Expr, &L, Preds); 13558 Entry = {Generation, NewSCEV}; 13559 13560 return NewSCEV; 13561 } 13562 13563 const SCEV *PredicatedScalarEvolution::getBackedgeTakenCount() { 13564 if (!BackedgeCount) { 13565 SCEVUnionPredicate BackedgePred; 13566 BackedgeCount = SE.getPredicatedBackedgeTakenCount(&L, BackedgePred); 13567 addPredicate(BackedgePred); 13568 } 13569 return BackedgeCount; 13570 } 13571 13572 void PredicatedScalarEvolution::addPredicate(const SCEVPredicate &Pred) { 13573 if (Preds.implies(&Pred)) 13574 return; 13575 Preds.add(&Pred); 13576 updateGeneration(); 13577 } 13578 13579 const SCEVUnionPredicate &PredicatedScalarEvolution::getUnionPredicate() const { 13580 return Preds; 13581 } 13582 13583 void PredicatedScalarEvolution::updateGeneration() { 13584 // If the generation number wrapped recompute everything. 13585 if (++Generation == 0) { 13586 for (auto &II : RewriteMap) { 13587 const SCEV *Rewritten = II.second.second; 13588 II.second = {Generation, SE.rewriteUsingPredicate(Rewritten, &L, Preds)}; 13589 } 13590 } 13591 } 13592 13593 void PredicatedScalarEvolution::setNoOverflow( 13594 Value *V, SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags Flags) { 13595 const SCEV *Expr = getSCEV(V); 13596 const auto *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Expr); 13597 13598 auto ImpliedFlags = SCEVWrapPredicate::getImpliedFlags(AR, SE); 13599 13600 // Clear the statically implied flags. 13601 Flags = SCEVWrapPredicate::clearFlags(Flags, ImpliedFlags); 13602 addPredicate(*SE.getWrapPredicate(AR, Flags)); 13603 13604 auto II = FlagsMap.insert({V, Flags}); 13605 if (!II.second) 13606 II.first->second = SCEVWrapPredicate::setFlags(Flags, II.first->second); 13607 } 13608 13609 bool PredicatedScalarEvolution::hasNoOverflow( 13610 Value *V, SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementWrapFlags Flags) { 13611 const SCEV *Expr = getSCEV(V); 13612 const auto *AR = cast<SCEVAddRecExpr>(Expr); 13613 13614 Flags = SCEVWrapPredicate::clearFlags( 13615 Flags, SCEVWrapPredicate::getImpliedFlags(AR, SE)); 13616 13617 auto II = FlagsMap.find(V); 13618 13619 if (II != FlagsMap.end()) 13620 Flags = SCEVWrapPredicate::clearFlags(Flags, II->second); 13621 13622 return Flags == SCEVWrapPredicate::IncrementAnyWrap; 13623 } 13624 13625 const SCEVAddRecExpr *PredicatedScalarEvolution::getAsAddRec(Value *V) { 13626 const SCEV *Expr = this->getSCEV(V); 13627 SmallPtrSet<const SCEVPredicate *, 4> NewPreds; 13628 auto *New = SE.convertSCEVToAddRecWithPredicates(Expr, &L, NewPreds); 13629 13630 if (!New) 13631 return nullptr; 13632 13633 for (auto *P : NewPreds) 13634 Preds.add(P); 13635 13636 updateGeneration(); 13637 RewriteMap[SE.getSCEV(V)] = {Generation, New}; 13638 return New; 13639 } 13640 13641 PredicatedScalarEvolution::PredicatedScalarEvolution( 13642 const PredicatedScalarEvolution &Init) 13643 : RewriteMap(Init.RewriteMap), SE(Init.SE), L(Init.L), Preds(Init.Preds), 13644 Generation(Init.Generation), BackedgeCount(Init.BackedgeCount) { 13645 for (auto I : Init.FlagsMap) 13646 FlagsMap.insert(I); 13647 } 13648 13649 void PredicatedScalarEvolution::print(raw_ostream &OS, unsigned Depth) const { 13650 // For each block. 13651 for (auto *BB : L.getBlocks()) 13652 for (auto &I : *BB) { 13653 if (!SE.isSCEVable(I.getType())) 13654 continue; 13655 13656 auto *Expr = SE.getSCEV(&I); 13657 auto II = RewriteMap.find(Expr); 13658 13659 if (II == RewriteMap.end()) 13660 continue; 13661 13662 // Don't print things that are not interesting. 13663 if (II->second.second == Expr) 13664 continue; 13665 13666 OS.indent(Depth) << "[PSE]" << I << ":\n"; 13667 OS.indent(Depth + 2) << *Expr << "\n"; 13668 OS.indent(Depth + 2) << "--> " << *II->second.second << "\n"; 13669 } 13670 } 13671 13672 // Match the mathematical pattern A - (A / B) * B, where A and B can be 13673 // arbitrary expressions. Also match zext (trunc A to iB) to iY, which is used 13674 // for URem with constant power-of-2 second operands. 13675 // It's not always easy, as A and B can be folded (imagine A is X / 2, and B is 13676 // 4, A / B becomes X / 8). 13677 bool ScalarEvolution::matchURem(const SCEV *Expr, const SCEV *&LHS, 13678 const SCEV *&RHS) { 13679 // Try to match 'zext (trunc A to iB) to iY', which is used 13680 // for URem with constant power-of-2 second operands. Make sure the size of 13681 // the operand A matches the size of the whole expressions. 13682 if (const auto *ZExt = dyn_cast<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(Expr)) 13683 if (const auto *Trunc = dyn_cast<SCEVTruncateExpr>(ZExt->getOperand(0))) { 13684 LHS = Trunc->getOperand(); 13685 // Bail out if the type of the LHS is larger than the type of the 13686 // expression for now. 13687 if (getTypeSizeInBits(LHS->getType()) > 13688 getTypeSizeInBits(Expr->getType())) 13689 return false; 13690 if (LHS->getType() != Expr->getType()) 13691 LHS = getZeroExtendExpr(LHS, Expr->getType()); 13692 RHS = getConstant(APInt(getTypeSizeInBits(Expr->getType()), 1) 13693 << getTypeSizeInBits(Trunc->getType())); 13694 return true; 13695 } 13696 const auto *Add = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(Expr); 13697 if (Add == nullptr || Add->getNumOperands() != 2) 13698 return false; 13699 13700 const SCEV *A = Add->getOperand(1); 13701 const auto *Mul = dyn_cast<SCEVMulExpr>(Add->getOperand(0)); 13702 13703 if (Mul == nullptr) 13704 return false; 13705 13706 const auto MatchURemWithDivisor = [&](const SCEV *B) { 13707 // (SomeExpr + (-(SomeExpr / B) * B)). 13708 if (Expr == getURemExpr(A, B)) { 13709 LHS = A; 13710 RHS = B; 13711 return true; 13712 } 13713 return false; 13714 }; 13715 13716 // (SomeExpr + (-1 * (SomeExpr / B) * B)). 13717 if (Mul->getNumOperands() == 3 && isa<SCEVConstant>(Mul->getOperand(0))) 13718 return MatchURemWithDivisor(Mul->getOperand(1)) || 13719 MatchURemWithDivisor(Mul->getOperand(2)); 13720 13721 // (SomeExpr + ((-SomeExpr / B) * B)) or (SomeExpr + ((SomeExpr / B) * -B)). 13722 if (Mul->getNumOperands() == 2) 13723 return MatchURemWithDivisor(Mul->getOperand(1)) || 13724 MatchURemWithDivisor(Mul->getOperand(0)) || 13725 MatchURemWithDivisor(getNegativeSCEV(Mul->getOperand(1))) || 13726 MatchURemWithDivisor(getNegativeSCEV(Mul->getOperand(0))); 13727 return false; 13728 } 13729 13730 const SCEV * 13731 ScalarEvolution::computeSymbolicMaxBackedgeTakenCount(const Loop *L) { 13732 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 16> ExitingBlocks; 13733 L->getExitingBlocks(ExitingBlocks); 13734 13735 // Form an expression for the maximum exit count possible for this loop. We 13736 // merge the max and exact information to approximate a version of 13737 // getConstantMaxBackedgeTakenCount which isn't restricted to just constants. 13738 SmallVector<const SCEV*, 4> ExitCounts; 13739 for (BasicBlock *ExitingBB : ExitingBlocks) { 13740 const SCEV *ExitCount = getExitCount(L, ExitingBB); 13741 if (isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ExitCount)) 13742 ExitCount = getExitCount(L, ExitingBB, 13743 ScalarEvolution::ConstantMaximum); 13744 if (!isa<SCEVCouldNotCompute>(ExitCount)) { 13745 assert(DT.dominates(ExitingBB, L->getLoopLatch()) && 13746 "We should only have known counts for exiting blocks that " 13747 "dominate latch!"); 13748 ExitCounts.push_back(ExitCount); 13749 } 13750 } 13751 if (ExitCounts.empty()) 13752 return getCouldNotCompute(); 13753 return getUMinFromMismatchedTypes(ExitCounts); 13754 } 13755 13756 /// A rewriter to replace SCEV expressions in Map with the corresponding entry 13757 /// in the map. It skips AddRecExpr because we cannot guarantee that the 13758 /// replacement is loop invariant in the loop of the AddRec. 13759 /// 13760 /// At the moment only rewriting SCEVUnknown and SCEVZeroExtendExpr is 13761 /// supported. 13762 class SCEVLoopGuardRewriter : public SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVLoopGuardRewriter> { 13763 const DenseMap<const SCEV *, const SCEV *> ⤅ 13764 13765 public: 13766 SCEVLoopGuardRewriter(ScalarEvolution &SE, 13767 DenseMap<const SCEV *, const SCEV *> &M) 13768 : SCEVRewriteVisitor(SE), Map(M) {} 13769 13770 const SCEV *visitAddRecExpr(const SCEVAddRecExpr *Expr) { return Expr; } 13771 13772 const SCEV *visitUnknown(const SCEVUnknown *Expr) { 13773 auto I = Map.find(Expr); 13774 if (I == Map.end()) 13775 return Expr; 13776 return I->second; 13777 } 13778 13779 const SCEV *visitZeroExtendExpr(const SCEVZeroExtendExpr *Expr) { 13780 auto I = Map.find(Expr); 13781 if (I == Map.end()) 13782 return SCEVRewriteVisitor<SCEVLoopGuardRewriter>::visitZeroExtendExpr( 13783 Expr); 13784 return I->second; 13785 } 13786 }; 13787 13788 const SCEV *ScalarEvolution::applyLoopGuards(const SCEV *Expr, const Loop *L) { 13789 SmallVector<const SCEV *> ExprsToRewrite; 13790 auto CollectCondition = [&](ICmpInst::Predicate Predicate, const SCEV *LHS, 13791 const SCEV *RHS, 13792 DenseMap<const SCEV *, const SCEV *> 13793 &RewriteMap) { 13794 // WARNING: It is generally unsound to apply any wrap flags to the proposed 13795 // replacement SCEV which isn't directly implied by the structure of that 13796 // SCEV. In particular, using contextual facts to imply flags is *NOT* 13797 // legal. See the scoping rules for flags in the header to understand why. 13798 13799 // If LHS is a constant, apply information to the other expression. 13800 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(LHS)) { 13801 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 13802 Predicate = CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Predicate); 13803 } 13804 13805 // Check for a condition of the form (-C1 + X < C2). InstCombine will 13806 // create this form when combining two checks of the form (X u< C2 + C1) and 13807 // (X >=u C1). 13808 auto MatchRangeCheckIdiom = [this, Predicate, LHS, RHS, &RewriteMap, 13809 &ExprsToRewrite]() { 13810 auto *AddExpr = dyn_cast<SCEVAddExpr>(LHS); 13811 if (!AddExpr || AddExpr->getNumOperands() != 2) 13812 return false; 13813 13814 auto *C1 = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(AddExpr->getOperand(0)); 13815 auto *LHSUnknown = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(AddExpr->getOperand(1)); 13816 auto *C2 = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS); 13817 if (!C1 || !C2 || !LHSUnknown) 13818 return false; 13819 13820 auto ExactRegion = 13821 ConstantRange::makeExactICmpRegion(Predicate, C2->getAPInt()) 13822 .sub(C1->getAPInt()); 13823 13824 // Bail out, unless we have a non-wrapping, monotonic range. 13825 if (ExactRegion.isWrappedSet() || ExactRegion.isFullSet()) 13826 return false; 13827 auto I = RewriteMap.find(LHSUnknown); 13828 const SCEV *RewrittenLHS = I != RewriteMap.end() ? I->second : LHSUnknown; 13829 RewriteMap[LHSUnknown] = getUMaxExpr( 13830 getConstant(ExactRegion.getUnsignedMin()), 13831 getUMinExpr(RewrittenLHS, getConstant(ExactRegion.getUnsignedMax()))); 13832 ExprsToRewrite.push_back(LHSUnknown); 13833 return true; 13834 }; 13835 if (MatchRangeCheckIdiom()) 13836 return; 13837 13838 // If we have LHS == 0, check if LHS is computing a property of some unknown 13839 // SCEV %v which we can rewrite %v to express explicitly. 13840 const SCEVConstant *RHSC = dyn_cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS); 13841 if (Predicate == CmpInst::ICMP_EQ && RHSC && 13842 RHSC->getValue()->isNullValue()) { 13843 // If LHS is A % B, i.e. A % B == 0, rewrite A to (A /u B) * B to 13844 // explicitly express that. 13845 const SCEV *URemLHS = nullptr; 13846 const SCEV *URemRHS = nullptr; 13847 if (matchURem(LHS, URemLHS, URemRHS)) { 13848 if (const SCEVUnknown *LHSUnknown = dyn_cast<SCEVUnknown>(URemLHS)) { 13849 auto Multiple = getMulExpr(getUDivExpr(URemLHS, URemRHS), URemRHS); 13850 RewriteMap[LHSUnknown] = Multiple; 13851 ExprsToRewrite.push_back(LHSUnknown); 13852 return; 13853 } 13854 } 13855 } 13856 13857 // Do not apply information for constants or if RHS contains an AddRec. 13858 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(LHS) || containsAddRecurrence(RHS)) 13859 return; 13860 13861 // If RHS is SCEVUnknown, make sure the information is applied to it. 13862 if (!isa<SCEVUnknown>(LHS) && isa<SCEVUnknown>(RHS)) { 13863 std::swap(LHS, RHS); 13864 Predicate = CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Predicate); 13865 } 13866 13867 // Limit to expressions that can be rewritten. 13868 if (!isa<SCEVUnknown>(LHS) && !isa<SCEVZeroExtendExpr>(LHS)) 13869 return; 13870 13871 // Check whether LHS has already been rewritten. In that case we want to 13872 // chain further rewrites onto the already rewritten value. 13873 auto I = RewriteMap.find(LHS); 13874 const SCEV *RewrittenLHS = I != RewriteMap.end() ? I->second : LHS; 13875 13876 const SCEV *RewrittenRHS = nullptr; 13877 switch (Predicate) { 13878 case CmpInst::ICMP_ULT: 13879 RewrittenRHS = 13880 getUMinExpr(RewrittenLHS, getMinusSCEV(RHS, getOne(RHS->getType()))); 13881 break; 13882 case CmpInst::ICMP_SLT: 13883 RewrittenRHS = 13884 getSMinExpr(RewrittenLHS, getMinusSCEV(RHS, getOne(RHS->getType()))); 13885 break; 13886 case CmpInst::ICMP_ULE: 13887 RewrittenRHS = getUMinExpr(RewrittenLHS, RHS); 13888 break; 13889 case CmpInst::ICMP_SLE: 13890 RewrittenRHS = getSMinExpr(RewrittenLHS, RHS); 13891 break; 13892 case CmpInst::ICMP_UGT: 13893 RewrittenRHS = 13894 getUMaxExpr(RewrittenLHS, getAddExpr(RHS, getOne(RHS->getType()))); 13895 break; 13896 case CmpInst::ICMP_SGT: 13897 RewrittenRHS = 13898 getSMaxExpr(RewrittenLHS, getAddExpr(RHS, getOne(RHS->getType()))); 13899 break; 13900 case CmpInst::ICMP_UGE: 13901 RewrittenRHS = getUMaxExpr(RewrittenLHS, RHS); 13902 break; 13903 case CmpInst::ICMP_SGE: 13904 RewrittenRHS = getSMaxExpr(RewrittenLHS, RHS); 13905 break; 13906 case CmpInst::ICMP_EQ: 13907 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(RHS)) 13908 RewrittenRHS = RHS; 13909 break; 13910 case CmpInst::ICMP_NE: 13911 if (isa<SCEVConstant>(RHS) && 13912 cast<SCEVConstant>(RHS)->getValue()->isNullValue()) 13913 RewrittenRHS = getUMaxExpr(RewrittenLHS, getOne(RHS->getType())); 13914 break; 13915 default: 13916 break; 13917 } 13918 13919 if (RewrittenRHS) { 13920 RewriteMap[LHS] = RewrittenRHS; 13921 if (LHS == RewrittenLHS) 13922 ExprsToRewrite.push_back(LHS); 13923 } 13924 }; 13925 // Starting at the loop predecessor, climb up the predecessor chain, as long 13926 // as there are predecessors that can be found that have unique successors 13927 // leading to the original header. 13928 // TODO: share this logic with isLoopEntryGuardedByCond. 13929 DenseMap<const SCEV *, const SCEV *> RewriteMap; 13930 for (std::pair<const BasicBlock *, const BasicBlock *> Pair( 13931 L->getLoopPredecessor(), L->getHeader()); 13932 Pair.first; Pair = getPredecessorWithUniqueSuccessorForBB(Pair.first)) { 13933 13934 const BranchInst *LoopEntryPredicate = 13935 dyn_cast<BranchInst>(Pair.first->getTerminator()); 13936 if (!LoopEntryPredicate || LoopEntryPredicate->isUnconditional()) 13937 continue; 13938 13939 bool EnterIfTrue = LoopEntryPredicate->getSuccessor(0) == Pair.second; 13940 SmallVector<Value *, 8> Worklist; 13941 SmallPtrSet<Value *, 8> Visited; 13942 Worklist.push_back(LoopEntryPredicate->getCondition()); 13943 while (!Worklist.empty()) { 13944 Value *Cond = Worklist.pop_back_val(); 13945 if (!Visited.insert(Cond).second) 13946 continue; 13947 13948 if (auto *Cmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Cond)) { 13949 auto Predicate = 13950 EnterIfTrue ? Cmp->getPredicate() : Cmp->getInversePredicate(); 13951 CollectCondition(Predicate, getSCEV(Cmp->getOperand(0)), 13952 getSCEV(Cmp->getOperand(1)), RewriteMap); 13953 continue; 13954 } 13955 13956 Value *L, *R; 13957 if (EnterIfTrue ? match(Cond, m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(L), m_Value(R))) 13958 : match(Cond, m_LogicalOr(m_Value(L), m_Value(R)))) { 13959 Worklist.push_back(L); 13960 Worklist.push_back(R); 13961 } 13962 } 13963 } 13964 13965 // Also collect information from assumptions dominating the loop. 13966 for (auto &AssumeVH : AC.assumptions()) { 13967 if (!AssumeVH) 13968 continue; 13969 auto *AssumeI = cast<CallInst>(AssumeVH); 13970 auto *Cmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(AssumeI->getOperand(0)); 13971 if (!Cmp || !DT.dominates(AssumeI, L->getHeader())) 13972 continue; 13973 CollectCondition(Cmp->getPredicate(), getSCEV(Cmp->getOperand(0)), 13974 getSCEV(Cmp->getOperand(1)), RewriteMap); 13975 } 13976 13977 if (RewriteMap.empty()) 13978 return Expr; 13979 13980 // Now that all rewrite information is collect, rewrite the collected 13981 // expressions with the information in the map. This applies information to 13982 // sub-expressions. 13983 if (ExprsToRewrite.size() > 1) { 13984 for (const SCEV *Expr : ExprsToRewrite) { 13985 const SCEV *RewriteTo = RewriteMap[Expr]; 13986 RewriteMap.erase(Expr); 13987 SCEVLoopGuardRewriter Rewriter(*this, RewriteMap); 13988 RewriteMap.insert({Expr, Rewriter.visit(RewriteTo)}); 13989 } 13990 } 13991 13992 SCEVLoopGuardRewriter Rewriter(*this, RewriteMap); 13993 return Rewriter.visit(Expr); 13994 } 13995